OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 V100R006C03
Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer) Issue
01
Date
2012-09-30
HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.
Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2012. All rights reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Trademarks and Permissions and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective holders.
Notice The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and the customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be within the purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements, information, and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees or representations of any kind, either express or implied. The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and recommendations in this document do not constitute a warranty of any kind, express or implied.
Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Address:
Huawei Industrial Base Bantian, Longgang Shenzhen 518129 People's Republic of China
Website:
http://www.huawei.com
Email:
[email protected]
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
i
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
About This Document
About This Document
Related Versions Product Name
Version
OptiX OSN 8800
V100R006C03
OptiX OSN 6800
V100R006C03
OptiX OSN 3800
V100R006C03
iManager U2000
V100R006C00
iManager U2000 Web LCT
V100R006C00
Intended Audience This document provides guides to get the information about how to installing, perform initial commissioning the products. This document also provides guides for routine operation on site. This document is intended for: l
Field Engineer
Symbol Conventions The symbols that may be found in this document are defined as follows. Symbol
Description
DANGER
WARNING Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Indicates a hazard with a high level of risk, which if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury. Indicates a hazard with a medium or low level of risk, which if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
ii
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Symbol
About This Document
Description
CAUTION
Indicates a potentially hazardous situation, which if not avoided, could result in equipment damage, data loss, performance degradation, or unexpected results.
TIP
Indicates a tip that may help you solve a problem or save time.
NOTE
Provides additional information to emphasize or supplement important points of the main text.
GUI Conventions The GUI conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows. Convention
Description
Boldface
Buttons, menus, parameters, tabs, window, and dialog titles are in boldface. For example, click OK.
>
Multi-level menus are in boldface and separated by the ">" signs. For example, choose File > Create > Folder.
Change History Updates between document issues are cumulative. Therefore, the latest document issue contains all updates made in previous issues.
Updates in Issue 01 (2012-09-30) Based on Product Version V100R006C03 This issue is the first official release for OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 V100R006C03.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
iii
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Contents
Contents About This Document.....................................................................................................................ii 1 Obtaining Latest Technical Documentation............................................................................1 2 Safety Operation Guide...............................................................................................................2 2.1 Alarm and Safety Symbols.................................................................................................................................3 2.2 Safe Usage of Fibers...........................................................................................................................................3 2.3 Operations on the Equipment with Power on.....................................................................................................6 2.4 ESD.....................................................................................................................................................................6
3 Quick View of Product.................................................................................................................8 3.1 Product Appearance and Highlights.................................................................................................................10 3.2 OptiX OSN 8800 Subrack and Power Requirement........................................................................................13 3.2.1 OptiX OSN 8800 T64 Subrack................................................................................................................13 3.2.1.1 Structure..........................................................................................................................................13 3.2.1.2 Slot Description..............................................................................................................................15 3.2.1.3 Management Interfaces...................................................................................................................16 3.2.1.4 Cross-Connect Capacities...............................................................................................................17 3.2.1.5 Fan..................................................................................................................................................18 3.2.1.6 Power Consumption.......................................................................................................................23 3.2.1.7 Power Requirement........................................................................................................................24 3.2.2 OptiX OSN 8800 T32 Subrack................................................................................................................27 3.2.2.1 Structure..........................................................................................................................................28 3.2.2.2 Slot Description..............................................................................................................................29 3.2.2.3 Management Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T32..........................................................................31 3.2.2.4 Cross-Connect Capacities...............................................................................................................32 3.2.2.5 Fan..................................................................................................................................................32 3.2.2.6 Power Consumption.......................................................................................................................38 3.2.2.7 Power Requirement........................................................................................................................40 3.2.3 OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Subrack................................................................................................................43 3.2.3.1 Structure..........................................................................................................................................43 3.2.3.2 Slot Description..............................................................................................................................44 3.2.3.3 Management Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T16..........................................................................45 3.2.3.4 Cross-Connect Capacities...............................................................................................................46 3.2.3.5 Fan..................................................................................................................................................46 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
iv
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Contents
3.2.3.6 Power Consumption.......................................................................................................................51 3.2.3.7 Power Requirement........................................................................................................................52 3.3 OptiX OSN 6800 Subrack and Power Requirement........................................................................................55 3.3.1 Structure...................................................................................................................................................55 3.3.2 Slot Description.......................................................................................................................................56 3.3.3 Cross-Connect Capacities........................................................................................................................57 3.3.4 Fan...........................................................................................................................................................59 3.3.5 Power Consumption................................................................................................................................64 3.3.6 Power Requirement.................................................................................................................................65 3.4 OptiX OSN 3800 Chassis and Power Requirement.........................................................................................67 3.4.1 Chassis Structure.....................................................................................................................................67 3.4.2 Slot Description.......................................................................................................................................68 3.4.3 Fan...........................................................................................................................................................69 3.4.4 AC Power Consumption..........................................................................................................................73 3.4.5 AC Power Requirement...........................................................................................................................73 3.4.6 DC Power Consumption..........................................................................................................................75 3.4.7 DC Power Requirement...........................................................................................................................76 3.5 DC PDU............................................................................................................................................................78 3.5.1 TN16PDU/TN51PDU.............................................................................................................................78 3.5.2 TN11PDU................................................................................................................................................80 3.6 Frame................................................................................................................................................................82 3.6.1 DCM Frame and DCM Module...............................................................................................................82 3.6.2 CRPC Frame............................................................................................................................................86 3.6.3 Fiber Spooling Frame..............................................................................................................................87 3.7 Overview of Boards..........................................................................................................................................88 3.7.1 Board Appearance and Dimensions........................................................................................................89 3.7.1.1 Appearance and Dimensions..........................................................................................................89 3.7.1.2 Symbols on Boards.........................................................................................................................91 3.7.2 OptiX OSN 8800 Board Category...........................................................................................................93 3.7.3 OptiX OSN 6800 Board Category.........................................................................................................100 3.7.4 OptiX OSN 3800 Board Category.........................................................................................................106 3.7.5 Optical Attenuator.................................................................................................................................110 3.7.5.1 Fixed Optical Attenuator .............................................................................................................110 3.7.5.2 Mechanical Variable Optical Attenuator......................................................................................111 3.8 Quick Reference Table of the Units...............................................................................................................111 3.8.1 Specification of OTUs, Tributary Boards, Line Boards .......................................................................111 3.8.1.1 OTUs and Tributary Boards Specification on the Client Side.....................................................111 3.8.1.2 OTUs and Line Boards Specification on the WDM Side.............................................................148 3.8.2 Specification of Optical Amplifying Unit.............................................................................................165 3.8.3 Insertion Loss Specifications of Boards................................................................................................167 3.8.4 MON Interface Optical Split Ratio........................................................................................................170 3.8.5 Basic Functions of OTUs, Tributary Boards, and Line Boards.............................................................171 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
v
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Contents
3.8.6 Loopback Function of OTUs, Tributary Boards, and Line Boards.......................................................177 3.8.7 Protection mode of OTUs, Tributary Boards and Line Boards ............................................................181 3.8.8 Electrical cross-connection of OTUs, Tributary Boards and Line Boards............................................183 3.9 Power Consumption, Weight, and Valid Slots of Boards..............................................................................187 3.9.1 Power Consumption, Weight and Slots of Boards in the OptiX OSN 8800.........................................187 3.9.2 Power Consumption, Weight and Slots of Boards in the OptiX OSN 6800.........................................238 3.9.3 Power Consumption, Weight and Slots of Boards in the OptiX OSN 3800.........................................267 3.10 Housekeeping Alarms...................................................................................................................................288 3.10.1 OptiX OSN 8800 Housekeeping Alarm Interfaces.............................................................................288 3.10.2 OptiX OSN 6800 Housekeeping Alarm Interfaces.............................................................................292 3.10.3 OptiX OSN 3800 Housekeeping Alarm Interfaces.............................................................................294 3.11 Network Management..................................................................................................................................297 3.11.1 Introduction to Network Cables..........................................................................................................298 3.11.2 Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T32/T64............................................299 3.11.2.1 Interfaces....................................................................................................................................299 3.11.2.2 Connections................................................................................................................................307 3.11.3 Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T16...................................................308 3.11.3.1 Interfaces....................................................................................................................................309 3.11.3.2 Connections................................................................................................................................316 3.11.4 Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 6800...........................................................317 3.11.4.1 Interfaces....................................................................................................................................318 3.11.4.2 Connections................................................................................................................................332 3.11.5 Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 3800...........................................................333 3.11.5.1 Interfaces....................................................................................................................................333 3.11.5.2 Connections................................................................................................................................340 3.11.6 Management Connections among OptiX OSN 8800&6800&3800....................................................342
4 Node Configurations................................................................................................................345 4.1 OTN Typical Configuration...........................................................................................................................346 4.1.1 OTM/Back to Back OTM......................................................................................................................346 4.1.1.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................346 4.1.1.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................347 4.1.1.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................348 4.1.2 1 Degree ROADM.................................................................................................................................349 4.1.2.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................350 4.1.2.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................351 4.1.2.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................352 4.1.3 2 Degree ROADM.................................................................................................................................353 4.1.3.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................353 4.1.3.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................355 4.1.3.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................356 4.1.4 3 Degree ROADM.................................................................................................................................357 4.1.4.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................357 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
vi
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Contents
4.1.4.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................360 4.1.4.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................361 4.1.5 4 Degree ROADM.................................................................................................................................362 4.1.5.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................362 4.1.5.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................365 4.1.5.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................366 4.1.6 OLA.......................................................................................................................................................367 4.1.6.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................367 4.1.6.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................368 4.1.6.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................369 4.1.7 Regenerator............................................................................................................................................370 4.1.7.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................370 4.1.7.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................371 4.1.7.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................372 4.1.8 FOADM.................................................................................................................................................373 4.1.8.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................374 4.1.8.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................374 4.1.8.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................375 4.1.9 CWDM..................................................................................................................................................376 4.1.9.1 Signal Flow...................................................................................................................................376 4.1.9.2 Subrack Layout.............................................................................................................................377 4.1.9.3 Subrack Connections....................................................................................................................378 4.2 OCS Typical Configuration............................................................................................................................379
5 Quick Installation Guide.........................................................................................................381 6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning.....................................................................382 6.1 Initial Commissioning Flow...........................................................................................................................384 6.2 Connecting NEs to the Web LCT...................................................................................................................385 6.2.1 Installing the Web LCT.........................................................................................................................385 6.2.2 Connecting to NEs.................................................................................................................................387 6.2.3 Logging In to the Web LCT..................................................................................................................387 6.3 Configuring NE Attributes.............................................................................................................................388 6.3.1 Searching and Adding NEs....................................................................................................................388 6.3.2 Logging In to an NE..............................................................................................................................390 6.3.3 Setting NE ID........................................................................................................................................390 6.3.4 Setting NE IP Addresses........................................................................................................................390 6.3.5 Configuring Master-Slave Subracks......................................................................................................391 6.4 Checking Board Slots.....................................................................................................................................392 6.5 Configuring the TN11TOM Board On-site....................................................................................................393 6.5.1 Working Mode and Signal Flow...........................................................................................................393 6.5.2 Scenario 1: ODU1 tributary mode (cascading).....................................................................................394 6.5.3 Scenario 2: ODU1 tributary-line mode (cascading)..............................................................................397 6.5.4 Scenario 3: ODU1 tributary mode (non-cascading)..............................................................................402 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
vii
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Contents
6.5.5 Scenario 4: ODU1 tributary-line mode (non-cascading).......................................................................405 6.5.6 Scenario 5: ODU1 tributary-line mode (electrical regeneration board)................................................407 6.6 Configuring the TN52TOM Board On-site....................................................................................................412 6.6.1 Working Mode and Signal Flow...........................................................................................................412 6.6.2 Scenario 2: ODU0 tributary-line mode (cascading)..............................................................................414 6.6.3 Scenario 4: ODU1 tributary-line mode (cascading)..............................................................................417 6.6.4 Scenario 6: ODU0 tributary-line mode (non-cascading).......................................................................420 6.6.5 Scenario 7: ODU1 mode (non-cascading).............................................................................................424 6.6.6 Scenario 8: ODU1_ANY_ODU0_ODU1 re-encapsulation mode (non-cascading).............................427 6.6.7 Scenario 9: ODU1_ANY_ODU0_ODU1 re-encapsulation tributary-line mode (non-cascading).......430 6.6.8 Scenario 10: ODU1 tributary-line mode (non-cascading).....................................................................435 6.6.9 Scenario 11: ODU1_ODU0 mode (non-cascading)..............................................................................441 6.6.10 Scenario 12: ODU1_ANY_ODU0 re-encapsulation mode (non-cascading)......................................444 6.7 Configuring the OA Boards............................................................................................................................447 6.8 Checking NE Communication Status.............................................................................................................448 6.9 Backing Up the NE Database to the SCC Board............................................................................................449 6.10 Exiting the Web LCT...................................................................................................................................450
7 Routine Operation On-site......................................................................................................451 7.1 Getting to Know Indicators............................................................................................................................452 7.1.1 Cabinet Indicators..................................................................................................................................452 7.1.2 Subrack Indicator...................................................................................................................................452 7.1.3 Chassis Indicators..................................................................................................................................453 7.1.4 Board Indicators....................................................................................................................................453 7.1.5 Fan Indicator..........................................................................................................................................457 7.1.6 PIU Indicator.........................................................................................................................................458 7.2 Testing Optical Power by Using an Optical Power Meter.............................................................................458 7.3 Checking Fiber Jumpers by Using an Optical Power Meter..........................................................................459 7.4 Inserting and Removing Fiber Jumpers..........................................................................................................461 7.4.1 Inserting the LC/PC Fiber Connector....................................................................................................462 7.4.2 Removing the LC/PC Fiber Connector.................................................................................................463 7.4.3 Inserting the LSH/APC Fiber Connector...............................................................................................465 7.4.4 Removing the LSH/APC Fiber Connector............................................................................................466 7.4.5 Inserting the FC/PC Fiber Connector....................................................................................................468 7.4.6 Removing the FC/PC Fiber Connector..................................................................................................469 7.4.7 Inserting the SC/PC Fiber Connector....................................................................................................470 7.4.8 Removing the SC/PC Fiber Connector..................................................................................................471 7.5 Inspecting and Cleaning the Optical Fiber Connectors..................................................................................472 7.5.1 Overview...............................................................................................................................................473 7.5.2 Protection of Optical Connectors..........................................................................................................474 7.5.3 Tools, Equipment, and Materials...........................................................................................................475 7.5.4 Inspecting Optical Connectors...............................................................................................................477 7.5.5 Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Cartridge Cleaners..............................................................480 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
viii
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Contents
7.5.6 Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Lens Tissue.........................................................................483 7.5.7 Cleaning Optical Adapters Using Optical Cleaning Sticks...................................................................485 7.6 Performing Hardware Loopback....................................................................................................................487 7.7 Reset a Board..................................................................................................................................................489 7.7.1 Performing a Warm Reset on the Board................................................................................................489 7.7.2 Performing a Cold Reset on the Board..................................................................................................490
8 Parts Replacement.....................................................................................................................492 8.1 General Guide for Replacing a Board............................................................................................................494 8.1.1 Prerequisite............................................................................................................................................495 8.1.2 Impact on the System............................................................................................................................495 8.1.3 Tools, Equipment, and Materials...........................................................................................................497 8.1.4 Precautions.............................................................................................................................................497 8.1.5 Procedure for Replacing a Board...........................................................................................................500 8.1.6 Substitution Relationships.....................................................................................................................506 8.1.6.1 Optical Transponder Boards.........................................................................................................506 8.1.6.2 Tributary and Line Boards............................................................................................................509 8.1.6.3 Optical Multiplexer and Demultiplexer Boards...........................................................................512 8.1.6.4 Optical Add and Drop Multiplexing Boards................................................................................514 8.1.6.5 Reconfigurable Optical Add and Drop Multiplexing Boards.......................................................514 8.1.6.6 Optical Amplifier Boards.............................................................................................................514 8.1.6.7 Optical Supervisory Channel Boards...........................................................................................515 8.1.6.8 Optical Protection Boards.............................................................................................................515 8.1.6.9 Spectrum Analyzer Boards...........................................................................................................515 8.1.6.10 Variable Optical Attenuator Boards...........................................................................................515 8.1.6.11 Optical Power and Dispersion Equalizing Boards.....................................................................515 8.1.6.12 Clock Board................................................................................................................................515 8.2 Replacing an SCC Board with One of the Same TNxx Version....................................................................516 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC..............................................................................................................517 8.2.2 Replacing the Protected SCC in a Master Subrack...............................................................................524 8.2.3 Replacing the Unprotected SCC in a Master Subrack...........................................................................527 8.2.3.1 Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data from the NMS (NE Is Unreachable)............528 8.2.3.2 Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data from a CF Card (NE Is Unreachable)..........534 8.2.3.3 Replacing the SCC After Configuring SCC 1+1 Protection........................................................540 8.2.3.4 Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data to the NMS (NE Is Reachable)....................543 8.2.3.5 Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data to a CF Card (NE Is Reachable)..................550 8.2.4 Replacing the SCC Board in a Slave Subrack.......................................................................................557 8.3 Replacing the SCC Board with One of a Different TNxx Version................................................................559 8.3.1 Substitution Relationships.....................................................................................................................559 8.3.2 Replacing the Protected SCC Board in a Master Subrack.....................................................................560 8.3.3 Replacing the Unprotected SCC Board in a Master Subrack................................................................564 8.3.3.1 Replacing the SCC with the Database Backed Up to the NMS...................................................564 8.3.3.2 Replacing the SCC with the Database Backed Up to a CF Card.................................................572 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
ix
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Contents
8.3.3.3 Replacing the Board After Configuring SCC 1+1 Protection......................................................579 8.3.4 Replacing the SCC in a Slave Subrack..................................................................................................582 8.4 Replacing the TN16XCH Board.....................................................................................................................585 8.4.1 Setting the Battery Jumper on the TN16XCH Board............................................................................585 8.4.2 Replacing the TN16XCH Board in a Master Subrack..........................................................................587 8.4.3 Replacing the TN16XCH Board in a Slave Subrack.............................................................................590 8.5 Replacing the Cross-Connect Board...............................................................................................................592 8.5.1 Substitution Relationships.....................................................................................................................592 8.5.2 Under Board 1+1 Protection..................................................................................................................593 8.5.3 Under No Protection..............................................................................................................................595 8.6 Replacing the Raman Amplifier Board..........................................................................................................596 8.7 Replacing the PID Board................................................................................................................................598 8.7.1 Replacing the ENQ2/NPO2/NPO2E Board..........................................................................................598 8.7.1.1 Under ODUk SNCP Protection....................................................................................................598 8.7.1.2 Under No Protection.....................................................................................................................602 8.7.2 Replacing the PQ2 Sub-board...............................................................................................................605 8.7.2.1 Under ODUk SNCP Protection....................................................................................................605 8.7.2.2 Under No Protection.....................................................................................................................607 8.8 Replacing the AUX Board..............................................................................................................................609 8.9 Replacing the DCM........................................................................................................................................614 8.10 Replacing the Pluggable Optical Module.....................................................................................................615 8.11 Replacing the EFI Frame..............................................................................................................................617 8.12 Replacing the EFI Board..............................................................................................................................619 8.13 Replacing the PIU Board..............................................................................................................................622 8.14 Replacing the Power Switch on the DC Power Distribution Box................................................................624 8.15 Replacing the Fan Tray Assembly................................................................................................................627 8.16 Replacing the Air Filter................................................................................................................................627 8.17 Replacing SDI Components.........................................................................................................................630 8.18 Replacing the Subrack..................................................................................................................................631
9 Nominal Central Wavelength and Frequency of the DWDM System ...........................639 10 Nominal Central Wavelengths of the CWDM System ...................................................641
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
x
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
1
1 Obtaining Latest Technical Documentation
Obtaining Latest Technical Documentation This section explains how to obtain the latest technical documentations. You can directly obtain the latest technical documentation from Huawei's technical support website to help analyze and locate faults. Website: http://support.huawei.com
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
1
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2
2 Safety Operation Guide
Safety Operation Guide
About This Chapter This section describes the safety operation guidelines. It contains the personal safety regulations and equipment operating regulations. These regulations must be followed to prevent personal injuries or damages to the equipment during operations. 2.1 Alarm and Safety Symbols During equipment installation and maintenance, observe the precautions indicated by the alarm and safety symbols to help prevent personal injury or equipment damage. 2.2 Safe Usage of Fibers This section describes how to safely use fibers. 2.3 Operations on the Equipment with Power on This section describes the requirements for performing operations on the equipment when the power is on. 2.4 ESD During installation and maintenance, follow antistatic procedures to prevent equipment damage:
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
2
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2 Safety Operation Guide
2.1 Alarm and Safety Symbols During equipment installation and maintenance, observe the precautions indicated by the alarm and safety symbols to help prevent personal injury or equipment damage. Table 2-1 describes the alarm and safety symbols on the WDM equipment. Table 2-1 Symbols on the WDM equipment Symbol
Describes ESD protection symbol. You must wear an ESD wrist strap or glove to avoid damage caused by electrostatic discharge to boards.
Laser level symbol. Indicates the laser level and warns that laser beams can cause injuries to eyes.
CAUTION
HAZARD LEVEL 1M INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION DO NOT VIEW DIRECTLY WITH NON-ATTENUATING OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS
Grounding symbol. Indicates the position of the grounding point. Regular cleaning symbol. Warns you to regularly clean the air filter. Fan warning symbol. Warns you not to touch the fan blade until the fan stops moving.
2.2 Safe Usage of Fibers This section describes how to safely use fibers.
DANGER Laser beams on the optical interface board or inside the optical fiber can cause damage to your eyes. When installing and maintaining optical interface boards and optical fibers, avoid directly exposing your eyes to the laser beams originating from the optical interfaces or fiber connectors.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
3
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2 Safety Operation Guide
Protection of Optical Connectors All idle optical connectors for fiber jumpers and optical ports on the optical interface boards must be covered with protective caps. The optical ports on the replaced boards must be promptly covered with protective caps. In addition, properly store these boards in their packages to keep the optical ports clean. Recommended protective caps are shown in Figure 2-1. Figure 2-1 Recommended protective caps
Protective caps that are not recommended are shown in Figure 2-2. Figure 2-2 Protective caps that are not recommended
NOTE
Do not use protective caps that are made of soft rubber. These caps tend to collect dust and other material. These caps are hard to clean and do not resist the build-up of dust.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
4
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2 Safety Operation Guide
Connecting Fibers
CAUTION When applying a physical fiber loopback between two optical ports, increase the attenuation to avoid equipment damage in case the laser optical power is excessively high. For boards that have the capability of having optical attenuators added, add an optical attenuator at the Rx optical port rather than at the Tx optical port. Insert fibers into optical connectors carefully when connecting fibers. If the optical power is excessively high, add a fixed optical attenuator before the optical port to avoid damages to the device caused by a high input of optical power.
DANGER Before removing or inserting fibers from/into the CRPC board, shut down the pump laser to avoid injuries due to the high optical power from the laser. The CRPC board has specific requirements on fiber loss of the line nearby. For details, see Table 2-2. Table 2-2 Fiber connection requirements of the CRPC Distance
Loss (dB)
Connector (piece)
0–10 (km)
≤0.1
0
10–20 (km)
≤0.2
0
NOTE
The ODF has only one connector for connecting to the CRPC board. All the other fiber connection points must be spliced.
Cleaning Fibers
CAUTION If fiber connectors or flanges are contaminated, optical power commissioning is seriously affected. Therefore, the two endfaces and flanges for each external fiber must be cleaned before the fibers from the ODF are inserted into the optical ports on the boards in the equipment. The fiber connectors and optical ports for the lasers must be cleaned by using special cleaning tools and materials. Some common cleaning tools are: Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
5
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2 Safety Operation Guide
l
Cleaning solvent. Isoamylol is preferred, propyl can be used (alcohol or formalin is never used)
l
Non-woven lens tissue
l
Special compressed gas
l
Dust-free cotton stick
l
Special cleaning roll used along with cleaning solvent, either isoamylol or propyl
l
Fiberscope
For details on how to clean fibers, see the Supporting Tasks.
2.3 Operations on the Equipment with Power on This section describes the requirements for performing operations on the equipment when the power is on. Follow these requirements when performing operations on the equipment when the power is on: l
Do not install or disassemble equipment when the power is on.
l
Do not install or remove power cables when the power is on.
l
Before connecting a cable, ensure that the cable and cable label comply with installation requirements.
2.4 ESD During installation and maintenance, follow antistatic procedures to prevent equipment damage: l
Always wear an ESD wrist strap during the operation.
l
Check that the equipment is securely grounded.
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch equipment or boards. Make sure that the wrist strap touches your skin. Insert the ESD strap connector into the ESD socket of the equipment. For information about how to wear an ESD wrist strap, see Figure 2-3.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
6
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2 Safety Operation Guide
Figure 2-3 Wearing an ESD wrist strap
NOTE
Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the equipment port. For details, see the Quick Installation Guide.
When you are following antistatic procedures, take the following precautions: l
Check the validity and functionality of the wrist strap. Its resistance value must be between 0.75 mega ohm to 10 mega ohm. If the wrist strap validity period (usually two years) has expired, or if the resistance value fails to meet requirements, replace it with a wrist strap that provides the required resistance value.
l
Do not touch a board with your clothing. Clothing generates static electricity that is not protected by the wrist strap.
l
Wear an ESD wrist strap and place the board on an ESD pad when you replace boards or chips. Use ESD tweezers or extraction tools to replace chips. Do not touch chips, circuits, or pins with your bare hands.
l
Keep the boards and other ESD-sensitive parts you are installing in ESD bags. Place the removed boards and components on an ESD pad or ESD material. Do not use non-antistatic materials such as white foams, common plastic bags, or paper bags to pack boards, and do not let these materials touch the boards.
l
Wear an ESD wrist strap when operating the ports of boards because they are also ESDsensitive. Discharge the static electricity of cables and protective sleeves before you connect them to the ports.
l
Keep packing materials (such as, ESD boxes and bags) available in the equipment room for packing boards in the future.
ESD complies with IEC Publication 1000, EN 55022, EN 55024, IEC 61000 and GR-1089CORE.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
7
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3
3 Quick View of Product
Quick View of Product
About This Chapter
3.1 Product Appearance and Highlights There are three types of the OptiX OSN 8800. The three types use the same software and hardware platforms and therefore they share most of the boards. However, each of them has its own highlights that address diverse network requirements.OptiX OSN 6800 applies to the convergence layer and the backbone layer with small or medium capacity.OptiX OSN 3800 applies to the access layer. 3.2 OptiX OSN 8800 Subrack and Power Requirement 3.3 OptiX OSN 6800 Subrack and Power Requirement 3.4 OptiX OSN 3800 Chassis and Power Requirement 3.5 DC PDU There are four types of power distribution units (PDUs): TN16, TN51, TN11 and PDU (DPD63-8-8). The availability of the boards is subject to the PCNs. For the availability of the boards, contact the product manager of your Huawei local office. 3.6 Frame 3.7 Overview of Boards 3.8 Quick Reference Table of the Units Quick reference tables include those for specifications of optical transponder units, optical amplifier units and other boards, and also the functions of OTUs, tributary boards and line boards. 3.9 Power Consumption, Weight, and Valid Slots of Boards This chapter describes the power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the boards. 3.10 Housekeeping Alarms Users can configure the severities for the eight alarm inputs to remotely monitor the alarms of an external system. The alarms can be sent to a centralized alarm management system for management. In addition, two housekeeping control interfaces are available for remotely controlling external equipment such as air conditioners, fans, and electric generators. 3.11 Network Management Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
8
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
This chapter describes the network management system, as well as inter-NE and intra-NE communication management.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
9
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.1 Product Appearance and Highlights There are three types of the OptiX OSN 8800. The three types use the same software and hardware platforms and therefore they share most of the boards. However, each of them has its own highlights that address diverse network requirements.OptiX OSN 6800 applies to the convergence layer and the backbone layer with small or medium capacity.OptiX OSN 3800 applies to the access layer. Table 3-1 describes the product appearance and highlights for OptiX OSN 8800. Table 3-2 describes the product appearance and highlights for OptiX OSN 6800. Table 3-3 describes the product appearance and highlights for OptiX OSN 3800. Table 3-1 Product appearance and highlights for OptiX OSN 8800 Specifications
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
Dimensions (mm)
498 (W) x 295 (D) x 450 (H)
498 (W) x 295 (D) x 900 (H)
498 (W) x 580 (D) x 900 (H)
Number of slots for service boards
16
32
64
1.28T ODUk(k=0, 1, 2, 2e, 3, flex)
2.56T ODUk(k=0, 1, 2, 2e, 3, flex)
Product appearance
Swit ch
Optical
1 to 9-degree ROADM
Electrical
640G ODUk(k=0, 1, 2, 2e, 3, flex)
Wavelength (max)
DWDM: 80-ch, CWDM: 8-ch
Wavelength range
DWDM: 1529.16 nm to 1560.61 nm (Band-C, ITU-T G.694.1) CWDM: 1471 nm to 1611 nm (Band S+C+L, ITU-T G.694.2)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Max. rate per channel
100Gbit/s (OTU4)
Service types supported
SDH, SONET, Ethernet, SAN, OTN, Video
Line rate
2.5 Gbit/s, 10 Gbit/s, 40 Gbit/s, 100 Gbit/s
Max. capacity per PID group
200 Gbit/s
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
10
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Specifications
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
Topology
Point-to-point, chain, star, ring, ring-with-chain, tangent ring, intersecting ring and mesh
Red unda ncy and Prot ectio n
Network level protection (OTN)
Optical line protection, intra-board 1+1 protection, client 1+1 protection, ODUk SNCP, tributary SNCP, SW SNCP, ODUk SPRing protection, OWSP
Network level protection (OCS)
-
Linear MSP, MSP ring, transoceanic MSP ring, SNCP, SNCTP
Network level protection (Ethernet)
DBPS, DLAG, ERPS, LAG, LPT, MC-LAG, MSTP, STP and RSTP, VLAN SNCP
DBPS, DLAG, ERPS, LAG, LPT, MC-LAG, MSTP, STP and RSTP, VLAN SNCP
Equipment level protection
Power redundancy, fan redundancy, cross-connect board redundancy, system control and communication board redundancy, centralized clock board redundancy
Optical power management
ALS, AGC, ALC, APE, IPA, OPA
Synchronization
l Synchronous Ethernet clock
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
DBPS, DLAG, ERPS, LAG, LPT, MC-LAG, MSTP, STP and RSTP, VLAN SNCP
l IEEE 1588v2 l 2 Mbit/s or 2 MHz (with the SSM function), ITU-T G.703compliant external clock source l External time source (1PPS+TOD) ASON
Optical-Layer ASON and electrical-Layer ASON
Table 3-2 Product appearance and highlights for OptiX OSN 6800 Specifications
OptiX OSN 6800
Product appearance
Dimensions (mm)
497 (W) x 295 (D) x 400 (H)
Number of slots for service boards
17
Switch
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Optical
1 to 9-degree ROADM
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
11
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Specifications Electrical
3 Quick View of Product
OptiX OSN 6800 l 180G GE l 360G 10GE/ODUk(k=1, 2, 2e)
Wavelength (max)
DWDM: 80-ch, CWDM: 8-ch
Wavelength range
DWDM: 1529.16 nm to 1560.61 nm (Band-C, ITU-T G. 694.1) CWDM: 1471 nm to 1611 nm (Band S+C+L, ITU-T G. 694.2)
Max. rate per channel
100 Gbit/s (OTU4)
Max. distance
Multi-span transmission: 32 span x 22 dB/span (10G), 25 span x 22 dB/span (40G), 14 span x 22 dB/span (100G) without electrical regeneration Ultra-long single-span transmission: 1 span x 81 dB/span (10G), 1 span x 71 dB/span (40G)
Service types supported
SDH, SONET, Ethernet, SAN, OTN, Video
Line rate
2.5 Gbit/s, 10 Gbit/s, 40 Gbit/s, 100 Gbit/s
Max. capacity per PID group
120 Gbit/s
Topology
Point-to-point, chain, star, ring, ring-with-chain, tangent ring, intersecting ring and mesh
Redundancy and Protection
Network level protection (OTN)
Optical line protection, intra-board 1+1 protection, client 1+1 protection, ODUk SNCP, tributary SNCP, SW SNCP, MS SNCP, ODUk SPRing protection, OWSP, board-Level protection
Network level protection (Ethernet)
DBPS, DLAG, ERPS, LAG, LPT, MSTP, STP and RSTP, VLAN SNCP
Equipment level protection
Power redundancy, fan redundancy, cross-connect board redundancy, system control and communication board redundancy
Optical power management
ALS, AGC, ALC, APE, IPA, OPA
Synchronization
l Synchronous Ethernet clock l IEEE 1588v2 l 2 Mbit/s or 2 MHz (with the SSM function), ITU-T G.703-compliant external clock source l External time source (1PPS+TOD)
ASON
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Optical-Layer ASON
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
12
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-3 Product appearance and highlights for OptiX OSN 3800 Specifications
OptiX OSN 3800
Product appearance Dimensions (mm)
436 (W) x 295 (D) x 134 (H)
Number of slots for service boards
4
Wavelength (max)
DWDM: 80-ch, CWDM: 8-ch
Wavelength range
DWDM: 1529.16 nm to 1560.61 nm (Band-C, ITU-T G. 694.1) CWDM: 1471 nm to 1611 nm (Band S+C+L, ITU-T G. 694.2)
Max. rate per channel
10 Gbit/s (OTU2)
Max. distance
Multi-span transmission: 32 span x 22 dB/span (10G), without electrical regeneration Ultra-long single-span transmission: 1 span x 81 dB/span (10G)
Service types supported
SDH, SONET, Ethernet, SAN, OTN, Video
Line rate
2.5 Gbit/s, 10 Gbit/s
Topology
Point-to-point, chain, star, ring, ring-with-chain, tangent ring, intersecting ring and mesh
Redundancy and Protection
Optical line protection, intra-board 1+1 protection, client 1+1 protection, ODUk SNCP, tributary SNCP, SW SNCP, MS SNCP, OWSP, board-Level protection
Network level protection
Equipment level protection Optical power management
DBPS, DLAG, ERPS, LAG, LPT, STP and RSTP, VLAN SNCP Power redundancy, fan redundancy, system control and communication board redundancy ALS, AGC, ALC, IPA
3.2 OptiX OSN 8800 Subrack and Power Requirement 3.2.1 OptiX OSN 8800 T64 Subrack 3.2.1.1 Structure Subracks are the basic working units of the OptiX OSN 8800 T64. Each subrack has independent power supply. Figure 3-1 shows the structure of the OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
13
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-1 OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack structure
3
1
6
2
5 3 4
1. Board area
2. Fiber cabling area
3. Fan tray assembly
4. Air filter
5. Fiber spool
6. Mounting ear
l
Board area: All the boards are installed in this area. 93 slots are available.
l
Fiber cabling area: Fiber jumpers from the ports on the front panel of each board are routed to the fiber cabling area before being routed on a side of the open rack.
l
Fan tray assembly: Four fan tray assemblies are available for this subrack. Each fan tray assembly contains three fans that provide ventilation and heat dissipation for the subrack. The front panel of the fan tray assembly has four indicators that indicate fan status and related information. NOTE
For detailed descriptions of the fan tray assembly, see 3.2.1.5 Fan.
l
Air filter: It protects the subrack from dust in the air and requires periodic cleaning.
l
Fiber spool: Fixed fiber spools are on two sides of the subrack. Extra fibers are coiled in the fiber spool on the open rack side before being routed to another subrack.
l
Mounting ears: The mounting ears attach the subrack in the cabinet.
Table 3-4 Mechanical specifications of the OptiX OSN 8800 T64
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Item
Specification
Dimensions
498 mm (W) × 580 mm (D) × 900 mm (H) (19.6 in. (W) × 22.8 in. (D) × 35.4 in. (H)) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
14
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Item
Specification
Weight (empty subracka)
65 kg (143 lb.)
a: An empty subrack means no boards are installed in the board area, and no fan tray assembly or air filter is installed.
3.2.1.2 Slot Description The OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack provide 93 slots. Slots of the OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack are shown in Figure 3-2. Figure 3-2 Slots of the OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack Front
Back
IU91
PIU
PIU
EFI2
IU69
IU70
IU71
IU 19
IU 23
IU 5
IU 6
IU 25
IU 7
IU75
IU 26
IU 27
IU 28
EF I1 IU 76
IU 77
IU 29
IU 30
PIU
PIU
PIU
PIU
STI
IU78
IU79
IU80
IU81
IU82
IU 31
IU 32
IU 33
IU 34
IU 53
IU 54
IU 55
IU 56
IU 57
IU 58
IU 83
IU 59
IU 84
STG
IU85
IU86
IU 60
IU 9
IU 10
IU 43
IU 44
IU 8
IU 11
IU 12
IU 13
IU 14
IU 15
IU 16
IU 17
IU 18
IU 35
IU 36
IU 37
IU 38
IU 39
IU 40
IU 41
IU 42
IU90
l
SCC
Cross-connect board
IU 4
IU 24
IU74
A U X
Cross-connect board
IU 3
IU 22
IU 73
STG
Cross-connect board
IU 2
IU 21
IU 72
IU93
SCC
Cross-connect board
IU 1
IU 20
A U X
ATE IU87
PIU
PIU
IU88
IU89
IU 61
IU 62
IU 63
IU 64
IU 65
IU 66
IU 67
IU 68
IU 45
IU 46
IU 47
IU 48
IU 49
IU 50
IU 51
IU 52
IU92
: houses service boards and supports service cross-connections.
l
IU9 and IU43 are reserved for the cross-connect board (XCT).
l
IU10 and IU44 are reserved for the cross-connect board (SXM/SXH).
l
IU73, IU77 and IU84 are reserved for future use.
l
The following table provides the slots for housing active and standby boards of the subrack.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Board
Slots for Active and Standby Boards
PIU
IU69 & IU78, IU70 & IU79, IU80 & IU88, and IU81 &IU89
SCC
IU74 & IU85
STG
IU75 & IU86
SXM/SXH
IU10 & IU44
XCT
IU9 & IU43 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
15
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.2.1.3 Management Interfaces The subrack provides various communication and maintenance interfaces for the management and maintenance purposes, as shown in Table 3-5. Table 3-5 Description of interfaces in the interface area Boar d
ATE
ALMI1
ALMI2
ALMO1
ALMO3
TN51 ATE
Front Panel
ALMO4
ALMO2
TN51 EFI1
SERIAL
EFI2
ETH1
LAMP1
ETH2
LAMP2 NM_ETH1
ETH3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Interfaces
Note
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 0.3 W
Housekeeping alarm input interface: ALMI1– ALMI2
For detailed information, refer to 3.10.1 OptiX OSN 8800 Housekeeping Alarm Interfaces.
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F): 0.3 W
Housekeeping alarm output interface: ALMO1– ALMO4
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 5 W
EFI1
NM_ETH2
TN51 EFI2
Power Consumption
Network management interface: Maximum Power NM_ETH2 Consumption at Management serial 55°C (131°F): 7 interface: SERIAL W
For detailed information, refer to Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T32/T64.
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 13 W
Subrack alarm cascading interfaces: LAMP1, LAMP2
For detailed information, refer to Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T32/T64.
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F): 15 W
Network management interface: NM_ETH1/ETH1/ ETH2/ETH3
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
16
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Boar d TN52 STI
STI
CLK2
CLK1
TOD2
TOD1
TNL 1STI
Front Panel
3 Quick View of Product
CLK1
TOD2
TOD1
PHONE
F1
Interfaces
Note
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 1.5 W
Clock signal interface: CLK1, CLK2
Provides clock and time inputs and outputs. The interfaces connect the board to the STG board through the backplane to achieve NElevel clock and time synchronization.
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 3 W
Clock signal interface: CLK1, CLK2
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F): 3 W
Time signal interface: TOD1, TOD2
Time signal Maximum Power interface: TOD01, Consumption at TOD02 55°C (131°F): 1.5 W
STI
CLK2
Power Consumption
Orderwire phone interface: PHONE
Provides clock and time inputs and outputs. The interfaces connect the board to the STG board through the backplane to achieve NElevel clock and time synchronization.
F1 interface: F1
3.2.1.4 Cross-Connect Capacities The cross-connect capacity of a slot in an OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack vary according to the type of cross-connect board installed in the slot. OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subracks can cross-connect ODU0, ODU1, ODU2, ODU2e, ODU3, ODUflex, VC-4, VC-3, and VC-12 granularities at the same time. Slots IU1-IU8, IU11-IU42, and IU45-IU68 provide the same cross-connect capacity. As shown in Table 3-6. Table 3-6 Cross-connect capacity of OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
CrossConnect Board
Maximum Cross-Connect Capacity of Each Slot ODUka
VC-4
VC-3/ VC-12c
ODUka
VC-4
VC-3/ VC-12
SXH
N/A
20 Gbit/s
N/A
N/A
1.28 Tbit/s
N/A
SXM
N/A
20 Gbit/s
20 Gbit/s
N/A
1.28 Tbit/s
80 Gbit/s
SXH +XCTb
40 Gbit/s
20 Gbit/s
N/A
2.56 Tbit/s
1.28 Tbit/s
N/A
Maximum Cross-Connect Capacity of Subrack
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
17
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
CrossConnect Board
Maximum Cross-Connect Capacity of Each Slot
Maximum Cross-Connect Capacity of Subrack
ODUka
VC-4
VC-3/ VC-12c
ODUka
VC-4
VC-3/ VC-12
SXM +XCTb
40 Gbit/s
20 Gbit/s
20 Gbit/s
2.56 Tbit/s
1.28 Tbit/s
80 Gbit/s
a: k=0, 1, 2, 2e, 3 or flex. b: OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subracks must be configured with both the SXH and XCT boards or the SXM and XCT boards to cross-connect ODUk granularities. c: All service slots share a bandwidth of 20 Gbit/s.
3.2.1.5 Fan Each OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack has four fan tray assemblies, each of which includes three independent fans. In each subrack, the lower fan tray assembly has an air filter, but the upper fan tray assembly does not. The user can withdraw, clean, and replace each air filter.
Version Description Only one functional version of the fan tray assembly is available, that is, TN51.
Functions and Features Table 3-7 describes the functions of a fan tray assembly. Table 3-7 Functions Function
Description
Basic function
Dissipates the heat generated by a network element (NE), so that the NE can operate normally within the designated temperature range.
Commissioning control
l Auto Speed Mode: Implements automatic fan speed regulation, depending on the subrack temperature. l Adjustable Speed Mode: You can manually adjust the fan speed.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Section-dependent heat dissipation
Each subrack is divided into six sections to provide efficient heat dissipation. The fan speed in each section is independently regulated.
Hot swapping
Provides the hot swapping function for the fan tray assembly.
Alarming
Reports alarms of the fans, and reports the in-service information.
Status checking
Checks and reports on the fan status.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
18
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Working Principle A fan tray assembly inside a subrack ventilates the subrack to ensure that the subrack works effectively at an appropriate temperature. The fan tray assembly is located in the lower portion of a subrack. It draws in air into the subrack, forming an air duct from bottom to top. Other boards in the subrack are installed vertically. In other words, the boards are parallel to the air duct. This design ensures reliable heat dissipation. Figure 3-3 shows how ventilation is performed in the OptiX OSN 8800 T64. Figure 3-3 shows how ventilation is performed in the OptiX OSN 8800 T64. Figure 3-3 Subrack heat dissipation and ventilation system Air outlet
Fan tray assembly
Board Area
Fan tray assembly
Optical fiber laying area
Air inlet
The OptiX OSN 8800 supports two fan speed modes, as described in Table 3-8. The sectiondependent speed regulating function is available in Auto Speed Mode. The Auto Speed Mode is recommended.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
19
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-8 FAN speed mode FAN Speed Mode
Description
Auto Speed Mode
Fan speed in each section is regulated automatically according to the temperature of the boards in the section that the fans are targeted for. l Lower than 25°C (77°F): the fans run at low speed. l Higher than 45°C (113°F): the fans run at high speed. l 25°C to 45°C (77°F to 113° F): The fans automatically adjust their rotation speeds. This mode can reduce noise and is power-saving. Fan speed in each section is independently regulated. The fans run at full speed if the speed regulating signal is abnormal. If one of the fans in one section fails, the other fans in this section run at full speed. When the user queries the fan speed using the NMS, the highest fan speed among all sections is displayed. In other words, if the fans in one section rotate at high speed, the NMS displays the fan speed as high speed in the query result. Six fan speeds are supported: Stop, Low Speed, Medium-Low Speed, Medium Speed, Medium-High Speed, and High Speed. In this mode, the user manually sets the fan speed and fans in all sections run at the same speed. The user cannot independently set the fan speed for a specific section.
Adjustable Speed Mode
Each OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack has two sides. Each side has six sections. See Figure 3-4. Figure 3-4 Section-dependent heat dissipation of the OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack IU91
FAN2
FAN1
IU69
IU19 IU20
IU70
IU21
IU71
IU22 IU23
IU24
IU72
IU74
IU73
IU25 IU26
IU1
IU2
IU3
IU4
IU5
IU6
IU7
FAN3
IU75
IU27
IU9
IU76
IU77
IU28 IU29
IU30
IU78
IU31
FAN8
FAN7
IU80
IU79
IU32 IU33
IU34
IU53 IU54
IU81
IU55
IU82
IU56 IU57
Partition 1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
IU84
IU85
IU59 IU60
FAN9
IU86
IU87
IU61
IU62 IU63
IU45
IU46
IU88
IU89
IU64
IU65
IU66 IU67
IU68
IU47 IU48
IU49
IU50 IU51
IU52
IU43 IU44
IU11
IU12
IU13 IU14
IU15
IU16 IU17
IU18
IU35 IU36
IU37 IU38
IU39 IU40
IU50 FAN4
IU58
IU83
IU10
IU8
IU93
Back
Front
IU41 IU42
IU50
FAN5
FAN6
Partition 2
Partition 3
FAN10 IU90
Partition 4
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
FAN11
Partition 5
FAN12
Partition 6
IU92
20
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
NOTE
If any one of the six fans in the two fan tray assemblies fails, the system can keep on operating for 96 consecutive hours in an environment with temperatures between 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F). Replace the fan tray assembly in either of the following two situations: l
Two or more fans fail in one of the two fan tray assemblies.
l
One or more fans fail in each of the two fan tray assemblies.
In a system that is operating normally, the two fans in the same section (such as FAN1 and FAN4) run at the same speed.
The fan tray assembly consists of fans and fan control unit. Figure 3-5 shows the functional blocks of the fan tray assembly. Figure 3-5 Functional block diagram of the fan tray assembly
Speed adjusting signal SCC
Status signal
Speed adjusting signal Fan control unit
Status signal FAN
External power External power supply 1 supply 2
l
FAN: dissipates heat generated by normal operation of the subrack. FAN is the core of the fan tray assembly.
l
Fan control board: – Controls the fan speed according to the fan speed regulating signals. – Detects faults. After a fault is detected, the fan control unit reports an alarm. In this case, the SCC board issues commands to instruct the other fans to run at the full speed. – Monitors speed regulating signals, the fan status, and the online/offline state of the fan tray assembly. – Receives and carries out commands from the SCC board to shut down the fans on the fan tray assembly if necessary.
Appearance Figure 3-6 shows a fan tray assembly.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
21
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-6 Fan tray assembly
3 SYSTEM
2
1
1. Air filter
2. Operating status indicators
3. Fans (three in total)
NOTE
An air filter is installed on the lower fan tray assembly to prevent dust from entering the subrack.
Valid Slots The fan tray assembly occupies one slot. The valid slots for the fan tray assembly are IU90 IU91, IU92 and IU93 in the OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack.
Specifications of the Fan Tray Assembly Table 3-9 lists the technical specifications of the fan tray assembly. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat consumption (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh).
Table 3-9 Technical specifications of the fan tray assembly Item
Specification
Dimensions (H x W x D)
64.0 mm (2.5 in.) x 493.7 mm (19.4 in.) x 280.5 mm (11.0 in.)
Weight
3.6 kg (7.9 lb.)
Power Consumptiona
l Low Speed: 70 W l Medium-Low Speed: 95 W l Medium Speed: 150 W l Medium-High Speed: 225W l High Speed: 270W
a: Rotating speed of fans is controlled intelligently. When the system is typically configured, rotating speed of fans is automatically adjusted to a low level. When the system is fully configured with boards of high power consumption, and the system is running in a high ambient temperature, rotating speed of fans may be adjusted to a high level. When rotating at the maximum speed, power consumption of fan tray assembly may reach 270 W.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
22
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.2.1.6 Power Consumption This section describes the maximum and typical subrack power consumption specifications. Table 3-10 describes the power consumption of an OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat rate (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh). Typical configuration power consumption indicates the average power consumption of the equipment with the typical configuration and the equipment runs at the room temperature. Maximum power consumption indicates the possible maximum power consumption when the equipment runs in an environment with extreme conditions.
Table 3-10 Power consumption of an OptiX OSN 8800 T64 Item
Value
Maximum subrack power consumptiona
6500 W
Typical configuration power consumption (OTN)
3700 W
Typical configuration power consumption (OCS)
2700 W
a: The maximum subrack power consumption refers to the theoretical power consumption obtained when boards with the highest power consumption are installed in every slot on the subrack.
Table 3-11 describes the power consumption of the subrack in typical configuration in an OptiX OSN 8800 T64. Table 3-11 Power consumption of the common units in an OptiX OSN 8800 T64
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Unit Name
Typical Power Consumptio n at 25°C (77° F) (W)a
Maximum Power Consumptio n at 55°C (131°F) (W)a
Remarks
Subrack
OTU subrack 1
1804.6
2827.9
32 x LDX, 1 x SCC, 8 x PIU, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 4 x fan tray assembly
OTU subrack 2
1686.7
2278.9
4 x LSC, 2 x SCC, 8 x PIUs, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 4 x fan tray assembly
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
23
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Unit Name
3 Quick View of Product
Typical Power Consumptio n at 25°C (77° F) (W)a
Maximum Power Consumptio n at 55°C (131°F) (W)a
Remarks
OTU electrical crossconnect subrack 1
2172.7
2822.9
2 x XCT, 2 x SXH, 8 x NS3, 2 x SCC, 2 x STG, 8 x PIU, 5 x TQX, 5 x TOA, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 4 x fan tray assembly
OTU electrical crossconnect subrack 2
1839.1
2776.7
2 x XCT, 2 x SXM, 20 x NQ2, 1 x SCC, 8 x PIU, 5 x TOA, 5 x TQX, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 4 x fan tray assembly
OTM subrack 1
963.78
1860.3
1 x M40V, 1 x D40, 1 x OAU1, 1 x OBU1, 12 x LDX, 1 x SCC, 1 x SC2, 8 x PIU, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 4 x fan tray assembly
OTM subrack 2
1734.7
2343.9
1 x M40V, 1 x D40, 1 x OAU1, 1 x OBU1, 4 x LSC, 2 x SCC, 8 x PIU, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 4 x fan tray assembly
1920
2830
2 x SXM, 20 x SLD64, 8 x SLO16, 4 x SLQ16, 4 x SLH41, 4 x EGSH, 2 x STG, 1 x STI, 2 x SCC, 8 x PIU, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 4 x fan tray assembly
OCS System
a: Indicates that the power consumption of the subrack and cabinet is the value in a certain configuration. The value is for reference only. The actual power consumed by the chassis and cabinet is a calculation based on the power consumption of each module.
3.2.1.7 Power Requirement This section describes the requirements on power supply.
Requirements on Voltage and Current Table 3-12 provides the requirements on voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
24
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-12 Requirements on voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 8800 T64 Item
Requirement
Rated working current
200 A (Independent power supplies to four sections of each subrack, with 50A for each section)
Nominal working voltage
-48V DC/-60V DC
Working voltage range
-48V DC: -40V to -57.6V -60V DC: -48V to -72V
PIU The PIU board receives and provides DC power for equipment. For OptiX OSN 8800 T64/8800 T32, the PIU board can be TN16PIU or TN51PIU. For OptiX OSN 8800 T16, the PIU board must be TN16PIU. l
Function Accesses DC power in a range from -40 V to -72 V. Provides lightning protection and power filtering functions. The TN16PIU supports intelligent ammeter function, which enables the TN16PIU to detect the power consumption of the entire subrack and report the power consumption to the system control unit. NOTE
The overcurrent protection function for the access power supplies of each subrack is realized by the magnetic circuit breaker of the PDU.
l
Front Panel As shown in the following figures, two types of front panel are available for The TN51PIU board. The difference between the two types of front panel lies in the silkscreen. Figure 3-7 Front panel of the TN51PIU board PIU RTN(+)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
PWR
REG(-)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
25
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
PIU PWR
RTN
-48V
Figure 3-8 Front panel of the TN16PIU board PIU RTN(+)
PWR
NEG(-)
l
There is only the power indicator (PWR), which is green.
l
Valid Slots Table 3-13 Valid slots for the TN51PIU board Product
Valid Slots
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
IU69, IU70, IU78, IU79, IU80, IU81,IU88 and IU89
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
IU39, IU40, IU45, and IU46
Table 3-14 Valid slots for the TN16PIU board
l Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Product
Valid Slots
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
IU69, IU70, IU78, IU79, IU80, IU81,IU88 and IU89
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
IU39, IU40, IU45, and IU46
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
IU20 and IU23
Specifications Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
26
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
– Performance Specifications Table 3-15 Performance specifications of the PIU board Item
Unit
Value
Number of DC input power supplies
-
1
Input DC power voltage range
V DC
-48V DC: -40V to -57.6V -60V DC: -48V to -72V
Input DC power current
A
≤60
– Mechanical Specifications Dimensions of front panel: 50.8 mm (W) x 220 mm (D) x 80 mm (H) (2.0 in. (W) x 8.7 in. (D) x 3.1 in. (H)) Weight: – TN51PIU: 0.5 kg (1.10 lb.) – TN16PIU: 0.65 kg (1.43 lb.) – Power Consumption Board
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
TN51PIU
5
5
TN16PIU
3
3.6
3.2.2 OptiX OSN 8800 T32 Subrack In this document, "OptiX OSN 8800 T32" refers to both enhanced OptiX OSN 8800 T32 and general OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subracks unless otherwise specified. Table 3-16 shows you how to distinguish between the "Enhanced OptiX OSN 8800 T32" and "General OptiX OSN 8800 T32" subracks. Table 3-16 Classification of OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subracks Subrack Type
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Subrack Label
Enhanced OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OSN 8800 T32
General OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OSN 8800 T32
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Display on the NMS "OSN8800 T32 Enhanced" "OSN8800 T32 Standard"
27
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.2.2.1 Structure Subracks are the basic working units of the OptiX OSN 8800 T32. Each subrack has independent power supply. Figure 3-9 shows the structure of the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack. Figure 3-9 OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack structure diagram
3
6
1 5
2
3 4
1. Board area
2. Fiber cabling area
3. Fan tray assembly
4. Air filter
5. Fiber spool
6. Mounting ear
NOTE
A subrack identified by "Enhanced" is an enhanced OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack. If the subrack is not identified by "Enhanced", it is a general OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack.
l
Board area: All the boards are installed in this area. 50 slots are available.
l
Fiber cabling area: Fiber jumpers from the ports on the front panel of each board are routed to the fiber cabling area before being routed on a side of the open rack.
l
Fan tray assembly: Fan tray assembly contains three fans that provide ventilation and heat dissipation for the subrack. The front panel of the fan tray assembly has four indicators that indicate subrack status. NOTE
For detailed descriptions of the fan tray assembly, see 3.2.2.5 Fan.
l Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Air filter: It protects the subrack from dust in the air and requires periodic cleaning. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
28
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
l
Fiber spool: Fixed fiber spools are on two sides of the subrack. Extra fibers are coiled in the fiber spool on the open rack side before being routed to another subrack.
l
Mounting ears: The mounting ears attach the subrack in the cabinet.
Table 3-17 Mechanical specifications of the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 Item
Specification
Dimensions
498 mm (W) × 295 mm (D) × 900 mm (H) (19.6 in. (W) × 11.6 in. (D) × 35.4 in. (H))
Weight (empty subracka)
35 kg (77.1 lb.)
a: An empty subrack means no boards are installed in the board area, and no fan tray assembly or air filter is installed.
3.2.2.2 Slot Description The OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack provide 50 slots. Slots of the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack are shown in Figure 3-10.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
29
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-10 Slots of the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack IU51
AUX EFI2 IU37
STG
STG
EFI1
PIU
PIU
PIU
PIU
IU38
IU39
IU40
IU45
IU46
IU41 IU42 IU43 IU44
STI IU47
ATE IU48
SCC
IU3
IU4
IU5
IU25
IU6
IU26 IU27
IU7
IU28
IU9
IU10
SCC or service board
IU2
IU23 IU24
Cross-connect board
IU1
IU22
Cross-connect board
IU20 IU21
IU8
IU29
IU30 IU31
IU32
IU33
IU34 IU35
IU36
IU12
IU13
IU14 IU15
IU16
IU17 IU18
IU19
IU11
IU50
l
: houses service boards and supports service cross-connections.
l
IU9 and IU10 are reserved for the cross-connect board (XCH/XCM).
l
IU43 is reserved for future use.
l
The following table provides the slots for housing active and standby boards of the subrack.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Board
Slots for Active and Standby Boards
PIU
IU39 & IU45 and IU40 & IU46
SCC
IU28 & IU11
STG
IU42 & IU44
XCH/XCM
IU9 & IU10
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
30
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.2.2.3 Management Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T32 The subrack provides various communication and maintenance interfaces for the management and maintenance purposes, as shown in Table 3-18. Table 3-18 Description of interfaces in the interface area Boar d TN51 EFI1
Front Panel
Power Consumption Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 5 W
EFI1
NM_ETH2 SERIAL
TN51 EFI2
EFI2
ETH1
LAMP1
ETH2
LAMP2
STI
CLK2
CLK1
TOD2
TOD1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Note
Network management interface: Maximum Power NM_ETH2 Consumption at Management serial 55°C (131°F): 7 interface: SERIAL W
For detailed information, refer to Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T32/T64.
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 13 W
Subrack alarm cascading interfaces: LAMP1, LAMP2
For detailed information, refer to Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T32/T64.
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F): 15 W
Network management interface: NM_ETH1/ETH1/ ETH2/ETH3
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 1.5 W
Clock signal interface: CLK1, CLK2
NM_ETH1
ETH3
TN52 STI
Interfaces
Time signal Maximum Power interface: TOD1, Consumption at TOD2 55°C (131°F): 1.5 W
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Provides clock and time inputs and outputs. The interfaces connect the board to the STG board through the backplane to achieve NElevel clock and time synchronization.
31
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Boar d TNL 1STI
Front Panel
STI
3 Quick View of Product
CLK2
CLK1
TOD2
TOD1
PHONE
F1
Power Consumption
Interfaces
Note
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 3 W
Clock signal interface: CLK1, CLK2
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F): 3 W
Time signal interface: TOD1, TOD2
Provides clock and time inputs and outputs. The interfaces connect the board to the STG board through the backplane to achieve NElevel clock and time synchronization.
Orderwire phone interface: PHONE F1 interface: F1
3.2.2.4 Cross-Connect Capacities The cross-connect capacity of a slot in an OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack vary the type of crossconnect board installed in the slot. OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subracks can cross-connect ODU0, ODU1, ODU2, ODU2e, ODU3, ODUflex, VC-4, VC-3, and VC-12 granularities at the same time. Slots IU1-IU8, IU12-IU27, and IU29-IU36 provide the same cross-connect capacity. As shown in Table 3-19. Table 3-19 Cross-connect capacity of OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack CrossConnec t Board
Maximum Cross-Connect Capacity of Each Slot ODUka
VC-4
VC-3/ VC-12b
ODUka
VC-4
VC-3/ VC-12
XCH
40 Gbit/s
40 Gbit/s
N/A
1.28 Tbit/s
1.28 Tbit/s
N/A
XCM
40 Gbit/s
40 Gbit/s
40 Gbit/s
1.28 Tbit/s
1.28 Tbit/s
80 Gbit/s
Maximum Cross-Connect Capacity of Subrack
a: k = 0, 1, 2, 2e, 3 or flex b: All service slots share a bandwidth of 40 Gbit/s.
In later versions, a single slot will support a maximum of 100 Gbit/s cross-connect capacities and a single subrack will be able to provide a maximum of 3.2 Tbit/s cross-connect capacities.
3.2.2.5 Fan Each OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack has two fan tray assemblies, each of which includes three independent fans. In each subrack, the lower fan tray assembly has an air filter, but the upper fan tray assembly does not have an air filter. The air filter can be drawn out, cleaned and replaced.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
32
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Version Description Only one functional version of the fan tray assembly is available, that is, TN51.
Functions and Features Table 3-20 describes the functions of a fan tray assembly. Table 3-20 Functions Function
Description
Basic function
Dissipates the heat generated by a network element (NE), so that the NE can operate normally within the designated temperature range.
Commissioning control
l Auto Speed Mode: Implements automatic fan speed regulation, depending on the subrack temperature. l Adjustable Speed Mode: You can manually adjust the fan speed.
Partitioned heat dissipation
Each subrack is divided into three partitions to help provide efficient heat dissipation. The fan speed in each partition is independently regulated.
Hot swapping
Provides the hot swapping function for the fan tray assembly.
Alarming
Reports alarms of the fans, and reports the in-service information.
Status checking
Checks and reports on the fan status.
Working Principle A fan tray assembly inside a subrack dissipates heat for the subrack to ensure that the subrack works effectively at a specified temperature. The fan tray assembly is located on the lower part of a subrack. It blows air into the subrack, forming an air duct from bottom to top. Other boards in the subrack are installed vertically. In other words, the boards are parallel to the air duct. This design ensures reliable heat dissipation. Figure 3-11 shows the heat dissipation and ventilation system in the OptiX OSN 8800 T32.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
33
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-11 Subrack heat dissipation and ventilation system
Air outlet
Fan tray assembly
Board Area
Fan tray assembly
Optical fiber laying area
Air inlet
The OptiX OSN 8800 supports two fan speed modes, as described in Table 3-21. The sectiondependent speed regulating function is available in Auto Speed Mode. The Auto Speed Mode is recommended. Table 3-21 FAN speed mode FAN Speed Mode
Description
Auto Speed Mode
Fan speed in each section is regulated automatically according to the temperature of the boards in the section that the fans are targeted for. l Lower than 25°C (77°F): the fans run at low speed. l Higher than 45°C (113°F): the fans run at high speed. l 25°C to 45°C (77°F to 113° F): The fans automatically adjust their rotation speeds. This mode can reduce noise and is power-saving. Fan speed in each section is independently regulated. The fans run at full speed if the speed regulating signal is abnormal. If one of the fans in one section fails, the other fans in this section run at full speed. When the user queries the fan speed using the NMS, the highest fan speed among all sections is displayed. In other words, if the fans in one section rotate at high speed, the NMS displays the fan speed as high speed in the query result.
Adjustable Speed Mode
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Six fan speeds are supported: Stop, Low Speed, Medium-Low Speed, Medium Speed, Medium-High Speed, and High Speed. In this mode, the user manually sets the fan speed and fans in all sections run at the same speed. The user cannot independently set the fan speed for a specific section.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
34
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Each OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack is divided into three partitions in terms of heat dissipation. The subrack adopts two fan tray assemblies to implement partitioned heat dissipation. See Figure 3-12. Figure 3-12 Partitioned heat dissipation of the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack FAN2
FAN1
IU37
IU20 IU21
IU38
IU39
IU22
IU23 IU24
IU40
IU25
IU41 IU42 IU43 IU44
IU26 IU27
IU9
IU1
IU2
IU3
IU4
IU5
IU6
IU7
FAN3
IU45
IU46
IU28 IU29
IU30 IU31
IU11 IU12
IU13
IU47
IU51
IU48
IU32
IU33
IU34 IU35
IU36
IU14 IU15
IU16
IU17 IU18
IU19
IU10
IU8
IU50 FAN4
Partition 1
FAN5
Partition 2
FAN6
IU50
Partition 3
NOTE
If any one of the six fans in the two fan tray assemblies fails, the system can keep on operating for 96 consecutive hours in an environment with temperatures between 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F). Replace the fan tray assembly in either of the following two situations: l
Two or more fans fail in one of the two fan tray assemblies.
l
One or more fans fail in each of the two fan tray assemblies.
In a system that is operating normally, the two fans in the same partition (such as FAN1 and FAN4) run at the same speed.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
35
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
The fan tray assembly consists of fans and fan control unit. Figure 3-13 shows the functional blocks of the fan tray assembly. Figure 3-13 Functional block diagram of the fan tray assembly
Speed adjusting signal SCC
Status signal
Speed adjusting signal Fan control unit
Status signal FAN
External power External power supply 1 supply 2
l
FAN: dissipates heat generated by normal operation of the subrack. FAN is the core of the fan tray assembly.
l
Fan control board: – Controls the fan speed according to the fan speed regulating signals. – Detects faults. After a fault is detected, the fan control unit reports an alarm. In this case, the SCC board issues commands to instruct the other fans to run at the full speed. – Monitors speed regulating signals, the fan status, and the online/offline state of the fan tray assembly. – Receives and carries out commands from the SCC board to shut down the fans on the fan tray assembly if necessary.
Appearance Figure 3-14 shows a fan tray assembly.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
36
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-14 Fan tray assembly
3 SYSTEM
2
1
1. Air filter
2. Operating status indicators
3. Fans (three in total)
NOTE
An air filter is installed on the lower fan tray assembly to prevent dust from entering the subrack.
Valid Slots The fan tray assembly occupies one slot. The valid slots for the fan tray assembly are IU50 and IU51 in the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack.
Specifications of the Fan Tray Assembly Table 3-22 lists the technical specifications of the fan tray assembly. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat consumption (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh).
Table 3-22 Technical specifications of the fan tray assembly Item
Specification
Dimensions (H x W x D)
64.0 mm (2.5 in.) x 493.7 mm (19.4 in.) x 280.5 mm (11.0 in.)
Weight
3.6 kg (7.9 lb.)
Power Consumptiona
l Low Speed: 70 W l Medium-Low Speed: 95 W l Medium Speed: 150 W l Medium-High Speed: 225W l High Speed: 270W
a: Rotating speed of fans is controlled intelligently. When the system is typically configured, rotating speed of fans is automatically adjusted to a low level. When the system is fully configured with boards of high power consumption, and the system is running in a high ambient temperature, rotating speed of fans may be adjusted to a high level. When rotating at the maximum speed, power consumption of fan tray assembly may reach 270 W.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
37
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.2.2.6 Power Consumption This section describes the maximum and typical subrack power consumption specifications. Table 3-23 describes the power consumption of an OptiX OSN8800 T32 subrack. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat rate (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh). Typical configuration power consumption indicates the average power consumption of the equipment with the typical configuration and the equipment runs at the room temperature. Maximum power consumption indicates the possible maximum power consumption when the equipment runs in an environment with extreme conditions.
Table 3-23 Power consumption of an OptiX OSN 8800 T32 Item
Value
Maximum subrack power consumptiona
3500 W
Recommended typical configuration power consumption (OTN)
2000 W
Recommended typical configuration power consumption (OCS)
2250 W
a: The maximum subrack power consumption refers to the theoretical power consumption obtained when boards with the highest power consumption are installed in every slot on the subrack.
Table 3-24 describes the power consumption of the subrack in typical configuration in an OptiX OSN 8800 T32. Table 3-24 Power consumption of the subrack in typical configuration in an OptiX OSN 8800 T32
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Unit Name
Typical Power Consumptio n at 25°C (77° F) (W)a
Maximum Power Consumptio n at 55°C (131°F) (W)a
Remarks
Subrack
OTU subrack 1
1633.4
2254.6
32 x LDX, 1 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
OTU subrack 2
1351.8
1701.3
4 x LSC, 2 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
38
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Unit Name
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Typical Power Consumptio n at 25°C (77° F) (W)a
Maximum Power Consumptio n at 55°C (131°F) (W)a
Remarks
OTU electrical crossconnect subrack 1
1641.6
2166.5
2 x XCH, 20 x NQ2, 1 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 5 x TQX, 5 x TOA, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
OTU electrical crossconnect subrack 2
2039.8
2466.5
2 x XCH, 8 x NS3, 2 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 5 x TQX, 5 x TOA, 2 x STG, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
OTM subrack 1
792.5
1287.1
1 x M40V, 1 x D40, 1 x OAU1, 1 x OBU1, 12 x LDX, 1 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
OTM subrack 2
1399.8
1766.3
1 x M40V, 1 x D40, 1 x OAU1, 1 x OBU1, 4 x LSC, 2 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
OLA subrack
290.3
706
4 x OBU1, 4 x VA1, 1 x SC2, 1 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
OADM subrack
974
1497.2
2 x OAU1, 2 x MR8V, 16 x LDX, 1 x SC2, 1 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
378.2
811
2 x M40V, 2 x D40, 2 x FIU, 1 x SC2, 2 x RMU9, 2 x WSM9, 2 x OAU1, 2 x OBU1, 1 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
373.1
306.6
2 x M40, 2 x D40, 2 x WSMD9, 2 x DAS1, 1 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
39
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Unit Name
Typical Power Consumptio n at 25°C (77° F) (W)a
Maximum Power Consumptio n at 55°C (131°F) (W)a
Remarks
OCS System
1281
1757
2 x XCM, 10 x SLQ64, 8 x SLO16, 2 x SLH41, 2 x EGSH, 2 x STG, 1 x STI, 2 x SCC, 4 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI1, 1 x EFI2, 1 x ATE, and 2 x fan tray assembly
a: Indicates that the power consumption of the subrack and cabinet is the value in a certain configuration. The value is for reference only. The actual power consumed by the chassis and cabinet is a calculation based on the power consumption of each module.
3.2.2.7 Power Requirement This section describes the requirements on power supply.
Requirements on Voltage and Current Table 3-25 provides the requirements on voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 8800 T32. Table 3-25 Requirements on voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 8800 T32 Item
Requirement
Rated working current
100 A (Independent power supplies to two sections of each subrack, with 50A for each section)
Nominal working voltage
-48V DC/-60V DC
Working voltage range
-48V DC: -40V to -57.6V -60V DC: -48V to -72V
PIU The PIU board receives and provides DC power for equipment. For OptiX OSN 8800 T64/8800 T32, the PIU board can be TN16PIU or TN51PIU. For OptiX OSN 8800 T16, the PIU board must be TN16PIU. l
Function Accesses DC power in a range from -40 V to -72 V. Provides lightning protection and power filtering functions. The TN16PIU supports intelligent ammeter function, which enables the TN16PIU to detect the power consumption of the entire subrack and report the power consumption to the system control unit.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
40
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
NOTE
The overcurrent protection function for the access power supplies of each subrack is realized by the magnetic circuit breaker of the PDU.
l
Front Panel As shown in the following figures, two types of front panel are available for The TN51PIU board. The difference between the two types of front panel lies in the silkscreen. Figure 3-15 Front panel of the TN51PIU board PIU RTN(+)
PWR
REG(-)
PIU RTN
PWR
-48V
Figure 3-16 Front panel of the TN16PIU board PIU RTN(+)
PWR
NEG(-)
l
There is only the power indicator (PWR), which is green.
l
Valid Slots
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
41
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-26 Valid slots for the TN51PIU board Product
Valid Slots
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
IU69, IU70, IU78, IU79, IU80, IU81,IU88 and IU89
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
IU39, IU40, IU45, and IU46
Table 3-27 Valid slots for the TN16PIU board
l
Product
Valid Slots
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
IU69, IU70, IU78, IU79, IU80, IU81,IU88 and IU89
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
IU39, IU40, IU45, and IU46
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
IU20 and IU23
Specifications – Performance Specifications Table 3-28 Performance specifications of the PIU board Item
Unit
Value
Number of DC input power supplies
-
1
Input DC power voltage range
V DC
-48V DC: -40V to -57.6V -60V DC: -48V to -72V
Input DC power current
A
≤60
– Mechanical Specifications Dimensions of front panel: 50.8 mm (W) x 220 mm (D) x 80 mm (H) (2.0 in. (W) x 8.7 in. (D) x 3.1 in. (H)) Weight: – TN51PIU: 0.5 kg (1.10 lb.) – TN16PIU: 0.65 kg (1.43 lb.) – Power Consumption
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Board
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
TN51PIU
5
5
TN16PIU
3
3.6
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
42
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.2.3 OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Subrack 3.2.3.1 Structure Subracks are the basic working units of the OptiX OSN 8800 T16. Each subrack has independent power supply. Figure 3-17 OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack structure (subrack door excluded)
1
6
5 2 3 4
1. Board area
2. Fiber cabling area
3. Fan tray assembly
4. Air filter
5. Fiber spool
6. Mounting ear
l
Board area: All the boards are installed in this area. 24 slots are available.
l
Fiber cabling area: Fiber jumpers from the ports on the front panel of each board are routed to the fiber cabling area before being routed on a side of the open rack.
l
Fan tray assembly: Fan tray assembly contains ten fans that provide ventilation and heat dissipation for the subrack. The front panel of the fan tray assembly has four indicators that indicate fan status and related information.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
43
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
NOTE
For detailed descriptions of the fan tray assembly, see 3.2.3.5 Fan.
l
Air filter: It protects the subrack from dust in the air and requires periodic cleaning.
l
Fiber spool: Fixed fiber spools are on two sides of the subrack. Extra fibers are coiled in the fiber spool on the open rack side before being routed to another subrack.
l
Mounting ears: The mounting ears attach the subrack in the cabinet.
Table 3-29 Mechanical specifications of the OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Item
Specification
Dimensions
498 mm (W) × 295 mm (D) × 450 mm (H) (19.6 in. (W) × 11.6 in. (D) × 17.7 in. (H))
Weight (empty subracka)
18 kg (39.6 lb.)
a: An empty subrack means no boards are installed in the board area, and no fan tray assembly or air filter is installed.
3.2.3.2 Slot Description The OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack provide 25 slots. Slots of the OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack are shown in Figure 3-18. Figure 3-18 Slots of the OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack IU20 PIU
IU19 EFI
IU21 AUX
IU9 IU 1
IU 2
IU 3
IU 4
IU 5
IU 6
IU 7
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
IU24 ATE
IU10
IU 8
IU 11
IU25
l
IU23 PIU
IU22
IU 12
IU 13
IU 14
IU 15
IU 16
IU 17
IU 18
FAN
: houses service boards and supports service cross-connections. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
44
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
3 Quick View of Product
IU9 and IU10 are reserved for the TN16XCH/TN16SCC or for the other service boards. NOTE
Slots IU9 and IU10 can be used to house service boards only when the OptiX OSN 8800 T16 functions as a slave subrack. If slots IU9 and IU10 are used to house service boards or SCC boards, install a special filler panel in each slot first
l
IU22 is reserved for future use.
l
The following table provides the slots for housing active and standby boards of the subrack. Board
Slots for Active and Standby Boards
PIU
IU20 & IU23
TN16XCH/ TN16SCC
IU9 & IU10
3.2.3.3 Management Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T16 The subrack provides various communication and maintenance interfaces for the management and maintenance purposes, as shown in Table 3-30. Table 3-30 Description of interfaces in the interface area Boa rd TN1 6EFI
Front Panel
EFI ETH1
LAMP1
ETH2
LAMP2
SERIAL
Power Consumption
Interfaces
Note
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 2 W
Network management interface: NM_ETH1/ NM_ETH2/ ETH1/ETH2/ ETH3
For detailed information, refer to Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T16.
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F): 2.5 W
NM_ETH1
ETH3
NM_ETH2
Management serial interface: SERIAL Subrack alarm cascading interfaces: LAMP1, LAMP2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
45
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Boa rd TN1 6AT E
Front Panel
ATE
3 Quick View of Product
ALMI2
ALMI1
ALMO3
TOD2
Interfaces
Note
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F): 0.2 W
Housekeeping alarm input interface: ALMI1–ALMI2
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F): 0.3 W
Housekeeping alarm output interface: ALMO1– ALMO4
For detailed information on housekeeping alarm inputs and outputs, refer to 3.10.1 OptiX OSN 8800 Housekeepin g Alarm Interfaces.
ALMO4
ALMO1 ALMO2 CLK1 TOD1
CLK2
Power Consumption
Clock signal interface: CLK1, CLK2 Time signal interface: TOD1, TOD2
The clock/ time input and output interfaces connect the board to the STG board through the backplane to achieve NElevel clock and time synchronizati on.
3.2.3.4 Cross-Connect Capacities Slots in an OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack provide the same cross-connect capacity. An OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack can cross-connect ODU0, ODU1, ODU2, ODU2e, ODU3, and ODUflex granularities at the same time with a maximum cross-connect capacity of 640 Gbit/ s. Slots IU1-IU8 and IU11-IU18 provide the same cross-connect capacity and each of the slots supports a maximum of 40 Gbit/s cross-connect capacity.
3.2.3.5 Fan Each OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack has one fan tray assembly, which includes ten independent fans and an air filter. The air filter can be drawn out, cleaned and replaced.
Version Description Only one functional version of the fan tray assembly is available, that is, TN16.
Functions and Features Table 3-31 describes the functions of a fan tray assembly. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
46
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-31 Functions Function
Description
Basic function
Dissipates the heat generated by a network element (NE), so that the NE can operate normally within the designated temperature range.
Commissioning control
l Auto Speed Mode: Implements automatic fan speed regulation, depending on the subrack temperature. l Adjustable Speed Mode: You can manually adjust the fan speed.
Partitioned heat dissipation
Each subrack is divided into five partitions to help provide efficient heat dissipation. The fan speed in each partition is independently regulated.
Hot swapping
Provides the hot swapping function for the fan tray assembly.
Alarming
Reports alarms of the fans, and reports the in-service information.
Status checking
Checks and reports on the fan status.
Working Principle A fan tray assembly inside a subrack dissipates heat for the subrack to ensure that the subrack works effectively at a specified temperature. The fan tray assembly is located on the lower part of a subrack. It blows air into the subrack, forming an air duct from bottom to top. Other boards in the subrack are installed vertically. In other words, the boards are parallel to the air duct. This design ensures reliable heat dissipation. Figure 3-19 shows the heat dissipation and ventilation system in the OptiX OSN 8800 T16. Figure 3-19 Subrack heat dissipation and ventilation system Air outlet
Board area
Optical fiber laying area Fan tray assembly Air inlet
The OptiX OSN 8800 T16 supports two fan speed modes, as described in Table 3-32. The partitioned speed regulating function is available in Auto Speed Mode. It is recommended that you operate fans in Auto Speed Mode by default. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
47
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-32 FAN speed mode FAN Speed Mode
Description
Auto Speed Mode
Fan speed in each partition is regulated automatically according to the temperature of the boards in the partition where the fans are installed. l Lower than 25°C (77°F): the fans run at low speed. l Higher than 45°C (113°F): the fans run at high speed. l 25°C to 45°C (77°F to 113° F): The fans automatically adjust their rotation speeds. This mode can reduce noise and is power-saving. Fan speed in each partition is independently regulated. The fans run at full speed if the speed regulating signals are abnormal. If one of the fans fails, the other fans run at full speed. Five fan speed modes are available: Low Speed, Medium-Low Speed, Medium Speed, Medium-High Speed, and High Speed. You can set the fan speed manually. In Adjustable Speed Mode, the fans in all partitions run at the same speed and do not support the partitioned manual fan speed adjustment.
Adjustable Speed Mode
Each OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack is divided into five partitions in terms of heat dissipation. The subrack adopts one fan tray assembly to implement partitioned heat dissipation. See Figure 3-20. Figure 3-20 Partitioned heat dissipation of the OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack IU20 PIU
IU19 EFI
IU21 AUX
IU9 IU 1
IU 2
A
IU 3
IU 4
IU 5
IU 6
B
IU 7
IU23 PIU
IU22
IU24 ATE
IU10
IU 8
C
IU
IU
IU
IU
11
12
13
14
D
IU 15
IU 16
E
IU 17
IU 18
Fan tray assembly
In the OptiX OSN 8800 T16, there are five partitions (A, B, C, D, and E) in each subrack. Two fans in each partition dissipate heat generated by the boards in the partition where the fans reside. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
48
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
NOTE
If any one of the ten fans in the fan tray assembly fails, the system can keep on operating for 96 consecutive hours in an environment with temperatures between 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F). Replace the fan tray assembly immediately if two or more fans fail in the fan tray assemblies.
The fan tray assembly consists of fans and fan control unit. Figure 3-21 shows the functional blocks of the fan tray assembly. Figure 3-21 Functional block diagram of the fan tray assembly
Speed adjusting signal SCC
Status signal
Speed adjusting signal Fan control unit
Status signal FAN
External power External power supply 1 supply 2
l
FAN: dissipates heat generated by normal operation of the subrack. FAN is the core of the fan tray assembly.
l
Fan control board: – Controls the fan speed according to the fan speed regulating signals. – Detects faults. After a fault is detected, the fan control unit reports an alarm. In this case, the SCC board issues commands to instruct the other fans to run at the full speed. – Monitors speed regulating signals, the fan status, and the online/offline state of the fan tray assembly. – Receives and carries out commands from the SCC board to shut down the fans on the fan tray assembly if necessary.
Appearance Figure 3-22 shows a fan tray assembly.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
49
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-22 Fan tray assembly 3
2
SYSTEM
1 1. Air filter
2. Operating status indicators
3. Fans (ten in total)
NOTE
An air filter is installed on the fan tray assembly to prevent dust from entering the subrack.
Valid Slots The fan tray assembly occupies one slot. The valid slot for the fan tray assembly is IU25 in the OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack.
Specifications of the Fan Tray Assembly Table 3-33 lists the technical specifications of the fan tray assembly. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat consumption (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh).
Table 3-33 Technical specifications of the fan tray assembly Item
Specification
Dimensions
493.7 mm (W) x 266.6 mm (D) x 56.1 mm (H) (19.44 in. (W) x 10.5 in. (D) x 2.21 in. (H))
Weight
3.6 kg (7.9 lb.)
Power Consumptiona
l Low Speed: 42.7 W l Medium-Low Speed: 74.8 W l Medium Speed: 106.8 W l Medium-High Speed: 165.5 W l High Speed: 215 W
a: Rotating speed of fans is controlled intelligently. When the system is typically configured, rotating speed of fans is automatically adjusted to a low level. When the system is fully configured with boards of high power consumption, and the system is running in a high ambient temperature, rotating speed of fans may be adjusted to a high level. When rotating at the maximum speed, power consumption of fan tray assembly may reach 215 W.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
50
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.2.3.6 Power Consumption This section describes the maximum and typical subrack power consumption specifications. Table 3-34 describes the power consumption of an OptiX OSN8800 T16 subrack. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat rate (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh). Typical configuration power consumption indicates the average power consumption of the equipment with the typical configuration and the equipment runs at the room temperature. Maximum power consumption indicates the possible maximum power consumption when the equipment runs in an environment with extreme conditions.
Table 3-34 Power consumption of an OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Item
Specification
Maximum subrack power consumptiona
1800 W
Typical configuration power consumption
700 W
a: The maximum subrack power consumption refers to the theoretical power consumption obtained when boards with the highest power consumption are installed in every slot on the subrack.
Table 3-35 describes the power consumption of the subrack in typical configuration in an 8800 T16. Table 3-35 Power consumption of the common units in an OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Unit Name
Subrack
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Typical Power Consumpt ion at 25°C (77°F) (W)a
Maximum Power Consumpt ion at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Remarks
OTU subrack 1
509.2
615.6
8 x 10G OTU (LDX), 1 x XCH, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
OTU subrack 2
1107.8
1432.7
4 x LSC, 2 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 2 x AUX, 1×EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
OTN electrical cross-connect subrack 1
501
808
5 x NQ2, 2 x XCH, 2 x PIU, 1 x TQX, 2 x TOA, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
a
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
51
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Unit Name
3 Quick View of Product
Typical Power Consumpt ion at 25°C (77°F) (W)a
Maximum Power Consumpt ion at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Remarks
OTN electrical cross-connect subrack 2
862.8
1180.7
2 x XCH, 4 x 55NS3, 2 x PIU, 1 x TQX, 2 x TOA, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
OTM subrack 1
468.7
569.7
1 x M40V, 1 x D40, 1 x OAU1, 1 x OBU1, 6 x LDX, 1 x XCH, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
OTM subrack 2
675.8
967.7
1 x M40V, 1 x D40, 1 x OAU1, 1 x OBU1, 2 x LSC, 2 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 2 x AUX, 1 x EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
OLA subrack
228.1
294.3
4 x OBU1, 4 x VA1, 1 x SC2, 2 x FIU, 1 x XCH, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
OADM subrack
449.5
561.5
2 x OAU1, 2 x MR8V, 2 x FIU, 8 x LSX, 1 x SC2, 1 x XCH, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
221
269.2
1 x M40, 1 x D40, 1 x WSMD9, 1 x DAS1, 1 x XCH, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, 1 x EFI, 1 x ATE, and 1 x fan tray assembly
a
a: Indicates that the power consumption of the subrack and cabinet is the value in a certain configuration. The value is for reference only. The actual power consumed by the chassis and cabinet is a calculation based on the power consumption of each module.
3.2.3.7 Power Requirement This section describes the requirements on power supply.
Requirements on Voltage and Current Table 3-36 provides the requirements on voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
52
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-36 Requirements on voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Item
Requirement
Rated working current
37.5 A
Nominal working voltage
-48V DC/-60V DC
Working voltage range
-48V DC: -40V to -57.6V -60V DC: -48V to -72V
PIU The PIU board receives and provides DC power for equipment. For OptiX OSN 8800 T64/8800 T32, the PIU board can be TN16PIU or TN51PIU. For OptiX OSN 8800 T16, the PIU board must be TN16PIU. l
Function Accesses DC power in a range from -40 V to -72 V. Provides lightning protection and power filtering functions. The TN16PIU supports intelligent ammeter function, which enables the TN16PIU to detect the power consumption of the entire subrack and report the power consumption to the system control unit. NOTE
The overcurrent protection function for the access power supplies of each subrack is realized by the magnetic circuit breaker of the PDU.
l
Front Panel As shown in the following figures, two types of front panel are available for The TN51PIU board. The difference between the two types of front panel lies in the silkscreen. Figure 3-23 Front panel of the TN51PIU board PIU RTN(+)
PWR
REG(-)
PIU RTN
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
PWR
-48V
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
53
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-24 Front panel of the TN16PIU board PIU RTN(+)
PWR
NEG(-)
l
There is only the power indicator (PWR), which is green.
l
Valid Slots Table 3-37 Valid slots for the TN51PIU board Product
Valid Slots
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
IU69, IU70, IU78, IU79, IU80, IU81,IU88 and IU89
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
IU39, IU40, IU45, and IU46
Table 3-38 Valid slots for the TN16PIU board
l
Product
Valid Slots
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
IU69, IU70, IU78, IU79, IU80, IU81,IU88 and IU89
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
IU39, IU40, IU45, and IU46
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
IU20 and IU23
Specifications – Performance Specifications Table 3-39 Performance specifications of the PIU board Item
Unit
Value
Number of DC input power supplies
-
1
Input DC power voltage range
V DC
-48V DC: -40V to -57.6V -60V DC: -48V to -72V
Input DC power current Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
A
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
≤60 54
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
– Mechanical Specifications Dimensions of front panel: 50.8 mm (W) x 220 mm (D) x 80 mm (H) (2.0 in. (W) x 8.7 in. (D) x 3.1 in. (H)) Weight: – TN51PIU: 0.5 kg (1.10 lb.) – TN16PIU: 0.65 kg (1.43 lb.) – Power Consumption Board
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
TN51PIU
5
5
TN16PIU
3
3.6
3.3 OptiX OSN 6800 Subrack and Power Requirement 3.3.1 Structure Subracks are the basic working units of the OptiX OSN 6800. The subrack of the OptiX OSN 6800 has an independent power supply. Figure 3-25 shows the structure of the subrack. Figure 3-25 OptiX OSN 6800 subrack structure diagram 1
2
7
3 6
4 5
1. Indicator
2. Board area
3. Fiber cabling area
4. Fan tray assembly
5. Air filter
6. Fiber spool
7. Mounting ear
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
55
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
NOTE
The interface area is behind the indicator panel in the upper part of the subrack. Remove the indicator panel before you connect cables.
l
Indicators: indicate the running status and alarm status of the subrack.
l
Board area: All service boards are installed in this area. 21 slots are available.
l
Fiber cabling area: Fiber jumpers from the ports on the front panel of each board are routed to the fiber cabling area before being routed on a side of the open rack. The mechanical VOA is also installed in this area. NOTE
For detailed descriptions of the fan tray assembly, see 3.3.4 Fan.
l
Fan tray assembly: Fan tray assembly contains ten fans that provide ventilation and heat dissipation for the subrack.
l
Air filter: The air filter protects the subrack from dust in the air and requires periodic cleaning.
l
Fiber spool: Fixed fiber spools are on two sides of the subrack. Extra fibers are coiled in the fiber spool on the open rack side before being routed to another subrack.
l
Mounting ears: The mounting ears attach the subrack in the cabinet.
l
Interface area: The interface area provides functional interfaces, such as management interface, inter-subrack communication interface, alarm output and cascading interface, alarm input and output interface. It is behind the subrack indicator panel.
Table 3-40 Mechanical specifications of the OptiX OSN 6800 Item
Specification
Dimensions
497 mm (W) x 295 mm (D) x 400 mm (H) (19.6 in. (W) × 11.6 in. (D) × 15.7 in. (H))
Weight (empty subracka)
13 kg (28.6 lb.)
a: An empty subrack means no boards are installed in the board area, and no fan tray assembly or air filter is installed.
3.3.2 Slot Description The board area of the subrack has 21 slots, labeled IU1 to IU21 from left to right. Slots of the subrack are shown in Figure 3-26.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
56
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-26 Slots of the subrack
IU1
IU2
IU3
IU4
IU5
IU6
IU7
IU8
IU11 IU12 IU13 IU14 IU15 IU16
IU9
IU10
SCC or service board
XCS XCS
IU19 PIU SCC
IU17 IU18
IU20 PIU
IU21 AUX
VOA area Fan Paired slots
l
Mutual backup
: houses service boards and supports service cross-connections.
l
IU15 and IU16 are also available for the STG.
l
Pair slots refer to a pair of slots whose resident boards' overhead can be processed by the buses on the backplanes. OptiX OSN 6800 supports seven pair slots. The pair slots support distributed grooming.
3.3.3 Cross-Connect Capacities The slots in an OptiX OSN 6800 subrack vary in cross-connect capacities.
Integrated Grooming When using the XCS board, an OptiX OSN 6800 subrack can cross-connect ODU1, ODU2,ODU2e, 10GE, and GE services between any two slots among slots IU1-IU8 and slots IU11-IU16. Figure 3-27 provides the cross-connect capacity for each slot.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
57
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-27 Cross-connect capacities of slots
IU1
IU2
IU3
IU4
IU5
IU6
IU7
IU8
IU11 IU12 IU13 IU14 IU15 IU16
IU9 IU10
SCC or service board
XCS XCS
IU19 PIU SCC
IU17 IU18
IU20 PIU
IU21 AUX
VOA area Fan
l
When TN12XCS boards are configured in an OptiX OSN 6800 subrack, the cross-connect capacities of the subrack are as follows: Table 3-41 Cross-connect capacity of OptiX OSN 6800 subrack Cro ssCon nect Boa rd TN1 2XC S
TN1 1XC S
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Slot
Maximum Cross-Connect Capacity of Each Slot ODU1/ODU2/ ODU2e/10GE
GE
40Gbit/s
20Gbit/s
20Gbit/s
10Gbit/s
0Gbit/s
0Gbit/s
20Gbit/s
10Gbit/s
0Gbit/s
0Gbit/s
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Maximum Cross-Connect Capacity of Subrack
180 Gbit/s GE 360 Gbit/s ODU1/ODU2/ ODU2e/10GE Supports hybrid transmission of the above-mentioned services with the maximum crossconnect capacity of 360 Gbit/s. 140 Gbit/s GE 280 Gbit/s ODU1/ODU2/ ODU2e/10GE Supports hybrid transmission of the above-mentioned services with the maximum crossconnect capacity of 280 Gbit/s.
58
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Distributed Grooming An OptiX OSN 6800 subrack provides seven pairs of slots: IU1 and IU2, IU3 and IU4, IU5 and IU6, IU7 and IU8, IU11 and IU12, IU13 and IU14, IU15 and IU16. GE/Any/ODU1/OTU1 services can be cross-connected between paired slots. No XCS board is required when paired slots are used to cross-connect electrical services.
3.3.4 Fan Each OptiX OSN 6800 subrack has one fan tray assembly, which includes ten independent fans and an air filter. The air filter can be drawn out, cleaned and replaced.
Version Description Only one functional version of the fan tray assembly is available, that is, TN11.
Functions and Features Table 3-42 describes the functions of a fan tray assembly. Table 3-42 Functions of a fan tray assembly Function
Description
Basic function
Dissipates the heat generated by an NE so that the NE can operate normally within the designated temperature range.
Commissioning control
l Auto Speed Mode: Implements automatic fan speed regulation, depending on the subrack temperature. l Adjustable Speed Mode: You can manually adjust the fan speed.
Partitioned heat dissipation
Each subrack is divided into five partitions to help provide efficient heat dissipation. The fan speed in each partition is independently regulated.
Hot swapping
Provides the hot swapping feature for the fan tray assembly.
Alarming
Reports alarms of the fans, and reports the in-service information.
Status checking
Checks and reports on the fan status.
Working Principle Air flow from the subrack is bottom intake top exhaust. Figure 3-28 and Figure 3-29 show the heat dissipation and ventilation system in the OptiX OSN 6800.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
59
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-28 Single-subrack heat dissipation and ventilation system Air outlet
Board area
Optical fiber laying area Fan tray assembly Air inlet
Figure 3-29 Multi-subrack heat dissipation and ventilation system Air deflector
Air outlet
Board area
Fan tray assembly
Optical fiber laying area
Air inlet
NOTE
If multiple subracks are used, an air duct deflector is required to help in heat dissipation.
The OptiX OSN 6800 supports two fan speed modes, as shown in Table 3-43. The partitioned speed regulating function is available in Auto Speed Mode. It is recommended that you set the speed mode to Auto Speed Mode.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
60
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-43 FAN speed mode FAN Speed Mode
Description
Auto Speed Mode
Fan speed in each partition is regulated automatically according to the temperature of the boards in the partition where the fans are installed. l Lower than 25°C (77°F): the fans run at low speed. l Higher than 45°C (113°F): the fans run at high speed. l 25°C to 45°C (77°F to 113° F): The fans automatically adjust their rotation speeds. This mode can reduce noise and is power-saving. Fan speed in each partition is independently regulated. The fans run at full speed if the speed regulating signals are abnormal. If one of the fans fails, the other fans run at full speed.
Adjustable Speed Mode
Four fan speed modes are available: Stop, Low Speed, Medium Speed, and High Speed. You can set the fan speed manually. In Adjustable Speed Mode, the fans in all partitions run at the same speed and do not support the partitioned manual fan speed adjustment.
Each OptiX OSN 6800 subrack is divided into five partitions in terms of heat dissipation. The subrack adopts one fan tray assembly to implement partitioned heat dissipation. See Figure 3-30. Figure 3-30 Partitioned heat dissipation of the OptiX OSN 6800 subrack
I U 1 9 I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U U 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 I U 2 1 1
2
A
3
4
B
5
C
6
7
D
VOA
8
E
Fan Tray Assembly
There are five partitions (A, B, C, D, and E) in each subrack. Two fans in each partition dissipate heat generated by the boards in the partition where the fans reside.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
61
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
NOTE
l
If any one of the ten fans in the fan tray assembly fails, the system can keep on operating for 96 consecutive hours in an environment with temperatures between 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F).
l
Replace the fan tray assembly immediately if: Two or more fans fail in the fan tray assemblies.
The fan tray assembly consists of ten fans and one fan control unit. Figure 3-31 shows the functional blocks of the fan tray assembly. Figure 3-31 Functional block diagram of the fan tray assembly
Speed adjusting signal SCC
Status signal
Speed adjusting signal Fan control unit
Status signal FAN
External power External power supply 1 supply 2
l
FAN: dissipates heat generated by normal operation of the subrack. FAN is the core of the fan tray assembly.
l
Fan control board: – Controls the fan speed according to regulating signals. – Detects faults. After a fault is detected, the fan control unit reports an alarm. In this case, the SCC board issues commands to instruct the other fan in the same partition to run at full speed. – Monitors the fan speed regulating signals, the fan status, and the online/offline state of the fan tray assembly. – Receives and carries out commands from the SCC board to shut down the fans on the fan tray assembly if necessary.
Appearance Figure 3-32 shows a fan tray assembly.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
62
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-32 Fan tray assembly
3
2
1
1. Air filter
2. Operating status indicators
3. Fans (ten in total)
NOTE
An air filter is installed on the fan tray assembly to prevent dust from entering the subrack.
Valid Slots One slot houses one fan tray assembly. The valid slot for the fan tray assembly is IU22.
Specifications of the Fan Tray Assembly Table 3-44 lists the technical specifications of the OptiX OSN 6800 fan tray assembly. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat consumption (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh).
Table 3-44 Technical specifications of the fan tray assembly Item
Specification
Dimensions
493.7 mm (W) x 266.6 mm (D) x 56.1 mm (H) (19.44 in. (W) x 10.5 in. (D) x 2.21 in. (H))
Weight
3.6 kg (7.9 lb.)
Power Consumptiona
l Low Speed: 40 W l Medium Speed: 60 W l High Speed: 120 W
a: Rotating speed of fans is controlled intelligently. When the system is typically configured, rotating speed of fans is automatically adjusted to a low level. When the system is fully configured with boards of high power consumption, and the system is running in a high ambient temperature, rotating speed of fans may be adjusted to a high level. When rotating at the maximum speed, power consumption of fan tray assembly may reach 120 W.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
63
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.3.5 Power Consumption This section describes the maximum and typical subrack power consumption specifications. Table 3-45 describes the power consumption of an OptiX OSN 6800 subrack. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat rate (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh). Typical configuration power consumption indicates the average power consumption of the equipment with the typical configuration and the equipment runs at the room temperature. Maximum power consumption indicates the possible maximum power consumption when the equipment runs in an environment with extreme conditions.
Table 3-45 Power consumption of an OptiX OSN 6800 Item
Value
Maximum subrack power consumption
1350 W
Table 3-46 lists the power consumption of the common units in an OptiX OSN 6800. Table 3-46 Power consumption of the subrack in typical configuration in an OptiX OSN 6800 Unit Name
Su bra ck
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F)a
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)a
Remarks
Subrack 1
566
722.2
17 x 10G OTU (LSX), 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
Subrack 2
168.7
281.6
1 x M40V, 1 x D40, 1 x OAU101, 1 x OBU103, 1 x FIU, 1 x SC1, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
Subrack 3
557
723.8
10 x ND2, 2 x TQX, 2 x TOA, 2 x XCS, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
OLA subrack
144.9
253.9
2 x OAU101s, 2 x FIU, 1 x SC2, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
FOADM subrack
292.3
418.3
2 x OAU101, 2 x VA4, 2 x OBU103, 2 x MR4, 4 x 10G OTU (LSX), 2 x FIU, 1 x SC2, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
OT M subr ack
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
64
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Unit Name
Ca bin et
3 Quick View of Product
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F)a
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)a
Remarks
RO AD M subr ack (2 x dime nsio ns)
Subrack 1
87.4
96.4
1 x M40, 1 x D40, 2 x WSMD2, 2 x DAS1, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
Subrack 2
566
722.2
17 x 10G OTU (LSX), 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
RO AD M subr ack (4 x dime nsio ns)b
Subrack 1
160
268.8
1 x WSMD4, 1 x DAS1, 1 x M40, 1 x D40, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
Subrack 2
160
268.8
1 x WSMD4, 1 x DAS1, 1 x M40, 1 x D40, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
Subrack 3
160
268.8
1 x WSMD4, 1 x DAS1, 1 x M40, 1 x D40, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
Subrack 4
160
268.8
1 x WSMD4, 1 x DAS1, 1 x M40, 1 x D40, 1 x SCC, 2 x PIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly
1422.2
1951.1
2 x OTU subrack and 1 x OTM subrack 2
OTM cabinet (40x10 Gbit/s)
a: Indicates that the power consumption of the subrack and cabinet is the value in a certain configuration. The value is for reference only. The actual power consumption of the chassis and cabinet is calculation based on the power consumption of each module. b: Subrack 1 and subrack 2 are used as subracks in the line dimensions at a four-dimension ROADM station; subrack 3 and subrack 4 are used as subracks for adding/dropping local services. Service boards can be configured in another subrack.
3.3.6 Power Requirement This section describes the requirements on power supply.
Requirements on Voltage and Current Table 3-47 provides the requirements on voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 6800 subrack.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
65
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-47 Requirements on voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 6800 Item
Requirement
Rated working current
25 A (-48 V)
Nominal working voltage
-48 V DC/-60 V DC
Working voltage range
-48V DC: -40V to -57.6V -60V DC: -48V to -72V
PIU The PIU board receives and provides DC power for equipment. For OptiX OSN 6800, the PIU board must be TN11PIU. l
Function Accesses DC power in a range from -40 V to -72 V. Provides lightning protection and power filtering functions. NOTE
The overcurrent protection function for the access power supplies of each subrack is realized by the magnetic circuit breaker of the PDU.
l
Front Panel Appearance of the Front Panel Figure 3-33 Front panel of the TN11PIU board PIU RUN
NEG(-) RTN(+)
Indicators: Running status indicator (RUN) - green l
Valid Slots Table 3-48 Valid slots for the TN11PIU board
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Product
Valid Slots
OptiX OSN 6800
IU19 and IU20
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
66
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
3 Quick View of Product
Specifications – Performance Specifications Table 3-49 Performance specifications of the PIU board Item
Unit
Value
Number of DC input power supplies
-
1
Input DC power voltage range
V DC
-48V DC: -40V to -57.6V -60V DC: -48V to -72V
Input DC power current
A
≤30
– Mechanical Specifications Dimensions of front panel: 28 mm (W) x 220 mm (D) x 65 mm (H) (1.1 in. (W) x 8.7 in. (D) x 2.6 in. (H)) Weight: 0.5 kg (1.1 lb.) – Power Consumption Board
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
TN11PIU
24
38
3.4 OptiX OSN 3800 Chassis and Power Requirement 3.4.1 Chassis Structure The 3U-high, case-shaped chassis is the basic working unit of the OptiX OSN 3800 compact intelligent optical transport platform (OptiX OSN 3800 for short). The chassis of the OptiX OSN 3800 can operate with an independent DC or AC power supply and can be installed in an ETSI 300 mm rear-column cabinet, a standard ETSI 300 mm cabinet, or a 19 and 23-inch open rack. Figure 3-34 shows appearance of the OptiX OSN 3800 chassis. Table 3-50 describes the mechanical specifications of the OptiX OSN 3800 chassis.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
67
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-34 OptiX OSN 3800 chassis
5 1 4 2
3
1. Grounding connector
2. Fiber frame
3. Board area
4. Antistatic jack
5. Fan indicator
l
Ground connector: Access the ground cables.
l
Fiber frame: Fiber jumpers in the service board area are routed through the fiber frame.
l
Board area: All service boards are installed in this area. In total, 11 slots are available.
l
Antistatic jack: The ESD strap is in this area.
l
Fan indicator: The fan indicator indicates the status of the fans.
Table 3-50 Mechanical specifications of the OptiX OSN 3800 Item
Specification
Dimensions
436 mm (W) x 295 mm (D) x 134 mm (H) or 17.17 in. (W) x 11.61 in. (D) x 5.28 in. (H)
Weight of an empty chassis (with backplane)
6 kg (13.23 lb.)
3.4.2 Slot Description The board area of the chassis has 11 slots, labeled IU1 to IU11 from left to right. Slots of the chassis are shown in Figure 3-35 and Figure 3-36. Figure 3-35 Slots of the chassis (DC power)
IU1 FAN
Paired slots Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
IU11
IU6/PIU
IU2
IU7/PIU
IU3
IU8/SCC
IU4
IU9/SCC
IU5
IU10/AUX
Mesh group
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Mutual backup
68
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-36 Slots of the chassis (AC power)
IU1
IU11
IU6/APIU
IU2 FAN
Paired slots
IU3
IU7/APIU
IU4
IU9/SCC
IU5
IU10/AUX
Mesh group
Mutual backup
NOTE
l
: service boards.
l Slots IU1 and IU11 can be used as two independent slots, each for housing an FOADM board with a height of 118.9 mm (4.7 in.). They can be also used as one slot for housing a service board with a height of 264.6 mm (10.4 in.). When the two slots are used as one slot, the slot ID is represented as IU11. l Pair slots refer to a pair of slots whose resident boards' overhead can be processed by the buses on the backplanes. l A mesh group refers to a group of slots housing the boards whose overhead can be processed by the buses on the backplane.
3.4.3 Fan Each OptiX OSN 3800 chassis has one fan tray assembly, which includes six independent fans and an air filter. The air filter can be drawn out, cleaned and replaced.
Version Description Only one functional version of the fan tray assembly is available, that is, TN21.
Functions and Features Table 3-51 shows the functions of a fan tray assembly. Table 3-51 Functions of a fan tray assembly
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Function
Description
Basic function
Dissipates heat generated by the equipment so that the equipment can operate normally within the designated temperature range.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
69
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Function
Description
Commissioning control
l Auto Speed Mode: Implements automatic fan speed regulation, depending on the subrack temperature. l Adjustable Speed Mode: You can manually adjust the fan speed. NOTE Only when the chassis accesses DC power, Fan speed control is available..
Hot swapping
Provides the hot swapping function for the fan tray assembly.
Alarming
Reports alarms of the fans and reports the inservice information.
Status checking
Checks the fan status.
Working Principle Air flow from the subrack is left intake right exhaust.. Figure 3-37 shows the heat dissipation and ventilation system in the OptiX OSN 3800. Figure 3-37 Front view of the heat dissipation and ventilation system
Air outlet
Air inlet Board Area
FAN
The OptiX OSN 3800 supports two fan speed modes, as shown in Table 3-52. It is recommended that you set the speed mode to Auto Speed Mode. Table 3-52 FAN speed mode FAN Speed Mode
Description
Auto Speed Mode
The fan speed depends on the temperature. l Lower than 45°C (113°F): the fans run at low speed. l Higher than 65°C (149°F): the fans run at high speed. l 45°C (113°F) to 65°C (149°F): the fans run at medium speed. The fans run at full speed if the speed regulating signals are abnormal.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
70
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
FAN Speed Mode
Description
Adjustable Speed Mode
Four fan speed modes are available: Stop, Low Speed, Medium Speed, and High Speed. You can set the fan speed manually. In Adjustable Speed Mode, the fans in all partitions run at the same speed and do not support the partitioned manual fan speed adjustment.
NOTE
l
If any one of the six fans in the fan tray assembly fails, the system can keep on operating for 96 consecutive hours in an environment with temperatures between 0°C to 45°C (32°F to 113°F).
l
Replace the fan tray assembly immediately if: Two or more fans fail in the fan tray assembly.
The fan tray assembly consists of six fans and one fan control unit. Figure 3-38 shows the functional block of the fan tray assembly. Figure 3-38 Functional block diagram of the fan tray assembly Status signal Speed adjusting signal Fan control unit Status signal FAN
Speed adjusting signal
External power External power supply 1 supply 2
l
FAN: dissipates heat generated by normal operation of the chassis. FAN is the core of the fan tray assembly.
l
Fan control board: – Controls the fan speed according to regulating signals. – Detects faults. After a fault is detected, the fan control unit reports an alarm. – Monitors the fan speed regulating signals, the fan status, and the online/offline state of the fan tray assembly. – Receives and carries out commands from the SCC board to shut down the fans on the fan tray assembly if necessary.
Appearance Figure 3-39 shows a fan tray assembly. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
71
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-39 Fan tray assembly 1
2
1. Fans (6 in total)
2. Operating status indicator
Valid Slots One slot houses one fan tray assembly. The valid slot for the fan tray assembly is IU12.
Specifications of the Fan Tray Assembly Table 3-53 list the technical specifications of the fan tray assembly for the OptiX OSN 3800 system. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat consumption (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh).
Table 3-53 Technical specifications of the fan tray assembly Item
Specification
Dimensions
41.0 mm (W) x 262.6 mm (D) x 126.5 mm (H) (1.61 in. (W) x 10.34 in. (D) x 4.98 in. (H))
Weight
0.81 kg (1.79 lb)
Power Consumptiona
l Low Speed: 9 W l Medium Speed: 17 W l High Speed: 32.7 W
a: Rotating speed of fans is controlled intelligently. When the system is typically configured, rotating speed of fans is automatically adjusted to a low level. When the system is fully configured with boards of high power consumption, and the system is running in a high ambient temperature, rotating speed of fans may be adjusted to a high level. When rotating at the maximum speed, power consumption of fan tray assembly may reach 32.7 W.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
72
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.4.4 AC Power Consumption This section provides the maximum and typical power consumption specifications of OptiX OSN 3800 when the equipment runs on AC power. Table 3-54 describes the AC power consumption of an OptiX OSN 3800 chassis. NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat rate (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh). Typical configuration power consumption indicates the average power consumption of the equipment with the typical configuration and the equipment runs at the room temperature. Maximum power consumption indicates the possible maximum power consumption when the equipment runs in an environment with extreme conditions.
Table 3-54 AC Power consumption of an OptiX OSN 3800 Item
Value
Maximum power consumption
350 W
Table 3-55 lists the power consumption of the common units in an OptiX OSN 3800. Table 3-55 AC Power consumption of the chassis in typical configuration in an OptiX OSN 3800 Unit Name
Typical Power Consump tion at 25° C (77°F)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)
Remarks
Chassis 1
162.2
207.5
2 x TN21MR2, 4 x 2.5 Gbit/s OTU, 1 x SCC, 2 x APIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly.
Chassis 2
117.7
154.5
1 x DFIU, 1 x SC2, 2 x OAU101, 1 x SCC, 2 x APIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly.
OLA chassis (Using the APIU)
119.7
156.7
1 x DFIU, 1 x SC2, 2 x OBU103, 1 x SCC, 2 x APIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly.
OADM chassis (Using the APIU)
a: Indicates that the power consumption of the chassis is the value in a certain configuration. The value is for reference only. The actual power consumption of the chassis is calculated based on the power consumption of each module.
3.4.5 AC Power Requirement This section describes the requirements on power supplywhen the equipment runs on AC power. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
73
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Requirements on AC Voltage and Current Table 3-56 provides the requirements on AC voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 3800 chassis. Table 3-56 Requirements on AC voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 3800 Item
Requirement
Rated working current
1.7 A
Nominal working voltage
220 V AC
Working voltage range
90 V AC to 285 V AC
APIU The APIU board receives and provides AC power for equipment. For OptiX OSN 3800, the APIU board must be TN21APIU. l
Function: Accesses AC power in a range from 90 V to 285 V. Provides lightning protection and power filtering functions.
l
Front Panel: Appearance of the Front Panel Figure 3-40 Front panel of the APIU board
APIU RUN
ON
OFF ~100-240V
S1 S11 APIU S2 S3 APIU S4 SCC S5 AUX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
74
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Indicator: Running status indicator (RUN) - green l
Valid Slots: IU6, IU7 and IU8 together house two APIU boards. That is, each APIU requires 1.5 slots.
l
Specifications: – Performance Specifications Table 3-57 Performance specifications of the APIU Item
Unit
Value
Input power voltage range
V (AC)
90 to 285
Input frequency
Hz
50
Input power current
A (AC)
≤4
Output rated voltage
V (DC)
-48
Output rated current
A (DC)
6.3
Output power
W
300
– Mechanical Specifications Dimensions of front panel: 37.5 mm (H) x 100 mm (W) x 220 mm (D) or 1.5 in. (H) x 3.9 in. (W) x 8.7 in. (D) Weight: 0.8 kg (1.8lb.) – Power Consumption Board
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
TN21APIU
50
55
3.4.6 DC Power Consumption This section provides the maximum and typical power consumption specifications of OptiX OSN 3800 when the equipment runs on DC power. Table 3-58 describes the DC power consumption of an OptiX OSN 3800 chassis.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
75
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
NOTE
For the transport equipment, heat consumption and power consumption are similar and can be taken as the same. Heat rate (BTU/h) = Power consumption (W) x Time (h)/0.2931(Wh). Typical configuration power consumption indicates the average power consumption of the equipment with the typical configuration and the equipment runs at the room temperature. Maximum power consumption indicates the possible maximum power consumption when the equipment runs in an environment with extreme conditions.
Table 3-58 DC Power consumption of an OptiX OSN 3800 Item
Value
Maximum power consumption
350 W
Table 3-59 lists the power consumption of the common units in an OptiX OSN 3800. Table 3-59 DC Power consumption of the chassis in typical configuration in an OptiX OSN 3800 Unit Name
Typical Power Consump tion at 25° C (77°F)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)
Remarks
Chassis 1
99.4
135.3
2 x TN21MR2, 4 x 2.5 Gbit/s OTU, 1 x SCC, 2 x DPIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly.
Chassis 2
77.7
111.5
1 x DFIU, 1 x SC2, 2 x OAU101, 1 x SCC, 2 x DPIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly.
OLA chassis (Using the PIU)
79.7
113.7
1 x DFIU, 1 x SC2, 2 x OBU103, 1 x SCC, 2 x DPIU, 1 x AUX, and 1 x fan tray assembly.
OADM chassis (Using the PIU)
a: Indicates that the power consumption of the chassis is the value in a certain configuration. The value is for reference only. The actual power consumption of the chassis is calculated based on the power consumption of each module.
3.4.7 DC Power Requirement This section describes the requirements on power supply when the equipment runs on DC power.
Requirements on DC Voltage and Current Table 3-60 provides the requirements on DC voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 3800 chassis.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
76
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-60 Requirements on DC voltage and current of an OptiX OSN 3800 Item
Requirement
Rated working current
8A
Nominal working voltage
-48 V DC/-60 V DC
Working voltage range
-40 V DC to -72 V DC
PIU The PIU board receives and provides DC power for equipment. For OptiX OSN 3800, the PIU board must be TN21PIU. l
Function: Accesses DC power in a range from -40 V to -72 V. Provides lightning protection and power filtering functions.
l
Front Panel: Appearance of the Front Panel Figure 3-41 Front panel of the PIU board
RUN
DO not hot plug this unit! S1 S4
S2
AUX
SCC
SCC
PIU
PIU
S5
S11
S6
NEG(-) RTN(+)
PIU
Indicator: Running status indicator (RUN) - green l
Valid Slots: IU6 and IU7
l
Specifications: – Performance Specifications
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
77
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-61 Performance specifications of the PIU Item
Unit
Value
Number of DC input power supplies
-
1
Input DC power voltage range
V
-40 to -72
Input DC power current
A
≤7
– Mechanical Specifications Dimensions of front panel: 218.50 mm (H) x 107.76 in. (W) or 8.6 in. (H) x 4.2 in. (W) Weight: 0.5 kg (1.0 lb.) – Power Consumption Board
Typical Power Consumption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
TN21PIU
10
12
3.5 DC PDU There are four types of power distribution units (PDUs): TN16, TN51, TN11 and PDU (DPD63-8-8). The availability of the boards is subject to the PCNs. For the availability of the boards, contact the product manager of your Huawei local office. l
The TN51PDU and TN16PDU use the same front panel and provide the same functions, but they are different in height. The two boards apply to the same scenarios. This manual uses the TN16PDU board as an example for illustration.
l
The TN16PDU is used for a cabinet housing only OptiX OSN 8800 subracks or a cabinet housing OptiX OSN 8800 and OptiX OSN 6800 subracks.
l
The TN11PDU is used only for a cabinet housing OptiX OSN 6800 subracks.
l
The PDU (DPD63-8-8) is used for a cabinet housing only OptiX OSN 8800 subracks , a cabinet housing only OptiX OSN 6800 subracks, or a cabinet housing OptiX OSN 8800 and OptiX OSN 6800 subracks.
3.5.1 TN16PDU/TN51PDU The TN16PDU/TN51PDU is installed in the upper part of a cabinet to supply power to subracks inside the cabinet. NOTE
The TN51PDU and TN16PDU have the same functions but differ in height. The TN51PDU is 133.4 mm high. When two OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subracks are installed on a cabinet, one more DCM frame can be configured if the TN16PDU is used, compared with the TN51PDU. TN51PDU can be substituted by the TN16PDU.This topic describes the TN16PDU.
The TN16PDU consists of two parts: A and B, which backs up each other. Both A and B receive four -48V/-60V power supplies and output four power supplies for subracks in the cabinet. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
78
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Whether short-circuiting copper bars are required is determined by the current of power supplied by the power supply equipment in the telecommunications room: l
When eight 63 A power supplies are provided, no short-circuiting copper bar is required.
l
When four 125 A power supplies are provided, short-circuiting copper bars are required for dividing one 125 A power supply into two 63 A power supplies. For more information about short-circuiting copper bars, see Short-Circuiting Copper Bar.
Figure 3-42 shows the front panel of the TN16PDU. Figure 3-42 Front panel of the TN16PDU Power supply input area
Power supply Power supply output area switch area
+ 1
+
+
2
Power supply Power supply switch area output area
A
1
2
+ 4
B
3
1. Output cable terminal block
3
2
1
4
+
+
+
+
3
2. Input cable terminal block
3. Power switch
l
Panel dimensions: 535 mm (W) x 100 mm (H)
l
Output cable terminal block: Both A and B of the DC PDU have four output cable terminal blocks for connecting power cables of subracks to supply power for subracks.
l
Input cable terminal block: Both A and B of the DC PDU have four input cable terminal blocks and receive four -48V/-60V DC power supplies, eight -48V/-60V DC power supplies in total.
l
Power switch: Both A and B of the DC PDU have four output power switches to control power supplies for subracks inside the cabinet and provide overcurrent protection for each other.
Figure 3-43 shows the internal pin assignments of the TN16PDU. Figure 3-43 TN16PDU internal pin assignments
OUTPUT B
OUTPUT A -
-
-
-
1
2
3
4
1 + ON
ON ON
ON
2 +
3 +
4 +
1 +
INPUT A
2 +
3 +
4 + ON
INPUT B
ON ON
+
+
+
1
2
3
4
-
-
2
3
4
OUTPUT B OFF OFF OFF OFF
OFF OFF OFF OFF
1 -
2
3
4
1
-
-
-
-
INPUT A
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
-
1 ON
OUTPUT A +
-
2
3
4
-
-
-
+
+
+
+
1
2
3
4
INPUT B
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
79
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Short-Circuit Copper Bar If a power supply is 125 A, both A and B need to receive two power supplies, four power supplies in total. In this case, short-circuit copper bars are required for both A and B. Figure 3-44 shows the appearance of the short-circuiting copper bar. Figure 3-44 Appearance
Copper Plate
3.5.2 TN11PDU The TN11PDU is installed in the upper part of a cabinet to supply power to subracks inside the cabinet.
DC PDU The TN11PDU consists of two parts: A and B, which backs up each other. Both A and B receive two -48V/-60V power supplies and output six power supplies for subracks in the cabinet. Whether junction boxes are required is determined by the current of power supplied by the power supply equipment in the telecommunications room: l
If a power supply is 63 A, both A and B need to receive two power supplies, four power supplies in total. In this case, no junction box is required.
l
If a power supply is 125 A, both A and B need to receive one power supply, two power supplies in total. In this case, junction boxes are required for dividing one 125 A current into four 32 A currents. For more information about junction boxes, see Junction Box.
Figure 3-45 shows the front panel of the TN11PDU.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
80
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-45 Front panel of the TN11PDU 1
2
3
3
2
1
4
4
1. Output cable terminal block
2. Ground screw
3. Input cable terminal block
4. Power switch
l
Panel dimensions: 535 mm (W) x 131 mm (H)
l
Output cable terminal block: Both A and B of the DC PDU have six output cable terminal blocks for connecting power cables of subracks to supply power for subracks.
l
Ground screw: used to connect (protection ground) PGND cables.
l
Input cable terminal block: Both A and B of the DC PDU have two input cable terminal blocks and receive two -48V/-60V DC power supplies, four -48V/-60V DC power supplies in total.
l
Power switch: Both A and B of the DC PDU have six power output switches (corresponding to the six output cable terminal blocks) to control power supplies for subracks in the cabinet. NOTE
For the OptiX OSN 6800, both A and B only use power switches SW2, SW3, SW4, and SW5 to control power supplies for four subracks from bottom to top.
Figure 3-46 shows the internal pin assignments of the TN11PDU. Figure 3-46 TN11PDU internal pin assignments OUTPUT
+- +- +
-
+
-
+- +
-
-
+
-
-
-
-
+- +
ON
+
+ INPUT
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
OUTPUT
+- +- +
-
ON OFF
-
-
-
+
+
-
-
OFF
INPUT
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
81
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Junction Box If a power supply is 125 A, both A and B need to receive one power supply, two power supplies in total. In this case, junction boxes are required for both A and B. Figure 3-47 shows the junction box structure and Figure 3-48 shows the installation position of the junction box. Figure 3-47 Structure
Figure 3-48 Installation position
3.6 Frame 3.6.1 DCM Frame and DCM Module The DCM frame is used to hold DCM modules. DCM modules compensate for the positive dispersion of transmitting fiber, to help maintain the original shape of the signal pulse. After an optical signal is transmitted over a certain distance, the optical signal pulse is expanded because of the accumulation of the positive dispersion. An expanded pulse has a negative impact Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
82
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
on system transmission performance. A dispersion compensation module (DCM) is a passive device that compensates for dispersion. DCMs use the inherent negative dispersion of a dispersion compensation fiber to offset the positive dispersion of a transmission fiber to prevent pulse expansion. The system provides two types of DCMs: those using dispersion compensation fibers (DCFs) and those that use fiber Bragg grating (FBG) technology. The DCMs are available in different compensation distance specifications: 5 km (3.1 mi.), 10 km (6.2 mi.), 20 km (12.4 mi.), 40 km (24.8 mi.), 60 km (37.3 mi.), 80 km (49.7 mi.), 100 km (62.1 mi.), 120 km (74.6 mi.), 160 km (99.4 mi.), 200 km (124.2 mi.), and 240 km (149.1 mi.). Each DCM frame holds two DCM modules. The DCM frame is installed on the columns of a cabinet with mounting airs and screws, as shown in Figure 3-49. Figure 3-49 DCM frame
1
2
1. DCM frame
2. DCMs
Table 3-62 Performance requirements for C-band dispersion compensation optical fibers (G. 652 fibers)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
DCM Module
Distance (mi./km)
Max. Inserti on Loss (dB)
DSC R
PMD (ps)
PD L (dB )
Max. Allowed Powera (dBm)
Operatin g Wavelen gth (nm)
DCM(S)
3.1/5
2.3
0.3
0.1
20
DCM(T)
6.2/10
2.8
90% to 110%
0.3
0.1
20
1528 to 1568
DCM(A)
12.4/20
3.3
0.4
0.1
20
DCM(B)
24.8/40
4.7
0.5
0.1
20
DCM(C)
37.3/60
6.4
0.6
0.1
20
DCM(D)
49.7/80
8
0.7
0.1
20
DCM(E)
62.1/100
9
0.8
0.1
20
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
83
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
DCM Module
Distance (mi./km)
Max. Inserti on Loss (dB)
DCM(F)
74.5/120
FBG-DCM (80)
3 Quick View of Product
DSC R
PMD (ps)
PD L (dB )
Max. Allowed Powera (dBm)
9.8
0.8
0.1
20
49.7/80
4
1.0
0.2
23
FBG-DCM (100)
62.1/100
4
1.0
0.2
23
FBG-DCM (120)
74.5/120
4
1.0
0.2
23
FBG-DCM (160)
99.4/160
8
1.6
0.4
23
FBG-DCM (200)
124.2/200
8
1.6
0.4
23
FBG-DCM (240)
149.1/240
8
1.6
0.4
23
Operatin g Wavelen gth (nm)
a: The Max. Allowed Power refers to the maximum input optical power that the optical module can receive without being damaged.
Table 3-63 Performance requirements for C-band dispersion compensation optical fibers (G. 655 LEAF fibers)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
DCM Module
Distance (mi./km)
Max. Inserti on Loss (dB)
DSC R
PMD (ps)
PD L (dB )
Max. Allowed Powera (dBm)
Operatin g Wavelen gth (nm)
DCM(A)
12.4/20
4
0.4
0.3
20
DCM(B)
24.8/40
5
90% to 110%
0.5
0.3
20
1528 to 1568
DCM(C)
37.3/60
5.9
0.7
0.3
20
DCM(D)
49.7/80
6.9
0.8
0.3
20
DCM(E)
62.1/100
7.8
0.9
0.3
20
DCM(F)
74.5/120
8.8
1.0
0.3
20
FBG-DCM (120)
74.5/120
3.7
1.0
0.2
23
FBG-DCM (160)
99.4/160
3.7
1.0
0.2
23
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
84
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
DCM Module
Distance (mi./km)
Max. Inserti on Loss (dB)
FBG-DCM (200)
124.2/200
FBG-DCM (240)
149.1/240
DSC R
PMD (ps)
PD L (dB )
Max. Allowed Powera (dBm)
3.7
1.0
0.2
23
3.7
1.0
0.2
23
Operatin g Wavelen gth (nm)
a: The Max. Allowed Power refers to the maximum input optical power that the optical module can receive without being damaged.
Table 3-64 Performance requirements for C-band dispersion compensation optical fibers (G. 653 fibers) DCM Module
Distance (mi./km)
Max. Insert ion Loss (dB)
DSC R
PMD (ps)
PDL (dB)
Max. Allowe d Powera (dBm)
Opera ting Wavel ength (nm)
DCM(S)
3.1/5
2
0.2
0.1
20
DCM(T)
6.2/10
3
90% to 110%
0.3
0.1
20
1528 to 1568
DCM(A)
12.4/20
5
0.5
0.1
20
a: The Max. Allowed Power refers to the maximum input optical power that the optical module can receive without being damaged.
Table 3-65 Performance requirements for C-band dispersion compensation optical fibers (TWRS fibers)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
DCM Module
Distance (mi./km)
Max. Insert ion Loss (dB)
DSC R
PMD (ps)
PDL (dB)
Max. Allowe d Powera (dBm)
Opera ting Wavel ength (nm)
DCM(A)
12.4/20
2.3
0.3
0.1
20
DCM(B)
24.8/40
2.8
90% to 110%
0.3
0.1
20
1528 to 1568
DCM(C)
37.3/60
3.3
0.4
0.1
20
DCM(D)
49.7/80
3.8
0.4
0.1
20
DCM(E)
62.1/100
4.2
0.5
0.1
20
DCM(F)
74.5/120
4.7
0.5
0.1
20
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
85
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
DCM Module
Distance (mi./km)
3 Quick View of Product
Max. Insert ion Loss (dB)
DSC R
PMD (ps)
PDL (dB)
Max. Allowe d Powera (dBm)
Opera ting Wavel ength (nm)
a: The Max. Allowed Power refers to the maximum input optical power that the optical module can receive without being damaged.
Table 3-66 Mechanical specifications of the DCM frame Item
Specification
Dimensions
48 mm (H) x 484 mm (W) x 270.5 mm (D) (1.9 in. (H) x 19.1 in. (W) x 10.6 in. (D) )
Weight
1.5 kg (3.3 lb.)
H = Height, W = Width, D = Depth
3.6.2 CRPC Frame The CRPC frame is used to hold the CRPC board, fan tray assembly, and power distribution box. The frame is installed into the open rack. Figure 3-50 shows the appearance of a CRPC frame. In the middle of the frame, the one with the front panel is the CRPC board. The fan tray assembly is at the left of the board. At the right are two power supplies as mutual backup.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
86
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-50 CRPC frame
3
2 1
1: Fan tray assembly
2: CRPC board
3: Power distribution box
Table 3-67 Mechanical specifications of the CRPC frame Item
Value
Mechanical specifications
535 mm (W) x 257 mm (D) x 86 mm (H) or 21.1 in. (W) x 10.1 in. (D) x 3.4 in. (H)
Weight
3 kg (6.6 lb)
3.6.3 Fiber Spooling Frame The fiber spooling frame is used to store fiber jumpers in a coil.
Appearance The fiber spool box is installed at the bottom of the cabinet, more than 50 mm away from the chassis. Figure 3-51 shows a fiber spooling frame.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
87
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-51 Fiber spooling frame
1 2
5 6
1: Attenuator holder
2: Mechanical VOA pen
5: Mounting ear
6: Fiber spool
3: Captive screw
4: Fiber holder
Specifications of the Fiber Spooling Frame l
Dimensions: 101.6 mm (W) x 220 mm (D) x 264.6 mm (H) (4.0 in. (W) x 8.7 in. (D) x 10.4 in. (H))
l
Maximum Capacity: A maximum of 40 fibers can be threaded into an fiber spooling frame from each side, and the maximum total fiber length is 50 m.
l
Weight: 4.1 kg (0.22 lb.)
3.7 Overview of Boards
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
88
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.7.1 Board Appearance and Dimensions The board appearance and dimensions include the board appearance, dimensions, and the laser hazard level label.
3.7.1.1 Appearance and Dimensions This section describes the appearance and dimensions of the board.
CAUTION Always wear a properly grounded ESD wrist strap when holding a board to prevent static from damaging the board. Table 3-68 shows the appearance and dimensions of the different board types. Table 3-68 Board appearance and dimensions Board Appearance
Width
Board Name
Numbe r of Slots Per Board
Heig ht (mm /in.)
Wi dt h (m m/ in. )
Dep th (m m/ in.)
TN11L4G
1
264.6 /10.4
25. 4/1 .0
220. 0/8. 7
Height
Depth
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
89
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Appearance
Width
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Numbe r of Slots Per Board
Heig ht (mm /in.)
Wi dt h (m m/ in. )
Dep th (m m/ in.)
TN11OAU1
2
264.6 /10.4
50. 8
220. 0/8. 7
TN11M40
3
264.6 /10.4
76. 2
220. 0/8. 7
TN11AUX
1
107.6 /4.2
25. 4/1 .0
220. 0/8. 7
Height
Depth
Width
Height
Depth
Width
Height Depth
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
90
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Appearance
Width
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Numbe r of Slots Per Board
Heig ht (mm /in.)
Wi dt h (m m/ in. )
Dep th (m m/ in.)
TN11LSXL
4
264.6 /10.4
10 1.6 / 4.0
220. 0/8. 7
TN21MR4
1
118.9 /4.7
25. 4/1 .0
220. 0/8. 7
Height
Depth
Width
Height Depth
3.7.1.2 Symbols on Boards This section describes the symbols on boards.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
91
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-69 Symbols on Boards Label
Type
Description
Laser safety class label
Indicates that the laser safety class of boards is HAZARD LEVEL 1M and there may be laser radiation. It warns users not to directly look into fiber connectors without taking any protection measures; instead an optical instrument that can attenuate optical power must be used.
Fiber type label
Applies to TN11LTX, TN12LSC, and TN55NS3 boards. It specifies the fiber type for the boards.
CAUTION
HAZARD LEVEL 1M INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION DO NOT VIEW DIRECTLY WITH NON-ATTENUATING OPTICAL INSTRUMENTS
G.657A2 FIBER ONLY 只能使用G.657A2 光纤
NOTE To prevent the cabinet door from squeezing fibers, the board can only use G.657A2 fibers. SM SFP WORK WITH G.657A2 FIBER ONLY 单模光模块仅配合使用 G.657A2 光纤
Fiber type label
Applies to TN54THA boards. It specifies the fiber type for the boards. NOTE To prevent the cabinet door from squeezing fibers, the board can only use G.657A2 fibers.
!
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
警告: 开启电源前, 务必连好光纤 WARNING : FIBERS MUST BE CONNECTED SEFORE POWER UP
Warning label
Applies to CRPC boards. It provides precautions for the boards.
Heat hazard label
Indicates that the board surface temperature is high and it may cause body injury.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
92
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.7.2 OptiX OSN 8800 Board Category The following types of boards are available for the system. Table 3-70 lists the boards for the OptiX OSN 8800. Table 3-70 Boards for the OptiX OSN 8800 Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
Optical transponder unit
TN12LD M
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board
Y
Y
N
TN11LD MD
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board, dual fed and selective receiving
Y
Y
N
TN11LD MS
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board, single fed and single receiving
Y
Y
N
TN12LDX
2 x 10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11LEM 24
22 x GE + 2 x 10GE and 2 x OTU2 Ethernet switch board
Y
Y
Y
TN11LEX 4
4 x 10GE and 2 x OTU2 Ethernet switch board
Y
Y
Y
TN11LOA
8 x Any-rate MUX OTU2 Wavelength Conversion Board
Y
Y
Y
TN11LOG
8 x Gigabit Ethernet unit
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
TN12LOG TN11LO M
8-port multi-service multiplexing & optical wavelength conversion board
TN12LO M TN13LQ M
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit
Y
Y
N
TN12LQ MD
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit, dual fed and selective receiving
Y
Y
N
TN12LQ MS
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit, single fed and single receiving
Y
Y
N
TN12LSC
100Gbit/s wavelength conversion board
Y
Y
Y
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
93
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
TN11LSQ
40 Gbit/s wavelength conversion board
Y
Y
Y
TN12LSX
10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion unit
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
TN13LSX TN12LSX L
40 Gbit/s wavelength conversion board
TN15LSX L TN12LSX LR
40 Gbit/s wavelength conversion relay unit
Y
Y
N
TN11LSX R
10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion relay unit
Y
Y
N
TN11LTX
10-Port 10Gbit/s Service Multiplexing & Optical Wavelength Conversion Board
Y
Y
Y
TN12LW XS
arbitrary rate (16Mbit/s-2.7Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board (single transmit)
Y
Y
Y
TN11TM X
4 channels STM-16/OC-48/OTU1 asynchronism mux OTU-2 wavelength conversion board
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
2 x 10G tributary service processing board
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
TN12TM X Tributary unit
3 Quick View of Product
TN52TDX TN53TDX TN54TEM 28
24xGE+4x10GE Ethernet tributary unit
Y
Y
Y
TN54THA
16 Any-rate Ports Service Processing Board
Y
Y
Y
TN54TOA
8 Any-rate Ports Service Processing Board
Y
Y
Y
TN52TOG
8 x GE tributary service processing board
Y
Y
Y
TN52TO M
8 x multi-rate ports service processing board
Y
Y
Y
TN52TQX
4 x 10 Gbit/s tributary service processing board
Y
Y
Y
TN53TQX
Y
Y
Y
TN55TQX
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
TN53TSX L
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
40 Gbit/s tributary service processing board
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
94
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
TN53NQ2
Y
Y
Y
TN54NQ2
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
TN54NS3
Y
Y
Y
TN55NS3
Y
Y
Y
TN54TSX L Line unit
TN52ND2
2 x 10G line service processing board
TN53ND2 TN52NQ2
TN52NS2
4 x 10G Line Service Processing Board
10G Line Service Processing Board
TN53NS2 TN52NS3
PID unit
40G line service processing board
TN54ENQ 2
4 x 10G Line Service Processing Board
Y
Y
Y
TN54NPO 2
12 x OTU2 PID Board
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
TN55NPO 2
Crossconnect unit and system and communica tion unit
3 Quick View of Product
TN55NPO 2E
10G PID line service processing board, 20– channel extended
Y
Y
Y
TN16XCH
High Cross-connection, System Control and Clock Processing Board
N
N
Y
TNK2SX M
OptiX OSN 8800 T64 centralized cross connect board
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
TNK4SX M TN52XCH
OptiX OSN 8800 T32 centralized cross connect board
N
Y
N
TN52XC M
Cross & connect process board (Support highcross and low-cross)
N
Y
N
TNK2XC T
OptiX OSN 8800 T64 centralized cross connect board
Y
N
N
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
95
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
3 Quick View of Product
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
TN52SCC
N
Y
N
TNK2SCC
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
TNK4XC T TN16SCC
system control and communication unit
TN51SCC d
TN16AUX
system auxiliary interface unit
TN51AUX TNK2SX H
OptiX OSN 8800 T64 centralized cross connect board
TNK4SX H Optical multiplexer and demultiple xer unit
TN11M40
40-channel multiplexing unit
TN12M40 TN11D40
40-channel demultiplexing unit
TN12D40 TN11M40 V
40-channel multiplexing unit with VOA
TN12M40 V TN11D40 V
40-channel demultiplexing unit with VOA
Y
Y
N
TN12FIU
fiber interface unit
Y
Y
Y
TN13FIU
Y
Y
Y
TN14FIU
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
TN11ITL
interleaver board
TN12ITL
Fixed optical add and drop
TN11SFIU
fiber interface unit for sync timing
Y
Y
Y
TN11CM R2
CWDM 2-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
Y
Y
Y
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
96
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
multiplexin g unit
TN11CM R4
CWDM 4-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11DM R1
CWDM 1-channel bidirectional optical add/ drop multiplexing board
Y
Y
N
TN11MR2
2-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11MR4
4-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11MR8
8-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
Y
Y
N
TN11MR8 V
8-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit with VOA
Y
Y
Y
TN11SBM 2
2-channel CWDM single-fiber bidirectional add/drop board
Y
Y
N
TN11RDU 9
9-port ROADM demultiplexing board
Y
Y
Y
TN11RM U9a
9-port ROADM multiplexing board
Y
Y
Y
TN11ROA M
reconfigurable optical adding board
Y
Y
N
TN12WS D9
9-port wavelength selective switching demultiplexing board
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Reconfigur able optical add and drop multiplexin g unit
TN13WS D9 TN12WS M9
9-port wavelength selective switching multiplexing board
TN13WS M9 TN11WS MD2
2-port wavelength selective switching multiplexer and demultiplexer board
Y
Y
N
TN11WS MD4
4-port wavelength selective switching multiplexer and demultiplexer board
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
TN12WS MD4 TN11WS MD9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
9-port wavelength selective multiplexing and demultiplexing board
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
97
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
Optical amplifier unit
TN11CRP C
case-shape Raman pump amplifier unit for Cband
Y
Y
Y
TN11DAS 1
optical amplifier unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11HBA
high-power booster amplifier board
Y
Y
Y
TN11OAU 1
optical amplifier unit
Y
Y
N
TN12OAU 1
Y
Y
Y
TN13OAU 1
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
TN12OBU 1
Y
Y
Y
TN11OBU 2
Y
Y
N
TN12OBU 2
Y
Y
Y
TN11OBU 1
Optical supervisory channel unit
Optical protection unit
optical booster unit
TN11RAU 1
backward raman and erbium doped fiber hybrid optical amplifier unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11HSC 1
high power unidirectional optical supervisory channel board
Y
Y
Y
TN12SC1
unidirectional optical supervisory channel unit
Y
Y
Y
TN12SC2
bidirectional optical supervisory channel unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11ST2
bidirectional optical supervisory channel and timing transmission unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11DCP
2-channel optical path protection unit
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
TN12DCP TN11OLP
optical line protection unit
TN12OLP TN11SCS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
sync optical channel separator unit
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
98
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
Spectrum analyzer unit
TN11MC A4
4-channel spectrum analyzer unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11MC A8
8-channel spectrum analyzer unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11OPM 8
8-channel optical power monitoring board
Y
Y
Y
TN11WM U
wavelength monitoring unit
Y
Y
Y
Variable optical attenuator unit
TN12VA1
1-channel variable optical attenuator unit
Y
Y
Y
TN12VA4
4-channel variable optical attenuator unit
Y
Y
Y
Optical power and dispersion equalizing unit
TN11DCU
dispersion compensation board
Y
Y
Y
TN11TDC
single-wavelength tunable-dispersion compensation board
Y
Y
Y
Clock unit
TN52STG
centralized clock board
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
TNK2STG OCS system unit
SSN4BPA
optical booster and pre-amplifier board
Y
Y
N
SSN3EAS 2
2-port 10xGE switching and processing board
Y
Y
N
SSN1EGS H
16 x GE Ethernet switching and processing board
Y
Y
N
SSN4SF64
1 x STM-64 optical interface board with the FEC function
Y
Y
N
SSN1SF64 A
1 x STM-64 optical interface board with the FEC function
Y
Y
N
SSN4SFD 64
1 x STM-64 optical interface board with the FEC function
Y
Y
N
SSN4SL64
1 x STM-64 optical interface board
Y
Y
N
SSN4SLD 64
2 x STM-64 optical interface board
Y
Y
N
SSN3SLH 41
16 x STM-4/STM-1 optical interface board
Y
Y
N
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
99
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
ROPA subsystem unitb Interface area unitc
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Board Description
OptiX OSN 8800 T64
OptiX OSN 8800 T32
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
SSN4SLO 16
8 x STM-16 optical interface board
Y
Y
N
SSN4SLQ 16
4xSTM-16 optical interface board
Y
Y
N
SSN4SLQ 64
4 x STM-64 line interface board
N
Y
N
TN11GFU
gain flatness unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11RGU
ROPA gain unit
Y
Y
Y
TN11ROP
ROPA pumping unit
Y
Y
Y
TN16ATE
interface board of alarm & timing & expanding
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
TN51EFI1
Y
Y
N
TN51EFI2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
TN51ATE TN16EFI
TNL1STI
EMI filter interface board
synchronous timing interface board
TN52STI TN51PIU
power interface unit
TN16PIU
a: For TN11RMU9: OptiX OSN 8800 T16 only supports the TN11RMU902. b: For details of the ROPA subsystem unit refer to ROPA Subsystem User Guide. c: For details of the interface area unit refer to 3.2 OptiX OSN 8800 Subrack and Power Requirement. d:TN51SCC only supports General OptiX OSN 8800 T32.
3.7.3 OptiX OSN 6800 Board Category The following types of boards are available for the system. Table 3-71 lists the boards for the OptiX OSN 6800.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
100
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-71 Boards for the OptiX OSN 6800 Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
Optical transponder unit
TN11ECOM
Enhanced communication interface unit
TN11L4G
Line wavelength conversion unit with 4 x Gigabit Ethernet line capacity
TN11LDGS
2 x Gigabit Ethernet unit, single fed and single receiving
TN11LDGD
2 x Gigabit Ethernet unit, dual fed and selective receiving
TN12LDM
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board
TN11LDMD
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board, dual fed and selective receiving
TN11LDMS
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board, single fed and single receiving
TN12LDX
2 x 10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion unit
TN11LEM24
22×GE + 2×10GE and 2×OTU2 ethernet switch board
TN11LEX4
4×10GE and 2×OTU2 ethernet switch board
TN11LOA
8 x Any-rate MUX OTU2 Wavelength Conversion Board
TN11LOG
8 x Gigabit Ethernet unit
TN12LOG TN11LOM TN12LOM
8-port multi-service multiplexing & optical wavelength conversion board
TN11LQG
4 x GE-multiplex-optical wavelength conversion board
TN13LQM
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit
TN11LQMD
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit, dual fed and selective receiving
TN12LQMD TN11LQMS TN12LQMS
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit, single fed and single receiving
TN12LSC
100Gbit/s wavelength conversion board
TN11LSQ
40 Gbit/s wavelength conversion board
TN11LSX
10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion unit
TN12LSX TN13LSX Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
101
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Board Description
TN11LSXL
40 Gbit/s wavelength conversion board
TN12LSXL TN15LSXL TN11LSXLR
40 Gbit/s wavelength conversion relay unit
TN12LSXLR TN11LSXR
10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion relay unit
TN11LTX
10-Port 10Gbit/s Service multiplexing & optical wavelength conversion board
TN11LWX2
arbitrary rate (16Mbit/s-2.7Gbit/s) dual-wavelength conversion board
TN11LWXD
arbitrary rate (16Mbit/s-2.7Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board (double transmit)
TN11LWXS
arbitrary rate (16Mbit/s-2.7Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board (single transmit)
TN12LWXS TN11TMX TN12TMX Tributary unit
4 channels STM-16/OC-48/OTU1 asynchronism mux OTU-2 wavelength conversion board
TN11TBE
10 Gigabit ethernet tributary board
TN11TDG
2 x GE tributary service processing board
TN11TDX
2 x 10G tributary service processing board
TN12TDX TN52TDX TN53TDX TN52TOG
8 x GE tributary service processing board
TN11TOM
8 x multi-rate ports service processing board
TN52TOM TN11TQM
4 x multi-rate tributary service processing board
TN12TQM TN11TQS
4 x STM-16/OC-48/OTU1 tributary service processing board
TN11TQX
4 x 10 Gbit/s tributary service processing board
TN52TQX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
102
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Board Description
TN55TQX
Line unit
TN11TSXL
40 Gbit/s tributary service processing board
TN11ND2
2 x 10G line service processing board
TN12ND2 TN52ND2 TN53ND2 TN51NQ2
4 x 10G Line Service Processing Board
TN52NQ2 TN53NQ2 TN11NS2
10G Line Service Processing Board
TN12NS2 TN52NS2 TN53NS2 TN11NS3
40G line service processing board
TN52NS3
NOTE The TN54NS3/55NS3 board for the OptiX OSN 6800 only supports relay mode.
TN54NS3 TN55NS3 PID unit
Cross-connect unit and system and communicatio n unit
TN11BMD4
PID Interleaver Board (C-band), 200/100 GHz
TN11BMD8
PID Interleaver Board (C_Band), 200/50 GHz
TN12ELQX
4×Electrical OTU2 with 4×10G Tributary Board
TN12PTQX
12× OTU2 PID board with 4×10G Tributary
TN11XCS
centralized cross connect board
TN12XCS TN11SCC
system control and communication unit
TN51SCC TN52SCC
Optical multiplexer and
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
TN11AUX
system auxiliary interface unit
TN11M40
40-channel multiplexing unit
TN12M40
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
103
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
demultiplexer unit
TN11D40
40-channel demultiplexing unit
TN12D40 TN11M40V
40-channel multiplexing unit with VOA
TN12M40V TN11D40V
40-channel demultiplexing unit with VOA
TN11FIU
fiber interface unit
TN12FIU TN13FIU TN14FIU TN11ITL
interleaver board
TN12ITL
Optical add and drop multiplexing unit
Reconfigurabl e optical add and drop multiplexing unit
TN11SFIU
fiber interface unit for sync timing
TN11CMR2
CWDM 2-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN11CMR4
CWDM 4-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN11DMR1
CWDM 1-channel bidirectional optical add/drop multiplexing board
TN11MR2
2-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN11MR4
4-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN11MR8
8-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN11MR8V
8-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit with VOA
TN11SBM2
2-channel CWDM single-fiber bidirectional add/drop board
TN11RDU9
9-port ROADM demultiplexing board
TN11RMU9
9-port ROADM multiplexing board
TN11ROAM
reconfigurable optical adding board
TN11WSD9
9-port wavelength selective switching demultiplexing board
TN12WSD9 TN13WSD9 TN11WSM9
9-port wavelength selective switching multiplexing board
TN12WSM9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
104
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Board Description
TN13WSM9 TN11WSMD2
2-port wavelength selective switching multiplexer and demultiplexer board
TN11WSMD4
4-port wavelength selective switching multiplexer and demultiplexer board
TN12WSMD4
Optical amplifier unit
TN11WSMD9
9-port wavelength selective multiplexing and demultiplexing board
TN11CRPC
case-shape Raman pump amplifier unit for C-band
TN11DAS1
optical amplifier unit
TN11HBA
high-power booster amplifier board
TN11OAU1
optical amplifier unit
TN12OAU1 TN13OAU1 TN11OBU1
optical booster unit
TN12OBU1 TN11OBU2
optical booster unit
TN12OBU2
Optical supervisory channel unit
TN11RAU1
backward raman and erbium doped fiber hybrid optical amplifier unit
TN11HSC1
high power unidirectional optical supervisory channel board
TN11SC1
unidirectional optical supervisory channel unit
TN12SC1 TN11SC2
bidirectional optical supervisory channel unit
TN12SC2
Optical protection unit
TN11ST2
bidirectional optical supervisory channel and timing transmission unit
TN11DCP
2-channel optical path protection unit
TN12DCP TN11OLP
optical line protection unit
TN12OLP
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
105
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Spectrum analyzer unit
Variable optical attenuator unit
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Board Description
TN11SCS
sync optical channel separator unit
TN11MCA4
4-channel spectrum analyzer unit
TN11MCA8
8-channel spectrum analyzer unit
TN11OPM8
8-channel optical power monitoring board
TN11WMU
wavelength monitoring unit
TN11VA1
1-channel variable optical attenuator unit
TN12VA1 TN11VA4
4-channel variable optical attenuator unit
TN12VA4 Optical power and dispersion equalizing unit
TN11DCU
dispersion compensation board
TN11TDC
single-wavelength tunable-dispersion compensation board
Clock unit
TN11STG
centralized clock board
ROPA subsystem unita
TN11GFU
gain flatness unit
TN11RGU
ROPA gain unit
TN11ROP
ROPA pumping unit
TN11EFI
EMI filter interface board
TN11PIU
power interface unit
Interface area unitb
a: For the details of the ROPA subsystem unit, refer to ROPA Subsystem User Guide. b: For the details of the interface area unit, refer to Data Communication and Equipment Maintenance Interfaces.
3.7.4 OptiX OSN 3800 Board Category The following types of boards are available for the system. Table 3-72 lists the boards for the OptiX OSN 3800. Table 3-72 Boards for the OptiX OSN 3800
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Board Category
Board Name
Board Description
Optical transponder unit
TN11ECOM
Enhanced communication interface unit
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
106
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Board Description
TN11L4G
Line wavelength conversion unit with 4 x Gigabit Ethernet line capacity
TN11LDGS
2 x Gigabit Ethernet unit, single fed and single receiving
TN11LDGD
2 x Gigabit Ethernet unit, dual fed and selective receiving
TN12LDM
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board
TN11LDMD
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board, dual fed and selective receiving
TN11LDMS
2-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board, single fed and single receiving
TN12LDX
2 x 10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion unit
TN11LOA
8 x Any-rate MUX OTU2 Wavelength Conversion Board
TN11LOG
8 x Gigabit Ethernet unit
TN12LOG TN11LOM TN12LOM
8-port multi-service multiplexing & optical wavelength conversion board
TN11LQG
4 x GE-multiplex-optical wavelength conversion board
TN13LQM
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit
TN11LQMD
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit, dual fed and selective receiving
TN12LQMD TN11LQMS TN12LQMS TN11LSX
4-channel multi-rate (100Mbit/s-2.5Gbit/s) wavelength conversion unit, single fed and single receiving 10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion unit
TN12LSX TN13LSX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
TN11LSXR
10 Gbit/s wavelength conversion relay unit
TN11LWX2
arbitrary rate (16Mbit/s-2.7Gbit/s) dual-wavelength conversion board
TN11LWXD
arbitrary rate (16Mbit/s-2.7Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board (double transmit)
TN11LWXS
arbitrary rate (16Mbit/s-2.7Gbit/s) wavelength conversion board (single transmit)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
107
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Board Description
TN12LWXS TN11TMX TN12TMX Tributary unit
4 channels STM-16/OC-48/OTU1 asynchronism mux OTU-2 wavelength conversion board
TN11TBE
10 Gigabit ethernet tributary board
TN11TDG
2 x GE tributary service processing board
TN11TDX
2 x 10G tributary service processing board
TN52TOG
8 x GE tributary service processing board
TN11TOM
8 x multi-rate ports service processing board
TN52TOM TN11TQM
4 x multi-rate tributary service processing board
TN12TQM
Line unit
TN11TQS
4 x STM-16/OC-48/OTU1 tributary service processing board
TN11NS2
10G Line Service Processing Board
TN12NS2 TN52NS2 TN53NS2 Optical multiplexer and demultiplexer unit
TN21DFIU
bidirectional fiber interface board
TN13FIUa
fiber interface unit
TN14FIU TN21FIU
Optical add and drop multiplexing unit
TN11SFIU
fiber interface unit for sync timing
TN21CMR1
CWDM 1-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN11CMR2
CWDM 2-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN21CMR2 TN11CMR4
CWDM 4-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN21CMR4 TN11DMR1 TN21DMR1 TN11MR2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
CWDM 1-channel bidirectional optical add/drop multiplexing board 2-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
108
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Board Description
TN21MR2 TN11MR4
4-channel optical add/drop multiplexing unit
TN21MR4
Optical amplifier unit
TN11SBM2
2-channel CWDM single-fiber bidirectional add/drop board
TN11DAS1
optical amplifier unit
TN11OAU1
optical amplifier unit
TN12OAU1 TN13OAU1 TN11OBU1
optical booster unit
TN12OBU1 TN11OBU2
optical booster unit
TN12OBU2
Cross-connect unit and system and communicatio n unit
TN11RAU1
backward raman and erbium doped fiber hybrid optical amplifier unit
TN21SCC
system control and communication unit
TN22SCC TN21AUX
system auxiliary interface unit
TN22AUX Optical supervisory channel unit
TN11HSC1
high power unidirectional optical supervisory channel board
TN11SC1
unidirectional optical supervisory channel unit
TN12SC1 TN11SC2
bidirectional optical supervisory channel unit
TN12SC2
Optical protection unit
TN11ST2
bidirectional optical supervisory channel and timing transmission unit
TN11DCP
2-channel optical path protection unit
TN12DCP TN11OLP
optical line protection unit
TN12OLP
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
109
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Category
Spectrum analyzer unit
Variable optical attenuator unit
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Board Description
TN11SCS
sync optical channel separator unit
TN11MCA4
4-channel spectrum analyzer unit
TN11MCA8
8-channel spectrum analyzer unit
TN11OPM8
8-channel optical power monitoring board
TN11VA1
1-channel variable optical attenuator unit
TN12VA1 TN11VA4
4-channel variable optical attenuator unit
TN12VA4 Optical power and dispersion equalizing unit
TN11DCU
dispersion compensation board
Interface area unitb
TN21PIU
power interface unit
TN21APIU
AC Power Interface Unit
a: For TN13FIU: OptiX OSN 3800 only supports the TN13FIU01. b: For the details of the interface area unit, refer to Data Communication and Equipment Maintenance Interfaces.
3.7.5 Optical Attenuator Optical attenuators are classified into fixed optical attenuators and mechanical variable optical attenuators (VOAs).
3.7.5.1 Fixed Optical Attenuator A fixed optical attenuator can reduce the optical power on an optical path by a fixed value. The common attenuation specifications of fixed optical attenuators are 2 dB, 5 dB, 7 dB, 10 dB, and 15 dB. Figure 3-52 shows the appearance of a fixed optical attenuator.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
110
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-52 Fixed optical attenuator
3.7.5.2 Mechanical Variable Optical Attenuator A mechanical variable optical attenuator (MVOA) can adjust the optical power on an optical path within a permitted range. The attenuation adjustment range of an MVOA is 2 dB to 30 dB. Figure 3-53 shows the appearance of a common MVOA. Figure 3-53 Appearance of an MVOA
3.8 Quick Reference Table of the Units Quick reference tables include those for specifications of optical transponder units, optical amplifier units and other boards, and also the functions of OTUs, tributary boards and line boards.
3.8.1 Specification of OTUs, Tributary Boards, Line Boards The main specifications of the optical transponder units (OTUs), tributary boards, and line boards include the access service type, optical module specifications and optical module type.
3.8.1.1 OTUs and Tributary Boards Specification on the Client Side The main client-side specifications of the optical transponder unit (OTU) and tributary boards include the access service type, optical module specifications and optical module type. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
111
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-73 Quick reference table for client-side specifications of OTUs and Tributary Boards Board Name
TN11ECOM
TN11L4G
TN11LDGD
Access Service Type
FE
GE
GE
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
100 BASEFX-10 km
-3
-11.5
-19
-3
100 BASEFX-40 km
0
-4.5
-20
-3
100 BASEFX-80 km
5
-2
-22
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-9.5
-17
0
-2.5
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
112
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN11LDGS
TN12LDM
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
GE
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
113
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
TN11LDMD
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-9.5
-17
0
eSFP
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
-2.5
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
114
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
eSFP DWDM
115
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN11LDMS
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
116
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
TN12LDX
TN11LEM24
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
OC-192/ STM-64/ 10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
XFP
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24.0
-7
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
–16
0
XFP DWDM
10GE LAN
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
XFP
FE/GE
1000 BASESX-0.5 km (I-850-LC)
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
eSFP
1000 BASELX-10 km (I-1310-LC)
-3
-9.5
-20
-3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
117
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
TN11LOA
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
10 Gbit/s BASE-SR-0.3 km (SFP+)
-1
-7.3
-11.1
-1
10 Gbit/s BASE-LR-10 km (SFP+)
0.5
-8.2
-12.6
0.5
10 Gbit/s BASE-SR-0.3 km (SFP+)
-1
-7.3
-11.1
-1
10 Gbit/s BASE-LR-10 km (SFP+)
0.5
-8.2
-12.6
0.5
FC200/GE/ FC100/FDDI/ FICON/ FICON Express/FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
FC400/ FICON4G
FC400/ FICON4G Module-0.3 km (Multi mode)
-1
-9
-14
0
FC400/ FICON4G Module-10 km (Single mode)
-2
-8
-18
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
10GE WAN/ 10GE LAN
TN11LEX4
3 Quick View of Product
10GE WAN/ 10GE LAN
GE/FC100/ STM-4/ OC-12/ ESCON/ STM-1/OC-3/ FDDI/FICON/ FE/DVB-ASI OTU1/ STM-16/ OC-48/FC200/
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
SFP+
SFP+
eSFP
118
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
SDI/HD-SDI/ 3G-SDI
270 Mbit/s to 3 Gbit/s multirate (Video eSFP)-10 km
0
-7
-16
0
GE/FC100/ STM-4/ OC-12/ ESCON/ STM-1/OC-3/ FDDI/FICON/ FE/DVB-ASI
5 1.25 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ OC-48/FC200/ FC100/FDDI/ FICON/ FICON Express/GE/ STM-4/ OC-12/ ESCON/ STM-1/OC-3/ DVB-ASI/FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
FC100/FDDI/ FICON/ FICON Express/GE/ STM-4/ OC-12/ ESCON/ STM-1/OC-3/ DVB-ASI/FE
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
119
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
OTU1/ STM-16/ OC-48/FC200/ FC100/FDDI/ FICON/ FICON Express/GE/ STM-4/ OC-12/ ESCON/ STM-1/OC-3/ DVB-ASI/FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
FC800/ FICON8G
1600-M5E-SNI-0.3 km (SFP +)
-1
-7.3
-11.1
-3
SFP+
1600-M5E-SNI-0.3 km (SFP +)
-0.5
-8.2
-12.6
0.5
1000 BASEBX10-U
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX10-D
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX-U
3
-2
-23
-3
1000 BASEBX-D
3
-2
-23
-3
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
GE
TN11LOG
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
GE
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
eSFP
120
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
GE
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
5
-2
-23
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
1000 BASEBX10-U
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX10-D
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX-U
3
-2
-23
-3
1000 BASEBX-D
3
-2
-23
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
TN12LOG
3 Quick View of Product
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
121
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN11LOM
Access Service Type
GE
FC 100/ FC 200/ FC 400/ FICON/ FICON Express
GE/ FC 100/ FC 200
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
FC400/ FICON4G Module-0.3 km (Multimode)
-1
-9
-14
0
FC400/ FICON4G Module-10 km (Single mode)
-2
-8
-18
0
FC100/FC200/ FICON/FICON Express Module-0.5 km (Multimode)
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
FC100/FC200/ FICON/FICON Express Module-2 km (Single mode)
-3
-10
-18
0
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
122
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN12LOM
Access Service Type
GE
FC 100/ FC 200/ FC 400/ FICON/ FICON Express
GE/ FC 100/ FC 200
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
FC400/ FICON4G Module-0.3 km (Multimode)
-1
-9
-14
0
FC400/ FICON4G Module-10 km (Single mode)
-2
-8
-18
0
FC100/FC200/ FICON/FICON Express Module-0.5 km (Multimode)
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
FC100/FC200/ FICON/FICON Express Module-2 km (Single mode)
-3
-10
-18
0
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
123
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
TN13LQM
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
1000 BASEBX10-U
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX10-D
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX-U
3
-2
-23
-3
1000 BASEBX-D
3
-2
-23
-3
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
GE
TN11LQG
3 Quick View of Product
GE
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
124
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
TN11LQMD
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
eSFP
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
125
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
OTU1b/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
TN12LQMD
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
OTU1b/ STM-16/ FC200/
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
126
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
TN11LQMS
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
eSFP
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
127
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
OTU1b/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
TN12LQMS
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
OTU1b/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
128
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
3
-2
-28
-9
STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
L-16.2-80 km
FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
TN11LSQ
STM-256/ OC-768/ OTU3
40G Transponder
3
0
-6
3
-
TN11LSX
OC-192/ STM-64/ 10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ OTU2/ FC1200a
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
XFP
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
TN12LSX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
129
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24.0
-7
10GE LAN/ FC1200a
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
OC-192/ STM-64/ 10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ OTU2/ OTU2e/ FC1200
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24.0
-7
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
–16
0
XFP DWDM
10GE LAN/ FC1200
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
XFP
TN11LSXL
STM-256/ OC-768
40G Transponder
3
0
-6
3
-
TN12LSXL/ TN15LSXL
STM-256/ OC-768/ OTU3
40G Transponder
3
0
-6
3
-
TN13LSX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
XFP
130
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN11LTX
TN11LWX2
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24.0
-7
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
0
-19
-3
10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
XFP
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
131
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
TN11LWXD
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
eSFP
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
132
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
TN11LWXS TN12LWXS
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
eSFP
ETR/ CLOc/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
ETR/ CLO/ GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
ETR/ CLO/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
133
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
TN11TMX TN12TMX
TN11TBE
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
ETR/ CLO/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
STM-16/ OC-48/ OTU1 (without FEC)
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
eSFP
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP CWDM
2.67 Gbit/s 4 Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
100 BASEFX-10 km
-3
-11.5
-19
-3
eSFP
100 BASEFX-80 km
5
-2
-22
-3
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
FE
GE/ 10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
134
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
FE/ GE/ 10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN
TN11TDG
GE
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
0
-19
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
XFP
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
135
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
TN11TDX TN12TDX TN52TDX
TN53TDX
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24.0
-7
10GE LAN
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192/ OTU2/ OTU2e/ FC800/ FC1200
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (Multirat e)/0.5 (10GE LAN)
10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192/ OTU2/ OTU2e/ FC1200
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192/ OTU2/ OTU2ed
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
XFP
XFP
136
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN54TEM28
Access Service Type
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
10GE LAN/ FC1200
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
XFP
10GE LAN
10 Gbit/s BASE-SR-0.3 km (SFP+)
-1
-7.3
-11.1
-1
SFP+
10 Gbit/s BASE-LR-10 km (SFP+)
0.5
-8.2
-12.6
0.5
1000 BASESX-0.5 km (I-850-LC)
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km (I-1310-LC)
-3
-9.5
-20
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ OC-48/FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ OC-12/ ESCON/ STM-1/OC-3/ DVB-ASI/FE
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
GE/FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10km (I-1310-LC)
-3
-9.5
-20
-3
GE
1000 BASEBX10-U
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX10-D
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX-U
3
-2
-23
-3
GE/ FE/
TN54THA
3 Quick View of Product
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
SFP+
eSFP
137
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN54TOA
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
1000 BASEBX-D
3
-2
-23
-3
FC400/ FICON4G Module (Multimode)
-1
-9
-14
0
FC400/ FICON4G Module (Single mode)
-2
-8
-18
0
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
FC200/FC100/ FE/GE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
0
-19
-3
FC400/ FICON4G
OTU1/ STM-16/ OC-48/FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ OC-12/ ESCON/ STM-1/OC-3/ DVB-ASI/FE
GE/FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/FE/ DVB-ASI
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
138
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
TN52TOG
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/FC100/ GE/STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/DVBASI/FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/FC100/ GE/STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/DVBASI/FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
SDI/HD-SDI
270 Mbit/s to 3 Gbit/s multirate (Video eSFP)-10 km
0
-7
-16
0
Video eSFP
GE
1000 BASEBX10-U
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
eSFP
1000 BASEBX10-D
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX-U
3
-2
-23
-3
1000 BASEBX-D
3
-2
-23
-3
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
GE
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
139
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
5
-2
-23
-3
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
0
-19
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
TN11TOM
3 Quick View of Product
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
140
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
TN52TOM
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
SDI
1.5 Gbit/s Multirate (Video eSFP)-20 km
0
-7
-22
0
eSFP
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
141
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
3
-2
-28
-9
STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
L-16.2-80 km
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
SDI
1.5 Gbit/s Multirate (Video eSFP)-20 km
0
-7
-22
0
eSFP
GE
1000 BASEBX10-U
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
eSFP
1000 BASEBX10-D
-3
-9
-19.5
-3
1000 BASEBX-U
3
-2
-23
-3
1000 BASEBX-D
3
-2
-23
-3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
142
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN11TQM
Access Service Type
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
OTU1b/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
TN12TQM
3 Quick View of Product
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
FC200/GE/ FC100/ FE
2.125 Gbit/s Multirate-0.5 km
-2.5
-9.5
-17
0
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/
1000 BASELX-10 km
-3
-9
-19
-3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP
eSFP CWDM
eSFP
143
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
OTU1b/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
TN11TQS
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
1000 BASELX-40 km
0
-5
-20
-3
1000 BASEZX-80 km
5
-2
-23
-3
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
GE/ FC100/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ FE/ DVB-ASI
1.25 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
0
-19
-3
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
5 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
OTU1/ STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
4 2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
STM-16/ OC-48/ OTU1
I-16-2 km
-3
-10
-18
-3
eSFP
S-16.1-15 km
0
-5
-18
0
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
eSFP CWDM
144
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN11TQX TN52TQX
TN53TQX
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
L-16.1-40 km
3
-2
-27
-9
L-16.2-80 km
3
-2
-28
-9
2.67 Gbit/s 5 Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP CWDM
2.67 Gbit/s 4 Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWDM
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
XFP
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24.0
-7
10GE LAN
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192/ OTU2/ OTU2e/ FC800/ FC1200
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192/ OTU2/ OTU2ee
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
XFP
145
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Maximu m (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
10GE LAN /FC1200
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192/ OTU2/ OTU2e/ FC800/ FC1200
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11 (multirate )/-12.6 (10GE LAN)
-1 (STM64 )/0.5 (10GE LAN)
0GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192/ OTU2/ OTU2e/ FC1200
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-4.7
-14 (multirate )/-15.8 (10GE LAN)
-1
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
10GE LAN /FC1200
10 Gbit/s Single Rate -0.3 km
-1.3
-7.3
-7.5
-1
TN11TSXL
STM-256/ OC-768
40G Transponder
3
0
-6
3
-
TN53TSXL
STM-256/ OC-768/OTU3
40G Transponder
3
0
-6
3
-
10GE LAN/ 10GE WAN/ STM-64/ OC-192/ OTU2/ OTU2e/ FC1200
TN55TQX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
XFP
146
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Note Mean Launched Optical Power
Maximu m (dBm)
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minim um Overloa d Point (dBm)
Minim um (dBm)
a: Only TN12LSX/TN13LSX supports FC1200 service. b: Only TN12LQMD/TN12LQMS/TN12TQM support OTU1 service. c: Only TN12LWXS supports ETR/CLO services. d: Only TN52TDX supports OTU2/OTU2e services. e: Only TN52TQX supports OTU2/OTU2e services.
Table 3-74 Quick reference table for client-side specifications of TN12LSC/TN54TSXL Board Name
TN12LSC
TN54TSXL
Access Service Type
Optical Module Optical Interfac e Type Suppor ted
Tra nsm it OM A per Lan e (Mi n)
Tra ns mit OM A per Lan e (Ma x)
Rev eive r Sen siti vity (O MA ) per Lan e
Min imu m recei ver over load (OM A) per Lan e
Ave rag e Lau nch Po wer per Lan e (Mi n)
Ave rag e Lau nch Po wer per Lan e (Ma x)
Ave rag e Rev eive r Po wer per Lan e (Mi n)
Ave rag e Rev eive r Po wer per Lan e (Ma x)
Tot al Ave rag e Lau nch Po wer
100GE
100 G BASELR4-10 km
-1.3
4.5
-8.6
4.5
-4.3
4.5
-10. 6
4.5
10.5
100 G BASE-1 0×10 G-10 km
-2.8
3.5
-8.8
3.5
-5.8
3.5
-10. 8
3.5
13.5
40GBA SELR4-10 km
-4
3.5
-11. 5
3.5
-7
2.3
-13. 7
2.3
8.3
40GE
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Opt ical Mo dul e Typ e
CFP
147
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.8.1.2 OTUs and Line Boards Specification on the WDM Side The main WDM-side specifications of the optical transponder units (OTUs) and line boards include the access service type, optical module specifications and optical module type. Table 3-75 Quick reference table for DWDM-side specifications of OTU boards and line boards Board Name
TN11L4 G
TN11LD GD
TN11LD GS
Access Service Type
OTU 5G
STM-16/ OTU1
STM-16/ OTU1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
3400 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-APD
2
-2
-25
-9
-
3400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-25
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZPIN
-4
-8
-18
0
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPD
-4
-8
-28
-9
-
6500 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
0
-5
-18
0
-
3200 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-APD
0
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
0
-5
-28
-9
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
0
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZPIN
-1
-5
-18
0
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPD
-1
-5
-28
-9
-
6500 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
3
-2
-18
0
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
148
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
3200 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-APD
3
-2
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
3
-2
-28
-9
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
3
-2
-28
-9
-
TN12LD M
OTU1
2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
3
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWD M
TN11LD MD
OTU1
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPD
-4
-8
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
0
-5
-28
-9
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
0
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPD
-1
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
3
-2
-28
-9
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
3
-2
-28
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
TN11LD MS
TN12LD X
OTU1
OTU2/ OTU2e
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
149
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN11LE M24
TN11LE X4
TN11LO A
TN11LO G
Access Service Type
OTU2
OTU2
OTU2
OTU2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
150
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN12LO G
TN11LO M
Access Service Type
OTU2
OTU2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
4800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
4800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
151
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN12LO M
TN11LQ G
Access Service Type
OTU2
FEC 5G/ OTU5G
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
3400 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-APD
2
-2
-25
-9
-
3400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-25
-9
-
TN13LQ M
OTU1
2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP DWDM)-120 km
3
0
-28
-9
eSFP DWD M
TN11LQ MD
OTU1
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZPIN
-4
-8
-18
0
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPD
-4
-8
-28
-9
-
6500 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
0
-5
-18
0
-
3200 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-APD
0
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
0
-5
-28
-9
-
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
152
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN12LQ MD
TN11LQ MS
TN12LQ MS
Access Service Type
OTU1
OTU1
OTU1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
0
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPD
-4
-8
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
0
-5
-28
-9
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
0
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZPIN
-1
-5
-18
0
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPD
-1
-5
-28
-9
-
6500 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
3
-2
-18
0
-
3200 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-APD
3
-2
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
3
-2
-28
-9
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
3
-2
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPD
-1
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
3
-2
-28
-9
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
153
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
3
-2
-28
-9
-
TN12LS C
OTU4
40000ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthePDM-QPSK(HFEC)-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
TN11LS Q
OTU3
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
4800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
TN11LS X TN12LS X
TN13LS X
OTU2/ OTU2e
OTU2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
154
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN11LS XL
TN12LS XL
Access Service Type
OTU3
OTU3
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
TN15LS XL
OTU3
60000 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthePDM-BPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
TN11LS XLR
OTU3
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
TN12LS XLR
TN11LS XR
OTU3/ OTU3e
OTU2/ OTU2e
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
155
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
4800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
TN11LT X
OTU4
40000ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthePDM-QPSK(HFEC)-PIN
0
-15
-16
0
-
TN11L WX2
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZPINa
-1
-5
-18
0
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPDa
-1
-5
-28
9
-
6500 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
3
-2
-18
0
-
6500 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
3
-2
-26
-10
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
3
-2
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZPINa
-4
-8
-18
0
-
TN11L WXD
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
156
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE
TN11L WXS TN12L WXSb
TN11T MX
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ DVBASI/ FE/ ETR/ CLO
OTU2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPDa
-4
-8
-28
-9
-
6500 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
0
-5
-18
0
-
3200 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-APD
0
-5
-26
-10
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
0
-5
-28
-9
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
0
-5
-28
-9
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZPINa
-1
-5
-18
0
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandFixed Wavelength-NRZAPDa
-1
-5
-28
-9
-
6500 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
3
-2
-18
0
-
3200 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-APD
3
-2
-26
-10
-
12800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
3
-2
-28
-9
-
6400 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four Channels-Tunable)
3
-2
-28
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
157
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN12T MX
TN11N D2
TN12N D2
Access Service Type
OTU2
OTU2/ OTU2e
OTU2/ OTU2e
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
4800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelength)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
158
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN52N D2
TN53N D2
Access Service Type
OTU2/ OTU2e
OTU2/ OTU2e
TN51N Q2/ TN52N Q2/ TN53N Q2/ TN54N Q2
OTU2/ OTU2e
TN11NS 2
OTU2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
159
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN12NS 2
TN52NS 2
Access Service Type
OTU2/ OTU2e
OTU2/ OTU2e
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
4800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
1200 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
4800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
2
-3
-26
-9
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
2
-3
-16
0
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
160
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN53NS 2
TN11NS 3
TN52NS 3
TN54NS 3
TN55NS 3
Access Service Type
OTU2/ OTU2e
OTU3/ OTU3e
OTU3/ OTU3e
OTU3/ OTU3e
OTU3/ OTU3e
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Receiver Overloa d (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths)-Fixed Wavelength-NRZ-PINXFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN-XFP
2
-3
-16
0
XFP DWD M
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
60000ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthePDM-BPSK-PIN
0
-5
-16
0
-
a: The 12800 ps/nm-PIN and 12800ps/nm-APD modules do not support pilot tone modulation mode. b: Only TN12LWXS supports ETR/CLO services.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
161
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-76 Quick reference table for CWDM-side specifications of OTU boards Board Name
TN11E COM
Access Service Type
GE
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Overload Point (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
1.25 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-40 km
5
0
-19
-3
eSFP CWD M
2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
5
0
-28
-9
eSFP CWD M
TN11L DGD
STM-16/ OTU1
1600 ps/nm-CWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-0.5
-28
-9
-
TN11L DGS
STM-16/ OTU1
1600 ps/nm-CWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
5
2.5
-28
-9
-
TN12L DM
OTU1
2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
5
0
-28
-9
eSFP CWD M
TN11L QG
FEC 5G/ OTU5G
5 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-50 km
5
2
-18
0
eSFP CWD M
5 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-70 km
5
2
-28
-9
eSFP CWD M
TN13L QM
OTU1
2.67 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-80 km
5
0
-28
-9
eSFP CWD M
TN11L QMD
OTU1
1600 ps/nm-CWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-0.5
-28
-9
-
TN11L QMS
OTU1
1600 ps/nm-CWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
5
2.5
-28
-9
-
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
162
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Overload Point (dBm)
Note
TN11L WX2
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ SDI/ FE
1600 ps/nm-CWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
5
2.5
-28
-9
-
TN11L WXD
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ SDI/ FE
1600 ps/nm-CWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
2
-0.5
-28
-9
-
TN11L WXS
STM-16/ FC200/ FC100/ GE/ STM-4/ ESCON/ STM-1/ SDI/ FE/ ETR/ CLO
1600 ps/nm-CWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
5
2.5
-28
-9
-
TN12L WXSa
a: Only TN12LWXS supports ETR/CLO services.
Table 3-77 Quick reference table for specifications of WDM-side gray optical modules on OTU boards and line boards Board Name
TN11L EM24
Access Service Type
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Overloa d Point (dBm)
Note
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
163
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Overloa d Point (dBm)
Note
Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
XFP
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
XFP
TN11L OA
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
TN12L OG
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
XFP
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
XFP
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
XFP
TN53N D2
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
TN51N Q2
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km
4
0
-24
-7
XFP
TN52N Q2/ TN53N Q2/ TN54N Q2
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
TN53N S2
OTU2
10 Gbit/s Multirate-10 km
-1
-6
-11
-1
XFP
TN11L EX4
TN12T MX
TN12N D2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
164
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN54N S3
Access Service Type
3 Quick View of Product
Optical Module Optical Interface Type Supported
Mean Launched Optical Power Maximu m (dBm)
Minimu m (dBm)
Receiver Sensitivi ty (dBm)
Minimu m Overloa d Point (dBm)
Note
OTU2/ OTU2e
10 Gbit/s Multirate-40 km
2
-1
-14
-1
XFP
OTU3/ OTU3e
40G Transponder
3
0
-6
3
-
3.8.2 Specification of Optical Amplifying Unit The main specifications of the optical amplifier unit include the operating wavelength range, channel gain, nominal input power range, nominal output power range and maximum output power of a single wavelength. Table 3-78 Quick reference table for optical amplifier unit Board Name
OAU100
DAS1/ OAU101
OAU102
OAU103
OAU105
Channel Gain (dB)
16 to 25.5
20 to 31
20 to 31
24 to 36
23 to 34
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Nomin al Chann el Gain (dB)
Input Power Range per Channel (dBm)
Nominal singlewavelength input optical power (dBm)
40 channels
80 channels
40 channels
80 channels
16
-32 to -14
-32 to -17
-14
-17
22
-32 to -20
-32 to -23
-20
-23
25.5
-32 to -23.5
-32 to -27.5
-23.5
-26.5
20
-32 to -16
-32 to -19
-16
-19
26
-32 to -22
-32 to -25
-22
-25
31
-32 to -27
-32 to -30
-27
-30
20
-32 to -19
-32 to -22
-19
-22
26
-32 to -25
-32 to -28
-25
-28
31
-32 to -30
-32
-30
-32
24
-32 to -20
-32 to -23
-20
-23
29
-32 to -25
-32 to -28
-25
-28
36
-32
-32
-32
-32
23
-32 to -16
-32 to -19
-16
-19
30
-32 to -23
-32 to -26
-23
-26
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
165
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Channel Gain (dB)
OAU106
16 to 23
3 Quick View of Product
Nomin al Chann el Gain (dB)
Input Power Range per Channel (dBm)
Nominal singlewavelength input optical power (dBm)
40 channels
80 channels
40 channels
80 channels
34
-32 to -27
-32 to -30
-27
-30
16
-24 to -12
-24 to -15
-12
-15
19
-24 to -15
-24 to -18
-15
-18
23
-24 to -19
-24 to -22
-19
-22
OBU101
20±1.5
20
-32 to -20
-32 to -23
-20
-23
OBU103
23±1.5
23
-32 to -19
-32 to -22
-19
-22
OBU104
17±1.5
17
-32 to -17
-32 to -20
-17
-20
OBU205
23±1.5
23
-24 to -16
-24 to -19
-16
-19
Table 3-79 Quick reference table for TN12OBU1P1 Board Name
Total input power range at the VI optical port(dBm)
Maximum total output optical power(dBm)
TN12OBU1P1
-30 to 7
9
Table 3-80 Quick reference table for CRPC Board Name
Channel Gain (dB)
Maximum Pump Power (dBm)
G.652 fiber
LEAF fiber
CRPC01
≥10
≥12
29
CRPC03
>10
N/A
29.5
Table 3-81 Quick reference table for HBA Board Name
HBA
Channel Gain (dB)
29±1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Typical Input Power of a Single Wavelength (dBm) 80 channels
40 channels
10 channels
Nominal Input Power Range (dBm)
-22
-19
-13
-25 to -3
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Channel Allocation (nm)
1529 to 1561
166
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-82 Quick reference table for RAU1 Board Name
RAU1
Gain range (dB) G.652 fiber
LEAF/G.653/TWRS/TW-C fiber
19 to 33
19 to 35
Max. OUT port optical power (dBm) 20
3.8.3 Insertion Loss Specifications of Boards This section provides the insertion loss specifications of boards. Table 3-83 Quick reference table for board insertion loss specifications Board Name
Insertion Loss (dB)
TN11MR2/TN21MR2
IN-MO
≤1.0
MI-OUT
TN11MR4/TN21MR4
Add/drop channel
≤1.5
IN-MO
≤1.5
MI-OUT
TN11MR8
Add/drop channel
≤2.2
IN-MO
≤3.5
MI-OUT
TN11MR8V
Add/drop channel
≤4
IN-MO
≤3
MI-OUT
TN21CMR1
TN11CMR2/TN21CMR2
Add/drop channel
≤4.5
IN-MO MI-OUT
≤0.8
Add/drop channel
≤1
IN-MO
≤1.0
MI-OUT
TN11CMR4/TN21CMR4
Add/drop channel
≤1.5
IN-MO
≤1.0
MI-OUT Add/drop channel
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
≤2
167
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Insertion Loss (dB)
TN11DMR1/ TN21DMR1
EIN-EMO
3 Quick View of Product
≤0.8
EMI-EOUT WIN-WMO WMI-WOUT Add/drop channel
≤1
TN11SBM2
Add/drop channel
≤3
TN11D40/TN12D40
≤6.5
TN11D40V
≤8a
TN21DFIU
EIN-ETM
≤1.5
ERM-EOUT WIN-WTM WRM-WOUT EIN-ETC
≤1
ERC-EOUT WIN-WTC WRC-WOUT TN11FIU/TN12FIU/ TN13FIU/TN14FIU/ TN21FIU
IN-TM
≤1.5
RM-OUT IN-TC
≤1
RC-OUT TN11SFIU
LINE1-SYS1
≤1.0
LINE2-SYS2 LINE1-OSC1
≤1.5
LINE1-OSC2 TN11ITL01
RE-OUT
<4.5
RO-OUT IN-TE
<2.5
IN-TO TN11ITL04
RE-OUT
<3
RO-OUT IN-TE
<3
IN-TO
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
168
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Insertion Loss (dB)
TN12ITL
RE-OUT
3 Quick View of Product
<4.5
RO-OUT IN-TE
<3.5
IN-TO TN11M40/TN12M40
≤6.5
TN11M40V/TN12M40V
≤8a
TN11DCP
Transmit-end insertion loss
Single mode ≤4
Receive-end insertion loss
Single mode ≤1.5
Multimode ≤4.5
Multimode ≤2 TN12DCP
TN11OLP
Transmit-end insertion loss
Single mode ≤4
Receive-end insertion loss
Single mode ≤1.5
Transmit-end insertion loss
Single mode ≤4
Receive-end insertion loss
Single mode ≤1.5
Multimode ≤4.5
Multimode ≤2 TN12OLP
TN11SCS
TN11RDU9
TN11RMU9
TN11ROAM
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Transmit-end insertion loss
Single mode
≤4
Receive-end insertion loss
Multimode
≤1.5
Wavelength dropping insertion loss
Single mode
≤4
Multimode
≤4.5
Wavelength adding insertion loss
Single mode
≤4
Multimode
≤4.5
IN-Drop(DM1-DM8)
≤12.5
ROA-Drop(DM1-DM8)
≤11.5
IN-EXPO
≤12.5
IN-TOA
≤1
EXPI-OUT
≤8.5
AMxb-TOA
≤12.5a
ROA-OUT
≤1.5
Mxc-OUT
≤9a
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
169
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Insertion Loss (dB) IN-DM
≤7
EXPI-OUT
≤14a
IN-EXPO
≤3
TN11WSD9/ TN12WSD9/TN13WSD9
IN-DMxd
≤8a
TN11WSM9/ TN12WSM9/ TN13WSM9
AMxb-OUT
TN11WSMD2
AMxb-OUT
≤8a
IN-DMxd
≤4.5
TN11WSMD4/ TN12WSMD4
AMxb-OUT
≤8a
TN11WSMD9
AMxb/EXPI-OUT
≤8a
IN-DMxd/EXPO
≤12
IN-EXPO ≤8a
EXPI-OUT
IN-DMxd
a: The value tested when the VOA attenuation is set to 0 dB. b: AMx denotes AM1-AM8. c: Mx denotes M1-M40. d: DMx denotes DM1-DM8. e: DMx denotes DM1-DM20. f: AMx denotes AM1-AM20.
3.8.4 MON Interface Optical Split Ratio Certain boards of WDM equipment provide MON interfaces. A small number of supervisory signals are split from the main-path signals and are output through MON for in-service performance monitoring of the optical signals. Table 3-84 lists the ratio of the optical power of signals at MON to that of the main-path signals of each type of board. Table 3-84 Ratio of the optical power of signals at MON to that of the main-path signals of each type of board Board Name
Ratio of MON Interface to Received Signal in Main Path
Ratio of MON Interface to Transmitting Signal in Main Path
CRPC
-
"MON"/"SYS" = 1/99 (20 dB)
D40
"MON"/"IN" = 10/90 (10 dB)
-
D40V
"MON"/"IN" = 10/90 (10 dB)
-
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
170
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Ratio of MON Interface to Received Signal in Main Path
Ratio of MON Interface to Transmitting Signal in Main Path
DAS1
"MONR"/"SOUT" = 1/99 (20 dB)
"MONT"/"LOUT" = 1/99 (20 dB)
FIU
-
"MON"/"OUT" = 1/99 (20 dB)
HBA
-
"MON"/"OUT" = 1/999 (30 dB)
ITL
-
"MON"/"OUT" = 10/90 (10 dB)
M40
-
"MON"/"OUT" = 10/90 (10 dB)
M40V
-
"MON"/"OUT" = 10/90 (10 dB)
OAU1
-
"MON"/"OUT" = 1/99 (20 dB)
OBU1
-
"MON"/"OUT" = 1/99 (20 dB)
OBU2
-
"MON"/"OUT" = 1/99 (20 dB)
RDU9
"MONI"/"EXPI" = 3/97 (15 dB)
"MONO"/"EXPO" = 3/97 (15 dB)
RMU9
"MONI"/"EXPI" = 3/97 (15 dB)
"MONO"/"TOA" = 3/97 (15 dB)
WSD9
"MONI"/"IN" = 3/97 (15 dB)
"MONO"/"EXPO" = 3/97 (15 dB)
WSM9
"MONI"/"EXPI" = 3/97 (15 dB)
"MONO"/"OUT" = 3/97 (15 dB)
WSMD2
"MONI"/"IN" = 3/97 (15 dB)
"MONO"/"OUT" = 3/97 (15 dB)
WSMD4
"MONI"/"IN" = 3/97 (15 dB)
"MONO"/"OUT" = 3/97 (15 dB)
WSMD9
"MONI"/"IN" = 3/97 (15 dB)
"MONO"/"OUT" = 3/97 (15 dB)
RAU1
-
"MONO"/"OUT"=1/99(20dB) "MONS"/"SYS"=1/99(20dB)
3.8.5 Basic Functions of OTUs, Tributary Boards, and Line Boards The main functions and features supported by OTUs, Tributary Boards, Line Boards, and Packet Service Boards are wavelength conversion, cross-connection at the electrical layer, OTN interfaces and ESC. For detailed functions and features, refer to Table 3-85.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
171
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-85 Basic functions of OTUs, Tributary Boards, and Line Boards Boards Board Name
Tun abl e Wa vele ngt h Fun ctio n
ESC Fun ctio n
ALS Fun ctio n
OT N Func tion
FEC Encoding
Opti cal Mo dule
PRB S on the Clie nt Side
PRB S on the WD M Side
FEC
AFE C
AFE C-2
HFE C
DW DM
CW DM
TN11EC OM
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
eSFP
N
N
TN11L4 G
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
N
N
TN11LD GD
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
N
N
TN11LD GS
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
N
N
TN11LD M
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
Y
Y
TN11LD MD
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
Y
Y
TN11LD MS
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
Y
Y
TN12LD X
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
XFP
Y
Y
TN11LE M24
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
XFP/ SFP +
N
Y
TN11LE X4
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
XFP/ SFP +
N
Y
TN11LO A
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
Y
eSFP /SFP +
Y
Y
TN11LO G
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
N
Y
TN12LO G
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
eSFP
N
Y
TN11LO M
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
N
Y
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
WDM Specificatio n
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
172
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Tun abl e Wa vele ngt h Fun ctio n
ESC Fun ctio n
ALS Fun ctio n
OT N Func tion
FEC Encoding
WDM Specificatio n
Opti cal Mo dule
PRB S on the Clie nt Side
PRB S on the WD M Side
FEC
AFE C
AFE C-2
HFE C
DW DM
CW DM
TN12LO M
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
eSFP
N
Y
TN11LQ G
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
N
Y
TN13LQ M
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
Y
Y
TN11LQ MD
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
N
Y
TN12LQ MD
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
Y
Y
TN11LQ MS
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
N
Y
TN12LQ MS
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
Y
Y
TN12LS C
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
CFP
N
Y
TN11LS Q
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
TN11LS X
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
XFP
Y
Y
TN13LS X
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
XFP
Y
Y
TN11LS XL
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
TN12LS XL
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
TN15LS XL
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
TN12LS X
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
173
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Tun abl e Wa vele ngt h Fun ctio n
ESC Fun ctio n
ALS Fun ctio n
OT N Func tion
FEC Encoding
Opti cal Mo dule
PRB S on the Clie nt Side
PRB S on the WD M Side
FEC
AFE C
AFE C-2
HFE C
DW DM
CW DM
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
TN11LS XR
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
XFP
N
N
TN11LT X
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
XFP
Y
Y
TN11L WX2
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
N
N
TN11L WXD
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
N
N
TN11L WXS
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
N
N
TN11T MX
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
eSFP
Y
Y
TN12T MX
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
eSFP
Y
Y
TN11N D2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
-
Y
TN12N D2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
XFP
-
Y
TN52N D2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
-
Y
TN53N D2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
XFP
-
Y
TN51N Q2
N
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
XFP
-
Y
TN52N Q2
N
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
XFP
-
Y
TN11LS XLR
WDM Specificatio n
TN12LS XLR
TN12L WXS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
174
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Tun abl e Wa vele ngt h Fun ctio n
ESC Fun ctio n
ALS Fun ctio n
OT N Func tion
FEC Encoding
WDM Specificatio n
Opti cal Mo dule
PRB S on the Clie nt Side
PRB S on the WD M Side
FEC
AFE C
AFE C-2
HFE C
DW DM
CW DM
TN53N Q2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
XFP
-
Y
TN54N Q2
N
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
XFP
-
Y
TN11NS 2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
-
Y
TN52NS 2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
-
Y
TN53NS 2
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
XFP
-
Y
TN11NS 3
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
-
Y
TN54NS 3
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
-
Y
TN55NS 3
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
-
Y
TN11TB E
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
eSFP XFP
N
-
TN11TD G
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
eSFP
N
-
TN11TD X
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
XFP
Y
-
TN52TD X
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
XFP
Y
-
TN53TD X
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
XFP
Y
-
TN12NS 2
TN52NS 3
TN12TD X
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
175
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Tun abl e Wa vele ngt h Fun ctio n
ESC Fun ctio n
ALS Fun ctio n
OT N Func tion
FEC Encoding
WDM Specificatio n
Opti cal Mo dule
PRB S on the Clie nt Side
PRB S on the WD M Side
FEC
AFE C
AFE C-2
HFE C
DW DM
CW DM
TN54TE M28
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
eSFP /SFP +
N
N
TN54TH A
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
eSFP
Y
-
TN54TO A
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
eSFP
Y
-
TN11TO M
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
eSFP
Y
Y
TN11TQ M
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
eSFP
N
-
TN12TQ M
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
eSFP
Y
-
TN11TQ S
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
eSFP
N
-
TN11TQ X
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
XFP
Y
-
TN52TQ X
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
XFP
Y
-
TN53TQ X
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
XFP
Y
-
TN55TQ X
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
XFP
Y
-
TN11TS XL
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
-
TN53TS XL
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
-
TN54TS XL
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
CFP
N
-
TN52TO M
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
176
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
TN52TO G
3 Quick View of Product
Tun abl e Wa vele ngt h Fun ctio n
ESC Fun ctio n
ALS Fun ctio n
OT N Func tion
FEC Encoding
WDM Specificatio n
FEC
AFE C
AFE C-2
HFE C
DW DM
CW DM
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Opti cal Mo dule
PRB S on the Clie nt Side
PRB S on the WD M Side
eSFP
N
-
NOTE l "Y" indicates that the OTU supports the function. "N" indicates that the OTU does not support the function l The SCC board can automatically detect that the eSFP and XFP modules are installed and online. The following information about the modules can be obtained through a query on the U2000: VendorName, BarCode, and type of optical interface. l The boards using different FEC codes cannot interconnect with each other.
3.8.6 Loopback Function of OTUs, Tributary Boards, and Line Boards The OTUs, Tributary Boards, and Line Boards support different types of loopback. Table 3-86 Loopback function of OTUs, Tributary Boards, and Line Boards Board Name
Client-Side Inloop
Client-Side Outloop
WDM-Side Inloop
WDM-Side Outloop
Channel loopback
ECOM
Y
Y
Y
N
N
LDGD
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LDGS
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LDM
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LDMD
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LDMS
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LDX
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LOA
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
LOG
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LOM
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LQG
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LQM
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
177
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Client-Side Inloop
Client-Side Outloop
WDM-Side Inloop
WDM-Side Outloop
Channel loopback
LQMD
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LQMS
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LSQ
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LSC
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LSX
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
TN11LSXL
N
N
Y
Y
N
TN12LSXL/ TN15LSXL
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LSXLR
N
N
N
N
N
LSXR
N
N
N
N
N
LTX
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LWX2
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LWXD
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
LWXS
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
TMX
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
ND2
N
N
Y
Y
Y
NQ2
N
N
Y
Y
Y
NS2
N
N
Y
Y
Y
NS3
N
N
Y
Y
Y
TDG
Y
Y
N
N
N
TDX
Y
Y
N
N
N
TEM28
Y
Y
N
N
N
THA
Y
Y
N
N
Y
TOA
Y
Y
N
N
Y
TOG
Y
Y
N
N
N
TN11TOM
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
TN52TOM
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
TQM
Y
Y
N
N
N
TQS
Y
Y
N
N
N
TQX
Y
Y
N
N
N
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
178
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Client-Side Inloop
Client-Side Outloop
WDM-Side Inloop
WDM-Side Outloop
Channel loopback
TSXL
Y
Y
N
N
N
NOTE "Y" indicates that the OTU supports the function. "N" indicates that the OTU does not support the function.
Table 3-87 Loop function of the Ethernet boards Board Name
Interface
Loop Mode
L4G
Client side
MAC inloop PHY outloop
WDM side
Inloop Outloop
TBE
10GE optical interface
MAC inloop MAC outloop PHY inloop PHY outloop
GE optical interface
MAC inloop PHY inloop
GE electric interface
MAC inloop PHY inloop PHY outloop
FE optical interface
MAC inloop PHY inloop
FE electric interface
MAC inloop PHY inloop PHY outloop
TEM28
10GE optical interface
MAC inloop MAC outloop PHY inloop PHY outloop
GE optical interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
MAC inloop
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
179
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Interface
3 Quick View of Product
Loop Mode PHY inloop
GE electric interface
PHY inloop PHY outloop MAC inloop
FE electric interface
PHY inloop PHY outloop MAC inloop
LEM24
10GE optical interface
MAC inloop MAC outloop PHY inloop PHY outloop
GE optical interface
MAC inloop PHY inloop
GE electric interface
MAC inloop PHY inloop PHY outloop
FE optical interface
MAC inloop PHY inloop
FE electric interface
MAC inloop PHY inloop PHY outloop
WDM side
Inloop Outloop
LEX4
10GE optical interface
MAC inloop MAC outloop PHY inloop PHY outloop
WDM side optical interface
Inloop Outloop
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
180
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.8.7 Protection mode of OTUs, Tributary Boards and Line Boards The OTUs, tributary boards, and line boards support protection function. For detailed protection mode, refer to Table 3-88. Table 3-88 Protection mode of OTUs, tributary boards and line boards Board Name
Protection Mode SW SNC P
VLA N SNC P
OD Uk SNC P
Clie ntSide 1+1 Prote ction
IntraBoard 1+1 Protec tion
OWS P Prote ction
OD Uk SPRi ng Prot ectio n
Bo ard Le vel Pro tect ion
DB PS
DL AG
MS SNCP
Tribut ary SNCP
ECOM
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
L4G
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
LDGD
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LDGS
Y
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
LDM
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
LDMD
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LDMS
N
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
LDX
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
LEM24
N
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
LEX4
N
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
LOA
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
LOG
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
LOM
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
LQG
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
LQM
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
LQMD
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
LQMS
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
LSC
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LSQ
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
LSX
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
181
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Protection Mode SW SNC P
VLA N SNC P
OD Uk SNC P
Clie ntSide 1+1 Prote ction
IntraBoard 1+1 Protec tion
OWS P Prote ction
OD Uk SPRi ng Prot ectio n
Bo ard Le vel Pro tect ion
DB PS
DL AG
MS SNCP
Tribut ary SNCP
LSXL
N
N
N
Y
Ya
Yb
N
N
N
N
N
N
LSXLR
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LSXR
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LTX
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LWX2
N
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
LWXD
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LWXS
N
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
TMX
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
ND2
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
NQ2
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
NS2
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
NS3
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
TBE
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
TDG
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
TDX
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
TEM28
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
THA
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
TOA
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
TOG
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
TOM
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
TQM
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
TQS
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
TQX
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
TSXL
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
182
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Protection Mode SW SNC P
VLA N SNC P
OD Uk SNC P
Clie ntSide 1+1 Prote ction
IntraBoard 1+1 Protec tion
OWS P Prote ction
OD Uk SPRi ng Prot ectio n
Bo ard Le vel Pro tect ion
DB PS
DL AG
MS SNCP
Tribut ary SNCP
NOTE a: The TN11LSXL does not support intra-board 1+1 protection. b: TN54TSXL only supports client-side 1+1 protection. NOTE "Y" indicates that the OTU supports the function. "N" indicates that the OTU does not support the function.
3.8.8 Electrical cross-connection of OTUs, Tributary Boards and Line Boards The OTUs, tributary boards, and line boards support electrical cross-connection. For detailed electrical cross-connection functions, refer to Table 3-89, Table 3-90 and Table 3-91. Table 3-89 Electrical cross-connection of OTUs, tributary boards and line boards in OptiX OSN 8800 Board Name
Electrical Cross-Connection
LDM
N
LDMD
N
LDMS
N
LDX
N
LEM24
N
LEX4
N
LOA
N
LOG
N
LOM
N
LQM
N
LQMD
N
LQMS
N
LSC
N
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
183
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Electrical Cross-Connection
LSQ
N
LSX
N
LSXL
N
LSXLR
N
LSXR
N
LTX
N
LWXS
N
TMX
N
ND2
16 x ODU0/8 x ODU1/4 x ODUflex/2 x ODU2/2 x ODU2e NOTE Only the TN53ND2 supports ODUflex.
NQ2
32 x ODU0/16 x ODU1/8 x ODUflex//4 x ODU2/4 x ODU2e NOTE Only the TN53NQ2 supports ODUflex.
NS2
8 x ODU0/4 x ODU1/2 x ODUflex/1 x ODU2/1 x ODU2e NOTE Only the TN53NS2 supports ODUflex.
NS3
32 x ODU0/16 x ODU1/4 x ODU2/4 x ODU2e/1 x ODU3 NOTE Only the TN54NS3/TN55NS3 supports ODU3.
TDX
2 x ODU2/2 x ODU2e/2x ODUflex NOTE Only the TN53TDX supports ODUflex.
TEM28
16 x ODU0/8 x ODU1/2 x ODU2/5 x ODUflex
THA
32 x ODU0/16 x ODU1
TOA
16 x ODU0/8 x ODU1/5 x ODUflex
TOM
8 x ODU0/4 x ODU1
TQX
4 x ODU2/4 x ODU2e/4 x ODUflex NOTE Only the TN55TQX supports ODUflex.
TOG
8 x ODU0
TSXL
1 x ODU3 NOTE Only the TN53TSXL/TN54TSXL supports ODU3
"N" indicates that the OTU does not support the function.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
184
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-90 Electrical cross-connection of OTUs, tributary boards and line boards in OptiX OSN 6800 Board Name
Electrical Cross-Connection Integrated Cross-Connection
Distributed Cross-Connection
ECOM
1 x GE
1 x GE
L4G
4 x GE
4 x GE
LDGD
2 x GE
2 x GE
LDGS
2 x GE
2 x GE
LDM
N
N
LDMD
N
N
LDMS
N
N
LDX
N
N
LEM24
2 x 10GE
N
LEX4
2 x 10GE
N
LOA
N
N
LOG
8 x GE
8 x GE
LOM
N
N
LQG
4 x GE
4 x GE
LQM
4 x GE
4 x Any/ 4 x GE/1 x OTU1
LQMD
4 x GE
4 x Any/ 4 x GE/1 x OTU1
LQMS
4 x GE/1 x ODU1
4 x Any/ 4 x GE/1 x OTU1
LSC
N
N
LSQ
N
N
LSX
N
N
LSXL
N
N
LSXLR
N
N
LSXR
N
N
LTX
N
N
LWX2
N
N
LWXD
N
x
LWXS
N
N
TMX
N
N
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
185
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
3 Quick View of Product
Electrical Cross-Connection Integrated Cross-Connection
Distributed Cross-Connection
ND2
8 x ODU1/2 x ODU2/2 x ODU2e
N
NQ2
16 x ODU1/4 x ODU2/4 x ODU2e
N
NS2
4 x ODU1/1 x ODU2/1 x ODU2e
4 x ODU1 NOTE It is supported by TN11NS2.
NS3
4 x ODU2/4 x ODU2e
N
TBE
16 x GE
N
TDG
2 x GE/1 x ODU1
2 x GE/1 x ODU1
TDX
8 x ODU1/2 x ODU2/2 x ODU2e
8 x ODU1
TOG
4 x ODU1
4 x ODU1/
TN11TOM
8 x GE/4 x ODU1
8 x GE/1 x OTU1/8 x Any/4 x ODU1
TN52TOM
4 x ODU1
8 x GE/1 x OTU1/8 x Any
TQM
4 x GE/1 x ODU1
4 x GE/4 x Any/1 x ODU1/1 x OTU1
TQS
4 x ODU1
4 x ODU1
TQX
4 x ODU2/4 x ODU2e
N
TSXL
4 x ODU2/4 x ODU2e
N
NOTE Only the TN11TSXL supports ODU2/ ODU2e
"N" indicates that the OTU does not support the function.
Table 3-91 Electrical cross-connection of OTUs, tributary boards and line boards in OptiX OSN 3800 Board Name
Electrical Cross-Connection
ECOM
1 x GE
L4G
4 x GE
LDGD
2 x GE
LDGS
2 x GE
LDM
N
LDMD
N
LDMS
N
LDX
N
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
186
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board Name
Electrical Cross-Connection
LOA
N
LOG
8 x GE
LOM
N
LQG
4 x GE
LQM
4 x Any/4 x GE
LQMD
4 x Any/4 x GE
LQMS
4 x Any/4 x GE
LSX
N
LSXR
N
LWX2
N
LWXD
N
LWXS
N
TMX
N
NS2
4 x ODU1
TBE
16 x GE
TDG
2 x GE/1 x ODU1
TDX
8 x ODU1
TOG
4 x ODU1
TOM
8 x GE/8 x Any/4 x ODU1
TQM
4 x Any/1 x ODU1
TQS
4 x ODU1
"N" indicates that the OTU does not support the function.
3.9 Power Consumption, Weight, and Valid Slots of Boards This chapter describes the power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the boards.
3.9.1 Power Consumption, Weight and Slots of Boards in the OptiX OSN 8800 This chapter describes the power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the boards used in the OptiX OSN 8800
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
187
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
The power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the boards for the OptiX OSN 8800 system are shown in Table 3-92. The values listed in the following table indicate the power consumption of the boards when they normally work at 25°C and 55°C. The power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the cross-connect boards for the OptiX OSN 8800 system are shown in Table 3-93. Table 3-92 Power consumption, weight and valid slots of the OptiX OSN 8800 boards Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN16AT E
-
0.2
0.3
0.5/1.1
1
IU24
-
-
TN51AT E
-
0.3
0.3
0.2/0.4
1
-
IU48
IU87
TN16AU X
-
16.5
19.2
0.6/1.32
2
IU21
-
-
TN51AU X
-
17.5
19.0
0.4/0.88
1
-
IU41
IU72, IU83
TN11CM R2
-
0.2
0.3
0.8/1.8
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11CM R4
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11CR PC01
-
110.0
121.0
4.0/8.8
-
Installed outside
Installed outside
Installed outside
TN11CR PC03
-
70.0
77.0
4.2/9.2
-
Installed outside
Installed outside
Installed outside
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
188
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11D40
-
10.0
13.0
2.2/4.8
3
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16
IU1-IU6, IU11IU17, IU20IU25, IU29IU34
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16, IU19IU24, IU27IU32, IU35IU40, IU45IU50, IU53IU58, IU61IU66
TN12D40
-
10.0
13.0
2.0/4.4
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU11IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
189
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11D40 V
-
38.5
42.3
2.3/5.1
3
-
IU1-IU6, IU11IU17, IU20IU25, IU29IU34
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16, IU19IU24, IU27IU32, IU35IU40, IU45IU50, IU53IU58, IU61IU66
TN11DA S1
-
22
28.6
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11DC P
-
6.8
7.5
1.0/2.2
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12DC P
-
6.8
7.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11DC U
-
0.2
0.3
1.5/3.3
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11DM R1
-
0.2
0.3
0.7/1.5
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
190
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN16EFI
-
2.0
2.5
0.5/1.1
1
IU19
-
-
TN51EFI 1
-
5.0
7.0
0.2/0.4
1
-
IU38
IU76
TN51EFI 2
-
13.0
15.0
0.3/0.7
1
-
IU37
IU71
TN54EN Q2
-
40.0
44.0
0.9/2.0
1
IU1, IU5, IU11, IU15
IU1, IU5, IU12, IU16, IU20, IU24, IU29, IU33
IU1, IU5, IU11, IU15, IU19, IU23, IU27, IU31, IU35, IU39, IU45, IU49, IU53, IU57, IU61, IU65
TN12FIU
-
4.2
4.6
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN13FIU
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN14FIU
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11GF U
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
191
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11HB A
-
47.0
75.0
3/6.6
3
IU2-IU7, IU12IU17
IU2-IU7, IU12IU18, IU21IU26, IU30IU35
IU2-IU7, IU12IU17, IU20IU25, IU28IU33, IU36IU41, IU46IU51, IU54IU59, IU62IU67
TN11HS C1
-
8
8.8
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11ITL
-
0.2
0.3
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12ITL
-
10
11.5
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12LD M
-
22.6
24.8
1.1/2.4
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11LD MD
-
26.9
29.6
1.2/2.6
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
192
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11LD MS
-
26.9
29.6
1.1/2.4
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12LD X
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
44.5
51.2
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
45.5
52.2
-
81.0
83.0
1.0/2.2
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
TN11LE M24
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
193
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11LE X4
-
64.0
67.0
0.7/1.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11LO A
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
31.8
36
1.19/2.64
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
32.8
37
10Gbit/s Multirate - 10km
31.8
36
10Gbit/s Multirate - 40km
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
194
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11LO G
800 ps/ nm-C Band (odd & even waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN 800 ps/ nm-C BandFixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN
40.0
45.0
1.6/3.5
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN 1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZAPD
43.0
48.0
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
43.5
48.5
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
195
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN12LO G
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
4800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBAPD
55.0
60.5
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
37.0
41.44
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
38.0
42.44
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN
41.61
46.6
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
43.04
48.0
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
196
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
10Gbit/s Multirate - 10km
37.0
41.44
800 ps/ nm-C Band (odd & even waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN 800 ps/ nm-C BandFixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN
92.7
101.7
1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN 1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZAPD
92.9
101.9
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
2.3/5.1
2
-
IU1-IU7, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU36IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
10Gbit/s Multirate - 40km 10Gbit/s Multirate - 80km TN11LO M
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
197
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN12LO Ma
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
93.4
102.7
4800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBAPD
98.2
108.0
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
61.8
69.2
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
62.8
70.2
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN
64.8
72.6
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
198
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
66.7
75.0
TN13LQ M
-
32.6
TN12LQ MD
-
TN12LQ MS
TN12LS C
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
35.9
1.1/2.4
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
31.1
34.3
1.4/3.1
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
-
29.0
32.3
1.3/2.9
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
-
240
265
5/11
4
IU1-IU5, IU11IU15
IU1-IU5, IU12IU16, IU20IU24, IU29IU33
IU1-IU5, IU11IU15, IU19IU23, IU27IU31, IU35IU39, IU45IU49, IU53IU57, IU61IU65
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
199
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11LS Q
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBPIN
75
82
2.5/5.5
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng thDQPSKPIN
82
89
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
800 ps/ nm-C Band (odd & even waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN 800 ps/ nm-C BandFixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN
30.5
36.6
1.4/3.1
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12LS X
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
200
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN13LS X
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN 1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZAPD
30.7
36.8
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
32.5
39
4800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBAPD
35.5
42.6
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN
29.4
32.8
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
29.5
33.9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
201
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN12LS XL
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
27.0
30.4
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
28.0
31.4
500 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBPIN
74.0
81.0
500 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng thDQPSKPIN
84.0
94.0
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
4.1/9.0
3
-
IU3-IU8, IU14IU19, IU22IU27, IU31IU36
IU3-IU8, IU13IU18, IU21IU26, IU29IU34, IU38IU42, IU47IU52, IU55IU60, IU63IU68
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
202
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN15LS XL
60000ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ePDMBPSKPIN
140
155
3.8/8.4
3
IU2-IU7, IU12IU17
IU2-IU7, IU13IU18, IU21IU26, IU30IU35
IU2-IU7, IU12IU17, IU20IU25, IU28IU33, IU36IU41, IU46IU51, IU54IU59, IU62IU67
TN12LS XLR
500 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng thDQPSKPIN
75.0
79.0
2.5/5.5
2
-
IU2-IU8, IU13IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
500 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBPIN
67.0
70.0
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
203
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11LS XR
800 ps/ nm-C Band (odd & even waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN 800 ps/ nm-C BandFixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN
34.8
37.8
1.2/2.6
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN 1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZAPD
35.0
38.0
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
36.8
39.8
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
204
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
4800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBAPD
39.8
42.8
TN11LT X(OTU mode)
-
248
273
TN11LT X (regenerat ion mode)
-
235
247
TN12LW XS
-
33.9
TN11M4 0
-
10.0
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
5.8/12.8
4
IU2-IU6, IU12IU16
IU2-IU6, IU13IU17, IU21IU25, IU30IU34
IU2-IU6, IU12IU16, IU20IU24, IU28IU32, IU36IU40, IU46IU50, IU54IU58, IU62IU66
37.3
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
13.0
2.2/4.8
3
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16
IU1-IU6, IU11IU17, IU20IU25, IU29IU34
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16, IU19IU24, IU27IU32, IU35IU40, IU45IU50, IU53IU58, IU61IU66
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
205
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN12M4 0
-
10.0
13.0
2.0/4.4
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU11IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
TN11M4 0V
-
20.0
25.0
2.3/5.1
3
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16
IU1-IU6, IU11IU17, IU20IU25, IU29IU34
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16, IU19IU24, IU27IU32, IU35IU40, IU45IU50, IU53IU58, IU61IU66
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
206
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN12M4 0V
-
16.0
26.0
2.3/5.1
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU11IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
TN11MC A4
-
8.0
8.5
1.9/4.2
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU11IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
207
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11MC A8
-
12.0
13.0
1.9/4.2
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU11IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
TN11MR 2
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11MR 4
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11MR 8
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
2
-
IU1-IU7, IU11IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
208
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11MR 8V
-
7.7
8.6
1.0/2.2
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
TN52ND 2
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
67.8
74.6
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN
70.5
77.5
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
25
28
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN53ND 2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
209
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
3 Quick View of Product
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
134.0
147.0
1.9/4.2
2
IU3, IU7, IU13, IU17
IU3, IU7, IU14, IU18, IU22, IU26, IU31, IU35
IU3, IU7, IU13, IU17, IU21, IU25, IU29, IU33, IU37, IU41, IU47, IU51, IU55, IU59, IU63, IU67
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP 10Gbit/s Multirate - 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate - 40km TN54NP O2
-
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
210
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN55NP O2
-
143.0
157.3
1.7/3.6
2
IU3, IU7, IU13, IU17
IU3, IU7, IU14, IU18, IU22, IU26, IU31, IU35
IU3, IU7, IU13, IU17, IU21, IU25, IU29, IU33, IU37, IU41, IU47, IU51, IU55, IU59, IU63, IU67
TN55NP O2E
-
143.0
157.3
1.7/3.6
2
IU3, IU7, IU13, IU17
IU3, IU7, IU14, IU18, IU22, IU26, IU31, IU35
IU3, IU7, IU13, IU17, IU21, IU25, IU29, IU33, IU37, IU41, IU47, IU51, IU55, IU59, IU63, IU67
TN52NQ 2
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
88.0
97.0
2.0/4.4
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
211
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
3 Quick View of Product
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
46.5
50
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
10Gbit/s Multirate - 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate - 40km 800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP TN53NQ 2
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP 10Gbit/s Multirate - 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate - 40km 800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
212
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN54NQ 2
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
53
58.3
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN
46.5
51.1
1.3/2.86
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
49.1
51.7
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP 10Gbit/s Multirate - 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate - 40km TN52NS 2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
213
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN53NS 2
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
20
24
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
21
25
10Gbit/s Multirate - 10km
20
24
500 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng thDQPSKPIN
118.0
130.0
2.4/5.2
2
-
IU2-IU8, IU13IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
500 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBPIN
110.0
118.0
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
10Gbit/s Multirate - 40km TN52NS 3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
214
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN54NS 3
TN55NS 3
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng thDQPSKPIN
118.0
130.0
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng thDQPSKPIN
73.0
80.0
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBPIN
60.0
65.0
40G Transpon der
62.0
69.0
60000ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ePDMBPSKPIN
135
150
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
1.8/3.96
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
2.6/5.73
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU13IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
215
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11OA U101
-
18.0
24.0
1.8/4.0
2
-
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
TN11OA U102
-
14.0
18.0
1.8/4.0
2
-
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
216
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11OA U103
-
18.0
24.0
1.8/4.0
2
-
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
TN11OA U105
-
22.0
29.0
1.8/4.0
2
-
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
217
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN12OA U100
-
11.0
14.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
TN12OA U101
-
12.0
15.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
218
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN12OA U102
-
10.0
13.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
TN12OA U103
-
12.0
15.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
219
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN12OA U105
-
15.0
21.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
TN13OA U101
-
12.0
15.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN13OA U103
-
12.0
15.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN13OA U105
-
15.0
21.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN13OA U106
-
12.0
15.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11OB U101
-
11.0
13.0
1.3/2.9
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
220
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11OB U103
-
13.0
15.0
1.3/2.9
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11OB U104
-
12.0
14.0
1.3/2.9
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12OB U101
-
10.0
11.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12OB U1P1
-
10.0
11.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12OB U103
-
11.0
12.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12OB U104
-
10.0
12.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
221
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11OB U205
-
17.0
24.0
1.9/4.2
2
-
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
TN12OB U205
-
14.0
19.0
1.6/3.5
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
TN11OL P
-
6.0
6.6
0.9/2.0
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12OL P
-
4.0
4.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
222
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11OP M8
-
12.0
15.0
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN16PIU
-
3.0
3.6
0.65/1.43
1
IU20, IU23
IU39, IU40, IU45, IU46
IU69, IU70, IU78, IU79, IU80, IU81, IU88, IU89
TN51PIU
-
1.8
1.8
0.5/1.1
1
-
IU39, IU40, IU45, IU46
IU69IU70, IU78IU81, IU88IU89
TN11RA U1
-
55
70
2.5/5.51
2
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18
IU2-IU8, IU12IU19, IU21IU27, IU30IU36
IU2-IU8, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU28IU34, IU36IU42, IU46IU52, IU54IU60, IU62IU68
TN11RD U9
-
6
6.6
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
223
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11RM U901
-
7.7
8.6
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11RM U902
-
8.2
9.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11RO AM
-
66.0
72.6
3.2/7.0
3
-
IU1-IU6, IU11IU17, IU20IU25, IU29IU34
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16, IU19IU24, IU27IU32, IU35IU40, IU45IU50, IU53IU58, IU61IU66
TN12SC1
-
11.0
14.9
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12SC2
-
13.5
14.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN16SC C
-
32
35
1.3/2.8
1
IU9, IU10
-
-
TN51SC C
-
18.0
20.0
1.2/2.6
1
-
IU11, IU28
-
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
224
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN52SC C
-
23.0
25.1
1.0/2.2
1
-
IU11, IU28
-
TNK2SC C
-
26.7
29.3
0.9/2.0
1
-
-
IU74, IU85
TN11SC S
-
0.2
0.3
0.8/1.8
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11SFI U
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11ST2
-
17.5
19.5
0.95/2.09
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN52ST G
-
13.0
14.1
0.5/1.1
1
-
IU42, IU44
-
TNK2ST G
-
14.0
16.0
0.5/1.1
1
-
-
IU75, IU86
TN52STI
-
1.5
1.5
0.3/0.7
1
-
IU47
IU82
TN11TD C
-
13.0
15.0
0.5/1.1
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN52TD X
-
57.3
63.0
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
225
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN53TD X
-
25
35.0
1.5/3.3
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN54TE M28
-
110
120
2.5
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
TN54TH A
-
35.0
40.0
1.5/3.3
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
226
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11TM X
800 ps/ nm-C Band (odd & even waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN 800 ps/ nm-C BandFixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN
40.3
44.3
1.4/3.1
1
-
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN 1200 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZAPD
42.1
46.4
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
44.5
51.2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
227
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN12TM X
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
4800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-ODBAPD
48.4
55.7
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
32.4
37.1
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-(D) RZ-PIN
41.0
45.5
800 ps/ nm-C BandTunable Waveleng th-NRZPIN
39.0
43.7
800 ps/ nm-C Band (Odd & Even Waveleng ths)Fixed Waveleng th-NRZPIN-XFP
31.4
36.1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
1.2/2.7
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
228
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
10Gbit/s Multirate - 10km
31.4
36.1
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
10Gbit/s Multirate - 40km 10Gbit/s Multirate - 80km TN54TO A
-
23.0
25.0
0.7/1.6
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN52TO G
-
41.8
46.0
0.85/1.87
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN52TO M
-
81.0
89.1
1.5/3.3
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN52TQ X
-
91.5
100.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN53TQ X
-
45.0
50.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN55TQ X
-
45.0
50.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
229
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN53TS XL
-
75.0
83.0
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN54TS XL
-
58
64
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12VA 1
-
6.5
7.2
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12VA 4
-
8.5
9.4
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN11W MU
-
12.0
15.0
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU11IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
TN12WS D9
-
25.4
28.5
2.7/6.0
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
230
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN13WS D9
-
25.4
28.5
2.9/6.4
3
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16
IU1-IU6, IU12IU17, IU20IU25, IU29IU34
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16, IU19IU24, IU27IU32, IU35IU40, IU45IU50, IU53IU58, IU61IU66
TN12WS M9
-
25.4
28.5
2.7/6.0
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
231
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN13WS M9
-
25.4
28.5
2.9/6.4
3
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16
IU1-IU6, IU12IU17, IU20IU25, IU29IU34
IU1-IU6, IU11IU16, IU19IU24, IU27IU32, IU35IU40, IU45IU50, IU53IU58, IU61IU66
TN11WS MD2
-
17.0
18.7
3.2/7.0
2
-
IU1-IU7, IU121IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
232
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11WS MD4
-
17.0
18.7
3.2/7.0
2
-
IU1-IU7, IU121IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
TN12WS MD4
-
12.0
15.0
2.6/5.7
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU12IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU35IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
233
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN11WS MD9
-
25
30
3.1/6.8
2
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17
IU1-IU7, IU121IU18, IU20IU26, IU29IU35
IU1-IU7, IU11IU17, IU19IU25, IU27IU33, IU36IU41, IU45IU51, IU53IU59, IU61IU67
N3EAS2
-
78
91
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
-
N1EGSH
-
89.3
98.2
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
N4SF64
-
27.3
29.3
0.7/1.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
N1SF64A
-
35.7
39.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
N4SFD64
-
38.2
42.0
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
234
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consum ption at 25°C (77° F)(W)
Maximu m Power Consum ption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Number of Occupie d Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
N4SL64
-
15.2
16.7
0.6/1.3
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
N4SLD6 4
-
20.3
22.1
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
N3SLH4 1
-
48.5
53.4
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
N4SLO1 6
-
21.5
23.7
0.8/1.8
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
N4SLQ1 6
-
12.8
13.9
0.7/1.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
IU1-IU8, IU11IU42, IU45IU68
N4SLQ6 4
-
37.2
40.9
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11IU18
IU1-IU8, IU12IU27, IU29IU36
-
a: When the FC extension function of the TN12LOM board is used, the power consumption of the board increases by another 2 W. (D)RZ modules include DRZ and RZ optical modules. Both module types have the same optical performance and can connect to modules of both the same type. This table lists all optical modules. Manufacture of some optical modules may be discontinued. A Product Change Notice (PCN) is released when manufacture of an optical module type is discontinued. For details about the availability of an optical module, contact the product manager of the local Huawei office.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
235
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-93 Power consumption, weight and valid slots of the OptiX OSN 8800 cross-connect boards Board
Power Consu mption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at Warm Backup (25°C, 77°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at Warm Backup (55°C, 131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Numbe r of Occupi ed Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TNK2S XH +TNK2 XCT
470-3.6 x (64-n)
517-3.6 x (64-n)
130
143
3.74 (7.9) +3.6 (7.9)
1+1
-
-
TNK2S XH : IU10, IU44 TNK2X CT : IU9, IU43
TNK2S XH +TNK4 XCT
318-2.5 x (64-n)
350-2.5 x (64-n)
113
124
3.74 (7.9) +2.9 (6.3)
1+1
-
-
TNK2S XH : IU10, IU44 TNK4X CT : IU9, IU43
TNK4S XH +TNK2 XCT
321-2.5 x (64-n)
353-2.5 x (64-n)
112
123
2.68 (5.9) +3.6 (7.9)
1+1
-
-
TNK4S XH : IU10, IU44 TNK2X CT : IU9, IU43
TNK4S XH +TNK4 XCT
169-1.2 x (64-n)
186-1.3 2 x (64n)
95
105
2.68 (5.9) +2.9 (6.3)
1+1
-
-
TNK4S XH : IU10, IU44 TNK4X CT : IU9, IU43
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
236
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Power Consu mption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at Warm Backup (25°C, 77°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at Warm Backup (55°C, 131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Numbe r of Occupi ed Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TNK2S XM +TNK4 XCT
378-2.5 x (64-n)
416-2.5 x (64-n)
173
190
3.74 (8.1) +2.9 (6.3)
1+1
-
-
TNK2S XM : IU10, IU44 TNK4X CT : IU9, IU43
TNK4S XM +TNK2 XCT
324-2.5 x (64-n)
356-2.5 x (64-n)
114
125
3.0(6.6) +3.6 (7.9)
1+1
-
-
TNK4S XM : IU10, IU44 TNK2X CT : IU9, IU43
TNK4S XM +TNK4 XCT
188-1.2 x (64-n)
207-1.3 2 x (64n)
97
107
3.0(6.6) +2.9 (6.3)
1+1
-
-
TNK4S XM : IU10, IU44 TNK4X CT : IU9, IU43
TN16X CH
73 - 1.4 x (16 - n)
88.8 1.4 x (16 - n)
40
48
1.8/4.0
1
IU9, IU10
-
-
TN52X CH01
243 - 3.6 x (32 - n)
267.3 3.6 x (32 - n)
65
72
3.4/7.5
1
-
IU9, IU10
-
TN52X CH02
101 1.12 x (32 - n)
111 1.12 x (32 - n)
43
47.3
3.4/7.5
1
-
IU9, IU10
-
TN52X CM01
339 - 3.6 x (32 - n) -80 x m
368 - 3.6 x (32 - n) -80 x m
125
138
3.8/8.4
1
-
IU9, IU10
-
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
237
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Power Consu mption at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at Warm Backup (25°C, 77°F) (W)
Power Consu mption at Warm Backup (55°C, 131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/lb.)
Numbe r of Occupi ed Slots
Valid Slots of 8800 T16
Valid Slots of 8800 T32
Valid Slots of 8800 T64
TN52X CM02
124 1.12 x (32 - n) -23 x m
136.4 1.12 x (32 - n) -23 x m
67
73.7
3.8/8.4
1
-
IU9, IU10
-
NOTE When the OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack grooms electrical-layer signals through the backplane, the XCT must be configured with SXM or SXH. "n" is equal to the total number of tributary, line, and PID boards housed in a subrack. l If a subrack is configured with VC-3 or VC-12 cross-connections, "m" is equal to 0. l If a subrack is not configured with any VC-3 or VC-12 cross-connections, "m" is equal to 1.
3.9.2 Power Consumption, Weight and Slots of Boards in the OptiX OSN 6800 This chapter describes the power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the boards used in the OptiX OSN 6800 system. The power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the boards for the OptiX OSN 6800 system are shown in Table 3-94. The values listed in the following table indicate the power consumption of the boards when they normally work at 25°C and 55°C. Table 3-94 Power consumption, weight and valid slots of the OptiX OSN 6800 boards Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11AUX
-
12.0
17.0
0.5/1.1
1
IU21
TN11BMD4
-
0.2
0.3
1.2/2.7
1
IU1-IU17
TN11BMD8
-
0.2
0.3
1.5/3.3
2
IU1-IU16
TN11CMR2
-
0.2
0.3
0.8/1.8
1
IU1-IU17
TN11CMR4
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU17
TN11CRPC0 1
-
110.0
121.0
4.0/8.8
-
-
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
238
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11CRPC0 3
-
70.0
77.0
4.2/9.2
-
-
TN11D40
-
10.0
13.0
2.2/4.8
3
IU1-IU15
TN12D40
-
10.0
13.0
2.0/4.4
2
IU1-IU16
TN11D40V
-
38.5
42.3
2.3/5.1
3
IU1-IU15
TN11DAS1
-
22
28.6
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11DCP/ TN12DCP
-
6.8
7.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11DCU
-
0.2
0.3
1.5/3.3
1
IU1-IU17
TN11DMR1
-
0.2
0.3
0.7/1.5
1
IU1-IU17
TN11ECOM
-
19.6
21.6
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN12ELQX
-
86.2
99.2
1.7/3.7
1
IU1, IU4, IU5, IU8, IU11, IU14
TN11FIU/ TN12FIU
-
4.2
4.6
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN13FIU
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN14FIU
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11SFIU
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11GFU
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU17
TN11HBA
-
47.0
75.0
3.0/6.6
3
IU2-IU16
TN11HSC1
-
8
8.8
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11ITL
-
0.2
0.3
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU17
TN12ITL
-
10
11.5
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU17
TN11L4G
3400 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
50.0
55.0
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
239
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN11LDGD
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
3400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
53.0
58.0
12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
34.0
37.4
38.0
41.8
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
6500 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 3200 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 1600 ps/nmCWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 12800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD 6400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four ChannelsTunable)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
240
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LDGS
12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
32.0
35.2
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
12800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD 6400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four ChannelsTunable)
36.0
39.6
TN12LDM
-
22.6
24.8
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
TN11LDMD
-
26.9
29.6
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU17
TN11LDMS
-
26.9
29.6
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
6500 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 3200 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 1600 ps/nmCWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
241
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN12LDX
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
44.5
51.2
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU17
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
45.5
52.2
TN11LEM24
-
81.0
83.0
1.0/2.2
2
IU1-IU7, IU11-IU15
TN11LEX4
-
64.0
67.0
0.7/1.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11LOA
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
31.8
36
1.19/2.64
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
32.8
37
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km
31.8
36
10Gbit/s Multirate 40km
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
242
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LOG
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
40.0
45.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
43.0
48.0
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZb-PIN
43.5
48.5
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
55.0
60.5
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
37.0
41.44
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN12LOG
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
243
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
38.0
42.44
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
41.61
46.6
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
43.04
48.0
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km
37.0
41.44
92.7
101.7
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
2.3/5.1
2
IU1-IU16
10Gbit/s Multirate 40km 10Gbit/s Multirate 80km TN11LOM
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
244
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN12LOMa
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
92.9
101.9
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
93.4
102.7
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
98.2
108.0
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
61.8
69.2
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
62.8
70.2
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
64.8
72.6
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
245
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN11LQG
TN13LQM
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
66.7
75.0
3400 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
28.4
32.0
3400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
31.0
34.4
5 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-50 km 5 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-70 km
23.18
26.0
-
32.6
35.9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.3/2.9
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
246
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LQMD
12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
57.1
65.7
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
61.1
67.2
31.1
35.0
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
6500 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 3200 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 1600 ps/nmCWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 12800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD 6400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four ChannelsTunable) TN12LQMD
-
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
247
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LQMS
12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
56.3
64.5
1.3/2.9
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
12800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD 6400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four ChannelsTunable)
60.4
66.4
-
29.0
32.3
1.3/2.9
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
6500 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 3200 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 1600 ps/nmCWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
TN12LQMS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
248
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LSX
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
47.7
50.1
1.3/2.9
1
IU1-IU17
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
47.9
50.9
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
49.7
52.7
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
52.7
55.7
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
30.5
36.6
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU17
TN12LSX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
249
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN13LSX
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
30.7
36.8
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
32.5
39
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
35.5
42.6
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
27.0
30.4
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
28.0
31.4
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
29.4
32.8
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
250
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
29.5
33.9
400 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
103.0
110.0
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
98.0
101.0
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
74.0
81.0
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
84.0
94.0
TN15LSXL
60000 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthePDMBPSK-PIN
140
TN11LSXLR
400 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN 500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
TN11LSXL
TN12LSXL
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
5.0/11.0
4
IU1-IU14
4.1/9.0
3
IU3-IU17
155
3.8/8.4
3
IU2-IU16
87.0
90.0
3.1/6.8
4
IU1-IU14
82.0
85.0
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
251
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LSQ
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
75
82
2.5/5.5
2
IU2-IU17
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
82
89
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
75
79
2.5/5.5
2
IU2-IU17
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
67.0
70.0
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
34.8
37.8
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU17
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
35.0
38
TN12LSXLR
TN11LSXR
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
252
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
36.8
39.8
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
39.8
42.8
248
273
TN11LTX (regeneration mode)
40000 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthePDM-QPSK (HFEC)-PIN
235
247
TN11LWX2
-
38.5
TN11LWXD
-
TN11LWXS/ TN12LWXS
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
5.8/12.8
4
IU2-IU15
42.4
1.3/2.9
1
IU1-IU17
35.8
39.4
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU17
-
33.9
37.3
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
TN11M40
-
10.0
13.0
2.2/4.8
3
IU1-IU15
TN12M40
-
10.0
13.0
2.0/4.4
2
IU1-IU16
TN11M40V
-
20.0
25.0
2.3/5.1
3
IU1-IU15
TN12M40V
-
16.0
26.0
2.3/5.1
2
IU1-IU16
TN11MCA4
-
8.0
8.5
1.9/4.2
2
IU1-IU16
TN11MCA8
-
12.0
13.0
1.9/4.2
2
IU1-IU16
TN11MR2
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU17
TN11MR4
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU17
TN11MR8
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
2
IU1-IU16
TN11MR8V
-
7.7
8.6
1.0/2.2
2
IU1-IU16
TN11LTX (OTU mode)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
253
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11ND2
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelength)Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
61.1
68.4
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
62.7
70.2
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
68.4
76.6
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
62.0
69.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
57.2
64.0
TN12ND2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
254
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
46.0
52.0
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
67.8
74.6
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
70.5
77.5
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
25
28
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate 40km 10 Gbit/s Multirate-80 km TN52ND2
TN53ND2
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
255
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
3 Quick View of Product
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
88.0
95.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
88.0
97.0
2.0/4.4
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate 40km TN51NQ2
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP 10Gbit/s Multirate 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate 40km 10Gbit/s Multirate 80km 800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
TN52NQ2
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
256
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
3 Quick View of Product
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
46.5
50
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate 40km 800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP TN53NQ2
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP 10Gbit/s Multirate 10km 10Gbit/s Multirate 40km 800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
257
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11NS2
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
38.0
41.8
1.2/2.64
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
39.0
42.9
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
41.0
45.1
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
44.0
48.4
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelength)Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
38.8
43.4
1.2/2.64
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN12NS2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
258
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN52NS2
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
39.4
44.1
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
39.7
44.46
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
42.5
47.6
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
30.32
34.0
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
25.35
28.39
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
46.5
51.1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.3/2.86
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
259
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN53NS2
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
49.1
51.7
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
20
24
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
21
25
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km
20
24
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
92
101.2
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
67.0
75.0
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
118.0
130.0
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
2.5/5.5
2
IU2-IU8, IU12-IU16
2.4/5.3
2
IU2-IU8, IU12-IU16
10Gbit/s Multirate 40km TN11NS3
TN52NS3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
260
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
500 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
110.0
118.0
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
118.0
130.0
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthDQPSK-PIN
73.0
80.0
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthODB-PIN
60.0
65.0
40G Transponder
62.0
69.0
TN55NS3
60000ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthePDMBPSK-PIN
135
TN11OAU10 1
-
TN11OAU10 2
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.8/3.96
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
150
2.6/5.73
2
IU2-IU8, IU12-IU16
18.0
24.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
-
14.0
18.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
TN11OAU10 3
-
18.0
24.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
TN11OAU10 5
-
22.0
29.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
TN12OAU10 0
-
11.0
14.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
TN54NS3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
261
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN12OAU10 1
-
12.0
15.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
TN12OAU10 2
-
10.0
13.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
TN12OAU10 3
-
12.0
15.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
TN12OAU10 5
-
15.0
21.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU2-IU17
TN13OAU10 1
-
12.0
15.0
1.6/3.6
1
IU1-IU17
TN13OAU10 3
-
12.0
15.0
1.6/3.6
1
IU1-IU17
TN13OAU10 5
-
15.0
21.0
1.6/3.6
1
IU1-IU17
TN13OAU10 6
-
12
15
1.6/3.6
1
IU1-IU17
TN11OBU10 1
-
11.0
13.0
1.3/2.9
1
IU1-IU17
TN11OBU10 3
-
13.0
15.0
1.3/2.9
1
IU1-IU17
TN11OBU10 4
-
12.0
14.0
1.3/2.9
1
IU1-IU17
TN12OBU10 1
-
10.0
11.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
TN12OBU10 3
-
11.0
12.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
TN12OBU10 4
-
10.0
12.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
TN12OBU1P 1
-
10.0
11.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
TN11OBU20 5
-
17.0
24.0
1.9/4.2
2
IU2-IU17
TN12OBU20 5
-
14.0
19.0
1.6/3.5
2
IU2-IU17
TN11OLP
-
6.0
6.6
0.9/2.0
1
IU1-IU17
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
262
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN12OLP
-
4.0
4.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11OPM8
-
12.0
15.0
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU17
TN11PIU
-
24.0
38.0
0.5/1.1
1
IU19, IU20
TN12PTQX
-
93.4
107.6
3/6.6
2
IU2-IU3, IU6-IU7, IU12-IU13
TN11RAU1
-
55
70
2.5/5.51
2
IU2-IU17
TN11RDU9
-
6
6.6
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
TN11RMU9 01
-
7.7
8.6
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU17
TN11RMU9 02
-
8.2
9.0
TN11ROAM
-
66.0
72.6
3.2/7.0
3
IU1-IU15
TN11SBM2
-
0.2
0.3
0.8/1.8
1
IU1-IU17
TN11SC1/ TN12SC1
-
11.0
14.9
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11SC2/ TN12SC2
-
13.5
14.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11ST2
-
17.5
19.5
0.95/2.09
1
IU1-IU8, IU11–IU16
TN11SCC
-
27.0
30.0
1.2/2.6
1
IU17, IU18
TN51SCC
-
18.0
20.0
1.2/2.6
1
IU17, IU18
TN52SCC
-
23.0
25.1
1.0/2.2
1
IU17, IU18
TN11SCS
-
0.2
0.3
0.8/1.8
1
IU1-IU17
TN11STG
-
8.7
9.57
1.1/2.4
1
IU15, IU16
TN11TBE
-
40.7
44.8
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11TDC
-
13.0
15.0
0.5/1.1
1
IU1-IU17
TN11TDG
-
30.0
33.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11TDX
-
78.0
80.0
1.3/2.8
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
263
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN12TDX
-
37.4
40.7
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN52TDX
-
57.3
63.0
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN53TDX
-
25
35.0
1.5/3.3
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11TMX
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
40.3
44.3
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU17
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
42.1
46.4
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
44.5
51.2
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
48.4
55.7
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
264
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN12TMX
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
31.4
36.1
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU17
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
32.4
37.1
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
41.0
45.5
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
39.0
43.7
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km
31.4
36.1
10Gbit/s Multirate 40km 10Gbit/s Multirate 80km TN52TOG
-
41.8
46.0
0.85/1.87
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11TOM
-
55.0
60.0
1.4/3.1
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN52TOM
-
81
89.1
1.5/3.3
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
265
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11TQM
-
50.3
57.6
1.2/2.6
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN12TQM
-
25.0
27.5
1.1/2.4
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11TQS
-
43.0
47.3
1.2/.6
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11TQX
-
65.0
71.2
1.5/3.3
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN52TQX
-
91.5
100.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN55TQX
-
45.0
50.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU1-IU8, IU11-IU16
TN11TSXL
-
90.2
96.0
2.5/5.5
2
IU2-IU8, IU12-IU16
TN11VA1/ TN12VA1
-
6.5
7.2
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11VA4/ TN12VA4
-
8.5
9.4
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11WMU
-
12.0
15.0
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11WSD9
-
17.0
18.7
2.2/4.8
2
IU1-IU16
TN12WSD9
-
25.4
28.5
2.7/5.94
2
IU1-IU16
TN13WSD9
-
25.4
28.5
2.9/6.38
3
IU1-IU15
TN11WSM9
-
17.0
18.7
2.2/4.8
2
IU1-IU16
TN12WSM9
-
25.4
28.5
2.7/5.94
2
IU1-IU16
TN13WSM9
-
25.4
28.5
2.9/6.38
3
IU1-IU15
TN11WSMD 2
-
17.0
18.7
3.2/7.0
2
IU1-IU16
TN11WSMD 4
-
17.0
18.7
3.2/7.0
2
IU1-IU16
TN12WSMD 4
-
12.0
15.0
2.6/5.7
2
IU1-IU16
TN11WSMD 9
-
25
30
3.1/6.8
2
IU1-IU16
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
266
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F)(W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11XCS
-
20.0
22.0
1.0/2.2
1
IU9, IU10
TN12XCS
-
25.0
27.5
1.2/2.6
1
IU9, IU10
a: When the FC extension function of the TN12LOM board is used, the power consumption of the board increases by another 2 W. b: (D)RZ modules include DRZ and RZ optical modules. Both module types have the same optical performance and can connect to modules of both the same type. This table lists all optical modules. Manufacture of some optical modules may be discontinued. A Product Change Notice (PCN) is released when manufacture of an optical module type is discontinued. For details about the availability of an optical module, contact the product manager of the local Huawei office.
3.9.3 Power Consumption, Weight and Slots of Boards in the OptiX OSN 3800 This chapter describes the power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the boards used in the OptiX OSN 3800 system. The power consumption, weight, and valid slots of the boards for the OptiX OSN 3800 system are shown in Table 3-95. The values listed in the following table indicate the power consumption of the boards when they normally work at 25°C and 55°C. Table 3-95 Power consumption, weight and valid slots of the OptiX OSN 3800 boards Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11DAS1
-
22
28.6
1.4/3.1
1
IU2-IU5
TN11ECOM
-
19.6
21.6
1.0/2.2
1
IU2-IU5
TN11HSC1
-
8
8.8
1.0/2.2
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
TN11L4G
3400 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
50.0
55.0
1.4/3.1
1
IU2-IU5
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
267
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN11LDGS
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
3400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
53.0
58.0
12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
32.0
35.2
36.0
39.6
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.2/2.6
1
IU2-IU5
6500 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 3200 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 1600 ps/nmCWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 12800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD 6400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four ChannelsTunable)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
268
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LDGD
12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
34.0
37.4
1.4/3.1
1
IU2-IU5
12800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD 6400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four ChannelsTunable)
38.0
41.8
TN12LDM
-
22.6
24.8
1.1/2.4
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
TN11LDMD
-
26.9
29.6
1.2/2.6
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
6500 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 3200 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 1600 ps/nmCWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
269
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LDMS
-
26.9
29.6
1.1/2.4
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
TN12LDX
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
44.5
51.2
1.6/3.5
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
45.5
52.2
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
31.8
36
1.19/2.64
1
IU2-IU5
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
32.8
37
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km
31.8
36
TN11LOA
10Gbit/s Multirate 40km
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
270
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LOG
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
40.0
45.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU2-IU5
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
43.0
48.0
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZb-PIN
43.5
48.5
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
55.0
60.5
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
37.0
41.44
1.1/2.4
1
IU2-IU5
TN12LOG
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
271
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
38.0
42.44
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
41.61
46.6
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
43.04
48
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km
37.0
41.44
92.7
101.7
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
2.3/5.1
2
IU3-IU5
10Gbit/s Multirate 40km 10Gbit/s Multirate 80km TN11LOM
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
272
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN12LOMa
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
92.9
101.9
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
93.4
102.7
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
98.2
108.0
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
61.8
69.2
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
62.8
70.2
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
64.8
72.6
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.1/2.4
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
273
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN11LQG
TN13LQM
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
66.7
75.0
3400 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
28.4
32.0
3400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
31.0
34.4
5 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-50 km 5 Gbit/s Multirate (eSFP CWDM)-70 km
23.18
26.0
-
32.6
35.9
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.3/2.9
1
IU2-IU5
1.1/2.4
1
IU2-IU5
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
274
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LQMS
12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
56.3
64.5
1.3/2.9
1
IU2-IU5
12800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD 6400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four ChannelsTunable)
60.4
66.4
-
29.0
33.3
1.3/2.9
1
IU2-IU5
6500 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 3200 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 1600 ps/nmCWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
TN12LQMS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
275
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LQMD
12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 12800 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
57.1
65.7
1.4/3.1
1
IU2-IU5
12800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD 6400 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD (Four ChannelsTunable)
61.1
67.2
-
31.1
34.3
1.4/3.1
1
IU2-IU5
6500 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 3200 ps/nmC BandFixed WavelengthNRZ-APD 1600 ps/nmCWDM Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-APD
TN12LQMD
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
276
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11LSX
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
47.7
50.1
1.4/3.1
1
IU11, IU2IU5
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
47.9
50.9
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
49.7
52.7
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
52.7
55.7
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
30.5
36.6
1.4/3.1
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN12LSX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
277
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN13LSX
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
30.7
36.8
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
32.5
39
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
35.5
42.6
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
27.0
30.4
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
28.0
31.4
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
29.4
32.8
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.1/2.4
1
IU11, IU2IU5
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
278
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
29.5
33.9
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
34.8
37.8
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
35.0
38
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
36.8
39.8
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
39.8
42.8
TN11LWXS/ TN12LWXS
-
33.9
TN11LWXD
-
TN11LWX2
-
TN11LSXR
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.2/2.6
1
IU11, IU2IU5
37.3
1.1/2.4
1
IU11, IU2IU5
35.8
39.4
1.2/2.6
1
IU11, IU2IU5
38.5
42.4
1.3/2.9
1
IU11, IU2IU5
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
279
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11TMX
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
40.3
44.3
1.4/3.1
1
IU11, IU2IU5
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
42.1
46.4
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
44.5
51.2
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
48.4
55.7
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
31.4
36.1
1.2/2.6
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN12TMX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
280
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
32.4
37.1
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
41.0
45.5
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
39.0
43.7
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km
31.4
36.1
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
10Gbit/s Multirate 40km 10Gbit/s Multirate 80km TN21DFIU
-
0.2
0.3
0.5/1.1
1
IU1, IU11, IU8
TN21FIU
-
0.2
0.3
0.5/1.1
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN13FIU
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
TN14FIU
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
TN11SFIU
-
0.2
0.3
1.0/2.2
1
IU1-IU17
TN11MR2
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU2-IU5
TN21MR2
-
0.2
0.3
0.5/1.1
1
IU1, IU11, IU8
TN11MR4
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU2-IU5
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
281
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN21MR4
-
0.2
0.3
0.5/1.1
1
IU1, IU11, IU8
TN21CMR1
-
0.2
0.3
0.5/1.1
1
IU1, IU11, IU8
TN11CMR2
-
0.2
0.3
0.8/1.8
1
IU2-IU5
TN21CMR2
-
0.2
0.3
0.5/1.1
1
IU1, IU11, IU8
TN11CMR4
-
0.2
0.3
0.9/2.0
1
IU2-IU5
TN21CMR4
-
0.2
0.3
0.5/1.1
1
IU1, IU11, IU8
TN11DMR1
-
0.2
0.3
0.7/1.5
1
IU2-IU5
TN21DMR1
-
0.2
0.3
0.7/1.5
1
IU1, IU11, IU8
TN11SBM2
-
0.2
0.3
0.8/1.8
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11TBE
-
40.7
44.8
1.4/3.1
1
IU2-IU5
TN11TDG
-
30
33
1.1/2.4
1
IU2-IU5
TN11TDX
-
78
80
1.3/2.9
1
IU2-IU5
TN52TOG
-
41.8
46.0
1.87 /0.85
1
IU2-IU5
TN11TOM
-
55.0
60.0
1.4/3.1
1
IU2-IU5
TN52TOM
-
81
89.1
1.5/3.3
1
IU2-IU5
TN11TQS
-
43.0
47.3
1.2/2.6
1
IU2-IU5
TN11TQM
-
50.3
57.6
1.2/2.6
1
IU2-IU5
TN12TQM
-
25.0
27.5
1.2/2.6
1
IU2-IU5
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
282
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN11NS2
800 ps/nm-C Band (odd & even wavelengths) -Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN 800 ps/nm-C Band-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
38.0
41.8
1.2/2.6
1
IU2-IU5
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
39.0
42.9
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
41.0
45.1
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
44.0
48.4
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelength)Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PIN
38.8
43.4
1.2/2.6
1
IU2-IU5
TN12NS2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
283
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN52NS2
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN 1200 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-APD
39.4
44.1
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
39.7
44.46
4800 ps/nmC BandTunable WavelengthODB-APD
42.5
47.6
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
30.32
34.0
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
25.35
28.39
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PIN
46.5
51.1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.3/2.9
1
IU2-IU5
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
284
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board
TN53NS2
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable Wavelength(D)RZ-PIN
49.1
51.7
800 ps/nm-C Band (Odd & Even Wavelengths )-Fixed WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
20
24
800 ps/nm-C BandTunable WavelengthNRZ-PINXFP
21
25
10Gbit/s Multirate 10km
20
24
3 Quick View of Product
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
1.0/2.2
1
IU2-IU5
10Gbit/s Multirate 40km TN11OAU10 1
-
18.0
24.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN11OAU10 2
-
14.0
18.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN11OAU10 3
-
18.0
24.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN11OAU10 5
-
22.0
29.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN12OAU10 0
-
11.0
14.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN12OAU10 1
-
12.0
15.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN12OAU10 2
-
10.0
13.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
285
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN12OAU10 3
-
12.0
15.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN12OAU10 5
-
15.0
21.0
1.8/4.0
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN13OAU10 1
-
12.0
15.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN13OAU10 3
-
12.0
15.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN13OAU10 5
-
15.0
21.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN13OAU10 6
-
12.0
15.0
1.6/3.5
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11OBU10 1
-
11.0
13.0
1.3/2.9
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11OBU10 3
-
13.0
15.0
1.3/2.9
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11OBU10 4
-
12.0
14.0
1.3/2.9
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN12OBU10 1
-
10.0
11.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN12OBU10 3
-
11.0
12.1
1.1/2.4
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN12OBU10 4
-
10.0
12.0
1.1/2.4
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11OBU20 5
-
17.0
24.0
1.9/4.2
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN12OBU20 5
-
14.0
19.0
1.6/3.5
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN11RAU1
-
55
70
2.5/5.51
2
IU11, IU2IU4
TN11SC1/ TN12SC1
-
11.0
14.9
1.0/2.2
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11SC2/ TN12SC2
-
13.5
14.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11ST2
-
17.5
19.5
0.95/2.09
1
IU2-IU5
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
286
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Board
Module Type
Typical Power Consumpti on at 25°C (77°F) (W)
Maximum Power Consumpti on at 55°C (131°F) (W)
Weight (kg/ lb.)
Number of Occupied Slots
Valid Slots
TN21SCC
-
14.0
16.0
0.5/1.1
1
IU8, IU9
TN22SCC
-
10.0
13.0
0.5/1.1
1
IU8, IU9
TN21AUX
-
11.7
13.0
0.6/1.3
1
IU10
TN22AUX
-
15.0
17.0
0.5/1.1
1
IU10
TN11DCP/ TN12DCP
-
6.8
7.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU11, IU2U5
TN11OLP
-
6.0
6.6
0.9/2.0
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN12OLP
-
4.0
4.5
1.0/2.2
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11OPM8
-
12.0
15.0
1.2/2.6
1
IU2-IU5, IU11
TN11SCS
-
0.2
0.3
0.8/1.8
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11VA1/ TN12VA1
-
6.5
7.2
1.0/2.2
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11VA4/ TN12VA4
-
8.5
9.4
1.0/2.2
1
IU11, IU2IU5
TN11MCA4
-
8.0
8.5
1.9/4.2
2
IU2-IU5
TN11MCA8
-
12.0
13.0
1.9/4.2
2
IU2-IU5
TN21PIU
-
10
12
0.5/1.1
1
IU6, IU7
TN21APIU
-
50
55
0.8/1.8
1.5
IU6, IU7, IU8
TN11DCU
-
0.2
0.3
1.5/3.3
1
IU11, IU2IU5
a: When the FC extension function of the TN12LOM board is used, the power consumption of the board increases by another 2 W. b: (D)RZ modules include DRZ and RZ optical modules. Both module types have the same optical performance and can connect to modules of both the same type. This table lists all optical modules. Manufacture of some optical modules may be discontinued. A Product Change Notice (PCN) is released when manufacture of an optical module type is discontinued. For details about the availability of an optical module, contact the product manager of the local Huawei office.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
287
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.10 Housekeeping Alarms Users can configure the severities for the eight alarm inputs to remotely monitor the alarms of an external system. The alarms can be sent to a centralized alarm management system for management. In addition, two housekeeping control interfaces are available for remotely controlling external equipment such as air conditioners, fans, and electric generators.
3.10.1 OptiX OSN 8800 Housekeeping Alarm Interfaces OptiX OSN 8800 provides alarm input and output interfaces. The alarm input interfaces are designed for remotely monitoring alarms of external systems, such as an environmental monitoring system. The alarm output interfaces are designed to output alarms to a centralized management system for management.
OptiX OSN 8800 T64/T32 The TN51ATE provides 8 alarm inputs and remote monitoring of alarm signals of the external systems, such as the environmental monitoring system. Users can configure the names and severity of the 8 alarm inputs so that the equipment can work with external systems to remotely monitor the external alarms. The alarm signals are forwarded to the EFI1 after the ATE processing is complete. The TN51ATE board provides eight alarm output interfaces, sending alarms to a centralized alarm management system. Figure 3-54 Interfaces in the TN51ATE ATE Alarm Input Interfaces ALMI1
ALMI2
ALMO1
ALMO3
Alarm Output Interfaces Pin No.
ALMO4
ALMO2
1 8
Table 3-96 Housekeeping alarm input/output interfaces
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Interf ace
PIN No.
Definit ion
Functio n
Interfa ce
PIN No.
Definitio n
Function
ALMI 1
1
SWITC HI_IN1
Alarm input 1
ALMO 1/ ALMO 2
1
CRIT_SW ITCH_OU TP
Outputs the critical alarm signal positive
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
288
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Interf ace
ALMI 2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
PIN No.
Definit ion
Functio n
2
GND
3
3 Quick View of Product
Interfa ce
PIN No.
Definitio n
Function
Ground
2
CRIT_SW ITCH_OU TN
Outputs the critical alarm signal negative
SWITC HI_IN2
Alarm input 2
3
MAJ_SWI TCH_OUT P
Outputs the major alarm signal positive
4
SWITC HI_IN3
Alarm input 3
4
MIN_SWI TCH_OUT P
Outputs the minor alarm signal positive
5
GND
Ground
5
MIN_SWI TCH_OUT N
Outputs the minor alarm signal negative
6
GND
Ground
6
MAJ_SWI TCH_OUT N
Outputs the major alarm signal negative
7
SWITC HI_IN4
Alarm input 4
7
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 1P
Reserved alarm signal output 1 positive
8
GND
Ground
8
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 1N
Reserved alarm signal output 1 negative
1
SWITC HI_IN5
Alarm input 5
1
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 2P
Reserved alarm signal output 2 positive
2
GND
Ground
2
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 2N
Reserved alarm signal output 2 negative
3
SWITC HI_IN6
Alarm input 6
3
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 3P
Reserved alarm signal output 3 positive
4
SWITC HI_IN7
Alarm input 7
4
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 4P
Reserved alarm signal output 4 positive
5
GND
Ground
5
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 4N
Reserved alarm signal output 4 negative
6
GND
Ground
6
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 3N
Reserved alarm signal output 3 negative
ALMO 3/ ALMO 4
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
289
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Interf ace
PIN No.
Definit ion
Functio n
7
SWITC HI_IN8
8
GND
3 Quick View of Product
Interfa ce
PIN No.
Definitio n
Function
Alarm input 8
7
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 5P
Reserved alarm signal output 5 positive
Ground
8
ALM_SWI TCH_OUT 5N
Reserved alarm signal output 5 negative
There are four alarm output interfaces: ALMO1, ALMO2, ALMO3, and ALMO4. Any of them can be used for alarm output or subrack cascading. Currently, only the ALMO1 and ALMO2 interfaces are available; the ALMO3 and ALMO4 interfaces are reserved for future use.
OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Housekeeping Alarm Input/Output Interfaces The TN16ATE provides 8 alarm inputs and remote monitoring of alarm signals of the external systems, such as the environmental monitoring system. Users can configure the names and severity of the 8 alarm inputs so that the equipment can work with external systems to remotely monitor the external alarms. The alarm signals are forwarded to the EFI after the ATE processing is complete. The TN16ATE board provides eight alarm output interfaces, sending alarms to a centralized alarm management system. Figure 3-55 Interfaces on the TN16ATE Board
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
290
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-97 Housekeeping alarm input/output interfaces Interf ace
PIN No.
Definit ion
Function
Interfa ce
PIN No.
Definitio n
Function
ALMI 1
1
SWITC HI_IN1
Alarm input 1
1
CRIT_SW ITCH_OU TP
Outputs the critical alarm signal positive
2
GND
Ground
ALMO 1/ ALMO 2
2
CRIT_SW ITCH_OU TN
Outputs the critical alarm signal negative
3
SWITC HI_IN2
Alarm input 2
3
MAJ_SWI TCH_OU TP
Outputs the major alarm signal positive
4
SWITC HI_IN3
Alarm input 3
4
MIN_SWI TCH_OU TP
Outputs the minor alarm signal positive
5
GND
Ground
5
MIN_SWI TCH_OU TN
Outputs the minor alarm signal negative
6
GND
Ground
6
MAJ_SWI TCH_OU TN
Outputs the major alarm signal negative
7
SWITC HI_IN4
Alarm input 4
7
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T1P
Reserved alarm signal output 1 positive
8
GND
Ground
8
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T1N
Reserved alarm signal output 1 negative
1
SWITC HI_IN5
Alarm input 5
1
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T2P
Reserved alarm signal output 2 positive
2
GND
Ground
2
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T2N
Reserved alarm signal output 2 negative
3
SWITC HI_IN6
Alarm input 6
3
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T3P
Reserved alarm signal output 3 positive
4
SWITC HI_IN7
Alarm input 7
4
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T4P
Reserved alarm signal output 4 positive
5
GND
Ground
5
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T4N
Reserved alarm signal output 4 negative
ALMI 2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
ALMO 3/ ALMO 4
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
291
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Interf ace
PIN No.
Definit ion
Function
6
GND
7
8
3 Quick View of Product
Interfa ce
PIN No.
Definitio n
Function
Ground
6
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T3N
Reserved alarm signal output 3 negative
SWITC HI_IN8
Alarm input 8
7
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T5P
Reserved alarm signal output 5 positive
GND
Ground
8
ALM_SW ITCH_OU T5N
Reserved alarm signal output 5 negative
There are four alarm output interfaces: ALMO1, ALMO2, ALMO3, and ALMO4. Any of them can be used for alarm output or subrack cascading. Currently, only the ALMO1 and ALMO2 interfaces are available; the ALMO3 and ALMO4 interfaces are reserved for future use.
3.10.2 OptiX OSN 6800 Housekeeping Alarm Interfaces OptiX OSN 6800 provides alarm input and output interfaces. The alarm input interfaces are designed for remotely monitoring alarms of external systems, such as an environmental monitoring system. The alarm output interfaces are designed to output alarms to a centralized management system for management.
Alarm Input/Output Interfaces The TN11EFI provides eight alarm inputs and remote monitoring of alarm signals of the external systems, such as the environmental monitoring system. Users can configure the names and severity of the 8 alarm inputs so that the equipment can work with external systems to remotely monitor the external alarms. The TN11EFI board provides eight alarm output interfaces, sending alarms to a centralized alarm management system. Defaults of the first three are critical alarm, major alarm, and minor alarm. The other five are reserved. Alarm outputs can be cascaded. Figure 3-56 Interfaces in the TN11EFI Alarm Output Interfaces
COM
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
ETH3
ALM01 ALM02 ALM03 ALM04
Alarm Input Interfaces
SERIAL
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
ALMI1 ALMI2 LAMP1 LAMP2
292
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-98 Alarm Input/Output Interfaces Inter face
PI N No .
Defin ition
Function
Inter face
PI N No.
Definiti on
Function
ALM I1
1
SWIT CHI_I N1
Alarm input 1
1
CRIT_S WITCH_ OUTP
Outputs the critical alarm signal positive
2
GND
Ground
ALM O1/ ALM O2
2
CRIT_S WITCH_ OUTN
Outputs the critical alarm signal negative
3
SWIT CHI_I N2
Alarm input 2
3
MAJ_S WITCH_ OUTP
Outputs the major alarm signal positive
4
SWIT CHI_I N3
Alarm input 3
4
MIN_S WITCH_ OUTP
Outputs the minor alarm signal positive
5
GND
Ground
5
MIN_S WITCH_ OUTN
Outputs the minor alarm signal negative
6
GND
Ground
6
MAJ_S WITCH_ OUTN
Outputs the major alarm signal negative
7
SWIT CHI_I N4
Alarm input 4
7
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT1P
Alarm signal output 1 positive
8
GND
Ground
8
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT1N
Alarm signal output 1 negative
1
SWIT CHI_I N5
Alarm input 5
1
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT2P
Reserved alarm signal output 2 positive
2
GND
Ground
2
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT2N
Reserved alarm signal output 2 negative
3
SWIT CHI_I N6
Alarm input 6
3
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT3P
Reserved alarm signal output 3 positive
4
SWIT CHI_I N7
Alarm input 7
4
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT4P
Reserved alarm signal output 4 positive
ALM I2
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
ALM O3/ ALM O4
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
293
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Inter face
PI N No .
Defin ition
Function
5
GND
6
3 Quick View of Product
Inter face
PI N No.
Definiti on
Function
Ground
5
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT4N
Reserved alarm signal output 4 negative
GND
Ground
6
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT3N
Reserved alarm signal output 3 negative
7
SWIT CHI_I N8
Alarm input 8
7
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT5P
Reserved alarm signal output 5 positive
8
GND
Ground
8
ALM_S WITCH_ OUT5N
Reserved alarm signal output 5 negative
There are four alarm output interfaces: ALMO1, ALMO2, ALMO3, and ALMO4. Any of them can be used for alarm output or subrack cascading. Currently, only the ALMO1 and ALMO2 interfaces are available; the ALMO3 and ALMO4 interfaces are reserved for future use.
3.10.3 OptiX OSN 3800 Housekeeping Alarm Interfaces OptiX OSN 3800 provides alarm input and output interfaces. The alarm input interfaces are designed for remotely monitoring alarms of external systems, such as an environmental monitoring system. The alarm output interfaces are designed to output alarms to a centralized management system for management.
Alarm Input/Output Interfaces The TN21AUX/TN22AUX provides six alarm inputs and remote monitoring of alarm signals of the external systems, such as the environmental monitoring system. The TN21AUX/TN22AUX provides two alarm output interfaces, sending alarms to a centralized alarm management system.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
294
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-57 Interfaces in the TN21AUX/TN22AUX
STAT PROG
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2
Alarm Input Interfaces Alarm Output Interfaces
EXT
AUX
Figure 3-58 Structure of the TN21AUX/TN22AUX signal cable 2
1
B
Pos.64 View A
A
W8 W7
Pos.1
View B
X8
1
X7
8
X6
W6 Delander
W5 W1
X5 ALMO
W4
X1
X4 ALMI2
W3
X3 ALMI1
View C
3
Pos.9
W2
C X2 Pos.1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
295
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-99 Alarm Input Interfaces Interface
PIN No.
Definition
Function
ALMI1
1
SW_IN1P
Alarm input signal 1
2
GND
Ground
3
SW_IN2P
Alarm input signal 2
4
SW_IN3P
Alarm input signal 3
5
GND
Ground
6
GND
Ground
7
SW_IN4P
Alarm input signal 4
8
GND
Ground
1
SW_IN5P
Alarm input signal 5
2
GND
Ground
3
SW_IN6P
Alarm input signal 6
4
NC
Reserved
5
NC
Reserved
6
GND
Ground
7
NC
Reserved
8
NC
Reserved
ALMI2
Table 3-100 Alarm Output Interfaces
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Interface
PIN No.
Definition
Function
ALMO
1
SWCRIT_OUT1+
Alarm output signal 1 positive
2
SWCRIT_OUT1-
Alarm output signal 1 negative
3
SWCRIT_OUT2+
Alarm output signal 2 positive
4
SWCRIT_OUT1+
Cascaded alarm output signal 1 positive
5
SWCRIT_OUT1-
Cascaded alarm output signal 1 negative
6
SWCRIT_OUT2-
Alarm output signal 2 negative
7
SWCRIT_OUT2+
Cascaded alarm output signal 2 positive
8
SWCRIT_OUT2-
Cascaded alarm output signal 2 negative
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
296
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.11 Network Management This chapter describes the network management system, as well as inter-NE and intra-NE communication management. Figure 3-59 shows a sample network management structure with Huawei equipment deployed. Figure 3-59 Network management structure Secondary U2000
Primary U2000 External DCN
Site E
Site D Site A
Site C
Master Site F Slave
Slave
GNE Subrack
U2000 Web LCT
Site B
NON-GNE Fiber
Switch
Router
Network cable
Network management involves the following aspects: l
Network management system: U2000 and U2000 Web LCT
l
Inter-NE communication: – The NEs between sites A and F are interconnected with fibers and exchange information over ESC/OSC channels using the HWECC, IP over DCC or OSI over DCC protocol. – Some NEs between sites A and F (for example, NEs at site B) are interconnected with network cables (generally where optical and electrical NEs are separate), and exchange information over Ethernet channels (at NM_ETH ports on the related boards) using the HWECC, IP over DCC or OSI over DCC protocol. – The NEs at sites A and C are used as gateway NEs (GNEs) and are connected to the external DCN through a switch or router, communicating with the network management system (NMS). All the other NEs are used as non-GNE, communicating with the NMS through the GNEs.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
297
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
3 Quick View of Product
Intra-NE communication: For each NE at sites A-F, the master and slave subracks implement intra-NE communication. In the figure above, one NE at site A has three subracks (one master connected to two slaves).
3.11.1 Introduction to Network Cables Network cables are classified into two types: crossover cables and straight-through cables. IntraNE connections must be established using straight-through cables and inter-NE connections (including the connections between NEs and the NMS) can be established using either straightthrough or crossover cables.
Connections Figure 3-60 shows the connections of straight-through cables and crossover cables. Figure 3-60 Network cable connection
Pin8
Pin8
Pin1
Pin1 X1
Straight-through cable
X2
Pin8
Pin8
Pin1
Pin1 X2
X1 Crossover cable
Pin Assignment Table 3-101 lists the pin assignment of the straight-through cable. Table 3-101 Pin assignment of the straight-through cable
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Connector X1
Connector X2
Color
Relationship
X1.pin1
X2.pin1
White/Orange
Twisted pair
X1.pin2
X2.pin2
Orange
X1.pin3
X2.pin3
White/Green
X1.pin6
X2.pin6
Green
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Twisted pair
298
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Connector X1
Connector X2
Color
Relationship
X1.pin4
X2.pin4
Blue
Twisted pair
X1.pin5
X2.pin5
White/Blue
X1.pin7
X2.pin7
White/Brown
X1.pin8
X2.pin8
Brown
Twisted pair
Table 3-102 lists the pin assignment of the crossover cable. Table 3-102 Pin assignment of the crossover cable Connector X1
Connector X2
Color
Relationship
X1.pin1
X2.pin3
White/Orange
Twisted pair
X1.pin2
X2.pin6
Orange
X1.pin3
X2.pin1
White/Green
X1.pin6
X2.pin2
Green
X1.pin4
X2.pin7
Blue
X1.pin5
X2.pin8
White/Blue
X1.pin7
X2.pin4
White/Brown
X1.pin8
X2.pin5
Brown
Twisted pair
Twisted pair
Twisted pair
3.11.2 Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T32/T64 3.11.2.1 Interfaces Interfaces For OptiX OSN 8800 T32/T64, the NM_ETH1/NM_ETH2 interfaces on TN51ETH1/ TN51ETH2 boards are used for achieving inter-NE communication and the ETH1, ETH2, and ETH3 interfaces on the TN51ETH2 boards are used to achieve intra-NE communication. Table 3-103 provides correct connections of these network interfaces.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
299
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-103 Network Cable Interfaces Board Name TN51E FI1
Front Panel
EFI1
Typ e
Function
NM_ETH 2a
RJ4 5
l Connects an NMS computer through a network cable so that the NMS can manage the equipment where the TN51EFI1 board is located.
NM_ETH2
Interface
SERIAL
l Connects the TN51EFI1 board inside one NE to the NM_ETH1/ NM_ETH2 interface on the TN51EFI1/TN51EFI2 boards inside another NE to achieve communication between NEs.
TN51E FI2
EFI2
SERIALa
DB9
Functions as a serial network interface and supports X.25 protocol and TL1 management. The default rate of this serial interface is 38400.
LAMP1/ LAMP2
RJ4 5
Controls the PWR and alarm indicators of the cabinet that holds the subrack with the TN51EFI2 board.
ETH1
LAMP1
ETH2
LAMP2 NM_ETH1
ETH3
CAUTION The LAMP interfaces on the TN51EFI2 board provide 5 V power, and it is only used for the indicators on a cabinet. It cannot connect to an RJ45 cable intended for an NM_ETH or ETH interface; otherwise, the TN51EFI2 board, the connected test instrument, or the equipment will be damaged.
NM_ETH 1a
RJ4 5
l Connects to an NMS computer using a network cable so that the NMS can manage the equipment where the TN51EFI2 board is located. l Connects the TN51EFI2 board inside one NE to the NM_ETH1 or NM_ETH2 interface on the TN51EFI2 board inside another NE to achieve communication between the NEs. NOTE NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 have the same function.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
300
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Front Panel
3 Quick View of Product
Interface
Typ e
Function
ETH1/ ETH2/ ETH3
RJ4 5
l Connect the TN51EFI2 board inside one subrack to the ETH1/ETH2/ ETH3 interfaces on the EFI2 boards inside other subracks using network cables to achieve communication between all the subracks. l Connects the TN51EFI2 board to a CRPC or ROP board using a network cable to achieve communication with the CRPC or ROP board.
NOTE Authentication is required before this port is connected. To be specific, you must log in to the NE using the NE administrator account for authentication.
Pin Assignment Figure 3-61 shows the pin assignment of the RJ45 connector. Figure 3-61 Pin assignment of the RJ45 connector
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 .
Figure 3-62 shows the pin assignment of the DB9 connector. Figure 3-62 Pin assignment of the DB9 connector
1 6 2 7 3 8 4 9 5
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
301
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-104 describes the pin assignment of the NM_ETH1 interface. Table 3-104 Pin assignment of the NM_ETH1 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
NM_ETNTXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for communication with the NM
2
NM_ETNTXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for communication with the NM
3
NM_ETNRXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for communication with the NM
4
NC
Not connected
5
NC
Not connected
6
NM_ETNRXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for communication with the NM
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-105 describes the pin assignment of the NM_ETH2 interface. Table 3-105 Pin assignment of the NM_ETH2 interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
NMJL_ETNTXP
Positive pole for transmitting the concatenated data for communication with a network management system (NM)
2
NMJL_ETNTXN
Negative pole for transmitting the concatenated data for communication with an NM
3
NMJL_ETNRXP
Positive pole for receiving the concatenated data for communication with an NM
4
NC
Not connected
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
302
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
5
NC
Not connected
6
NMJL_ETNRXN
Negative pole for receiving the concatenated data for communication with an NM
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-106 describes the pin assignment of the ETH1 interface. Table 3-106 Pin assignment of the ETH1 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH1_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for normal intersubrack communication
2
ETH1_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for normal inter-subrack communication
3
ETH1_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
4
ETH1_CRIT_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for emergent intersubrack communication
5
ETH1_CRIT_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for emergent inter-subrack communication
6
ETH1_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
7
ETH1_CRIT_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
8
ETH1_CRIT_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Table 3-107 describes the pin assignment of the ETH2 interface. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
303
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-107 Pin assignment of the ETH2 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH2_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for normal intersubrack communication
2
ETH2_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for normal inter-subrack communication
3
ETH2_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
4
ETH2_CRIT_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for emergent intersubrack communication
5
ETH2_CRIT_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for emergent inter-subrack communication
6
ETH2_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
7
ETH2_CRIT_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
8
ETH2_CRIT_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Table 3-108 describes the pin assignment of the ETH3 interface. Table 3-108 Pin assignment of the ETH3 interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH3_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for ordinary intersubrack communication
2
ETH3_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for ordinary inter-subrack communication
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
304
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
3
ETH3_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for ordinary intersubrack communication
4
ETH3_CRIT_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for emergent intersubrack communication
5
ETH3_CRIT_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for emergent inter-subrack communication
6
ETH3_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for ordinary intersubrack communication
7
ETH3_CRIT_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
8
ETH3_CRIT_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Table 3-109 describes the pin assignment of the LAMP1 and LAMP2 interfaces. Table 3-109 Pin assignment of the LAMP1 and LAMP2 interfaces
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
CRIT_ALMP
Positive pole for critical alarm signals
2
CRIT_ALMN
Negative pole for critical alarm signals
3
MAJ_ALMP
Positive pole for major alarm signals
4
RUNP
Positive pole for power indicating signals
5
RUNN
Negative pole for power indicating signals
6
MAJ_ALMN
Negative pole for major alarm signals
7
MIN_ALMP
Positive pole for minor alarm signals
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
305
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
8
MIN_ALMN
Negative pole for minor alarm signals
Table 3-110 describes the pin assignment of the SERIAL interface. Table 3-110 Pin assignment of the SERIAL interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
N.C
Not defined
2
RXD
Receive end
3
TXD
Transmit end
4
DTR
Data terminal equipment ready
5
GND
Ground
6
-
Reserved
7
-
Reserved
8
GND
Ground
9
N.C
Not defined
DIP Switches There are DIP switches inside the EFI1 board. The EFI2 board is connected to the master subrack through the ETH1, ETH2, or ETH3 interface. The ID of each subrack is set by using two DIP switches on the EFI1 board. The value that can be set by using each of the two DIP switches on the EFI1 board is a binary value 0 or 1. ID1-ID4 correspond to bits 1-4 of SW2, and ID5-ID8 corresponding to bits 1-4 of SW1. Among these ID values, only ID1-ID5 are valid. ID6-ID8 are reserved. The bits from high to low are ID5-ID1, by which a maximum of 32 states can be set. The value is 00000 by default. "0" indicates the master subrack. The other values indicate slave subracks. Figure 3-63 shows the position of the DIP switches on the EFI1 board. l
The two DIP switches are numbered SW1 and SW2 and are located to the right of the CPLD.
l
When the DIP switch is ON, the value of the corresponding bit is set to 0.
l
As shown in Figure 3-63, the value represented by the ID5-ID1 is 000001, which is 1 in decimal system. That is, the subrack ID is 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
306
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-63 Position of the DIP switches on the EFI1 board
NM_ETH2
CPLD SERIAL
(ID5)
ON
(ID1)
ON
(ID6)
ON
(ID2)
ON
(ID7)
ON
(ID3)
ON
(ID8)
ON
(ID4)
ON
SW1
SW2
NOTE
Ensure that the ID6 to ID8 switches are turned on as shown in Figure 3-63.
3.11.2.2 Connections On a network where only OptiX OSN 8800 T32/T64 NEs are used, intra-NE and inter-NE communication are achieved through fiber connections and network cable connections.
NE Connections Figure 3-64 shows the NE connection scheme. The figure presents connections between two NEs: NE1 and NE2. Each NE consists of three subracks, one of which is the master subrack and the other two are slave subracks. The master and slave subracks are connected using fibers and network cables.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
307
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-64 NE connection scheme NMS NE1
NE2 Master Subrack (1)
OTU OTU OTU OTU
EFI2
SCC SC2
FIU
Other NE
OADM/OA/O M/OD
FIU
LAMP1LAMP2NM_ETH1
ETH3
Slave Subrack (3) SCC
EFI2
SC2
FIU
ETH3
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
ETH1 ETH2
Fiber
Other NE
EFI2
LAMP1LAMP2NM_ETH1
ETH1 ETH2
ETH3
FIU
OADM/OA/O M/OD
SCC
Slave Subrack (2)
EFI2
LAMP1LAMP2NM_ETH1
SC2
ETH1 ETH2
SCC FIU
Other NE
EFI2
EFI2
Other NE
ETH3
Slave Subrack (3)
Master Subrack (1)
EFI2
LAMP1LAMP2NM_ETH1
ETH3
FIU
OADM/OA/O M/OD
ETH1 ETH2
SC2
FIU
EFI2
SCC
ETH1 ETH2
EFI2
Slave Subrack (2) Other NE
SERIAL
OTU
NM_ETH2
ETH3
OTU
EFI2
EFI1
LAMP1LAMP2NM_ETH1
ETH1 ETH2
OTU
EFI1/EFI2
SCC OTU
EFI2
FIU
Other NE
OADM/OA/O M/OD
Network Cable
Inter-NE communication: l
As shown in the figure above, NE1 connects to the NMS through the NM_ETH1 interface on the EFI2 board in the master subrack using a network cable, enabling the NMS to manage the two NEs.
l
Inside each NE, OTU, OADM/OA/OM/OD, OSC, and FIU boards are properly connected through fibers and the FIU boards are also connected to other NEs. ESC or OSC channels are used to achieve inter-NE communication.
l
The NM_ETH2 interface on the EFI1 board in the master subrack of one NE is connected to the NM_ETH1 interface on the EFI2 board inside the master subrack of the other NE using a network cable, achieving inter-NE communication over Ethernet channels.
Intra-NE communication: For each NE, the ETH1 interface on the EFI2 board inside the one subrack are connected to the ETH2 interfaces on the EFI2 board in the other subrack to achieve communication between the subracks.
3.11.3 Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
308
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.11.3.1 Interfaces Interfaces For OptiX OSN 8800 T16, the NM_ETH1/NM_ETH2 interfaces on TN16EFI board are used for achieving inter-NE communication and the ETH1, ETH2, and ETH3 interfaces on the TN16EFI boards are used to achieve intra-NE communication. Table 3-111 provides correct connections of these network interfaces. Table 3-111 Network Cable Interfaces Board Name TN16E FI
Front Panel
EFI
LAMP2
ETH2
NM_ETH1
ETH3
NM_ETH2
Type
Function
LAMP1LAMP2
RJ45
Controls the PWR indicators and alarm indicators of the cabinet that holds the subrack.
ETH1ETH3
RJ45
l Connects a network cable from the ETH1/ETH2/ETH3 interface on one subrack to corresponding interfaces on the other subracks to achieve the communication between the master subrack and slave subracks.
LAMP1
ETH1
SERIAL
Interface
NOTE When inter-subrack protection is configured, the ETH3 interface cannot be used for the communication between the master and slave subracks.
l Connects a network cable to a CRPC or ROP board to achieve communication with the CRPC or ROP board. NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2
RJ45
a
l Connects the network interface on the equipment through a network cable to that on an NM server so that the NM can manage the equipment. l Connects the NM_ETH1/ NM_ETH2 network interface on one NE through a network cable to that on another NE to achieve communication between NEs.
SERIALa
DB9
The interface provides serial NM and supports X.25 protocol.
NOTE Authentication is required before this port is connected. To be specific, you must log in to the NE using the NE administrator account for authentication.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
309
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin Assignment Figure 3-65 shows the pin assignment of the RJ45 connector. Figure 3-65 Pin assignment of the RJ45 connector
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 .
Figure 3-66 shows the pin assignment of the DB9 connector. Figure 3-66 Pin assignment of the DB9 connector
1 6 2 7 3 8 4 9 5
Table 3-112 describes the pin assignment of the NM_ETH1 interface. Table 3-112 Pin assignment of the NM_ETH1 interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
NM_ETNTXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for communication with the NM
2
NM_ETNTXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for communication with the NM
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
310
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
3
NM_ETNRXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for communication with the NM
4
NC
Not connected
5
NC
Not connected
6
NM_ETNRXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for communication with the NM
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-113 describes the pin assignment of the NM_ETH2 interface. Table 3-113 Pin assignment of the NM_ETH2 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
NMJL_ETNTXP
Positive pole for transmitting the concatenated data for communication with a network management system (NM)
2
NMJL_ETNTXN
Negative pole for transmitting the concatenated data for communication with an NM
3
NMJL_ETNRXP
Positive pole for receiving the concatenated data for communication with an NM
4
NC
Not connected
5
NC
Not connected
6
NMJL_ETNRXN
Negative pole for receiving the concatenated data for communication with an NM
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-114 describes the pin assignment of the ETH1 interface. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
311
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-114 Pin assignment of the ETH1 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH1_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for normal intersubrack communication
2
ETH1_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for normal inter-subrack communication
3
ETH1_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
4
ETH1_CRIT_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for emergent intersubrack communication
5
ETH1_CRIT_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for emergent inter-subrack communication
6
ETH1_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
7
ETH1_CRIT_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
8
ETH1_CRIT_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Table 3-115 describes the pin assignment of the ETH2 interface. Table 3-115 Pin assignment of the ETH2 interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH2_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for normal intersubrack communication
2
ETH2_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for normal inter-subrack communication
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
312
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
3
ETH2_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
4
ETH2_CRIT_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for emergent intersubrack communication
5
ETH2_CRIT_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for emergent inter-subrack communication
6
ETH2_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
7
ETH2_CRIT_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
8
ETH2_CRIT_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Table 3-116 describes the pin assignment of the ETH3 interface. Table 3-116 Pin assignment of the ETH3 interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH3_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for ordinary intersubrack communication
2
ETH3_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for ordinary inter-subrack communication
3
ETH3_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for ordinary intersubrack communication
4
ETH3_CRIT_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
313
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
5
ETH3_CRIT_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for emergent inter-subrack communication
6
ETH3_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for ordinary intersubrack communication
7
ETH3_CRIT_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
8
ETH3_CRIT_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Table 3-117 describes the pin assignment of the LAMP1 and LAMP2 interfaces. Table 3-117 Pin assignment of the LAMP1 and LAMP2 interfaces Pin
Signal
Function
1
CRIT_ALMP
Positive pole for critical alarm signals
2
CRIT_ALMN
Negative pole for critical alarm signals
3
MAJ_ALMP
Positive pole for major alarm signals
4
RUNP
Positive pole for power indicating signals
5
RUNN
Negative pole for power indicating signals
6
MAJ_ALMN
Negative pole for major alarm signals
7
MIN_ALMP
Positive pole for minor alarm signals
8
MIN_ALMN
Negative pole for minor alarm signals
Table 3-118 describes the pin assignment of the SERIAL interface.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
314
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-118 Pin assignment of the SERIAL interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
N.C
Not defined
2
RXD
Receive end
3
TXD
Transmit end
4
DTR
Data terminal equipment ready
5
GND
Ground
6
-
Reserved
7
-
Reserved
8
GND
Ground
9
N.C
Not defined
DIP Switches There are DIP switches inside the EFI board. The master and slave subracks are connected through the ETH1/ETH2/ETH3 interface on the EFI. The ID of each subrack is set by using two DIP switches on the EFI board. The value that can be set by using each of the two DIP switches on the EFI board is a binary value 0 or 1. ID1-ID4 correspond to bits 1-4 of SW2, and ID5-ID8 corresponding to bits 1-4 of SW1. Among these ID values, only ID1-ID5 are valid. ID6-ID8 are reserved. The bits from high to low are ID5-ID1, by which a maximum of 32 states can be set. The value is 00000 by default. "0" indicates the master subrack. The other values indicate slave subracks. Figure 3-67 shows the position of the DIP switches on the EFI board. l
The two DIP switches are numbered SW1 and SW2 and are located to the right of the T1.
l
When the DIP switch is ON, the value of the corresponding bit is set to 0.
l
As shown in Figure 3-67, the value represented by the ID5-ID1 is 000001, which is 1 in decimal system. That is, the subrack ID is 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
315
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-67 Position of the DIP switches on the EFI board
U8 SERIAL
SW2
NM_ETH2
SW1
T1
ON
ON
ON
ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON
ON
ON
ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
SW1
SW2
NOTE
Ensure that the ID6 to ID8 switches are turned on as shown in Figure 3-67.
3.11.3.2 Connections On a network where only OptiX OSN 8800 T16 NEs are used, intra-NE and inter-NE communication are achieved through fiber connections and network cable connections.
NE Connections Figure 3-68 shows the NE connection scheme. The figure presents connections between two NEs: NE1 and NE2. Each NE consists of three subracks, one of which is the master subrack and the other two are slave subracks. The master and slave subracks are connected using fibers and network cables.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
316
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-68 NE connection scheme NMS NE1
NE2 Master Subrack (1)
Master Subrack (1) SCC
EFI
ETH1 ETH2
SERIAL
ETH3
NM_ETH2
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
EFI
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
ETH3
NM_ETH2
OTU
ETH1 ETH2
EFI
OTU
SERIAL
SCC OTU
EFI
OTU OTU OTU
OTU
OTU
SCC
EFI
ETH1 ETH2 ETH3
SC2
FIU
Other NE
FIU
OADM/OA/O M/OD
SCC
EFI
SC2
FIU
ETH3
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
ETH1 ETH2
NM_ETH2
Other NE
Slave Subrack (2)
Slave Subrack (3)
EFI SERIAL
Fiber
Other NE
NM_ETH2
ETH3
NM_ETH2
FIU
OADM/OA/O M/OD
EFI SERIAL
SC2
ETH1 ETH2
FIU
SERIAL
SCC
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
EFI
EFI
Other NE
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
Slave Subrack (3)
ETH3
FIU
OADM/OA/O M/OD
ETH1 ETH2
SC2
NM_ETH2
FIU
SERIAL
SCC
EFI
Other NE
EFI
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
Slave Subrack (2)
FIU
Other NE
OADM/OA/O M/OD
Network Cable
Inter-NE communication: l
As shown in the figure above, NE1 connects to the NMS through the NM_ETH1 interface on the EFI board in the master subrack using a network cable, enabling the NMS to manage the two NEs.
l
Inside each NE, OTU, OADM/OA/OM/OD, OSC, and FIU boards are properly connected through fibers and the FIU boards are also connected to other NEs. ESC or OSC channels are used to achieve inter-NE communication.
l
The NM_ETH2 interface on the EFI board in the master subrack of one NE is connected to the NM_ETH1 interface on the EFI board inside the master subrack of the other NE using a network cable, achieving inter-NE communication over Ethernet channels.
Intra-NE communication: For each NE, the ETH1 interface on the EFI board inside the one subrack are connected to the ETH2 interfaces on the EFI board in the other subrack to achieve communication between the subracks.
3.11.4 Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 6800 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
317
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
3.11.4.1 Interfaces Interfaces For OptiX OSN 6800, the NM_ETH1/NM_ETH2 interfaces on TN11AUX board are used for achieving inter-NE communication and the ETH1 and ETH2 interfaces on the TN11AUX boards are used to achieve intra-NE communication. Table 3-119 provides correct connections of these network interfaces. Table 3-119 Network Cable Interfaces Board Name
Front Panel
TN11 AUX NM_ETH1
Interfac e
T y p e
Function
NM_ET H1/ NM_ET H2
R J 4 5
l Using a network cable, the port connects the network interface on the OptiX OSN 6800 to the NMS server to enable the management of the NMS over the OptiX OSN 6800.
NM_ETH2
l Using a network cable, the port connects the NM_ETH1/NM_ETH2 network interface on one NE to another NE for communication between NEs.
ETH1 ETH2
ETH1/ ETH2
R J 4 5
STAT PROG
l Connects a network cable to a CRPC or ROP board to achieve communication with the CRPC or ROP board.
AUX
TN11 EFI
COM
ETH3
ALM01 ALM02 ALM03 ALM04
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
l Using a network cable, the port connects the ETH1/ETH2/ETH3 interface on one subrack to the other subracks for communication between the master subrack and slave subracks.
SERIAL
ALMI1 ALMI2 LAMP1 LAMP2
COM
R J 4 5
This interface is intended only for Huawei engineers to commission the equipment at the factory.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
318
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Front Panel
3 Quick View of Product
Interfac e
T y p e
Function
ETH3
R J 4 5
l Connects a network cable from the ETH1/ ETH2/ETH3 interface on one subrack to corresponding interfaces on the other subracks to achieve the communication between the master subrack and slave subracks. NOTE When inter-subrack protection is configured, the ETH3 interface cannot be used for the communication between the master and slave subracks.
l Connects a network cable to a CRPC or ROP board to achieve communication with the CRPC or ROP board. ALMO1/ ALMO2/ ALMO3/ ALMO4
R J 4 5
l Alarm outputs are sent to the DC power distribution cabinet through the output interface and the cascading interface. You can configure it to be the other outputs to implement integrated display of alarms. The alarm outputs are controlled by the internal relay contact. When the relay contact is closed, the resistance of each ALMO interface is less than 1 ohm. When the relay contact is open, the resistance of each ALMO interface is an infinite number. l The definitions for the pins of the ALMO1 and ALMO2 interfaces are the same. The two interfaces are used for output/cascading, respectively. The definitions for the pins of the ALMO3 and ALMO4 interfaces are the same. The two interfaces are used for output/ cascading, respectively. For example, if ALMO1 is used to output alarm signals, ALMO2 can be cascaded to ALMO1 on another subrack. l The OptiX OSN 6800 provides eight alarm outputs. Defaults of the first three are critical alarm, major alarm, and minor alarm. The other five are reserved. Alarm outputs can be cascaded.
SERIAL
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
D B 9
The OAM interface is a serial NM interface, providing functions of serial NM and supporting X.25 protocol.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
319
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Name
Front Panel
3 Quick View of Product
Interfac e
T y p e
Function
ALMI1/ ALMI2
R J 4 5
External alarm signal input function is designed for requirements when the alarm signals of the external systems (such as the environment monitory) need remote monitoring. The OptiX OSN 6800 provides eight alarm inputs. The severity of the eight alarms can be configured to cooperate with the external system to implement remote monitoring of external alarms.
LAMP1/ LAMP2
R J 4 5
This interface drives the running indicators and alarm indicators of the cabinet that holds the subrack.
Pin Assignment Figure 3-69 shows the pin assignment of the RJ45 connector. Figure 3-69 Pin assignment of the RJ45 connector
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 .
Figure 3-70 shows the pin assignment of the DB9 connector.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
320
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-70 Pin assignment of the DB9 connector
1 6 2 7 3 8 4 9 5
Table 3-120 describes the pin assignment of the COM interface. Table 3-120 Pin assignment of the COM interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETNTX_P_1
Transmits the data positive
2
ETNTX_N_1
Transmits the data negative
3
ETNRX_P_1
Receives the data positive
4
NC
Not connected
5
NC
Not connected
6
ETNRX_N_1
Receives data negative
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-121 describes the pin assignment of the NM_ETH1 interface. Table 3-121 Pin assignment of the NM_ETH1 interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
NM_ETNTXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for communication with the NM
2
NM_ETNTXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for communication with the NM
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
321
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
3
NM_ETNRXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for communication with the NM
4
NC
Not connected
5
NC
Not connected
6
NM_ETNRXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for communication with the NM
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-122 describes the pin assignment of the NM_ETH2 interface. Table 3-122 Pin assignment of the NM_ETH2 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
NMJL_ETNTXP
Positive pole for transmitting the concatenated data for communication with a network management system (NM)
2
NMJL_ETNTXN
Negative pole for transmitting the concatenated data for communication with an NM
3
NMJL_ETNRXP
Positive pole for receiving the concatenated data for communication with an NM
4
NC
Not connected
5
NC
Not connected
6
NMJL_ETNRXN
Negative pole for receiving the concatenated data for communication with an NM
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-123 describes the pin assignment of the ETH1 interface. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
322
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-123 Pin assignment of the ETH1 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH1_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for normal intersubrack communication
2
ETH1_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for normal inter-subrack communication
3
ETH1_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
4
ETH1_CRIT_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for emergent intersubrack communication
5
ETH1_CRIT_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for emergent inter-subrack communication
6
ETH1_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
7
ETH1_CRIT_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
8
ETH1_CRIT_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Table 3-124 describes the pin assignment of the ETH2 interface. Table 3-124 Pin assignment of the ETH2 interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH2_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for normal intersubrack communication
2
ETH2_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for normal inter-subrack communication
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
323
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
3
ETH2_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
4
ETH2_CRIT_TXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for emergent intersubrack communication
5
ETH2_CRIT_TXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for emergent inter-subrack communication
6
ETH2_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for normal intersubrack communication
7
ETH2_CRIT_RXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
8
ETH2_CRIT_RXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for emergent intersubrack communication
Table 3-125 describes the pin assignment of the ETH3 interface. Table 3-125 Pin assignment of the ETH3 interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETH3_TXP
Transmits the data positive for inter-subrack ordinary communications
2
ETH3_TXN
Transmits the data negative for inter-subrack ordinary communications
3
ETH3_RXP
Receives the data positive for inter-subrack ordinary communications
4
ETH3_CRIT_TXP
Transmits the data positive for inter-subrack emergent communications
5
ETH3_CRIT_TXN
Transmits the data negative for inter-subrack emergent communications
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
324
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
6
ETH3_RXN
Receives the data negative for inter-subrack ordinary communications
7
ETH3_CRIT_RXP
Receives the data positive for inter-subrack emergent communications
8
ETH3_CRIT_RXN
Receives the data negative for inter-subrack emergent communications
Table 3-126 describes the pin assignment of the ALMO1 and the ALMO2 interfaces. Table 3-126 Pin assignment of the ALMO1 and ALMO2 interfaces Pin
Signal
Function
1
CRIT_SWITCH_OUTP
Outputs the critical alarm signal positive
2
CRIT_SWITCH_OUTN
Outputs the critical alarm signal negative
3
MAJ_SWITCH_OUTP
Outputs the major alarm signal positive
4
MIN_SWITCH_OUTP
Outputs the minor alarm signal positive
5
MIN_SWITCH_OUTN
Outputs the minor alarm signal negative
6
MAJ_SWITCH_OUTN
Outputs the major alarm signal negative
7
ALM_SWITCH_OUT1P
Alarm signal output 1 positive
8
ALM_SWITCH_OUT1N
Alarm signal output 1 negative
Table 3-127 describes the pin assignment of the ALMO3 and the ALMO4 interfaces.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
325
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-127 Pin assignment of the ALMO3 and the ALMO4 interfaces Pin
Signal
Function
1
ALM_SWITCH_OUT2P
Alarm signal output 2 positive
2
ALM_SWITCH_OUT2N
Alarm signal output 2 negative
3
ALM_SWITCH_OUT3P
Alarm signal output 3 positive
4
ALM_SWITCH_OUT4P
Alarm signal output 4 positive
5
ALM_SWITCH_OUT4N
Alarm signal output 4 negative
6
ALM_SWITCH_OUT3N
Alarm signal output 3 negative
7
ALM_SWITCH_OUT5P
Alarm signal output 5 positive
8
ALM_SWITCH_OUT5N
Alarm signal output 5 negative
Table 3-128 describes the pin assignment of the SERIAL interface. Table 3-128 Pin assignment of the SERIAL interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
N.C
Not defined
2
RXD
Receive end of data
3
TXD
Transmit end of data
4
DTR
Data terminal equipment ready
5
GND
Ground
6
-
Reserved
7
-
Reserved
8
GND
GND
9
5VOADM
Power supply for OADM
Table 3-129 describes the pin assignment of the ALMI1 interface. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
326
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-129 Pin assignment of the ALMI1 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
SWITCHI_IN1
Alarm input 1
2
GND
Ground
3
SWITCHI_IN2
Alarm input 2
4
SWITCHI_IN3
Alarm input 3
5
GND
Ground
6
GND
Ground
7
SWITCHI_IN4
Alarm input 4
8
GND
Ground
Table 3-130 describes the pin assignment of the ALMI2 interface. Table 3-130 Pin assignment of the ALMI2 Pin
Signal
Function
1
SWITCHI_IN5
Alarm input 5
2
GND
Ground
3
SWITCHI_IN6
Alarm input 6
4
SWITCHI_IN7
Alarm input 7
5
GND
Ground
6
GND
Ground
7
SWITCHI_IN8
Alarm input 8
8
GND
Ground
Table 3-131 describes the pin assignment of the LAMP1 and the LAMP2 interfaces. Table 3-131 Pin assignment of the LAMP1 and the LAMP2 interfaces
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
CRIT_ALMP
Critical alarm signal positive
2
CRIT_ALMN
Critical alarm signal negative
3
MAJ_ALMP
Major alarm signal positive
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
327
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
4
RUNP
Power indicating signal positive
5
RUNN
Power indicating signal negative
6
MAJ_ALMN
Major alarm signal positive
7
MIN_ALMP
Minor alarm signal positive
8
MIN_ALMN
Minor alarm signal negative
Jumper The SCC detects the subrack ID and identifies whether the subrack is a primary or a secondary one. The result is indicated by the LED indicator of the SCC front panel. The TN11AUX01 board is available in two types. For one type there are three jumpers and for the other type there are eight jumpers inside the board. l
For the TN11AUX01 board that has three jumpers inside, the jumpers can be set in eight combinations, representing decimal values 0-7. The default setting of the three jumpers is 000. The value 0 indicates the master subrack, and the other values indicate slave subracks. Figure 3-71 shows the position of the three jumpers. When the two pins on the right of each jumper are capped, the setting is 1; when the two pins on the left of each jumper are capped, the setting is 0. As shown in Figure 3-71, the jumper setting represents the decimal value of 1, which means that the subrack ID is 1.
l
For the TN11AUX01 board that has eight jumpers inside, the J14, J15, J16, J17, and J18, jumpers are reserved and the two pins on the left of each reserved jumper must be capped. The J4, J3, and J2 jumpers can be set in 8 combinations, representing decimal values 0-7. The default setting of the three jumpers is 000. The value 0 indicates the master subrack and the other values indicate slave subracks. Figure 3-72 shows the position of the jumpers. When the two pins on the right of each of the three jumpers are capped, the setting is 1; when the two pins on the left of each of the three jumpers are capped, the setting is 0. As shown in Figure 3-72, the jumper setting represents the decimal value of 1, which means that the subrack ID is 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
328
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-71 Position of the three jumpers on the TN11AUX01 board Representing Representing Representing
0
0
1
1
2
3
Junper cap
Jumpers
1
2
3 CPU
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
329
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-72 Position of the eight jumpers on the TN11AUX01 board Representing 0
Representing 0
J3
J4
J2
Representing 0
Representing 0
J17
Representing 1
Representing0
J15
J16 Representing 0
Representing0
Junper cap J14
J18
J4
J3
J2
J17
J16
J15
J18
J14
Jumpers
CPU
CAUTION The J14, J15, J16, J17, and J18 jumpers must be set as specified in Figure 3-72 . Exercise caution when modifying the subrack ID, because the modification may cause service interruption.
The TN11AUX02 board has eight jumpers, which can be used to implement 32 states that represent decimal values 0-31. Each jumper represents a binary value: 0 or 1. In the TN11AUX02 Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
330
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
board, the J14, J17, and J18 jumpers are reserved. The default value of the five jumpers is 00000. "0" indicates the master subrack. The other values indicate slave subracks. Figure 3-73 shows the jumpers on the board. Figure 3-73 Position of the jumper on the TN11AUX02 board Representing 0
Representing 0
J3
J4
J2
Representing 0
Representing 0
J17
Representing 1
Representing0
J15
J16 Representing 0
Representing0
Junper cap J14
J18
J4
J3
J2
J17
J16
J15
J18
J14
Jumpers
CPU
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
331
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
CAUTION The J14, J17, and J18 jumpers must be set as specified in Figure 3-73. Exercise caution when modifying the subrack ID, because the modification may cause service interruption.
3.11.4.2 Connections On a network where only OptiX OSN 6800 NEs are used, intra-NE and inter-NE communication are achieved through fiber connections and network cable connections.
NE Connections Figure 3-74 shows the NE connection scheme. The figure presents connections between two NEs: NE1 and NE2. Each NE consists of three subracks, one of which is the master subrack and the other two are slave subracks. The master and slave subracks are connected using fibers and network cables. Figure 3-74 NE connection scheme NMS Master Subrack (0)
SCC OTU OTU
STAT PROG
STAT PROG
OTU
NE2 Master Subrack (0)
AUX
OTU
ETH2
AUX
SCC OTU
NM_ETH1NM_ETH2 ETH1
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2 ETH1 ETH2
NE1
OTU
AUX
AUX
OTU
OTU
SC2
FIU
Other NE
FIU
OADM/OA/O M/OD
ETH2
Slave Subrack (2) SCC
AUX
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2 ETH1
SC2
STAT PROG AUX
FIU
Other NE
AUX
Fiber
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
AUX
ETH2
AUX STAT PROG
FIU
OADM/OA/O M/OD
SC2
SCC
STAT PROG
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2 ETH1
SCC FIU
Other NE
AUX
Slave Subrack (2) Other NE
ETH2
STAT PROG
FIU
OADM/OA/O M/OD
SC2
ETH2
FIU
Slave Subrack (1)
AUX
SCC
AUX
Other NE
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2ETH1
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2ETH1
Slave Subrack (1)
FIU
Other NE
OADM/OA/O M/OD
Network Cable
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
332
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Inter-NE communication: l
As shown in the figure above, NE1 connects to the NMS through the NM_ETH1 interface on the AUX board in the master subrack using a network cable, enabling the NMS to manage the two NEs.
l
Inside each NE, OTU, OADM/OA/OM/OD, OSC, and FIU boards are properly connected through fibers and the FIU boards are also connected to other NEs. ESC or OSC channels are used to achieve inter-NE communication.
l
The NM_ETH2 interface on the AUX board in the master subrack of one NE is connected to the NM_ETH1 interface on the AUX board inside the master subrack of the other NE using a network cable, achieving inter-NE communication over Ethernet channels.
Intra-NE communication: For each NE, the ETH1 interface on the AUX board inside the one subrack are connected to the ETH2 interfaces on the AUX board in the other subrack to achieve communication between the subracks.
3.11.5 Management Connections and Interfaces of OptiX OSN 3800 3.11.5.1 Interfaces Network Cable Interfaces For OptiX OSN 3800, the NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 interfaces of TN21AUX and TN22AUX boards are used for achieving inter-NE communication. Table 3-132 provides the correct connections of these network interfaces.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
333
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-132 Network Cable Interfaces Board Name
Front Panel
TN21AU X/ TN22AU X
STAT PROG
Interfac e
T y p e
Function
NM_ET H1/ NM_ET H2
R J4 5
l Using a network cable, the port connects the network interface on the OptiX OSN 3800 to the NMS server to enable the management of the NMS over the OptiX OSN 3800.
NM_ETH1
l Using a network cable, the port connects the NM_ETH1/ NM_ETH2 network interface on one NE to another NE for communication between NEs.
NM_ETH2
EXT
EXT
D B 9, R J4 5
Provides the alarm input/output interface, cascading interface, commissioning network interface and management serial interface. NOTE EXT interfaces include ALMO, LAMP1, LAMP2, ETH, SERIAL, ALMI1, and ALMI2.
AUX
Pin Assignment Figure 3-75 shows the pin assignment of the RJ45 connector. Figure 3-75 Pin assignment of the RJ45 connector
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 .
Figure 3-76 shows the pin assignment of the DB9 connector.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
334
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-76 Pin assignment of the DB9 connector
1 6 2 7 3 8 4 9 5
Table 3-133 describes the pin assignment of the NM_ETH1 interface. Table 3-133 Pin assignment of the NM_ETH1 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
NM_ETNTXP
Positive pole for transmitting the data for communication with the NM
2
NM_ETNTXN
Negative pole for transmitting the data for communication with the NM
3
NM_ETNRXP
Positive pole for receiving the data for communication with the NM
4
NC
Not connected
5
NC
Not connected
6
NM_ETNRXN
Negative pole for receiving the data for communication with the NM
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-134 describes the pin assignment of the NM_ETH2 interface.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
335
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-134 Pin assignment of the NM_ETH2 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
NMJL_ETNTXP
Positive pole for transmitting the concatenated data for communication with a network management system (NM)
2
NMJL_ETNTXN
Negative pole for transmitting the concatenated data for communication with an NM
3
NMJL_ETNRXP
Positive pole for receiving the concatenated data for communication with an NM
4
NC
Not connected
5
NC
Not connected
6
NMJL_ETNRXN
Negative pole for receiving the concatenated data for communication with an NM
7
NC
Not connected
8
NC
Not connected
Table 3-135 describes the pin assignment of the ETH interface. Table 3-135 Pin assignment of the ETH interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
ETNTX_P_1
Positive pole for transmitting the data
2
ETNTX_N_1
Negative pole for transmitting the data
3
ETNRX_P_1
Positive pole for receiving the data
4
NC
Not defined
5
NC
Not defined
6
ETNRX_N_1
Negative pole for receiving the data
7
NC
Not defined
8
NC
Not defined
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
336
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-136 describes the pin assignment of the ALMO interface. Table 3-136 Pin assignment of the ALMO interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
SWCRIT_OUT1+
Alarm output signal 1 positive
2
SWCRIT_OUT1-
Alarm output signal 1 negative
3
SWCRIT_OUT2+
Alarm output signal 2 positive
4
SWCRIT_OUT1+
Cascaded alarm output signal 1 positive
5
SWCRIT_OUT1-
Cascaded alarm output signal 1 negative
6
SWCRIT_OUT2-
Alarm output signal 2 negative
7
SWCRIT_OUT2+
Cascaded alarm output signal 2 positive
8
SWCRIT_OUT2-
Cascaded alarm output signal 2 negative
Table 3-137 describes the pin assignment of the SERIAL interface. Table 3-137 Pin assignment of the SERIAL interface
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Pin
Signal
Function
1
N.C
Not defined
2
RXD
Receive end
3
TXD
Transmit end
4
DTR
Data terminal equipment ready
5
GND
Ground
6
–
Reserved
7
–
Reserved
8
GND
Ground
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
337
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Pin
Signal
Function
9
V5_OADM
Power supply for OADM
Table 3-138 describes the pin assignment of the ALMI1 interface. Table 3-138 Pin assignment of the ALMI1 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
SW_IN1P
Alarm input signal 1
2
GND
Ground
3
SW_IN2P
Alarm input signal 2
4
SW_IN3P
Alarm input signal 3
5
GND
Ground
6
GND
Ground
7
SW_IN4P
Alarm input signal 4
8
GND
Ground
Table 3-139 describes the pin assignment of the ALMI2 interface. Table 3-139 Pin assignment of the ALMI2 interface Pin
Signal
Function
1
SW_IN5P
Alarm input signal 5
2
GND
Ground
3
SW_IN6P
Alarm input signal 6
4
NC
Not defined
5
NC
Not defined
6
GND
Ground
7
NC
Not defined
8
NC
Not defined
Table 3-140 describes the pin assignment of the LAMP1 and the LAMP2 interfaces.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
338
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Table 3-140 Pin assignment of the LAMP1 and the LAMP2 interfaces Pin
Signal
Function
1
RED+
Positive pole for critical alarm signals
2
RED-
Negative pole for critical alarm signals
3
YELLOW+
Positive pole for major alarm signals
4
GREEN+
Positive pole for power indicating signals
5
GND
Negative pole for power indicating signals
6
YELLOW-
Negative pole for major alarm signals
7
ORG+
Positive pole for minor alarm signals
8
ORG-
Negative pole for minor alarm signals
Jumper of TN21/TN22AUX The TN21AUX has 3 jumpers. Figure 3-77 shows the jumpers. The TN22AUX has 8 jumpers. Before the board is used, make sure that the setting of the J4 jumper is the same as that shown in Figure 3-78. Figure 3-77 Position of the jumper on the TN21AUX
CPU
Jumper
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
339
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-78 Position of the jumper on the TN22AUX
Jumper
Jumper cap
8 (J4)
3.11.5.2 Connections On a network where only OptiX OSN 3800 NEs are used, communication between the NEs is achieved through fiber connections and network cable connections.
NE Connections Figure 3-79 shows the NE connection scheme. The figure presents how two NEs, namely NE1 and NE2, are connected using fibers and network cables.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
340
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-79 NE connection scheme
NMS NE1 STAT PROG
AUX
OTU
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2
SCC
EXT
OTU AUX
NE2 STAT PROG
FIU
SC2 FIU
EXT
OADM/OA
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2
Other NE
AUX
SCC
AUX
Other NE Fiber
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Other NE
Network Cable
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
341
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Inter-NE communication: l
As shown in the figure above, the NEs are connected to the NMS through the NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 interfaces on the AUX boards using network cables, enabling the NMS to manage the two NEs.
l
The OTU, OADM/OA, OSC, and FIU boards of the NEs are properly connected through fibers and the FIU boards are also connected to other NEs. ESC or OSC channels are used to achieve inter-NE communication.
l
The NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 interfaces on the AUX boards of the two NEs are connected using network cables, achieving inter-NE communication over Ethernet channels.
3.11.6 Management Connections among OptiX OSN 8800&6800&3800 On a hybrid network where OptiX OSN 8800, 6800, and 3800 NEs are used, the inter-NE communication and intra-NE communication are achieved through fiber connections and network cable connections.
Connections Figure 3-80 shows the NE connection scheme. The figure illustrates how three NEs (namely NE1, NE2, and NE3) of different types are connected. As shown in the figure, NE1 consists of a master subrack (OptiX OSN 8800) and two slave subracks (OptiX OSN 8800 T16/6800); NE2 and NE3 are two OptiX OSN 3800 NEs.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
342
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
Figure 3-80 NE connection scheme NMS NE1
SCC SC2
EXT
FIU
FIU
Other NE
OADM/OA
AUX
Other NE
STAT PROG
FIU
OADM/OA/ OM/OD
3800
STAT PROG
ETH2
AUX
SC2
Other NE
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2 ETH1
SCC FIU
NE3
AUX
ETH3
NM_ETH2
FIU
6800 Slave Subrack (3) Other NE
OTU
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2
ETH1 ETH2
SERIAL
SC2
OADM/OA/ OM/OD
OTU
OTU
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
EFI
SCC FIU
OTU
AUX
EFI
Other NE
SCC
AUX
8800 T16 Slave Subrack (2)
3800
EXT
OTU
SERIAL
ETH3
OTU
STAT PROG
NM_ETH2
OTU
LAMP1 LAMP2 NM_ETH1
OTU
ETH1 ETH2
EFI1/EFI2
SCC
NE2 EFI1
EFI2
NM_ETH1 NM_ETH2
8800 T32/T64 Master Subrack (1)
Other NE
AUX
Fiber
Network Cable
Inter-NE communication: l
As shown in the figure above, NE1 connects to the NMS through the NM_ETH1 interface on the EFI2 board in the master subrack using a network cable, enabling the NMS to manage all the NEs.
l
The OTU, OADM/OA/OM/OD, OSC, and FIU boards inside NE1 are connected through fibers. The FIU boards are also connected to other NEs. ESC or OSC channels are used to achieve inter-NE communication.
l
NE2 and NE3 are connected through their OTU, OADM/OA, OSC, and FIU boards using fibers. The FIU boards of the two NEs are also connected to other NEs. ESC or OSC channels are used to achieve inter-NE communication.
l
The NM_ETH2 interface on the EFI1 board of the master subrack inside NE1 connects to the NM_ETH1 interface on the AUX board inside NE2 through a network cable. The NM_ETH2 interface on the AUX board inside NE2 also uses a network cable to connect to the NM_ETH1 interface on the AUX board inside NE3. In this manner, all the NEs communicate with each other using Ethernet channels.
Intra-NE communication:
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
343
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3 Quick View of Product
For NE1, the ETH1 interface on the EFI2/EFI board inside the one subrack are connected to the ETH2 interfaces on the EFI/AUX board in the other subrack to achieve communication between the subracks.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
344
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4
4 Node Configurations
Node Configurations
About This Chapter 4.1 OTN Typical Configuration This section uses an 80-wavelength system as an example to describe the typical configurations of an optical transmission network (OTN). Compared with an 80-wavelength system, a 40wavelength system does not use ITL boards. A 40-wavelength system is configured in a similar way as an 80-wavelength system. 4.2 OCS Typical Configuration
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
345
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
4.1 OTN Typical Configuration This section uses an 80-wavelength system as an example to describe the typical configurations of an optical transmission network (OTN). Compared with an 80-wavelength system, a 40wavelength system does not use ITL boards. A 40-wavelength system is configured in a similar way as an 80-wavelength system.
4.1.1 OTM/Back to Back OTM A back-to-back optical terminal multiplexer (OTM) site consists of two OTMs arranged back to back.
4.1.1.1 Signal Flow The OTM node is used at the terminal station. The back-to-back OTM node is usually used at central sites. In the receive direction: l
The optical supervisory signals and the main path optical signals are separated from the line signals received from west. The optical supervisory signals are sent to the optical supervisory unit for processing, and the main-path optical signals are sent to the demultiplexer after amplification.
l
Certain wavelengths are dropped and enter the OTU before being sent to the local client equipment. The other wavelengths are not demultiplexed locally. They pass through and are multiplexed with the locally added wavelengths before the optical amplification.
l
Finally, the signals are multiplexed with the processed optical supervisory signals for line transmission.
The signal flow of the transmit direction is the reverse of this process. Figure 4-1 shows the signal flow of an 80-wavelength back-to-back OTM node.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
346
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-1 Signal flow of an 80-wavelength back-to-back OTM node
4.1.1.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the typical configurations for the optical layer of a back-to-back OTM node.
Configuration Principle Optical multiplexer unit and demultiplexer unit: l
For an 80-wavelength back-to-back OTM node, ITL boards must be configured if the M40V/M40/D40 boards are used for adding/dropping wavelengths.
Optical amplifier unit: l
Optical amplifier boards must be configured according to the power budget for actual situations.
Spectrum analyzer unit: l
When WMU and MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an OTM node, configure WMU boards prior to MCA/MC8/OPM8 boards.
l
When only MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an OTM node, the MCA4 boards are most preferred.
l
It is preferred to connect an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board to the MON port on an optical amplifier board or the MON port on an FIU board.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
347
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Optical supervisory channel unit: l
For an 80-wavelength back-to-back OTM node, two SC1 or one SC2 can be configured.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configurations for the optical layer of a back-to-back OTM node. As shown in Figure 4-2, two subracks are required. Figure 4-2 Typical configurations for the optical layer of a back-to-back OTM node
4.1.1.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of an 80-wavelength back-toback OTM node. Figure 4-3 uses a westbound 80-wavelength back-to-back OTM node as an example to illustrate how fibers are connected.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
348
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-3 Subrack fiber connections for an 80-wavelength back-to-back OTM node Shelf1-IU20 Shelf1-IU21
FIU
SC2
OUT
Shelf1-IU22
OAU101 MON
Shelf1-IU24
Shelf1-IU26
MON
MON
OAU103
ITL
IN
Shelf1-IU35
MCA4 IN1 IN2
TC
TM1
OUT
OUT
OUT
IN3
RC
RM1
IN
IN
IN
IN4
TM
TM2
VO
VO
TO
RM
RM2
VI
VI
RO TE RE
Shelf1-IU4
MON
MON
MON
MON
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
M01
M01
D01
D01
M40
M40
D40
D40
M40E
Receive direction signal
Shelf1-IU14 Shelf1-IU17
Shelf1-IU1
Transmit direction signal
M40O
Optical supervisory signal
D40E
D40O
Optical monitoring signal
4.1.2 1 Degree ROADM This section uses the WSMD4 board as an example to illustrate how to configure a 1-degree 80wavelength ROADM node.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
349
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
4.1.2.1 Signal Flow A 1-degree ROADM node provides only one optical direction and can be upgraded to multidegree ROADM nodes without interrupting services to provide multiple optical directions. The 1-degree ROADM node consists of one WSMD4. In the receive direction: l
The optical supervisory signals and the main path optical signals are separated from the line signals received from west. The optical supervisory signals are sent to the optical supervisory unit for processing, and the main-path optical signals are sent to the WSMD4 board after being amplified.
l
The main-path optical signal from the west WSMD4 board is sent to the ITL board and is then split into two multiplexed wavelength signals (odd wavelength and even wavelength) in the C-band with frequency spacing of 100 GHz. Then the two optical signals are locally dropped through two demultiplexer boards.
The signal flow of the transmit direction is the reverse of this process. Figure 4-4 shows the signal flow of 1-degree ROADM. Figure 4-4 Signal flow of a 1-degree ROADM in an 80-wavelength system
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
350
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
4.1.2.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the typical configurations for the optical layer of a 1-degree 80wavelength ROADM node that uses one WSMD4 board.
Configuration Principle Reconfigurable optical add and drop multiplexing unit: l
One WSMD2 board, or WSMD4 board, or one combination of WSD9+WSM9 board, or one combination of RDU9+WSM9 board, or one WSMD9 board must be used.
l
If the node needs to be upgraded to a 2-, 3-, or 4-degree node, the WSMD4 boards are recommended.
l
If the node needs to be upgraded to more than four degrees, the combinations of RDU9 +WSM9 boards or combinations of WSD9+WSM9 boards or the WSMD9 boards are recommended.
Optical multiplexer unit and demultiplexer unit: l
For an 80-wavelength ROADM node, ITL boards must be configured if the M40V/M40/ D40 boards are used for adding/dropping wavelengths.
Optical amplifier unit: l
Optical amplifier boards must be configured according to the power budget for actual situations.
l
When WSDM4/WSMD9 boards are used, it is recommended that optical amplifier boards be configured in wavelength-dropping directions.
l
If optical amplifier boards need to be used in wavelength-adding directions, low-power optical amplifiers are recommended.
Spectrum analyzer unit: l
When WMU and MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an ROADM node, configure WMU boards prior to MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards.
l
When only MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an ROADM node, the MCA4 boards are most preferred.
l
It is preferred to connect an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board to the MON port on an optical amplifier board or the MON port on an FIU board.
l
Automatic deployment: – MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards must be configured for automatic deployment. If OSNR detection for 10 Gbit/s rates is not required, the OPM8 boards are most preferred. – An MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured for remote power commissioning and must be connected to the MON port on the OA board that is connected to an FIU board. – When there are five or more fiber spans between two power equalization site, an MCA4/ MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured in the middle of the spans (spans/2±0.5), both in the transmit and receive directions. – When there are four or fewer fiber spans between two power equalization site, an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured at the transmit end.
Optical supervisory channel unit: Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
351
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
4 Node Configurations
The optical supervisory unit is required in each direction of an ROADM node. For a 1degree ROADM node, one SC1 board can be configured.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configurations for the optical layer of a 1-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node that uses one WSMD4 board. As shown in Figure 4-5, one subrackis required. Figure 4-5 Typical configurations for the optical layer of a 1-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node
A S S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE X G G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
O A F S U I C 1 U 1 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
W S M D 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
O B S U C 1 C 0 1
O B I U T 1 L 0 4
M C A 4
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
S C C
D 4 0 E
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
4.1.2.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of a 1-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node. Figure 4-6 shows the subrack fiber connections for the optical layer of a 1-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
352
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-6 Subrack fiber connections for a 1-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node
Shelf1-IU20 Shelf1-IU21
FIU
SC1
Shelf1-IU22
Shelf1-IU24
MON
MON
OAU101
OUT
OAU103
TC
WSMD4 MONO
Shelf1-IU29
Shelf1-IU30
Shelf1-IU31
MON
MON
MON
IN3 IN4
OBU101
OBU104
ITL
MONI
IN
RC
Shelf1-IU26
TM
OUT
OUT
OUT
RM
IN
IN
IN DM1
VO
VO
AM1 DM2
TM
VI
VI
RM
Shelf1-IU35
MCA4 IN1 IN2
OUT
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
IN
VO
VO
TO
VI
RO
VI
AM2
TE
DM3
RE
AM3 DM4 AM4
Shelf1-IU1
Shelf1-IU4
MON
MON
MON
MON
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
M01
M01
D01
D01
M40
M40
D40
D40
M40E
Receive direction signal
Transmit direction signal
Optical supervisory signal
M40O
Shelf1-IU14 Shelf1-IU17
D40E
D40O
Optical monitoring signal
4.1.3 2 Degree ROADM This section uses the WSMD4 board as an example to illustrate how to configure a 2-degree 80wavelength ROADM node.
4.1.3.1 Signal Flow A 2-degree ROADM node provides two optical directions and can be upgraded to multi-degree ROADM nodes without interrupting services to provide multiple optical directions. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
353
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
The 2-degree ROADM node consists of two WSMD4 boards (west, east) with the same signal grooming. The signal grooming of the west WSMD4 board is used as an example. In the receive direction: l
The optical supervisory signals and the main-path optical signals are separated from the line signals received from west. The optical supervisory signals are sent to the optical supervisory unit for processing, and the main-path optical signals are sent to the WSMD4 board after being amplified.
l
The west WSMD4 board splits the main-path optical signals into two equal optical signals. – One optical signal is sent to the ITL board and split into two multiplexed wavelength signals (odd wavelength and even wavelength) with frequency spacing of 100 GHz. Then the two optical signals are locally dropped through two demultiplexer boards. – The other optical signal passes through the east WSMD4 board.
The signal flow of the transmit direction is the reverse of this process. Figure 4-7 shows the signal flow of a 2-degree ROADM. Figure 4-7 Signal flow of a 2-degree ROADM in an 80-Wavelength system
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
354
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
4.1.3.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the principles for configuring a 2-degree 80-channel ROADM node and the typical configurations of the equipment.
Configuration Principle Reconfigurable optical add and drop multiplexing unit: l
Two WSMD2 board, or two WSMD4 board, or two combinations of WSD9+WSM9 boards, or two combinations of RDU9+WSM9 boards, or two WSMD9 boards must be used.
l
If the node needs to be upgraded to a 3- or 4-degree node, the WSMD4 boards are recommended.
l
If the node needs to be upgraded to more than four degrees, the combinations of RDU9 +WSM9 boards or combinations of WSD9+WSM9 boards or the WSMD9 boards are recommended.
Optical multiplexer unit and demultiplexer unit: l
For an 80-wavelength ROADM node, ITL boards must be configured if the M40V/M40/ D40 boards are used for adding/dropping wavelengths.
Optical amplifier unit: l
Optical amplifier boards must be configured according to the power budget for actual situations.
l
When WSDM4/WSMD9 boards are used, it is recommended that you configure optical amplifier boards in wavelength-dropping directions.
l
If optical amplifier boards need to be used in wavelength-adding directions, low-power optical amplifiers are recommended.
Spectrum analyzer unit: l
When WMU and MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an ROADM node, configure WMU boards prior to MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards.
l
When only MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an ROADM node, the MCA4 boards are most preferred.
l
It is preferred to connect an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board to the MON port on an optical amplifier board or the MON port on an FIU board.
l
Automatic deployment: – MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards must be configured for automatic deployment. If OSNR detection for 10 Gbit/s rates is not required, the OPM8 boards are most preferred. – An MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured for remote power commissioning and must be connected to the MON port on the OA board that is connected to an FIU board. – When there are five or more fiber spans between two power equalization site, an MCA4/ MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured in the middle of the spans (spans/2±0.5), both in the transmit and receive directions. – When there are four or fewer fiber spans between two power equalization site, an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured at the transmit end.
Optical supervisory channel unit: Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
355
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
4 Node Configurations
The optical supervisory unit is required in each direction of an ROADM node. For a 2degree ROADM node, two SC1 or one SC2 boards can be configured.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configurations for the optical layer of a 2-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node that uses two WSMD4 boards. As shown in Figure 4-8, two subracks are required. Figure 4-8 Typical configurations for the optical layer of a 2-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node West
East
S A S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE G X G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
S A S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE G X G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
O A F S U I C 1 U 2 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
W S M D 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
O B S U C 1 C 0 1
O B I U T 1 L 0 4
M C A 4
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
D 4 0 E
S C C
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
O A F S U I C 1 U 1 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
W S M D 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
O B S U C 1 C 0 1
O B I U T 1 L 0 4
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
S C C
D 4 0 E
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
4.1.3.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of a 2-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node. Figure 4-9 shows the subrack fiber connections for the optical layer of a 2-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
356
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-9 Subrack fiber connections for a 2-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node
Shelf1-IU20 Shelf1-IU21
FIU
SC2
Shelf1-IU22
Shelf1-IU24
MON
MON
OAU101
OUT
OAU103
Shelf1-IU26
WSMD4 MONO
TM1
OUT
OUT
OUT
RC
RM1
IN
IN
IN DM1
TM
TM2
VO
VO
AM1 DM2
RM
Shelf1-IU30
Shelf1-IU31
MON
MON
MON
IN3 IN4
OBU101
OBU104
ITL
MONI
IN TC
Shelf1-IU29
RM2
VI
VI
Shelf1-IU35
MCA4 IN1 IN2
OUT
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
IN
VO
VO
TO
VI
RO
VI
AM2
TE
DM3
RE
AM3 DM4 AM4
Shelf1-IU1
Shelf1-IU4
MON
MON
MON
MON
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
M01
M01
D01
D01
M40
M40
D40
D40
M40E
Receive direction signal
Transmit direction signal
Optical supervisory signal
M40O
Shelf2-IU14 Shelf2-IU17
D40E
D40O
Optical monitoring signal
4.1.4 3 Degree ROADM This section uses the WSMD4 board as an example to illustrate how to configure a 3-degree 80wavelength ROADM node.
4.1.4.1 Signal Flow A 3-degree ROADM node provides three optical direction and can be upgraded to multi-degree ROADM nodes without interrupting services to provide multiple optical directions. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
357
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
The 3-degree ROADM node consists of three WSMD4 boards (west, east, south) with the same signal grooming. The signal grooming of the west WSMD4 board is used as an example. In the receive direction: l
The optical supervisory signals and the main path optical signals are separated from the line signals received from west. The optical supervisory signals are sent to the optical supervisory unit for processing, and the main path optical signals are sent to the west WSMD4 board after being amplified.
l
The west WSMD4 board splits the main-path optical signals into three equal optical signals. – One optical signal is sent to the ITL board and split into two multiplexed wavelength signals (one odd and one even wavelength) with frequency spacing of 100 GHz. Then the two optical signals are locally dropped through two demultiplexer boards. – The other two optical signals each pass through the east and south WSMD4 boards each.
The signal flow of the transmit direction is the reverse of this process. Figure 4-10 shows the signal flow of 3-degree ROADM.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
358
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-10 Signal flow of a 3-degree ROADM in an 80-wavelength system
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
359
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
4.1.4.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the principles for configuring a 3-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node and the typical configurations of the equipment.
Configuration Principle Reconfigurable optical add and drop multiplexing unit: l
Three WSMD4 boards, or three combinations of WSD9+WSM9 boards, or three combinations of RDU9+WSM9 boards, or three WSMD9 boards must be used.
l
If the node needs to be upgraded to four degrees, the WSMD4 boards are recommended.
l
If the node needs to be upgraded to more than four degrees, the combinations of RDU9 +WSM9 boards or combinations of WSD9+WSM9 boards or the WSMD9 boards are recommended.
Optical multiplexer unit and demultiplexer unit: l
For an 80-wavelength ROADM node, ITL boards must be configured if the M40V/M40/ D40 boards are used for adding/dropping wavelengths.
Optical amplifier unit: l
Optical amplifier boards must be configured according to the power budget for actual situations.
l
When WSDM4/WSMD9 boards are used, it is recommended that you configure optical amplifier boards in wavelength-dropping directions.
l
If optical amplifier boards need to be used in wavelength-adding directions, low-power optical amplifiers are recommended.
Spectrum analyzer unit: l
When WMU and MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an ROADM node, configure WMU boards prior to MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards.
l
When only MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an ROADM node, the MCA8/ OPM8 boards are most preferred.
l
It is preferred to connect an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board to the MON port on an optical amplifier board or the MON port on an FIU board.
l
Automatic deployment: – MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards must be configured for automatic deployment. If OSNR detection for 10 Gbit/s rates is not required, the OPM8 boards are most preferred. – An MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured for remote power commissioning and must be connected to the MON port on the OA board that is connected to an FIU board. – When there are five or more fiber spans between two power equalization site, an MCA4/ MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured in the middle of the spans (spans/2±0.5), both in the transmit and receive directions. – When there are four or fewer fiber spans between two power equalization site, an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured at the transmit end.
Optical supervisory channel unit: Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
360
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
4 Node Configurations
The optical supervisory unit is required in each direction of an ROADM node. For a 3degree ROADM node, three SC1 or one SC2 plus one SC1 board can be configured.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configurations for the optical layer of a 3-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node that uses three WSMD4 boards. As shown in Figure 4-11, three subracks are required. Figure 4-11 Typical configurations for the optical layer of a 3-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node West
East/South
S A S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE G X G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
S A S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE G X G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
O A F S U I C 1 U 2 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
W S M D 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
O B S U C 1 C 0 1
O B I U T 1 L 0 4
M C A 8
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
D 4 0 E
S C C
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
O A F S U I C 1 U 1 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
W S M D 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
O B S U C 1 C 0 1
O B I U T 1 L 0 4
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
S C C
D 4 0 E
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
4.1.4.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of a 3-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node. Figure 4-12 shows the subrack fiber connections for the optical layer of a 3-degree 80wavelength ROADM node.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
361
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-12 Subrack fiber connections for a 3-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node
Shelf1-IU20 Shelf1-IU21
FIU
SC2
OUT
Shelf1-IU22
Shelf1-IU24
MON
MON
OAU101
OAU103
RC TM RM
WSMD4 MONO
Shelf1-IU29
Shelf1-IU30
Shelf1-IU31
MON
MON
MON
OBU101
OBU104
ITL
MONI
IN TC
Shelf1-IU26
TM1
OUT
RM1
IN
Shelf1-IU35
MCA8 IN1 IN2
OUT
OUT
OUT
OUT
OUT
IN3
IN
IN DM1
IN
IN
IN
IN4
AM1 DM2
VO
VO
TO
IN5
VI
VI
RO
IN6
AM2
TE
IN7
DM3
RE
IN8
TM2
VO
VO
RM2
VI
VI
AM3 DM4 AM4
Shelf1-IU1
Shelf1-IU4
MON
MON
MON
MON
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
M01
M01
D01
D01
M40
M40
D40
D40
M40E
Receive direction signal
Transmit direction signal
Optical supervisory signal
M40O
Shelf1-IU14 Shelf1-IU17
D40E
D40O
Optical monitoring signal
4.1.5 4 Degree ROADM This section uses the WSMD4 board as an example to illustrate how to configure a 4-degree 80wavelength ROADM node.
4.1.5.1 Signal Flow A 4-degree ROADM node provides four optical directions and can be upgraded to a multi-degree ROADM node without interrupting services to provide four optical directions. The 4-degree ROADM node consists of four WSMD4 boards (north, south, east, west) with the same signal grooming. The signal grooming of the west WSMD4 board is used as an example. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
362
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
In the receive direction: l
The optical supervisory signals and the main path optical signals are separated from the line signals received from west. The optical supervisory signals are sent to the optical supervisory unit for processing, and the main path optical signals are sent to the west WSMD4 board after being amplified.
l
The west WSMD4 board splits the main-path optical signals into four equal optical signals. – One optical signal is sent to the ITL board and split into two multiplexed wavelength signals (one odd and one even wavelength) with frequency spacing of 100 GHz. Then the two optical signals are locally dropped through two demultiplexer boards. – The other three optical signals pass through the east, south, and north WSMD4 boards each.
The signal flow of the transmit direction is the reverse of this process. Figure 4-13 shows the signal flow of a 4-degree ROADM.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
363
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-13 Signal flow of a 4-degree ROADM in an 80-wavelength system
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
364
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
4.1.5.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the typical configurations for the optical layer of a 4-degree 80wavelength ROADM node that uses four WSMD4 boards.
Configuration Principle Reconfigurable optical add and drop multiplexing unit: l
Four WSMD4 board, or four combinations of WSD9+WSM9 boards, or four combinations of RDU9+WSM9 boards, or four WSMD9 board must be used.
l
If the node needs to be upgraded to more than four degrees, the combinations of RDU9 +WSM9 boards or combinations of WSD9+WSM9 boards or the WSMD9 boards are recommended.
Optical multiplexer unit and demultiplexer unit: l
For an 80-wavelength ROADM node, ITL boards must be configured if the M40V/M40/ D40 boards are used for adding/dropping wavelengths.
Optical amplifier unit: l
Optical amplifier boards must be configured according to the power budget for actual situations.
l
When WSDM4/WSMD9 boards are used, it is recommended that optical amplifier boards be configured in wavelength-dropping directions.
l
If optical amplifier boards need to be used in wavelength-adding directions, low-power optical amplifiers are recommended.
Spectrum analyzer unit: l
When WMU and MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an ROADM node, configure WMU boards prior to MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards.
l
When only MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an ROADM node, the MCA8 boards are most preferred.
l
It is preferred to connect an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board to the MON port on an optical amplifier board or the MON port on an FIU board.
l
Automatic deployment: – MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards must be configured for automatic deployment. If OSNR detection for 10 Gbit/s rates is not required, the OPM8 boards are most preferred. – An MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured for remote power commissioning and must be connected to the MON port on the OA board that is connected to an FIU board. – When there are five or more fiber spans between two power equalization site, an MCA4/ MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured in the middle of the spans (spans/2±0.5), both in the transmit and receive directions. – When there are four or fewer fiber spans between two power equalization site, an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board must be configured at the transmit end.
Optical supervisory channel unit: Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
365
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
4 Node Configurations
The optical supervisory unit is required in each direction of an ROADM node. For a 4degree ROADM node, four SC1 or two SC2 can be configured.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configurations for the optical layer of a 4-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node that uses four WSMD4 boards. As shown in Figure 4-14, four subracks are required. Figure 4-14 Typical configurations for the optical layer of a 4-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node West
East/South/North
S A S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE G X G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
S A S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE G X G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
O A F S U I C 1 U 2 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
W S M D 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
O B S U C 1 C 0 1
O B I U T 1 L 0 4
M C A 8
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
D 4 0 E
S C C
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
O A F S U I C 1 U 1 2 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
W S M D 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
O B S U C 1 C 0 1
O B I U T 1 L 0 4
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
S C C
D 4 0 E
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
4.1.5.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of a 4-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node. Figure 4-15 uses a westbound 4-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node as an example to illustrate how fibers are connected.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
366
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-15 Subrack fiber connections for a 4-degree 80-wavelength ROADM node
Shelf1-IU20 Shelf1-IU21
FIU
SC2
OUT
Shelf1-IU22
Shelf1-IU24
MON
MON
OAU101
OAU103
RC TM RM
WSMD4 MONO
Shelf1-IU29
Shelf1-IU30
Shelf1-IU31
MON
MON
MON
OBU101
OBU104
ITL
MONI
IN TC
Shelf1-IU26
TM1
OUT
RM1
IN
Shelf1-IU35
MCA8 IN1 IN2
OUT
OUT
OUT
OUT
OUT
IN3
IN
IN DM1
IN
IN
IN
IN4
AM1 DM2
VO
VO
TO
IN5
VI
VI
RO
IN6
AM2
TE
IN7
DM3
RE
IN8
TM2
VO
VO
RM2
VI
VI
AM3 DM4 AM4
Shelf1-IU1
Shelf1-IU4
MON
MON
MON
MON
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
M01
M01
D01
D01
M40
M40
D40
D40
M40E
Receive direction signal
Transmit direction signal
Optical supervisory signal
M40O
Shelf1-IU14 Shelf1-IU17
D40E
D40O
Optical monitoring signal
4.1.6 OLA 4.1.6.1 Signal Flow The DWDM OLA equipment is used for amplification of optical signals from two transmission directions The FIU board separates the optical supervisory signal from the main path optical signals and sends the former to the OSC unit for processing. The main path optical signals are amplified by the amplifier unit and multiplexed with the OSC that has already been processed, and then sent to the line fiber for transmission. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
367
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-16 shows the signal flow of a DWDM OLA node. Figure 4-16 Signal flow of a DWDM OLA node
OA East
West F I U
SC2
F I U
OA
4.1.6.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the typical configurations for the optical layer of an OLA node.
Configuration Principle Optical amplifier unit: l
Optical amplifier boards must be configured according to the power budget for actual situations.
Spectrum analyzer unit: l
When only MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an OLA node, the MCA4 boards are most preferred.
l
It is preferred to connect an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board to the MON port on an optical amplifier board or the MON port on an FIU board.
Optical supervisory channel unit: l
For an OLA node, two SC1 or one SC2 can be configured.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configurations for the optical layer of an OLA node. As shown in Figure 4-17, one subrack is required.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
368
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-17 Typical configurations for the optical layer of an OLA node
A S S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE X G G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
F I U
S C C
2021222324 2526 27 9
F I U
M S 4 C 0 2 E
O O A MA U 4U 1 01 0 O0 1 3
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
M S F C C I A C U 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
4.1.6.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of an OLA node. Figure 4-18 shows the subrack fiber connections for the optical layer of an OLA node.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
369
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-18 Subrack fiber connections for an OLA node Shelf1-IU1
FIU
Shelf1-IU2
SC2
OUT
Shelf1-IU3
Shelf1-IU5
MON
MON
OAU101
OAU103
Shelf1-IU12
IN TC RC TM
MCA4
OUT
IN1
IN
IN2
OUT
OUT
TC
IN3
RM1
IN
IN
RC
IN4
VO
VO
TM
VI
VI
RM
RM2
Receive direction signal
Shelf1-IU13
TM1
TM2
RM
FIU
Transmit direction signal
Optical supervisory signal
Optical monitoring signal
4.1.7 Regenerator 4.1.7.1 Signal Flow We have already discussed that the OLA can extend the optical transmission distance without regeneration. However, when the distance is longer, such factors as dispersion, optical noise, non-linear effect, or PMD will affect the transmission performance. In this case, we need to regenerate the original signals. An REG implements the 3R function: reshaping, re-timing and regenerating. This is to improve the signal quality and to extend the transmission distance. The signal flow of the REG is similar to that of back-to-back OTMs, except that no signal is added or dropped. Signals are regenerated through the OTU or line unit. In the receive direction: l
It separates the optical supervisory signals and the main path optical signals from the received line signals. The optical supervisory signals are sent to the OSC unit for processing.
l
The main path signals are sent to the demultiplexer after being amplified. The demultiplexed signals enter the OTU or line unit and are reshaped, re-timed, and regenerated. Then the wavelengths are multiplexed by the multiplexer before the optical amplification. Finally, the signals are multiplexed with the processed optical supervisory signals for line transmission.
The signal flow of the transmit direction is the reverse of this process. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
370
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-19 shows the signal flow of 80-wavelength REG node. OTU, TOM, and line boards can be used as regeneration units. OTU boards are classified into two types: OTU with the regeneration function (LSXLR and LSXR) and OTU without the regeneration function (for example, LOM and TMX). Two OTU boards that do not have the regeneration function can be cascaded to provide the regeneration function. Similarly, line boards are also classified into two types: line board with the regeneration function and line board without the regeneration function. Two line boards that do not have the regeneration function can be cascaded to provide the regeneration function. Figure 4-19 Signal flow of an 80-wavelength REG node
l 01 OD C-EVEN
ln
OM C-EVEN
l 01
OA West
OM C-EVEN F I U
I T L
ln
OA
I T L
l 01 OD C-ODD
OA
ln
Pass-through signal
ln
F I U
OM C-ODD OA
l 01 OM C-ODD
East
OD C-EVEN
OD C-ODD
Regeneration unit
4.1.7.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the principles for configuring an 80-wavelength REG node and the typical configurations of the equipment.
Configuration Principle Optical multiplexer unit and demultiplexer unit: l
For an 80-wavelength REG node, ITL boards must be configured if the M40V/M40/D40 boards are used for adding/dropping wavelengths.
Optical amplifier unit: l
Optical amplifier boards must be configured according to the power budget for actual situations.
Spectrum analyzer unit: l
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
When WMU and MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an OTM node, configure WMU boards prior to MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
371
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
l
When only MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 boards are required for an REG node, the MCA4 boards are most preferred.
l
It is preferred to connect an MCA4/MCA8/OPM8 board to the MON port on an optical amplifier board or the MON port on an FIU board.
Optical supervisory channel unit: l
For an 80-wavelength REG node, two SC1 boards or one SC2 board can be configured.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configuration. As shown in Figure 4-20, two subracks are required. Figure 4-20 Typical configurations for the optical layer of an 80-wavelength REG node West
East
A S S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE X G G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
A S S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE X G G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
O A F S U I C 1 U 2 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
I T L
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
M C A 4
S C C
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
D 4 0 E
S C C
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
O A F S U I C 1 U 1 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
I T L
2021222324 2526 27 9
M 4 0 E
M 4 0 O
S C C
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
S C C
D 4 0 E
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
4.1.7.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of an 80-wavelength REG node. Figure 4-21 uses a westbound 80-wavelength REG node as an example to illustrate how fibers are connected. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
372
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-21 Subrack fiber connections for an 80-wavelength REG node Shelf1-IU20 Shelf1-IU21
FIU
SC2
OUT
Shelf1-IU22
OAU101 MON
Shelf1-IU24
Shelf1-IU26
MON
MON
OAU103
ITL
IN
Shelf1-IU35
MCA4 IN1 IN2
TC
TM1
RC
RM1
TM
TM2
RM
RM2
OUT
OUT
IN3
IN
IN
IN
IN4
VO
VO
TO
VI
VI
RO
OUT
TE RE
Shelf1-IU4
MON
MON
MON
MON
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
M01
M01
D01
D01
M40
M40
D40
D40
M40E
Receive direction signal
Shelf1-IU14 Shelf1-IU17
Shelf1-IU1
Transmit direction signal
M40O
Optical supervisory signal
D40E
D40O
Optical monitoring signal
4.1.8 FOADM
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
373
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
4.1.8.1 Signal Flow The DWDM FOADM node is responsible for processing the optical signals in two transmission directions. An FOADM node consists of two MR4s. In the receive direction: l
The FIUboard separates the optical supervisory signal from the main path optical signals and sends the former to the SC2 board for processing.
l
Main path signals are sent to the MR4 after amplification. Certain wavelengths are dropped to the local station.
l
The other wavelengths pass through and are multiplexed with the locally added wavelengths before the optical amplification.
l
Finally, the signals are multiplexed with the processed optical supervisory signals for line transmission.
The signal flow of the transmit direction is the reverse of this process. Figure 4-22 shows the signal flow of an FOADM node. Figure 4-22 Signal flow of an FOADM node
4.1.8.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the principles for configuring a FOADM node and the typical configurations for the optical layer of a FOADM node.
Configuration Principle Optical Add and Drop Multiplexing Unit: Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
374
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
4 Node Configurations
If a DMR1 board is used, and the transmission distance is short, the FIU board cannot be used.
Optical amplifier unit: l
If a DMR1 board is used, optical amplifier units cannot be used on the line.
l
If DMR1 board is not used, the optical amplifier boards must be configured according to the power budget for actual situations.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configuration. As shown in Figure 4-23, two subracks are required. Figure 4-23 Typical configurations for the optical layer of an FOADM node West
East
A S S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE X G G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
A S S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE X G G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
O A F S U I C 1 U 2 0 1
O A U 1 0 3
M R 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
M F S 4 I C 0 U 2 E
O O A MA U 4U 1 01 0 O0 1 3
M R 4
O A F S U I C 1 U 1 0 1
S C C
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
D 4 0 E
S C C
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
O A U 1 0 3
M R 4
2021222324 2526 27 9
O O M A MA F 4 U 4U I 0 1 01 U E 0 O0 1 3
M R 4
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
S C C
D 4 0 E
D 4 0 O
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
4.1.8.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of a FOADM node. Figure 4-24 uses a westbound FOADM node as an example to illustrate how fibers are connected. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
375
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-24 Subrack fiber connections for a FOADM node
Shelf1-IU1
FIU
Shelf1-IU2
SC2
OUT
Shelf1-IU3
Shelf1-IU5
MON
MON
OAU101
OBU101
IN
Shelf1-IU6
MR4
OUT IN
TC
TM1
OUT
OUT
MO
RC
RM1
IN
IN
TM
TM2
VO
VO
MI D1
RM2
VI
VI
RM
A1 D2 A2 D3 A3 D4 A4
Receive direction signal
Transmit direction signal
Optical supervisory signal
4.1.9 CWDM 4.1.9.1 Signal Flow An 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node is used to process the optical signals in two transmission directions. It receives line signals and sends the signals to the CMR4 board, where some wavelengths are dropped to the OTUs and then to the client side equipment. Other wavelengths pass through the CMR4 board and are multiplexed with the wavelengths added locally. Then, the multiplexed wavelengths are sent to the line for transmission. Figure 4-25 shows the signal flow of an 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
376
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-25 Signal flow of an 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node
4.1.9.2 Subrack Layout This section describes the typical configurations of an 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node.
Typical Configuration This section uses the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 as an example to illustrate the typical configurations of an 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node. As shown in Figure 4-26, one subrack is required.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
377
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-26 Typical configurations for the optical layer of an 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node
A S S E EFI2 FI PIU PIU U T T PIU PIU STI ATE X G G 1 37 38 39 40 41424344 45 46 47 48
S C C
F I U
2021222324 2526 27 9
CM C M 4M R 0R 4 E4
1 2829 3031323334 3536 0
S C C
M C A 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 111213 141516171819
4.1.9.3 Subrack Connections This section describes how to connect fibers for optical subracks of an 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node. Figure 4-27 shows the subrack fiber connections for the optical layer of an 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
378
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
Figure 4-27 Subrack fiber connections for an 8-wavelength CWDM FOADM node
Shelf1-IU1
CMR4
Shelf1-IU2
CMR4
OUT
OUT
IN
IN
MO MI D1
MO MI D1
A1 D2
A1 D2
A2
A2
D3
D3
A3
A3
D4
D4
A4
A4
Receive direction signal
Transmit direction signal
4.2 OCS Typical Configuration ADM The architecture of the add-drop multiplexer (ADM) is similar to the combination of two backto-back TMs, as shown in Figure 4-28. Figure 4-28 Functional block diagram of an ADM used in the OptiX OSN 8800 STM-16/64
STM-16/64
low-rate SDH signals
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
379
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4 Node Configurations
MADM The multiple add/drop multiplexer (MADM) is a core unit required for building a complex network. Figure 4-29 shows the functional block diagram of an MADM. The OptiX OSN 8800 can be configured as an MADM combined with ADMs at a rate ranging from STM-1 to STM-64. Figure 4-29 Functional block diagram of the OptiX OSN 8800 configured as an MADM ...
STM-16/64
low-rate SDH signals
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
380
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
5
5 Quick Installation Guide
Quick Installation Guide
For detailed installation procedures of OptiX OSN 8800 T64, refer to OptiX OSN 8800 T64 Quick Installation Guide For detailed installation procedures of OptiX OSN 8800 T32, refer to OptiX OSN 8800 T32 Quick Installation Guide For detailed installation procedures of OptiX OSN 8800 T16, refer to OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Quick Installation Guide For detailed installation procedures of OptiX OSN 6800, refer to OptiX OSN 6800 Quick Installation Guide For detailed installation procedures of OptiX OSN 3800, refer to OptiX OSN 3800 Quick Installation Guide
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
381
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
About This Chapter Initial commissioning must be conducted using the Web LCT because NEs cannot be managed in the network management center (NMC) before initial commissioning is completed. During initial commissioning, NEs must be connected and configured onsite, so that the U2000 can remotely manage these NEs. 6.1 Initial Commissioning Flow Some initial commissioning operations are optional and can be performed when required. 6.2 Connecting NEs to the Web LCT Before performing initial commissioning on an NE, install the Web LCT on a computer, directly connect the computer to the NE using a crossover cable, and log in to the Web LCT. 6.3 Configuring NE Attributes Configure NE attributes using the Web LCT. 6.4 Checking Board Slots Verify that the logical boards displayed on the Web LCT, physical boards inserted into the equipment, and boards specified in the network plan are consistent so future operations can be effectively performed. 6.5 Configuring the TN11TOM Board On-site If there is no OSC channel on an NE and the TN11TOM board is required to provide an ESC channel, this operation must be performed. The U2000 can remotely manage the NE and its connected NEs after the TN11TOM board is configured. 6.6 Configuring the TN52TOM Board On-site If there is no OSC channel on an NE and the TN52TOM board is required to provide an ESC channel, this operation must be performed. The U2000 can remotely manage the NE and its connected NEs after the TN52TOM board is configured. 6.7 Configuring the OA Boards Set optical attenuation and nominal gain for optical amplifier boards, with assistance from the engineers in the network management center (NMC). 6.8 Checking NE Communication Status Correct configuration of each NE is the basis for the entire network to operate properly. This section describes how to check whether the configuration of each NE is correct. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
382
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
6.9 Backing Up the NE Database to the SCC Board By backing up an NE database to an SCC board, you can ensure that the NE automatically restores to the normal state in case a power failure occurs. When you back up an NE database to an SCC board, you actually back up the NE data to the flash memory of the SCC board. After a power-off reset occurs on the NE, the SCC board automatically reads the configuration data from the flash memory and applies the data to the boards on this NE. 6.10 Exiting the Web LCT After performing initial NE commissioning using the Web LCT, log out of the commissioned NE, reconnect the network cables to the NE, and exit the Web LCT.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
383
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
6.1 Initial Commissioning Flow Some initial commissioning operations are optional and can be performed when required. Figure 6-1 shows the flow for conducting initial commissioning using the Web LCT. Figure 6-1 Initial commissioning flow
Connecting NEs to the Web LCT Configuring NE Attributes
Checking Board Slots
Configuring the TN11TOM/TN52TOM Board Onsite Configuring the OA Boards Checking NE Communication Status Backing Up the NE Database to the SCC Board Mandatory Exiting the Web LCT
Optional
Optional Operations l
Configure the TN11TOM or TN52TOM board onsite. If there is no OSC channel on an NE and the TN11TOM or TN52TOM board is required to provide an ESC channel, this operation must be performed. The U2000 can remotely manage the NE and its connected NEs after the TN11TOM or TN52TOM board is configured.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
384
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
Only the TOM board needs to be configured to provide an ESC channel.
Figure 6-2 shows an application scenario in which the TOM board provides an ESC channel. Figure 6-2 Application scenario in which the TOM board provides an ESC channel
Site A
NMS WDM side Site B
Client side
OTU1
TOM
WDM side
M U X / OTU1 D M U X
M U X / D OTU1 M U X
Client side
TOM
Site C
OTU1
WDM-side ESC channel Client-side ESC channel
SCC
Client-side ESC channel
– The TN11TOM or TN52TOM board provides an ESC channel only when it receives OTU1 signals on the client side or transmits OTU1 signals on the WDM side. Similarly, an ESC channel (on the client or WDM side) is available after cross-connections for OTU1 signals are configured. – Client-side ESC channel: When the TN11TOM or TN52TOM board receives OTU1 signals on the client side, the client-side ESC channel is available after client-side OTU1 cross-connections are configured. – WDM-side ESC channel: When the TN11TOM or TN52TOM board transmits OTU1 signals on the WDM side, the WDM-side ESC channel is available after WDM-side OTU1 cross-connections are configured. – In OTU1 regeneration scenarios, the ESC channel on either the client or WDM side is required. l
Configure the OA boards. If NEs are unreachable by the U2000 and optical power must be set for optical amplifier (OA) boards, connect the Web LCT to the NEs onsite and perform this operation.
6.2 Connecting NEs to the Web LCT Before performing initial commissioning on an NE, install the Web LCT on a computer, directly connect the computer to the NE using a crossover cable, and log in to the Web LCT.
6.2.1 Installing the Web LCT You can install the Web LCT using a CD or DVD, or by copying and decompressing the software package that contains the Web LCT. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
385
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Installing the Web LCT by Copying and Decompressing the Software Package 1.
Obtain the software package that contains the Web LCT from Huawei engineers.
2.
Decompress the installation software package that includes U2000WebLCTversion_en_win32_x86.zip. NOTE
The version indicates the detailed version number of the Web LCT. Ensure that the decompressing directory contains no spaces, punctuation, or non-alphabetic characters.
Installing the Web LCT Using a CD or DVD 1.
Insert the installation CD or DVD.
2.
Run the setup.exe file.
3.
Select the language version for Wizard, and click Next.
4.
Click Next.
5.
Select I accept the terms of the license agreement, and click Next.
6.
Select the installation directory, and click Next. NOTE
When you click Browse to select a different installation folder, ensure that the destination path does not contain spaces or punctuation.
7.
The following dialog box is displayed. Select the features you want to install based on the following NOTE. Click Next.
NOTE
When you select the features to be installed, COMMON must be selected and other features can be selected based on the managed equipment. l For OTN equipment using the North American version only, select NA OTN. l For OTN equipment using the global version only, select NG WDM. l It is recommended that all the features are selected.
8. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click Install to install the Web LCT. The entire installation process lasts five minutes. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
386
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
9.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
After the installation is complete, the Installation finished dialog box is displayed. Click Finish.
6.2.2 Connecting to NEs Connect the computer where the Web LCT is installed to an NE using a crossover or straightthrough cable so the Web LCT can directly manage the connected NE.
Procedure Step 1 Connect the crossover or straight-through cable to the Web LCT. One end of the cable should be connected to the network port of the computer. For the specific ports and boards to be connected, see Table 6-1. Table 6-1 Specific port on a board Product
Board Name
Port
OptiX OSN 8800 T64, OptiX OSN 8800 T32
EFI2
NM_ETH1
EFI1
NM_ETH2
OptiX OSN 8800 T16
EFI
NM_ETH1 or NM_ETH2
OptiX OSN 6800, and OptiX OSN 3800
AUX
NM_ETH1 or NM_ETH2
Step 2 Check the green indicator of the network adapter interface of the computer and the indicators on the board that connect to the computer. NOTE
The indicator of the computer and the green "LINK" indicator on the board remain on. The orange "ACT" indicator on the board should blink. If the three indicators are malfunctioning: l Replace the network cable with a new one. If the indicators are functioning correctly, the original cable is faulty. l If all the above-mentioned indicators are still malfunctioning, check whether the network adapter of the computer and the board that connects to the network cable are functioning correctly.
Step 3 Change the IP address of the computer being used to commission the NE so that the computer IP address is on the same subnet as the default IP Address of the NE. NOTE
l The default IP address of an NE ranges from 129.9.0.0 to 129.9.0.255 or from 129.9.191.0 to 129.9.191.255. l Change the computer IP address that is in the same network segment as the NE, for example, 129.9.0.N, where N is an integer from 1 to 255. l Change the computer subnet mask to 255.255.255.0.
----End
6.2.3 Logging In to the Web LCT Log in to the Web LCT before performing NE settings on the Web LCT. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
387
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Procedure Step 1 Double-click the startweblct.bat file at "WebLCT\WebLCT\Tomcat" to launch the Web LCT application. Step 2 In the browser, enter the default value admin for User Name and Changeme_123 for Password.
Step 3 Enter the Verification Code according to the picture that is displayed on the right side. Step 4 Click Login to display the NE List window. ----End
6.3 Configuring NE Attributes Configure NE attributes using the Web LCT.
6.3.1 Searching and Adding NEs Search and add NEs by IP addresses or IP domains.
Procedure Step 1 Click NE Search and select Advanced Search at the bottom of the Screen. A Search NE window opens.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
388
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Step 2 Click Manage Domain. A Manage Domain Search window opens. Step 3 Click Add and the New Domain window is displayed. Step 4 Set Domain Type to GNE IP Domain or GNE IP Address, and enter an IP address in the Domain Address field. Click OK.
Attribute
Value
Domain Type
l GNE IP Domain: Search for all NEs in the specified IP domain. l GNE IP Address: Search for a specific NE using the specified IP address.
Domain Address l If Domain Type is set to GNE IP Domain, enter an IP domain value, for example, 10.191.255.255. l If Domain Type is set to GNE IP Address, enter an IP address, for example, 10.191.167.131. Step 5 Click Cancel to exit the Manage Domain Search window. Step 6 Select the entered NE IP Address in the Domain drop-down list on the Search NE window. Step 7 Click Search. After the search for NEs is complete, click End Search. Step 8 Select the NE being commissioned and click Add NE. Step 9 Click OK then Cancel. ----End
Result The NE to be commissioned is now in the list of NEs on the main Web LCT screen, and the login status is Not Logged In or Logged In. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
389
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
6.3.2 Logging In to an NE Log in to an NE that has been added if the NE indicates "Not Logged In".
Procedure Step 1 Highlight the NE in the main Web LCT screen and click NE Login. Enter the default value lct for User Name, and password for Password. Step 2 Click OK. The login status is Logged In. Step 3 Click NE Explorer to display the NE Explorer of the selected NE. ----End
6.3.3 Setting NE ID The ID of NEs that are searched out and added are still factory defaults, which may be different from the planned ID. The ID of NEs must be set according to the engineering design document so that commissioning engineers can perform operations on the NEs using the NMS at the network management center.
Procedure Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > NE Attribute from the Function Tree. Step 2 Click Modify NE ID. In the Modify NE ID dialog box that is displayed, enter values in the New ID and New Extended ID fields, and then click OK. Step 3 A Warning dialog box is displayed, click Yes. A dialog box indicating that the operation is successful is displayed, click Close to complete changing the NE ID. At this time, the NE is unreachable. ----End
6.3.4 Setting NE IP Addresses The IP addresses of NEs that are searched out and added are factory defaults, which may be different from the planned IP addresses. The IP addresses of NEs must be set according to the engineering design document so that commissioning engineers can perform operations on the NEs using the NMS at the network management center.
Procedure Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree. Step 2 Enter the IP Address, Gateway IP Address and Subnet Mask of the NE. Step 3 Click Apply. Click OK in the two displayed Confirm dialog boxes. Then click Close in the displayed Operation Result dialog box. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
390
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
You will lose your connection to the NE at this point. To restore communications, perform the following: l Change the IP address of your computer to an address on the same subnet as the NE. l Re-run 6.3.1 Searching and Adding NEs and 6.3.2 Logging In to an NE.
----End
6.3.5 Configuring Master-Slave Subracks This operation applies to versions earlier than V100R005C00SPC900 in which slave subracks must be manually added. If the equipment version is V100R005C00SPC900 or later, this operation is not required. Instead, the master and slave subrack configurations are automatically uploaded when you search and add NEs.
Background Information The OptiX OSN 8800/6800 supports the management of master/slave subracks. When multiple subracks are required for an NE, the master/slave subrack mode must be used for centralized management. In this mode, the master subrack and its slave subracks are displayed as one NE in the network management system. They share the same NE ID and IP address.
Procedure Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select a NE and the Slot Layout is displayed. Step 2 Select a subrack on the top of the Slot Layout, right-click, and choose Add Slave Subrack from the shortcut menu. The Add Slave Subrack dialog box is displayed.
Step 3 Set Shelf Type, Shelf Name, and Subrack FIC in the Add Slave Subrack dialog box. Click OK. NOTE
l The subrack FIC is the physical location of the NE in the rack. Set the location information of the shelf. The recommended format is Floor-Room-Aisle-Open rack-shelf. l For the OptiX OSN 8800, the following table lists the values for Cross-Connect Type and CrossConnect Capacity.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Parameter
Value
Cross-Connect Type
OTN
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
391
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Parameter
Value
Cross-Connect Capacity
l OptiX OSN 8800 T16: 0G to 640G l OptiX OSN 8800 T32: 0G to 1.28T l OptiX OSN 8800 T64: 0G to 2.56T
Step 4 Click Close in the Operation Result dialog box. ----End
6.4 Checking Board Slots Verify that the logical boards displayed on the Web LCT, physical boards inserted into the equipment, and boards specified in the network plan are consistent so future operations can be effectively performed.
Procedure Step 1 Check whether the logical boards and physical boards are consistent. l
If yes, go to the next step.
l
If no, check as follows: – If the number of logical boards is less than the number of physical boards, verify that the physical boards are correctly inserted and add the logical boards. NOTE
If add the CRPC or ROP board, you should click
to display the slots.
1.
In the NE Explorer, select Slot Layout.
2.
Verify that the physical boards are correctly inserted. On the Slot Layout pane, right-click the corresponding logical slot, and select the required board type from the shortcut menu.
. – If the logical board types are inconsistent with the physical board types, delete and readd the logical boards.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
1.
In the NE Explorer, select Slot Layout.
2.
Then right-click the board and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
392
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Right-click the target logical slot and select the required board type from the shortcut menu.
Step 2 Check whether the physical boards and the boards specified in the network plan are consistent. l
If yes, you do not need to perform any other operations.
l
If no, replace the physical boards, and delete and re-add the logical boards on the panel layout.
----End
6.5 Configuring the TN11TOM Board On-site If there is no OSC channel on an NE and the TN11TOM board is required to provide an ESC channel, this operation must be performed. The U2000 can remotely manage the NE and its connected NEs after the TN11TOM board is configured.
6.5.1 Working Mode and Signal Flow Set the working mode for the TN11TOM board according to the network plan and configuration scenarios. Table 6-2 lists the available working modes of the TN11TOM board and the service mapping path for each scenario. Table 6-2 Mappings between the working modes and the service mapping paths Board Working Mode
Scenario No.
Port Working Mode
Mapping Path
Configuration Scenario
Cascading
Scenario 1
N/A
OTU1/Any->ODU1
6.5.2 Scenario 1: ODU1 tributary mode (cascading)
Scenario 2
N/A
OTU1/Any>ODU1->OTU1
6.5.3 Scenario 2: ODU1 tributary-line mode (cascading)
Scenario 3
N/A
OTU1/Any->ODU1
6.5.4 Scenario 3: ODU1 tributary mode (noncascading)
Scenario 4
N/A
Any->ODU1>OTU1
6.5.5 Scenario 4: ODU1 tributary-line mode (non-cascading)
Scenario 5
N/A
OTU1->ODU1>OTU1
6.5.6 Scenario 5: ODU1 tributary-line mode (electrical regeneration board)
Noncascading
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
393
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
6.5.2 Scenario 1: ODU1 tributary mode (cascading) The application scenario in which the TN11TOM board works in cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary mode is defined as scenario 1: cascading ODU1 tributary mode. When the TN11TOM board works in cascading ODU1 tributary mode, intra-board client-side OTU1 cross-connections must be configured so that an ESC channel is available between the NE equipped with the TN11TOM board and its connected NEs.
Application Diagram Figure 6-3 shows the position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system where the TN11TOM board works in cascading ODU1 tributary mode. Figure 6-3 Position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 1: ODU1 tributary mode (cascading)) 1xODU1 1xOTU2 TOM
TOM
1
8
Any
M U X / D M U X
1 N S 2
ODU1
8×Any
N S 2
M U X / D M U X
1×ODU1
1×ODU1
8×Any
FE, GE, FDDI, STM-1, OC-3, DVB-ASI, SDI, STM-16, OC48, ESCON, STM-4, OC-12, FC100, FICON, FC200, FICON Express, HDSDI, OTU1
1xOTU2 1xODU1
8
ODU1
Any
FE, GE, FDDI, STM-1, OC-3, DVB-ASI, SDI, STM-16, OC48, ESCON, STM-4, OC-12, FC100, FICON, FC200, FICON Express, HDSDI, OTU1
OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 6800: N/A OptiX OSN 3800: From/To non-paired slots of the mesh group
Cross-Connection Diagram Create a cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN11TOM board, which is marked (1) in Figure 6-4.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
394
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Figure 6-4 Cross-connection diagram for the TN11TOM board (scenario 1: cascading ODU1 tributary mode)
Other board
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-2 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-3 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-4
Cross-connect module
Client side
WDM side
WDM side 3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1 10(TX8/RX8)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-5 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-6 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-7 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-8
Cross-connect module
2
TOM
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The client side of the TOM board are cross-connected to the WDM side of other boards, which needs to be configured on the NMS
NOTE
A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN11TOM board. Set Board Mode to Cascading mode. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN11TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Board from the drop-down list.
3.
Double-click the Board Mode field and set it to Cascading mode.
4.
Click Apply.
5.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Configure a service mode for the client-side ports on the TN11TOM board. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. 1.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Channel from the drop-down list. Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
2.
Select a client-side port. Double-click the Service Mode field and set it to OTN Mode.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
395
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click Apply.
Step 3 Set the service type to OTU-1 for ClientLP the ports. It is recommended to select the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
2.
Select a ClientLP port. Double-click the Service Type field and set it to OTU-1.
3.
Click Apply.
Step 4 Configure an intra-board client-side cross-connection. Configure an intra-board bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured at steps 3 and 4. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. The following figure shows an example of configuring a bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between the 3 (RX1/TX1) port and the 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1) port.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
396
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.5.3 Scenario 2: ODU1 tributary-line mode (cascading) The application scenario in which the TN11TOM board works in cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary-line mode is defined as scenario 2: cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode. When the TN11TOM board works in cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode, it can receive OTU1 signals on the client side and transmit OTU1 signals on the WDM side. To provide an ESC channel between the local and remote NEs, configure an intra-board client-side OTU1 cross-connection. In other cases, either a WDM-side or a client-side intra-board crossconnection is required to provide an ESC channel.
Application Diagram Figure 6-5 shows two scenarios in which the TN11TOM board works in cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode. Configure the TN11TOM board according to the network plan. l
Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: The TN11TOM board receives a maximum of six services on the client side and the other two client-side ports work as WDM-side ports, which selectively receive services.
l
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: The TN11TOM board receives a maximum of seven services on the client side and the other client-side port works as a WDM-side port, which also receives services.
Figure 6-5 Position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 2: ODU1 tributaryline mode (cascading)) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side:
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
397
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
1xOTU1
1xOTU1
TOM 1 FE, GE, FDDI, STM1, OC-3, STM-4, OC12, STM-16, OC48,ESCON, FC100, FICON, FC200, FICON Express, HD-SDI, DVB-ASI, SDI, OTU1 6
TOM 1
MUX/ DMUX
6×Any
MUX/ DMUX
1×ODU1
MUX/ DMUX
1×OTU1
1×OTU1
1×ODU1
6×Any
MUX/ DMUX
6
FE, GE, FDDI, STM1, OC-3, STM-4, OC12, STM-16, OC48,ESCON, FC100, FICON, FC200, FICON Express, HD-SDI, DVB-ASI, SDI, OTU1
Any
Any
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: 1xOTU1
1xOTU1
TOM
TOM
1
1
FE, GE, FDDI, STM1, OC-3, STM-4, OC12, STM-16, OC48,ESCON, FC100, FICON, FC200, FICON Express, HD-SDI, DVB-ASI, SDI, OTU1
7×Any
MUX/ DMUX
1×OTU1
MUX/ DMUX
1×ODU1
1×OTU1
1×ODU1
7×Any
FE, GE, FDDI, STM1, OC-3, STM-4, OC12, STM-16, OC48,ESCON, FC100, FICON, FC200, FICON Express, HD-SDI, DVB-ASI, SDI, OTU1
7
7
Any
Any
OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot
Cross-Connection Diagram Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1) and WDMside ports on the TN11TOM board, which is marked (2) in Figure 6-6. Figure 6-6 Cross-connection diagram for the TN11TOM board (scenario 2: ODU1 tributaryline mode (cascading)) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: Client side
WDM side 3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-5 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-6 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-7 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-8
Cross-connect module
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1
9(TX7/RX7)-1
3
10(TX8/RX8)-1 2 TOM
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: Client side
WDM side 3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-5 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-6 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-7 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-8
Cross-connect module
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 3
Cross-connect module
2
10(TX8/RX8)-1
TOM
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
398
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
l Only the RX7/TX7 and RX8/TX8 optical ports can be used as WDM-side optical ports. l A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Configuration Process The configuration process for providing a client-side ESC channel differs from that for providing a WDM-side ESC channel. Table 6-3 lists the configuration process. Table 6-3 Configuration process No.
Task
To Provide a ClientSide ESC Channel
To Provide a WDMSide ESC Channel
1
Set the state of the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
2
Configure the working mode for the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
3
Set the port type.
No
Yes
4
Set the service mode.
Yes
No
5
Configure the service type.
Yes
No
6
Configure an intra-board cross-connection.
Yes
Yes
7
Set the state of the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
Remarks: l Yes: This task is required. l No: This task is not required.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN11TOM board. Set Board Mode to Cascading mode. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN11TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Board from the drop-down list.
3.
Double-click the Board Mode field and set it to Cascading mode.
4.
Click Apply.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
399
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
5.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Optional: Set the port type. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a WDM-side ESC channel.
Set an RX/TX port as a WDM-side port according to the network plan. It is recommended to set the type for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. For the application of "dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side", set the type for the port planned to carry the working channel. 1.
Right-click the board in the Slot Layout pane and choose Path View from the shortcut menu.
2.
Right-click the port and choose Delete Port.
3.
Right-click the blank area and choose Add Port. The Add Port dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Type according to the network plan. Click OK to apply the configuration.
Step 3 Optional: Configure a service mode for client-side ports on the TN11TOM board. It is recommended to set a service mode for the client-side port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a client-side ESC channel.
Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN11TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Channel from the drop-down list. Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
3.
Select a client-side port. Double-click the Service Mode field and set it to OTN Mode as shown in the following figure.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
400
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Step 4 Optional: Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to set a service type for the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a client-side ESC channel.
1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
2.
Select a ClientLP port. Double-click the Service Type field and set it to OTU-1 as shown in the following figure.
Step 5 Configure an intra-board cross-connection. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. l To configure a client-side cross-connection, configure a cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 4 and 5. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection.
l To configure a WDM-side cross-connection, configure the cross-connection between an ODU1LP port and the WDM-side port that is specified in step 3. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
401
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.5.4 Scenario 3: ODU1 tributary mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN11TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary mode is defined as scenario 3: non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode. When the TN11TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode, intra-board client-side OTU1 cross-connections must be configured so an ESC channel is available between the NE equipped with the TN11TOM board and its connected NEs.
Application Diagram Figure 6-7 shows the position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system where the TN11TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode. Figure 6-7 Position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 3: ODU1 tributary mode (non-cascading)) 4xODU1
1xOTU2
1xOTU2
4xODU1
TOM
TOM 1
1
1
1 MUX/ DMUX
MUX/ DMUX
4
8
Any
NS2
8×Any
NS2
4×ODU1
4×ODU1
8×Any
FC100, FICON, FE, GE, STM-1, OC-3, STM-4, OC-12, STM-16, OC-48 , FC200, FICON Express, DVB-ASI, ESCON, FDDI, SDI, HD-SDI, OTU1
4
ODU1
8
ODU1
FC100, FICON, FE, GE, STM-1, OC-3, STM-4, OC-12, STM-16, OC-48 , FC200, FICON Express, DVB-ASI, ESCON, FDDI, SDI, HD-SDI, OTU1
Any
OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 6800: N/A OptiX OSN 3800: From/To non-paired slots of the mesh group
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
402
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Cross-Connection Diagram Create a cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN11TOM board, which is marked (1) in Figure 6-8. Figure 6-8 Cross-connection diagram for the TN11TOM board (scenario 3: ODU1 tributary mode (non-cascading))
Other board
Client side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1 10(TX8/RX8)-1
1
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-2 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-3 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-4
Cross-connect module
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-1 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-2 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-2 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-3 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-4 204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)-1 204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)-2
Cross-connect module
WDM side
WDM side
2
TOM
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The client side of the TOM board are cross-connected to the WDM side of other boards, which needs to be configured on the NMS
NOTE
A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN11TOM board. Set Board Mode to Non-cascading mode. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN11TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Board from the drop-down list.
3.
In the Board Mode pane, double-click the Board Mode field and set it to Non-cascading mode.
4.
Click Apply.
5.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Configure a service mode for the client-side ports on the TN11TOM board. It is recommended to set a service mode for the client-side port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
403
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
1.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Channel from the drop-down list. Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
2.
Select a client-side port. Double-click the Service Mode field and set it to OTN Mode as shown in the following figure.
Step 3 Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to set a service type for the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
2.
Select a ClientLP port. Double-click the Service Type field and set it to OTU-1 as shown in the following figure.
Step 4 Configure an intra-board client-side cross-connection. Configure an intra-board bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between a client-side and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 3 and 4. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. The following figure shows an example of configuring a bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between the 3 (RX1/TX1) port and the 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1) port.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
404
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click OK. The created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.5.5 Scenario 4: ODU1 tributary-line mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN11TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary-line mode is defined as scenario 4: non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode. When the TN11TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode, an intra-board WDM-side OTU1 cross-connection must be configured to provide an ESC channel.
Application Diagram Figure 6-9 shows the position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system where the TN11TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode. Figure 6-9 Position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 4: ODU1 tributaryline mode (non-cascading)) 4xOTU1
4xOTU1 TOM
TOM 1
1
1
4×Any
4
MUX/ DMUX
4×ODU1
MUX/ DMUX
1
4×OTU1
4
4×OTU1
4×ODU1
4×Any
FC100, FICON, FE, GE, STM-1, OC-3 , STM-4, OC-12, DVB-ASI, ESCON, FDDI, FC200, FICON Express, SDI, HD-SDI, STM16, OC-48
4
Any
4
FC100, FICON, FE, GE, STM-1, OC-3 , STM-4, OC-12, DVB-ASI, ESCON, FDDI, FC200, FICON Express, SDI, HD-SDI, STM16, OC-48
Any
OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
405
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Cross-Connection Diagram Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal ODU1LP and WDM-side ports on the TN11TOM board, which is marked (2) in Figure 6-10. Figure 6-10 Cross-connection diagram for the TN11TOM board (scenario 4: ODU1 tributaryline mode (non-cascading)) WDM side
Client side 3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)
7(TX5/RX5)-1
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1) 3
202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)
52(ODU1LP2/ODU1LP2)
2
8(TX6/RX6)-1
5(TX3/RX3)-1
203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)
53(ODU1LP3/ODU1LP3)
9(TX7/RX7)-1
6(TX4/RX4)-1
204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)
54(ODU1LP4/ODU1LP4)
10(TX8/RX8)-1
Cross-connect module
TOM
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS
NOTE
l All RX/TX optical ports can be used as WDM-side optical ports. l A cross-connection can be configured between any ODU1LP port and any WDM-side port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN11TOM board. Set Board Mode to Non-cascading mode. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN11TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Board from the drop-down list.
3.
In the Board Mode pane, double-click the Board Mode field and set it to Non-cascading mode.
4.
Click Apply.
5.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Set the port type. Set an RX/TX port as a WDM-side port according to the network plan. It is recommended to set the type for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Right-click the board in the Slot Layout pane, and choose Path View from the shortcut menu.
2.
Right-click the port and choose Delete Port.
3.
Right-click the blank area and choose Add Port. The Add Port dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Type according to the network plan. Click OK to apply the configuration.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
406
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Step 3 Configure an intra-board WDM-side cross-connection. Configure a cross-connection between an ODU1LP port and the WDM-side port that is specified in step 3. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection.
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.5.6 Scenario 5: ODU1 tributary-line mode (electrical regeneration board) When the TN11TOM board works as an electrical regeneration board with its ports working in ODU1 tributary-line mode, it can receive OTU1 signals on the client side and transmit OTU1 signals on the WDM side. To provide an ESC channel between the local and remote NEs, configure an intra-board client-side OTU1 cross-connection. In other cases, either a WDM-side or a client-side intra-board cross-connection is required to provide an ESC channel.
Application Diagram Figure 6-11 shows the position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system where the TN11TOM board works as an electrical regeneration board in ODU1 tributary-line mode. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
407
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Figure 6-11 Position of the TN11TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 5: ODU1 tributaryline mode (electrical regeneration board))
4xOTU1
4xOTU1 TOM
4×OTU1
4×ODU1
4×OTU1
DMUX
4xOTU1
MUX
4xOTU1 TOM
4×OTU1
4×ODU1
4×OTU1
MUX
DMUX
Cross-Connection Diagram l
Create a cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN11TOM board, which is marked (1) in Figure 6-12.
l
Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal ODU1LP and WDM-side ports on the TN11TOM board, which is marked (2) in Figure 6-12.
Figure 6-12 Cross-connection diagram for the TN11TOM board (scenario 5: ODU1 tributaryline mode (electrical regeneration board)) WDM side
Client side 3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1) 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)
7(TX5/RX5)-1
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1) 3
52(ODU1LP2/ODU1LP2)
2
8(TX6/RX6)-1
5(TX3/RX3)-1
203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)
53(ODU1LP3/ODU1LP3)
9(TX7/RX7)-1
6(TX4/RX4)-1
204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)
54(ODU1LP4/ODU1LP4)
10(TX8/RX8)-1
TOM
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
408
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
l All RX/TX optical ports can be used as WDM-side optical ports. l A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port. l A cross-connection can be configured between any ODU1LP port and any WDM-side port.
Configuration Process The configuration process for providing a client-side ESC channel differs from that for providing a WDM-side ESC channel. Table 6-4 lists the configuration process. Table 6-4 Configuration process No.
Task
To Provide a ClientSide ESC Channel
To Provide a WDMSide ESC Channel
1
Set the state of the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
2
Configure the working mode for the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
3
Set the port type.
No
Yes
4
Set the service mode.
Yes
No
5
Configure the service type.
Yes
No
6
Configure an intra-board cross-connection.
Yes
Yes
7
Set the state of the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
Remarks: l Yes: This task is required. l No: This task is not required.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN11TOM board. Set Board Mode to Non-cascading mode. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN11TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Board from the drop-down list.
3.
In the Board Mode pane, double-click the Board Mode field and set it to Non-cascading mode.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
409
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
4.
Click Apply.
5.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Optional: Set the port type. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a WDM-side ESC channel.
Set an RX/TX port as a WDM-side port according to the network plan. It is recommended to set the type for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Right-click the board in the Slot Layout pane and choose Path View from the shortcut menu.
2.
Right-click the port and choose Delete Port.
3.
Right-click the blank area and choose Add Port. The Add Port dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Type according to the network plan. Click OK to apply the configuration.
Step 3 Optional: Configure a service mode for the client-side ports on the TN11TOM board. It is recommended to set a service mode for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a client-side ESC channel.
Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN11TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Channel from the drop-down list. Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
3.
Select a client-side port. Double-click the Service Mode field and set it to OTN Mode as shown in the following figure.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
410
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Step 4 Optional: Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to set a service type for the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a client-side ESC channel.
1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
2.
Select a ClientLP port. Double-click the Service Type field and set it to OTU-1 as shown in the following figure.
Step 5 Configure an intra-board cross-connection. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. l To configure a client-side cross-connection, configure a cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 4 and 5. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
411
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
l To configure a WDM-side cross-connection, configure the cross-connection between an ODU1LP port and the WDM-side port that is specified in step 3. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection..
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.6 Configuring the TN52TOM Board On-site If there is no OSC channel on an NE and the TN52TOM board is required to provide an ESC channel, this operation must be performed. The U2000 can remotely manage the NE and its connected NEs after the TN52TOM board is configured.
6.6.1 Working Mode and Signal Flow Set the working mode for the TN52TOM board according to the network plan and configuration scenarios. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
412
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Table 6-5 lists the available working modes of the TN52TOM board and the service mapping path for each scenario. Table 6-5 Mapping between the working modes and the service mapping paths Board Workin g Mode
Scenar io No.
Port Working Mode
Mapping Path
Configuration Scenario
Cascadin g
Scenari o1
ODU0 mode
Any->ODU0[>ODU1]
In this mode, the TN52TOM board cannot receive OTU1 signals, and an ESC channel cannot be provided. No configuration is required in this mode.
Scenari o2
ODU0 TributaryLine mode
Any->ODU0>ODU1->OTU1
6.6.2 Scenario 2: ODU0 tributaryline mode (cascading)
Scenari o3
ODU1 mode
Any->ODU1
In this mode, the TN52TOM board cannot receive OTU1 signals, and an ESC channel cannot be provided. No configuration is required in this mode.
Scenari o4
ODU1 TributaryLine mode
OTU1/Any->ODU1>OTU1
6.6.3 Scenario 4: ODU1 tributaryline mode (cascading)
Scenari o5
ODU0 mode
Any->ODU0[>ODU1]
In this mode, the TN52TOM board cannot receive OTU1 signals, and an ESC channel cannot be provided. No configuration is required in this mode.
Scenari o6
ODU0 TributaryLine Mode
Any->ODU0>ODU1->OTU1
6.6.4 Scenario 6: ODU0 tributaryline mode (noncascading)
Scenari o7
ODU1 mode
OTU1/Any->ODU1
6.6.5 Scenario 7: ODU1 mode (noncascading)
Noncascadin g
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
413
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Workin g Mode
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Scenar io No.
Port Working Mode
Mapping Path
Configuration Scenario
Scenari o8
ODU1_ANY_ODU0 _ODU1 reencapsulation mode
OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0>ODU1
6.6.6 Scenario 8: ODU1_ANY_ODU 0_ODU1 reencapsulation mode (non-cascading)
Scenari o9
ODU1_ANY_ODU0 _ODU1 reencapsulation tributary-line mode
OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0>ODU1->OTU1
6.6.7 Scenario 9: ODU1_ANY_ODU 0_ODU1 reencapsulation tributary-line mode (non-cascading)
Scenari o 10
ODU1 tributary-line mode
OTU1/Any->ODU1>OTU1
6.6.8 Scenario 10: ODU1 tributaryline mode (noncascading)
Scenari o 11
ODU1_ODU0 mode
OTU1->ODU1>ODU0
6.6.9 Scenario 11: ODU1_ODU0 mode (non-cascading)
Scenari o 12
ODU1_ANY_ODU0 re-encapsulation mode
OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0
6.6.10 Scenario 12: ODU1_ANY_ODU 0 re-encapsulation mode (noncascading)
NOTE
[->ODU1]: indicates that "ODU1" is optional. For example, in non-cascading ODU0 tributary mode, there are two service signal mapping paths: Any->ODU0 and Any->ODU0->ODU1.
6.6.2 Scenario 2: ODU0 tributary-line mode (cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in cascading mode with its ports working in ODU0 tributary-line mode is defined as scenario 2: cascading ODU0 tributary-line mode.When the TN52TOM board works in cascading ODU0 tributary-line mode, an intra-board WDM-side OTU1 cross-connection must be configured to provide an ESC channel.
Application Diagram Figure 6-13 shows two scenarios in which the TN52TOM board works in cascading ODU0 tributary-line mode. Configure the TN52TOM board according to the network plan. l
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: The TN52TOM board receives a maximum of six services on the client side and the other two client-side ports work as WDM-side ports, which selectively receive services. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
414
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: The TN52TOM board receives a maximum of seven services on the client side and the other client-side port works as a WDM-side port, which also receives services.
Figure 6-13 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 2: Any->ODU0>ODU1->OTU1) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: 1xOTU1
1xOTU1 TOM
TOM
1
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
6×Any
6
2×ODU0
MUX/ DMUX
1×OTU1
MUX/ DMUX
1
1×ODU1
MUX/ DMUX
1×OTU1
1×ODU1
2×ODU0
6×Any
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
MUX/ DMUX
6
Any
Any
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: 1xOTU1
1xOTU1
TOM
TOM
1
1
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
7×Any
2×ODU0
MUX/ DMUX
1×OTU1
MUX/ DMUX
1×ODU1
1×OTU1
1×ODU1
2×ODU0
7×Any
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
7
7
Any
Any
OptiX OSN 8800: N/A OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot
Cross-Connection Diagram Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1) and WDMside ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (2) in Figure 6-14. Figure 6-14 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 2: Any->ODU0>ODU1->OTU1) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side:
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
415
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer) Client side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1
1
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-5 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-6 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-7 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-8 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-1 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-2 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-3 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-4 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-5 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-6 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-7 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-8
Cross-connect module
161(ODU0LP1 /ODU0LP1)-1
51(ODU1LP1/ ODU1LP1)-1
9(TX7/RX7)-1
WDM side
10(TX8/RX8)-1 3
3
2
161(ODU0LP1 /ODU0LP1)-2
TOM
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS The client side of the TOM board are cross-connected to the WDM side of other boards, which needs to be configured on the NMS
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: Client side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-5 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-6 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-7 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-8 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-1 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-2 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-3 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-4 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-5 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-6 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-7 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-8
Cross-connect module
161(ODU0LP1 /ODU0LP1)-1
51(ODU1LP1/ ODU1LP1)-1
WDM side 10(TX8/RX8)-1 2
3
3 161(ODU0LP1 /ODU0LP1)-2
Cross-connect module Cross-connect module
TOM Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS The client side of the TOM board are cross-connected to the WDM side of other boards, which needs to be configured on the NMS
NOTE
l Only the RX7/TX7 and RX8/TX8 optical ports can be used as WDM-side optical ports. l A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Cascading and Port Working Mode to ODU0 tributary-line mode (Any->ODU0->ODU1->OTU1). 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Cascading.
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, set Port Working Mode for the 201(ClientLP1/ ClientLP1) port. Double-click the Port Working Mode field and choose ODU0 tributaryline mode (Any->ODU0->ODU1->OTU1).
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
416
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Set the port type. Set an RX/TX port as a WDM-side port according to the network plan. It is recommended to set the type for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. For the application of "dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side", set the type for the port planned to carry the working channel. 1.
Right-click the board in the Slot Layout pane and choose Path View from the shortcut menu.
2.
Right-click the port and choose Delete Port.
3.
Right-click the blank area and choose Add Port. The Add Port dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Type according to the network plan. Click OK to apply the configuration.
Step 3 Configure an intra-board WDM-side cross-connection. Configure a bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between an ODU1LP port and a WDM-side port. Ensure that the WDM-side port the one for which the port type is changed in step 3. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required.
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.6.3 Scenario 4: ODU1 tributary-line mode (cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary-line mode is defined as scenario 4: cascading ODU1 tributary-line Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
417
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
mode. When the TN52TOM board works in cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode, an intra-board WDM-side OTU1 cross-connection must be configured to provide an ESC channel.
Application Diagram Figure 6-15 shows two scenarios in which the TN52TOM board works in cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode. Configure the TN52TOM board according to the network plan. l
Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: The TN52TOM board receives a maximum of six services on the client side and the other two client-side ports work as WDM-side ports, which selectively receive services.
l
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: The TN52TOM board receives a maximum of seven services on the client side and the other client-side port works as a WDM-side port, which also receives services.
Figure 6-15 Position of the TN52TOM in a WDM system (scenario 4: OTU1/Any->ODU1>OTU1) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: 1xOTU1
1xOTU1 TOM
TOM 1
1
MUX/ DMUX
MUX/ DMUX
6×Any
MUX/ DMUX
1×OTU1
6
MUX/ DMUX
1×ODU1
1×OTU1
1×ODU1
6×Any
FE, GE, STM-1, STM-4, STM-16, OC-3, OC-12, OC48, FC100, FC200, FICON, FICON Express, HD-SDI, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
6
Any
FE, GE, STM-1, STM-4, STM-16, OC-3, OC-12, OC48, FC100, FC200, FICON, FICON Express, HD-SDI, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
Any
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: 1xOTU1
1xOTU1
TOM
TOM
1
1
7×Any
MUX/ DMUX
1×OTU1
MUX/ DMUX
1×ODU1
1×OTU1
1×ODU1
7×Any
FE, GE, STM-1, STM-4, STM-16, OC-3, OC-12, OC48, FC100, FC200, FICON, FICON Express, HD-SDI, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
7
7
Any
FE, GE, STM-1, STM-4, STM-16, OC-3, OC-12, OC48, FC100, FC200, FICON, FICON Express, HD-SDI, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
Any
OptiX OSN 8800: N/A OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot
Cross-Connection Diagram Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1) and WDMside ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (2) in Figure 6-16. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
418
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Figure 6-16 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 4: OTU1/Any>ODU1->OTU1) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: Client side
WDM side 3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-5 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-6 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-7 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-8
Cross-connect module
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1
9(TX7/RX7)-1
3
10(TX8/RX8)-1 2 TOM
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: Client side
WDM side 3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-5 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-6 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-7 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-8
Cross-connect module
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 3
Cross-connect module
2
10(TX8/RX8)-1
TOM
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS
NOTE
l Only the RX7/TX7 and RX8/TX8 optical ports can be used as WDM-side optical ports. l A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Cascading, and Port Working Mode to ODU1 tributary-line mode (OTU1/Any->ODU1->OTU1). 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Cascading.
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, set Port Working Mode for the 201(ClientLP1/ ClientLP1) port. Double-click the Port Working Mode field and set it to ODU1 tributaryline mode (OTU1/Any->ODU1->OTU1).
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Set the port type. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
419
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Set an RX/TX port as a WDM-side port according to the network plan. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. For the application of "dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side", set the type for the port planned to carry the working channel. 1.
Right-click the board in the Slot Layout pane and choose Path View from the shortcut menu.
2.
Right-click the port and choose Delete Port.
3.
Right-click the blank area and choose Add Port. The Add Port dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Type according to the network plan. Click OK to apply the configuration.
Step 3 Configure an intra-board WDM-side cross-connection. Configure a bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between an ODU1LP port and a WDM-side port. Ensure that the WDM-side port is the one for which the port type is changed in step 3. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed. Set the parameters.
3.
Click OK. The created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.6.4 Scenario 6: ODU0 tributary-line mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU0 tributary-line mode is defined as scenario 6: non-cascading ODU0 tributary-line mode. When the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU0 tributary-line mode, an intra-board WDM-side OTU1 cross-connection must be configured to provide an ESC channel. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
420
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Application Diagram Figure 6-17 shows two scenarios in which the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU0 tributary-line mode. Configure the TN52TOM board according to the network plan. l
Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: The TN52TOM board receives a maximum of four services on the client side and the other two client-side ports work as WDM-side ports, which selectively receive services.
l
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: The TN52TOM board receives a maximum of six services on the client side and the other client-side port works as a WDMside port, which also receives services.
Figure 6-17 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 6: Any->ODU0>ODU1->OTU1) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: 2xOTU1
2xOTU1
TOM
TOM 1
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
4×Any
4
4×ODU0
MUX/ DMUX
2×OTU1
MUX/ DMUX
1
2×ODU1
MUX/ DMUX
2×OTU1
2×ODU1
4×ODU0
4×Any
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
MUX/ DMUX
4
Any
Any
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: 2xOTU1
2xOTU1
TOM
TOM
1
1
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
6×Any
4×ODU0
MUX/ DMUX
2×OTU1
MUX/ DMUX
2×ODU1
2×OTU1
4×ODU0
2×ODU1
6×Any
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, DVB-ASI, SDI, ESCON, FDDI
6
6
Any
Any
OptiX OSN 8800: N/A OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot
Cross-Connection Diagram Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal ODU1LP and WDM-side ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (2) in Figure 6-18. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
421
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Figure 6-18 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 6: Any->ODU0>ODU1->OTU1) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: Client side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-1 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-2 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-3 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-4 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-2 204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)-1 204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)-2
Cross-connect module
3
161(ODU0LP1/ ODU0LP1)-1
3
51(ODU1LP1/ ODU1LP1)-1 2
161(ODU0LP1/ ODU0LP1)-2
WDM side
52(ODU1LP2/ ODU1LP2)-1
162(ODU0LP1/ ODU0LP1)-1
TOM
162(ODU0LP1/ ODU0LP1)-2
Cross-connect module
7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1 10(TX8/RX8)-1
Cross-connect module Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: Client side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-1 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-2 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-3 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-4 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-2 204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)-1 204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)-2
Cross-connect module
3
161(ODU0LP1/ ODU0LP1)-1
3
10(TX8/RX8)-1
52(ODU1LP2/ ODU1LP2)-1
162(ODU0LP1/ ODU0LP1)-2
Cross-connect module
9(TX7/RX7)-1 2
161(ODU0LP1/ ODU0LP1)-2 162(ODU0LP1/ ODU0LP1)-1
WDM side
51(ODU1LP1/ ODU1LP1)-1
TOM
Cross-connect module Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS
NOTE
l All RX/TX optical ports can be used as WDM-side optical ports. l A cross-connection can be configured between any ODU1LP port and any WDM-side port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Non-Cascading, and Port Working Mode to ODU0 tributaryline mode (Any->ODU0->ODU1->OTU1). 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Non-Cascading.
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, double-click the Port Working Mode field and set the 205 (or 207) port to None (not for ports) first. Then set the 201 (or 203) port to ODU0 tributary-line Mode (Any->ODU0->ODU1->OTU1). It is recommended to set a working mode for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
422
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Set the port type. Set an RX/TX port as a WDM-side port according to the network plan. It is recommended to set the type for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. For the application of "dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side", set the type for the port planned to carry the working channel. 1.
Right-click the board in the Slot Layout pane and choose Path View from the shortcut menu.
2.
Right-click the port and choose Modify Port from the shortcut menu. The Modify Port dialog box is displayed. Set Type according to the network plan.
3.
Click OK to apply the configuration.
Step 3 Configure an intra-board WDM-side cross-connection. Select an internal port from (3) in Figure 6-18. The internal port that is identical to the service port specified in the network plan is recommended. Then configure an intra-board crossconnection between the internal port and a WDM-side port. Ensure that the WDM-side port is the one for which the port type is changed in step 3. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level and Service Type, and set other parameters as required.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
423
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click OK. The created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.6.5 Scenario 7: ODU1 mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary mode (OTU1->ODU1) is defined as scenario 7: application 1 of non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode. When the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode, an intra-board OTU1 client-side cross-connection must be configured so an ESC channel is available between the NE equipped with the TN52TOM board and its connected NEs.
Application Diagram Figure 6-19 shows the position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system where the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode. Figure 6-19 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 7: OTU1->ODU1) 4xODU1
4xODU1
1xOTU2
1xOTU2
TOM 1
1
1 MUX/ DMUX
MUX/ DMUX
NS2
4
ODU1
4×OTU1
NS2
4×ODU1
4×OTU1 4
4×ODU1
OTU1
TOM 1
OTU1
4
4
ODU1
OptiX OSN 8800: N/A OptiX OSN 6800: N/A OptiX OSN 3800: From/To non-paired slots of the mesh group
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
424
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
In this working mode, configurations for the TN52TOM board to receive Any services differ from those for the board to receive OTU1 services. If the TN52TOM board is configured to receive Any services, it cannot carry an ESC channel. In this case, no configuration is required.
Cross-Connection Diagram Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (1) in Figure 6-20. Figure 6-20 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 7: OTU1->ODU1)
Other board
Client side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1 10(TX8/RX8)-1
1
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-2 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-3 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-4
Cross-connect module
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-2 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-3 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-4 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-1 202(ClientLP2/ClientLP2)-2 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-2 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-3 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-4 204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)-1 204(ClientLP4/ClientLP4)-2
Cross-connect module
WDM side
WDM side
2
TOM
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The client side of the TOM board are cross-connected to the WDM side of other boards, which needs to be configured on the NMS
NOTE
A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Non-Cascading and Port Working Mode to ODU1 mode (OTU1/Any->ODU1). 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Non-Cascading.
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, set Port Working Mode for a ClientLP port. The port that is carrying the channel specified in the network plan is recommended. Double-click the Port Working Mode field and set it to ODU1 mode (OTU1/Any->ODU1).
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
425
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Configure the working mode for the client-side ports on the TN52TOM board as OTN Mode. Because the service type is OTU1, set Service Mode to OTN Mode for the port. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Channel from the drop-down list.
3.
Click the Basic Attributes tab and select a client-side port. Double-click the Service Mode field and choose OTN Mode.
4.
Click Apply.
Step 3 Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to select the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab and select a ClientLP port.
2.
Double-click the Service Type field and set it to OTU-1.
3.
Click Apply.
Step 4 Configure an intra-board client-side cross-connection. Configure an intra-board bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 3 and 4. 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
426
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. The following figure shows an example of configuring a bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between the 3 (RX1/TX1) port and the 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1) port.
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.6.6 Scenario 8: ODU1_ANY_ODU0_ODU1 re-encapsulation mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any->ODU0->ODU1) is defined as scenario 8: application 4 of non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode. When the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode, an intra-board OTU1 client-side crossconnection must be configured so an ESC channel is available between the NE equipped with the TN52TOM board and its connected NEs.
Application Diagram Figure 6-21 shows the position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system where the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
427
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Figure 6-21 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 8: OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0->ODU1) 4xODU1 1xOTU2
1xOTU2 4xODU1 TOM
TOM
1
1
4
OTU1
4
ODU1
ODU1
4×OTU1
4
32×Any
N S 2
4×ODU1
Any
4
1
64×Any
4
4
M U X / D M U X
4×ODU1
N S 2
M U X / D M U X
8×ODU0
4×ODU1
64×Any 8×Any
8×ODU0 8×Any
32×Any
4×OTU1
4×ODU1
OTU1
1
8×Any
1
8×Any
1
Any
OptiX OSN 8800: N/A OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 8800: N/A OptiX OSN 6800: N/A OptiX OSN 3800: From/To non-paired slots of the mesh group
Cross-Connection Diagram Create a cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (1) in Figure 6-22. Figure 6-22 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 8: OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0->ODU1)
Other board
Client side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1
1
201(ClientLP1 /ClientLP1)-1 203(ClientLP3 /ClientLP3)-1
6(TX4/RX4)-1
205(ClientLP5 /ClientLP5)-1
7(TX5/RX5)-1
207(ClientLP7 /ClientLP7)-1
8(TX6/RX6)-1
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-2 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-3 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-4
Cross-connect module
237(AnyLP5/AnyLP5)-1
233(AnyLP1/AnyLP1)-1
2
3
2 233(AnyLP1/AnyLP1)-8
WDM side 4
237(AnyLP5/AnyLP5)-8 238(AnyLP6/AnyLP6)-1
234(AnyLP2/AnyLP2)-1
238(AnyLP6/AnyLP6)-8 239(AnyLP7/AnyLP7)-1
234(AnyLP2/AnyLP2)-8 235(AnyLP3/AnyLP3)-1
239(AnyLP7/AnyLP7)-8
235(AnyLP3/AnyLP3)-8
240(AnyLP8/AnyLP8)-8
9(TX7/RX7)-1
161(ODU0LP1 /ODU0LP1)-1
WDM side
240(AnyLP8/AnyLP8)-1
162(ODU0LP2 /ODU0LP2)-1
163(ODU0LP3 /ODU0LP3)-1
244(AnyLP12/AnyLP12)1
10(TX8/RX8)-1
TOM
Cross-connect module
236(AnyLP4/AnyLP4)-7 236(AnyLP4/AnyLP4)-8
Cross-connect module
244(AnyLP12/AnyLP12)-8
Cross-connect module
164(ODU0LP4 /ODU0LP4)-1
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS The client side of the TOM board are cross-connected to the WDM side of other boards, which needs to be configured on the NMS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
428
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Non-Cascading, and Port Working Mode to ODU1_ANY_ODU0_ODU1 re-encapsulation mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any->ODU0>ODU1). 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Non-Cascading.
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, set Port Working Mode for a ClientLP port. The port that is carrying the channel specified in the network plan is recommended. Double-click the Port Working Mode field and choose ODU1_ANY_ODU0_ODU1 re-encapsulation mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any->ODU0->ODU1).
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Configure the service mode for the client-side ports on the TN52TOM board as OTN Mode. Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Channel from the drop-down list.
3.
Click the Basic Attributes tab and select a client-side port.
4.
Double-click the Service Mode field and set it to OTN Mode.
5.
Click Apply.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
429
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Step 3 Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to select the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab and select a ClientLP port.
2.
Double-click the Service Type field and set it to OTU-1.
3.
Click Apply.
Step 4 Configure intra-board client-side cross-connections. Configure an intra-board bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 3 and 4. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. The following figure shows an example of configuring a bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between the 3 (RX1/TX1) port and the 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1) port.
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.6.7 Scenario 9: ODU1_ANY_ODU0_ODU1 re-encapsulation tributary-line mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary-line mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any->ODU0->ODU1->OTU1) is defined as scenario 9: application 1 of non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode. When the Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
430
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode, it can receive OTU1 services on the client side and also transmit OTU1 services on the WDM side. To provide an ESC channel between the local and remote NEs, configure an intra-board client-side OTU1 cross-connection. In other cases, either a WDM-side or a client-side intra-board crossconnection is required to provide an ESC channel.
Application Diagram Figure 6-23 shows the position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system where the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any->ODU0>ODU1->OTU1). Figure 6-23 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 9: OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0->ODU1->OTU1) 2xOTU1
TOM
MUX/ DMUX
1
2×OTU1
16×Any
2×ODU1
MUX/ DMUX
32×Any 4×ODU0
MUX/ DMUX
1
2×OTU1
2
TOM
MUX/ DMUX
2×ODU1
2×OTU1
2×ODU1
4×ODU0 32×Any
16×Any
2×OTU1
2×ODU1
OTU1
2xOTU1
OTU1 2
Cross-Connection Diagram l
Create a cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (1) in Figure 6-24.
l
Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal ODU1LP and WDM-side ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (4) in Figure 6-24.
Figure 6-24 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 9: OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0->ODU1->OTU1) Client side
WDM side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1
1
201(ClientLP1 /ClientLP1)-1 203(ClientLP3 /ClientLP3)-1
237(AnyLP5/AnyLP5)-1
233(AnyLP1/AnyLP1)-1 2
3 233(AnyLP1/AnyLP1)-8
205(ClientLP5 /ClientLP5)-1 207(ClientLP7 /ClientLP7)-1
161(ODU0LP1 /ODU0LP1)-1
237(AnyLP5/AnyLP5)-8 238(AnyLP6/AnyLP6)-1 238(AnyLP6/AnyLP6)-8
234(AnyLP2/AnyLP2)-1
237(AnyLP5/AnyLP5)-1
234(AnyLP2/AnyLP2)-8
237(AnyLP5/AnyLP5)-8 238(AnyLP6/AnyLP6)-1
2
51(ODU1LP1 /ODU1LP1)-1
8(TX6/RX6)-1
2 162(ODU0LP2 /ODU0LP2)-1
7(TX5/RX5)-1
4 52(ODU1LP2 /ODU1LP2)-1
9(TX7/RX7)-1 10(TX8/RX8)-1
238(AnyLP6/AnyLP6)-8
TOM
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
431
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
l All RX/TX optical ports can be used as WDM-side optical ports. l A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port. l A cross-connection can be configured between any ODU1LP port and any WDM-side port.
Configuration Process The configuration process for providing a client-side ESC channel differs from that for providing a WDM-side ESC channel. Table 6-6 lists the configuration process. Table 6-6 Configuration process No.
Task
To Provide a ClientSide ESC Channel
To Provide a WDMSide ESC Channel
1
Set the state of the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
2
Configure the working mode for the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
3
Set the port type.
No
Yes
4
Set the service mode.
Yes
No
5
Configure the service type.
Yes
No
6
Configure an intra-board cross-connection.
Yes
Yes
7
Set the state of the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
Remarks: l Yes: This task is required. l No: This task is not required.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Non-Cascading, and Port Working Mode to ODU1_ANY_ODU0_ODU1 re-encapsulation tributary-line mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any>ODU0->ODU1->OTU1). 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Non-Cascading.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
432
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, double-click the Port Working Mode field and set the 205 (or 207) port to None (not for ports) first. Then set the 201 (or 203) port to ODU1_ANY_ODU0_ODU1 re-encapsulation tributary-line mode (OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0->ODU1->OTU1). It is recommended to set a working mode for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan.
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Optional: Set the port type. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a WDM-side ESC channel.
Set an RX/TX port as a WDM-side port according to the network plan. It is recommended to set a service type for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Right-click the board in the Slot Layout pane and choose Path View from the shortcut menu.
2.
Right-click the port and choose Modify Port from the shortcut menu. The Modify Port dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Type according to the network plan.
4.
Click OK to apply the configuration.
Step 3 Optional: Configure a service mode for the client-side ports on the TN52TOM board. It is recommended to set a service type for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a client-side ESC channel.
Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. 1. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
433
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
2.
Select a client-side port. Double-click the Service Mode field and set it to OTN Mode as shown in the following figure.
3.
Click Apply.
Step 4 Optional: Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to select the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. NOTE
This operation is required to provide a client-side ESC channel.
1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane. Select a port, double-click the Service Type field, and set it to OTU-1 as shown in the following figure..
2.
Click Apply.
Step 5 Configure an intra-board cross-connection. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. l To configure a client-side cross-connection, configure a cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 4 and 5. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
434
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
l To configure a WDM-side cross-connection, configure a cross-connection between an ODU1LP port and the WDM-side port that is specified in step 3. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection.
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.6.8 Scenario 10: ODU1 tributary-line mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary-line mode (OTU1/Any->ODU1->OTU1) is defined as scenario 10: application 2 of non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode. When the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode, it can receive OTU1 services on the client side and also transmit OTU1 services on the WDM side. To provide an ESC channel between the local and remote NEs, configure an intra-board client-side OTU1 cross-connection. In other cases, either a WDM-side or a client-side intra-board cross-connection is required to provide an ESC channel.
Application Diagram Figure 6-25 and Figure 6-26 show the position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system where the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary-line mode (OTU1/Any>ODU1->OTU1). Configure the TN52TOM board according to the network plan. l
Figure 6-25 shows a scenario in which OTU1 signals are electrically regenerated.
l
Figure 6-26 shows a scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in tributary-line mode and receives Any signals.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
435
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
– Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: The TN52TOM board receives a maximum of four services on the client side, and the other four client-side ports work as WDM-side ports, two of which selectively receive services. – Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: The TN52TOM board receives a maximum of six services on the client side, and the other two client-side ports work as WDM-side ports, which also receive services. Figure 6-25 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 10: OTU1->ODU1>OTU1) 4xOTU1
4xOTU1 TOM
4×OTU1 4×ODU1 4×OTU1
D M U 4 X
M 4 U X
TOM
4
4×OTU1 4×ODU1 4×OTU1
M U X
D M 4 U X
Figure 6-26 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 10: Any->ODU1>OTU1) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: 2xOTU1
2xOTU1
TOM
TOM
MUX/ DMUX
2×OTU1
4×Any
MUX/ DMUX
1
4
2×ODU1
MUX/ DMUX
2×OTU1
MUX/ DMUX
4×Any
1
2×ODU1
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, STM-4, OC-12, DVBASI, ESCON, FDDI, SDI, STM-1, OC-3 , FC200, FICON Express, HDSDI, STM-16, OC-48
4
Any
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, STM-4, OC-12, DVBASI, ESCON, FDDI, SDI, STM-1, OC-3 , FC200, FICON Express, HDSDI, STM-16, OC-48
Any
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: 2xOTU1
2xOTU1
TOM
TOM 1
1
6
6
Any
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
6×Any
MUX/ DMUX
2×OTU1
MUX/ DMUX
2×ODU1
2×OTU1
2×ODU1
6×Any
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, STM-4, OC-12, DVBASI, ESCON, FDDI, SDI, STM-1, OC-3 , FC200, FICON Express, HDSDI, STM-16, OC-48
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
FE, GE, FC100, FICON, STM-4, OC-12, DVBASI, ESCON, FDDI, SDI, STM-1, OC-3 , FC200, FICON Express, HDSDI, STM-16, OC-48
Any
436
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
OptiX OSN 8800: N/A OptiX OSN 6800: From/To paired slot OptiX OSN 3800: From/To paired slot
Cross-Connection Diagram l
Create a cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (1) in Figure 6-27 and Figure 6-28.
l
Create an OTU1 cross-connection between the internal ODU1LP and WDM-side ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (3) in Figure 6-27 and Figure 6-28.
Figure 6-27 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 10: OTU1->ODU1>OTU1) Client side
WDM side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 TOM
1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1 205(ClientLP5/ClientLP5)-1 207(ClientLP7/ClientLP7)-1
Cross-connect module
2
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 52(ODU1LP2/ODU1LP2)-1 53(ODU1LP3/ODU1LP3)-1 54(ODU1LP4/ODU1LP4)-1
Cross-connect module
3
7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1 10(TX8/RX8)-1
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS
Figure 6-28 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 10: Any->ODU1>OTU1) Dual-fed and selectively receiving on the WDM side: Client side
WDM side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 1
2
203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1
Cross-connect module
7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1 10(TX8/RX8)-1
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 52(ODU1LP2/ODU1LP2)-1
Cross-connect module
3
TOM
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS
Single transmitting and single receiving on the WDM side: Client side
WDM side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 1
203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1
2
51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-1 52(ODU1LP2/ODU1LP2)-1
9(TX7/RX7)-1 3 10(TX8/RX8)-1 TOM
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
437
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
l All RX/TX optical ports can be used as WDM-side optical ports. l A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Configuration Process The configuration process for providing a client-side ESC channel differs from that for providing a WDM-side ESC channel. Table 6-7 lists the configuration process. Table 6-7 Configuration process No.
Task
To Provide a ClientSide ESC Channel
To Provide a WDMSide ESC Channel
1
Set the state of the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
2
Configure the working mode for the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
3
Set the port type.
No
Yes
4
Set the service mode.
Yes
No
5
Configure the service type.
Yes
No
6
Configure an intra-board cross-connection.
Yes
Yes
7
Set the state of the TOM board.
Yes
Yes
Remarks: l Yes: This task is required. l No: This task is not required.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Non-Cascading, and Port Working Mode to ODU1 tributaryline mode (OTU1/Any->ODU1->OTU1). 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Non-Cascading.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
438
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, double-click the Port Working Mode field and set Port Working Mode for each Optical Port. l For the 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-207(ClientLP7/ClientLP7) ports, set Port Working Mode to ODU1 tributary-line mode (OTU1/Any->ODU1->OTU1).
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Optional: Set the port type. NOTE
This operation is required to provide an ESC channel.
Set the port as a WDM-side port according to the network plan. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Right-click the board in the Slot Layout pane and choose Path View from the shortcut menu.
2.
Right-click the port and choose Modify Port from the shortcut menu. The Modify Port dialog box is displayed. Set Type to Line Side Colorless Optical Port.
3.
Click OK to apply the configuration.
Step 3 Optional: Configure a service mode for the ports on the TN52TOM board. NOTE
This operation is required to provide an ESC channel.
Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane. Select a client-side port, double-click the Service Mode field and set it to OTN Mode.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
439
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click Apply.
Step 4 Optional: Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to select the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. NOTE
This operation is required to provide an ESC channel.
1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab in the WDM Interface pane.
2.
Select a ClientLP port, double-click the Service Type field, and set it to OTU-1.
3.
Click Apply.
Step 5 Configure an intra-board cross-connection. Configure bidirectional OTU1 cross-connections between the 51(ODU1LP1/ODU1LP1)-54 (ODU1LP4/ODU1LP4) optical ports and 7(RX5/TX5)-10(RX8/TX8) optical ports based on Figure 6-27 and Figure 6-28. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. l To configure a client-side cross-connection, configure a cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 4 and 5. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
440
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
l To configure a WDM-side cross-connection, configure the cross-connection between an ODU1LP port and the WDM-side port that is specified in step 3. The following figure shows an example of configuring such a cross-connection.
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.6.9 Scenario 11: ODU1_ODU0 mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary mode (OTU1->ODU1->ODU0) is defined as scenario 11: application 2 of non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode. When the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode, an intra-board OTU1 client-side cross-connection must be configured so an ESC channel is available between the NE equipped with the TN52TOM board and its connected NEs.
Application Diagram Figure 6-29 shows the position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system where the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
441
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Figure 6-29 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 11: OTU1->ODU1>ODU0) 1xOTU2 8xODU0
8xODU0 1xOTU2
TOM
TOM 1
8
1
1
N S 2 8
4×OTU1
8
4
1
4×ODU1
N S 2
M U X / D M U X
8×ODU0
4×ODU1
8×ODU0 8×Any
4×OTU1
OTU1
1
M U X / D M U X
8×Any
1
8
OTU1
4
Cross-Connection Diagram Create a cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN52TOM board, which is marked (1) in Figure 6-30. Figure 6-30 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 11: OTU1->ODU1>ODU0) 161(ODU0LP1/ODU0LP1)-1 161(ODU0LP1/ODU0LP1)-2 162(ODU0LP2/ODU0LP2)-1 162(ODU0LP2/ODU0LP2)-2 163(ODU0LP3/ODU0LP3)-1 163(ODU0LP3/ODU0LP3)-2 164(ODU0LP4/ODU0LP4)-1 164(ODU0LP4/ODU0LP4)-2
Other board Cross-connect module
Client side
3(TX1/RX1)-1 4(TX2/RX2)-1 5(TX3/RX3)-1 6(TX4/RX4)-1 7(TX5/RX5)-1 8(TX6/RX6)-1 9(TX7/RX7)-1 10(TX8/RX8)-1
TOM
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1 203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1 1
3
205(ClientLP5/ClientLP5)-1 207(ClientLP7/ClientLP7)-1
Cross-connect module
161(ODU0LP1/ODU0LP1)-1 161(ODU0LP1/ODU0LP1)-2 162(ODU0LP2/ODU0LP2)-1 162(ODU0LP2/ODU0LP2)-2 163(ODU0LP3/ODU0LP3)-1 163(ODU0LP3/ODU0LP3)-2 164(ODU0LP4/ODU0LP4)-1 164(ODU0LP4/ODU0LP4)-2
Cross-connect module
WDM side
WDM side
2
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS The client side of the TOM board are cross-connected to the WDM side of other boards, which needs to be configured on the NMS
NOTE
A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Non-Cascading, and Port Working Mode to ODU1_ODU0 mode (OTU1->ODU1->ODU0). Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
442
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Non-Cascading.
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, set Port Working Mode for a ClientLP port. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. Double-click the Port Working Mode field and set it to ODU1_ODU0 mode (OTU1->ODU1->ODU0).
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Configure the working mode for the ports on the TN52TOM board as OTN. Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Channel from the drop-down list.
3.
Click the Basic Attributes tab and select a client-side port. Double-click the Service Mode field and set it to OTN Mode.
4.
Click Apply.
Step 3 Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to select the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab and select a ClientLP port.
2.
Double-click the Service Type field and choose OTU-1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
443
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click Apply.
Step 4 Configure intra-board client-side cross-connections. Configure an intra-board bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 3 and 4. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. The following figure shows an example of configuring a bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between the 3 (RX1/TX1) port and the 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1) port.
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed in the user interface.
----End
6.6.10 Scenario 12: ODU1_ANY_ODU0 re-encapsulation mode (non-cascading) The application scenario in which the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading mode with its ports working in ODU1 tributary mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any->ODU0) is defined as scenario 12: application 3 of non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode. When the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode, an intra-board OTU1 client-side cross-connection must be configured so an ESC channel is available between the NE equipped with the TN52TOM board and its connected NEs.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
444
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Application Diagram Figure 6-31 shows the position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system where the TN52TOM board works in non-cascading ODU1 tributary mode. Figure 6-31 Position of the TN52TOM board in a WDM system (scenario 12: OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0) 1xOTU2 8xODU0
8xODU0 1xOTU2 TOM
TOM 1
8
4×OTU1
N S 2
32×Any
8
1
1
4×ODU1
8
4
1
64×Any
N S 2
M U X / D M U X
8×ODU0
64×Any
8×ODU0 8×Any
4×ODU1
32×Any
4×OTU1
OTU1
M U X / D M U X
1
8×Any
1
8
OTU1
4
Cross-Connection Diagram Create a cross-connection between the internal client-side and ClientLP ports on the TN52TOM board, as marked (1) in Figure 6-32. Figure 6-32 Cross-connection diagram for the TN52TOM board (scenario 12: OTU1->ODU1>Any->ODU0) 161(ODU0LP1/ODU0LP1)-1 161(ODU0LP1/ODU0LP1)-2 162(ODU0LP2/ODU0LP2)-1 162(ODU0LP2/ODU0LP2)-2 163(ODU0LP3/ODU0LP3)-1 163(ODU0LP3/ODU0LP3)-2 164(ODU0LP4/ODU0LP4)-1 164(ODU0LP4/ODU0LP4)-2
Other board Cross-connect module
Client side
201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1)-1
3(TX1/RX1)-1 1
3
2
4(TX2/RX2)-1
203(ClientLP3/ClientLP3)-1
5(TX3/RX3)-1
205(ClientLP5/ClientLP5)-1
233(AnyLP1/AnyLP1)-8 234(AnyLP2/AnyLP2)-1 234(AnyLP2/AnyLP2)-8
6(TX4/RX4)-1
207(ClientLP7/ClientLP7)-1
7(TX5/RX5)-1
235(AnyLP1/AnyLP1)-8 236(AnyLP2/AnyLP2)-1
241(AnyLP9/AnyLP9)-8 242(AnyLP10/AnyLP10)-1
236(AnyLP2/AnyLP2)-8
4
238(AnyLP6/AnyLP6)-8 241(AnyLP9/AnyLP9)-1
8(TX6/RX6)-1
242(AnyLP10/AnyLP10)-8 244(AnyLP12/AnyLP12)-1
10(TX8/RX8)-1
TOM
237(AnyLP5/AnyLP5)-8 238(AnyLP6/AnyLP6)-1
235(AnyLP1/AnyLP1)-1
9(TX7/RX7)-1
WDM side
237(AnyLP5/AnyLP5)-1
233(AnyLP1/AnyLP1)-1
WDM side
244(AnyLP12/AnyLP12)-8
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
Cross-connect module
The internal cross-connection of the board, which needs to be configured on the NMS The straight-through of the board, which does not need to be configured on the NMS The client side of the TOM board are cross-connected to the WDM side of other boards, which needs to be configured on the NMS
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
445
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
NOTE
A cross-connection can be configured between any client-side port and any ClientLP port.
Procedure Step 1 Configure the working mode for the TN52TOM board. Set Board Working Mode to Non-Cascading and Port Working Mode to ODU1_ANY_ODU0 re-encapsulation mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any->ODU0). 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > Working Mode in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Board Working Mode pane, double-click the Board Working Mode field and set it to Non-Cascading.
3.
Click Apply.
4.
In the Port Working Mode pane, set Port Working Mode for a ClientLP port. It is recommended to set a working mode for the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. Double-click the Port Working Mode field and set it to ODU1_ANY_ODU0 re-encapsulation mode (OTU1->ODU1->Any->ODU0).
5.
Click Apply.
6.
Click Query. Confirm that the query results are the same as the preset values.
Step 2 Configure the service mode for the ports on the TN52TOM board as OTN Mode. Because the service type is OTU1, Service Mode must be set to OTN Mode for the ports. It is recommended to select the port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the TN52TOM board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface in the navigation tree.
2.
Click By Board/Port (Channel) and choose Channel from the drop-down list.
3.
Click the Basic Attributes tab and select a client-side port. Double-click the Service Mode field and choose OTN Mode.
4.
Click Apply.
Step 3 Set the service type to OTU-1 for the ClientLP ports. It is recommended to select the ClientLP port that is carrying the service channel specified in the network plan. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
446
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
1.
Click the Basic Attributes tab and select a ClientLP port.
2.
Double-click the Service Type field and set it to OTU-1.
3.
Click Apply.
Step 4 Configure intra-board client-side cross-connections. Configure an intra-board bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between a client-side port and a ClientLP port. Ensure that the client-side and ClientLP ports are identical to those configured in steps 3 and 4. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Configuration > Electrical CrossConnection Service Management in the navigation tree.
2.
In the Electrical Cross-Connection Configuration pane, click New. The Create CrossConnection Service dialog box is displayed.
3.
Set Service Level to OTU1, and set other parameters as required. The following figure shows an example of configuring a bidirectional OTU1 cross-connection between the 3 (RX1/TX1) port and the 201(ClientLP1/ClientLP1) port.
4.
Click OK. The newly created cross-connection is displayed.
----End
6.7 Configuring the OA Boards Set optical attenuation and nominal gain for optical amplifier boards, with assistance from the engineers in the network management center (NMC).
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
447
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Setting Optical Attenuation 1.
Right-click the board and choose WDM Interface. The WDM Interface window is displayed.
2.
Click By Board/Port(Channel), and select Channel from the drop-down list.
3.
On the Basic Attributes tab page, double-click the Optical Interface Attenuation Ratio field, and enter the data provided by the engineers in the NMC, and click Apply. NOTE
The adjustable range of the built-in attenuator for a board depends on the board type.
Setting Nominal Gain 1.
Right-click the board and choose WDM Interface. The WDM Interface window is displayed.
2.
In the WDM Interface window, click By Function and choose Nominal Gain from the drop-down list.
3.
Double-click the Nominal Gain field, enter the data provided by the engineers in the NMC, and click Apply.
6.8 Checking NE Communication Status Correct configuration of each NE is the basis for the entire network to operate properly. This section describes how to check whether the configuration of each NE is correct.
Context After the initial network configuration of an NE is completed, check the NE communication status to determine whether the configuration is correct. You can determine that the NE communication status is normal if information about the NMS or other NEs is displayed in the IP Route Management area.
Procedure Step 1 In the NE Explorer, choose Communication > IP Protocol Stack Management from the Function Tree. Step 2 Click Query. ----End
Follow-up Procedure If no information about the NMS or other NEs is displayed in the IP Route Management area, perform the following checks on NE: l
Check the fiber connections against the fiber connection diagram in the network design. Correct fiber connections if there are incorrect ones.
l
Test the transmit and receive optical power on the line. Handle the line fault if the line attenuation is abnormal.
l
Check the network cable connections against the network cable connection diagram in the network design. Correct network cable connections if there are incorrect ones.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
448
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Test the transmit and receive optical power of the OSC board or the DAS1 board if OSC communication is used. Do as follows if the transmit or receive optical power is abnormal: – Check the fiber connections between the OSC and FIU boards. – Check the fiber connections between TM and RX ports, and the fiber connections between RM and TX ports for the DAS1 board. – If the OSC or DAS1 board receive optical power queried on the Web LCT is remarkably lower than the IN port input optical power measured using an optical power meter, clean the fiber connected to the IN port. If the fault persists, replace the board. If the OSC or DAS1 board receive optical power exceeds the permitted range, add fixed optical attenuators (FOAs) with reference to OSC commissioning requirements. If the OSC or DAS1 board transmit optical power exceeds the permitted range, replace the board.
l
Check the status of the DCC channels to be used if ESC communication is used. Choose Communication > DCC Management. In the displayed window, check the value of Communication State for the DCC channels to be used. If Receiving failed, Transmitting failed, or Receiving/transmitting failed is displayed for any channel, perform the following checks: – Check the WDM-side transmit and receive optical power of the OTU board. – Check whether electrical cross-connections have been correctly configured for boards requiring cross-connections to implement ESC communication. An example of such boards is the TOM board. – Check whether the configuration of the remote NE is completed.
6.9 Backing Up the NE Database to the SCC Board By backing up an NE database to an SCC board, you can ensure that the NE automatically restores to the normal state in case a power failure occurs. When you back up an NE database to an SCC board, you actually back up the NE data to the flash memory of the SCC board. After a power-off reset occurs on the NE, the SCC board automatically reads the configuration data from the flash memory and applies the data to the boards on this NE.
Prerequisites You must have logged in to an NE. The NE must be configured properly.
Precautions NOTE
After backing up an NE database to an SCC board, you can restore the NE database from the SCC board by performing a warm or cold reset on the SCC board.
Procedure 1.
Select one or more NEs in the NE list. Click Back Up NE Database > Back Up to SCC. NOTE
The Web LCT takes a few minutes to back up the NE database. Do not perform any operation in the process of backup.
2. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click OK in the confirmation dialog box. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
449
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3.
6 Performing Initial Web LCT Commissioning
Click Close in the Operation Result dialog box is displayed.
6.10 Exiting the Web LCT After performing initial NE commissioning using the Web LCT, log out of the commissioned NE, reconnect the network cables to the NE, and exit the Web LCT.
Procedure Step 1 Highlight the NE that you are logged in to, and click the NE Logout at the bottom of the screen. Step 2 Physically disconnect the Web LCT from the NE Step 3 Close the browser. Step 4 Double-click the stopweblct.bat file at "WebLCT\WebLCT\Tomcat" to stop the Web LCT application. ----End
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
450
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7
7 Routine Operation On-site
Routine Operation On-site
About This Chapter 7.1 Getting to Know Indicators This section introduces the indicators of equipment. 7.2 Testing Optical Power by Using an Optical Power Meter This section describes the basic method for testing optical power by using an optical power meter during the detection of faults and the commissioning. 7.3 Checking Fiber Jumpers by Using an Optical Power Meter This section describes the basic method for checking a fiber jumper by using an optical power meter during the detection of faults or the commissioning. 7.4 Inserting and Removing Fiber Jumpers This section describes the basic method for replacing a fiber jumper when the fiber jumper is damaged. 7.5 Inspecting and Cleaning the Optical Fiber Connectors Cleaning optical components is to remove dust or other dirt to avoid performance degradation of optical transmission systems. Inspecting and cleaning fiber connectors used in fiber optic connections are described here. 7.6 Performing Hardware Loopback Manually perform loopback to a physical port (optical port) with a fiber. 7.7 Reset a Board
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
451
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
7.1 Getting to Know Indicators This section introduces the indicators of equipment.
7.1.1 Cabinet Indicators There are altogether four indicators in different colors on each cabinet: green, red, orange and yellow. The corresponding messages of each indicator are listed in Table 7-1. Table 7-1 Meanings of cabinet indicators Indicator
Name
Status
Meaning
power
Power indicator
On (green)
The cabinet is powered on.
Off
The cabinet is not powered on.
Critical alarm indicator
On (red)
There is a critical alarm.
Off
There is no critical alarm.
Major alarm indicator
On (Orange)
There is a major alarm.
Off
There is no major alarm.
Minor alarm indicator
On (Yellow)
There is a minor alarm.
Off
There is no minor alarm.
critical
major
minor
7.1.2 Subrack Indicator There are four subrack indicators for the OptiX OSN 6800 and OptiX OSN 8800. Indicators are in the following colors: red, yellow and green. The corresponding messages of each indicator are listed in Table 7-2. NOTE
The OptiX OSN 8800 subrack indicators are on the panel of the fan tray assembly.
Table 7-2 Meanings of subrack indicators
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Indicator
Name
Status
Meaning
PWR
Power indicator
On (Green)
The subrack works normally.
Off
The subrack does not work.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
452
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Indicator
Name
Status
Meaning
OptiX OSN 6800: CRI OptiX OSN 8800: CRIT
Critical alarm indicator
On (Red)
There is a critical alarm.
Off
There is no critical alarm.
MAJ
Major alarm indicator
On (Red)
There is a major alarm.
Off
There is no major alarm.
Minor alarm indicator
On (Yellow)
There is a minor alarm.
Blinking slowly (Yellow)
The MIN indicator is in the maintenance blinking mode.
Off
There is no minor alarm.
MIN
7.1.3 Chassis Indicators There are four chassis indicators in the following colors: green, yellow, orange and red. The corresponding messages of each indicator are listed in Table 7-3. Table 7-3 Meanings of chassis indicators Indicator
Name
Status
Meaning
PWR
Chassis power supply indicator
On (green)
The chassis is powered on.
Off
The chassis is not powered on.
On (yellow)
There is a minor alarm.
Off
There is no minor alarm.
On (orange)
There is a major alarm.
Off
There is no major alarm.
On (red)
There is a critical alarm.
Off
There is no critical alarm.
MIN
Minor alarm indicator
MAJ
Major alarm indicator
CRI
Critical alarm indicator
7.1.4 Board Indicators On the front panel of each board, there are indicators, indicating the alarm status and running status of the board. The meanings of the board indicators are listed in Table 7-4, Table 7-5, and Table 7-6. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
453
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Table 7-4 Meanings of board indicators Indicato r
Name
Status
Meaning
STAT
Board hardware indicator
On (green)
The board works normally.
Blinking slowly (green)a
The STAT indicator is in the maintenance blinking mode.
On (red)
A critical/major alarm occurs on the board.
On (yellow)
A minor alarm occurs on the board.
Off
The board is not powered on.
On (red)
The memory check fails.
PROG
Board software indicator
Loading the board software fails. The FPGA file is lost. The board software is lost.
SRV
ACTb
Service alarm indicator
Service activation indicator
Blinking quickly (red)
On for 100 ms and off for 100 ms: The BOOTROM check fails.
Blinking quickly (green)
On for 100 ms and off for 100 ms: Writing the flash memory is in progress.
Blinking slowly (green)
On for 300 ms and off for 300 ms: The BIOS booting is in progress.
On (green)
The board software or FPGA is uploaded successfully, or the board software is initialized successfully.
On (green)
The service is normal with any service alarm.
On (red)
A critical or major service alarm occurs.
On (yellow)
A minor or remote service alarm occurs.
Off
No service is configured.
On (green)
The board is in the working mode. The board is in the active mode.
Off
The board is not in the working mode. The board is in the standby mode.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
454
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Indicato r
LINK/ ACTn
LAS
Name
Data port connection/data transceive indicator
Laser emission status indicator
7 Routine Operation On-site
Status
Meaning
Blinking quickly (green)
On for 100 ms and off for 100 ms: Backing up the system database in batches is in progress.
On (green)
The data port connection is normal.
Off
The data port connection is abnormal.
Blinking quickly (yellow)
On for 100 ms and off for 100 ms: Data ports are receiving and transmitting data.
On (green)
The Raman laser is in the working mode.
Off
The Raman laser is ont in the working mode.
NOTE a: When the STAT indicator on a board is in maintenance blinking mode, the board can be removed. Most of the boards support this function except the following boards: ACS, APIU, ATE, BMD4, BMD8, CMR1, CMR2, CMR4, CRPC, DCM, DCU, DMR1, DFIU, EFI, FAN, TN21FIU, TN13FIU, GFU, TN11ITL, TN11L4G, MB2, MR2, MR4, MR8, PIU, SBM2, SCS, SFIU, STI, TBE, TN11XCS. b: During the testing of the indicators on the TN51AUX board, the ACT indicator is lit orange.
Table 7-5 Meanings of the indicators on the PQ2 sub-board
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Indicato r
Name
Status
Meaning
STAT
Board hardware indicator
On (green)
The PQ2 sub-board works normally.
On (red)
The PQ2 sub-board is abnormal.
On (yellow)
Logical sub-board is not configured.
Off
The PQ2 sub-board is not powered on.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
455
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Table 7-6 Meanings of the indicators on the SCC board Indicato r
Name
Status
Meaning
STAT
Board hardware indicator
On (green)
The board is working normally.
Blinking slowly (green)a
The STAT indicator is in the maintenance blinking mode.
On (red)
A critical alarm occurs on the board.
On (yellow)
A minor alarm occurs on the board.
Off
The board is not powered on.
On (red)
The memory check fails.
PROG
Board software indicator
Loading the board software fails. The FPGA file is lost. The NE software is lost.
SRV
ACT
Service alarm indicator
Service activation indicator
Blinking quickly (red)
On for 100 ms and off for 100 ms: The BOOTROM check fails.
Blinking quickly (green)
On for 100 ms and off for 100 ms: Writing the flash memory is in progress.
Blinking slowly (green)
On for 300 ms and off for 300 ms: The BIOS booting is in progress.
On (green)
The board software or FPGA is uploaded successfully, or the board software is initialized successfully.
On (green)
The service is normal with any service alarm.
On (red)
A critical or major service alarm occurs.
On (yellow)
A minor alarm occurs.
On (green)
The board is in the working mode. The board is in the active mode.
Off
The board is not in the working mode. The board is in the standby mode.
Blinking quickly (green)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
On for 100 ms and off for 100 ms: Backing up the system database in batches is in progress.
456
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Indicato r
Name
Status
Meaning
PWRA
Indicator for system power supply
On (green)
-48 V power supply A is normal.
On (red)
-48 V power supply A is faulty (lost or failed).
Off
No power is input.
On (green)
-48 V power supply B is normal.
On (red)
-48 V power supply B is faulty (lost or failed).
Off
No power is input.
Indicator for protection power supply
On (green)
The +3.3 V protection power is normal.
On (red)
The +3.3 V protection power is lost.
Alarm cut-off indicator
On (yellow)
There is no audible or visual warning in case of an alarm.
Off
Audible warning is generated in case of an alarm.
PWRB
PWRC
ALMC
Indicator for system power supply
NOTE a: When the STAT indicator on a board is in maintenance blinking mode, the board can be removed. The boards that support this function include: TN11SCC, TN16SCC, TN51SCC, TN52SCC, and TNK2SCC.
7.1.5 Fan Indicator There is one indicator on the FAN, indicating the status of the FAN. The corresponding meanings of the Fan indicator are listed in Table 7-7. Table 7-7 Meanings of the FAN indicator
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Indicator
Name
Status
Meaning
OptiX OSN 6800/OptiX OSN 3800: STAT OptiX OSN 8800: FAN
Fan indicator
On (green)
The fan is normal.
On (red)
A major alarm occurs or two or more fans are faulty.
On (yellow)
A minor alarm occurs or one fan is faulty.
Off
The fan is not powered on, is absent, or the software is not loaded.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
457
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
7.1.6 PIU Indicator There is one indicator on the PIU, indicating power access status. The corresponding messages of each indicator are listed in Table 7-8. Table 7-8 Meanings of the PIU indicator Indicator
Name
Status
Meaning
OptiX OSN 6800/OptiX OSN 3800: RUN OptiX OSN 8800: PWR
Running status indicator
On (green)
Indicates that the power is accessed normally.
Off
Indicates that the power is not accessed.
7.2 Testing Optical Power by Using an Optical Power Meter This section describes the basic method for testing optical power by using an optical power meter during the detection of faults and the commissioning.
Prerequisites Before the test, make sure that the laser is closed. After the fiber jumper is connected to the board, open the laser.
Impact on System The services on the tested board are interrupted.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials Fiber jumper, optical power meter, optical fiber extractor
Precaution
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
458
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
WARNING Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
CAUTION Keep the optical connector and end face clean. Cover the fiber immediately after the fiber is removed.
Procedure Step 1 Turn on the optical power meter, set the unit of the optical power to dBm, and set the operating wavelength of the meter to 1550 nm. Step 2 The test of optical power consists of the following two parts: l
Testing the receive optical power: In this test, remove the fiber jumper that is connected to the receive optical port and connect the fiber jumper to the optical power meter.
l
Testing the transmit optical power: In this test, remove the fiber jumper that is connected to the transmit optical port. Connect one end of a known-good fiber jumper to the transmit optical port and the other end to the optical power meter.
Step 3 Open the laser, after the optical power value displayed on the meter is stable, record the value. Step 4 Close the laser, connect the removed fiber jumper back to the optical port, and then open the laser. ----End
7.3 Checking Fiber Jumpers by Using an Optical Power Meter This section describes the basic method for checking a fiber jumper by using an optical power meter during the detection of faults or the commissioning.
Prerequisites The light source must exist and the transmit optical power must be stable. The checked fiber does not have services or services are interrupted.
Impact on System During the test, the services in the tested fiber are interrupted. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
459
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Tools, Equipment, and Materials Fiber jumper, optical power meter, optical fiber extractor, light source
Precaution
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
WARNING Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
CAUTION Keep the optical connector and end face clean. Cover the fiber immediately after the fiber is removed.
Procedure Step 1 Turn on the optical power meter, set the unit of the optical power to dBm, and set the operating wavelength of the meter to 1550 nm. Step 2 Connect one end of a known-good fiber jumper to the light source. Step 3 Connect the other end of the known-good fiber jumper to the optical power meter. Step 4 Enable the laser of the light source that is connected to the fiber jumper. Step 5 Measure the transmit optical power P1 of the light source by using the optical power meter. Step 6 Disconnect the two ends of the fiber jumper. Step 7 Connect one end of the tested fiber jumper to the light source. Step 8 Connect the other end of the tested fiber jumper to the optical power meter. Step 9 Measure the transmit optical power P2 of the light source by using the optical power meter. l
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
If the difference between P1 and P2 is less than 1 dB, it indicates that the fiber connection is normal. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
460
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
7 Routine Operation On-site
If the difference between P1 and P2 is greater than 1 dB, it indicates that the fiber connection is faulty.
----End
7.4 Inserting and Removing Fiber Jumpers This section describes the basic method for replacing a fiber jumper when the fiber jumper is damaged.
Prerequisites The laser that is connected to the fiber jumper must be disabled before the replacement.
Impact on System The services on the fiber jumper where the fiber jumper is replaced are interrupted.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials New fiber jumper, optical fiber extractor
Precaution
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
WARNING Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
CAUTION Before installing a fiber jumper, attach temporary labels to the two ends for distinguishing.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
461
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
CAUTION When replacing the fiber jumper that leads out the cabinet, make sure that the new fiber jumper is routed along the route for the original fiber jumper. In addition, the open corrugated pipe is used to protect the new fiber jumper.
CAUTION Keep the optical connector and end face clean. Cover the fiber immediately after the fiber is removed. NOTE
The type of the fiber jumper before and after the replacement must be the same.
Procedure Step 1 Disconnect the two ends of the fiber jumper to be replaced. Step 2 Insert the new fiber connectors into the corresponding optical ports on the board. Step 3 Lead the optical fibers out from the subrack through the holder at the subrack bottom and the hole at the subrack side. Step 4 Pass the optical fibers to the corresponding subrack side along the space at both sides of the cabinet. Step 5 Make the optical fibers pass through the hole at the subrack side and the holder at the subrack bottom. Step 6 Insert the fiber connectors into corresponding optical ports on the board. Step 7 Coil the redundant optical fibers around the fiber spool at the side of the subrack. Step 8 After the fiber installation, insert fiber plugs in idle ports and cover idle fibers with fiber caps. Step 9 Label the new fiber jumper according to the methods and specifications of labeling for the original fiber jumper. Step 10 Bind the new fiber jumper. NOTE
After replacing the fiber jumper, you should recover the laser status to the status before the replacement.
----End
7.4.1 Inserting the LC/PC Fiber Connector This section describes how to insert LC/PC fiber connectors.
Prerequisites The end face of the fiber must be clean. Wear an ESD wrist strap before carrying out this operation. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
462
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Tools, Equipment, and Materials None
Precautions
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to eyes, or even blindness.
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment or board. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
Procedure Step 1 Remove protective cap on the LC/PC connector. Step 2 Align the LC/PC connector to the optical port on the board. Step 3 Push the connector gently in along the guide rail until it clicks. Figure 7-1 LC/PC fiber connector
LC/PC connector Protective cap
----End
7.4.2 Removing the LC/PC Fiber Connector This section describes how to remove LC/PC fiber connectors. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
463
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Prerequisites The end face of the fiber must be clean. Wear an ESD wrist strap before carrying out this operation.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials Optical fiber extractor, protective cap
Precautions
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment or board. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
Procedure Step 1 Clamp the fiber connector from the up and down sides by hand or with optical fiber extractor. Press down the hook switch. NOTE
The LC/PC fiber connector can be directly pulled out by hand. However, if the optical fibers are arranged densely, a dedicated optical fiber extractor shall be used. Figure 7-2 shows the tweezers-like optical fiber extractor.
Figure 7-2 Tweezers-like optical fiber extractor
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
464
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Step 2 Pull out the optical fiber gently. Step 3 Cover the fiber connector with the protective cap. Figure 7-3 LC/PC fiber connector
LC/PC connector Protective cap
----End
7.4.3 Inserting the LSH/APC Fiber Connector This section describes how to insert LSH/APC fiber connectors.
Prerequisites The end face of the fiber must be clean. Wear an ESD wrist strap before carrying out this operation.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials None
Precautions
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
465
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
DANGER Raman amplifier emits strong light. Do not insert or remove the fiber connector when the laser is working, to avoid damage to human body.
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment or board. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
Procedure Step 1 Remove dust-proof protection cover on the LSH/APC fiber connector. Step 2 Align the connector on optical fiber with the optical port of the board. Step 3 Push the connector gently in along the guide rail. Figure 7-4 LSH/APC fiber connector
LSH/APC connector
Protective slidding cover
----End
7.4.4 Removing the LSH/APC Fiber Connector This section describes how to remove LSH/APC fiber connectors.
Prerequisites The end face of the fiber must be clean. Wear an ESD wrist strap before carrying out this operation.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials Optical fiber extractor Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
466
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Precautions
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
DANGER Raman amplifier emits strong light. Do not insert or remove the fiber connector when the laser is working, to avoid damage to human body.
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment or board. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
Procedure Step 1 Clamp the connector by hand. Step 2 Pull it out gently when it gets loose. NOTE
The LSH/APC fiber connector has a dust-proof protection cover. When the connector is pulled out from the optical port, the protection cover will be closed automatically so as to protect against dust and intense light signals output.
Figure 7-5 LSH/APC fiber connector
Protective slidding cover
LSH/APC connector
----End Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
467
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
7.4.5 Inserting the FC/PC Fiber Connector This section describes how to insert FC/PC fiber connectors.
Prerequisites The end face of the fiber must be clean. Wear an ESD wrist strap before carrying out this operation.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials None
Precautions
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment or board. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
Procedure Step 1 Remove protective cap on the FC/PC connector. Step 2 Align the keyed ridge on the FC/PC fiber connector with the concave slot of the optical port. Step 3 Push in the connector with proper force not to damage the fiber connector. After the connector is seated properly, the keyed ridge shall match the concave slot and the optical connector cannot be turned around. Step 4 When the optical fiber connector is pushed to the bottom, turn the outer ring of the optical connector clockwise to secure the optical fiber connector.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
468
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Figure 7-6 FC/PC fiber connector Protective cap
FC/PC connector
----End
7.4.6 Removing the FC/PC Fiber Connector This section describes how to remove FC/PC fiber connectors.
Prerequisites The end face of the fiber must be clean. Wear an ESD wrist strap before carrying out this operation.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials None
Precautions
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment or board. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
469
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Procedure Step 1 Turn the outer ring of the fiber connector anticlockwise. Step 2 Pull it out gently when it gets loose. Step 3 Cover the fiber connector with the protective cap. Figure 7-7 FC/PC fiber connector Protective cap
FC/PC connector
----End
7.4.7 Inserting the SC/PC Fiber Connector This section describes how to insert SC/PC fiber connectors.
Prerequisites The end face of the fiber must be clean. Wear an ESD wrist strap before carrying out this operation.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials None
Precautions
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
470
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment or board. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
Procedure Step 1 Remove protective cap on the SC/PC connector. Step 2 Align the keyed ridge on the SC/PC fiber connector with the concave slot of the optical port. Step 3 Push the connector in with proper force. After the connector is seated properly, the keyed ridge shall match the concave slot. Step 4 The fiber is not seated properly until it clicks. Figure 7-8 SC/PC fiber connector Protective cap
SC/PC connector
----End
7.4.8 Removing the SC/PC Fiber Connector This section describes how to remove SC/PC fiber connectors.
Prerequisites The end face of the fiber must be clean. Wear an ESD wrist strap before carrying out this operation.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials Optical fiber extractor
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
471
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Precautions
DANGER Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
CAUTION Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap whenever you touch any equipment or board. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
Procedure Step 1 Clamp the SC/PC fiber connector from the up and down sides with the optical fiber extractor. Step 2 Pull out the connector slowly from the optical port with force. Step 3 Cover the fiber connector with the protective cap. Figure 7-9 SC/PC fiber connector Protective cap
SC/PC connector
----End
7.5 Inspecting and Cleaning the Optical Fiber Connectors Cleaning optical components is to remove dust or other dirt to avoid performance degradation of optical transmission systems. Inspecting and cleaning fiber connectors used in fiber optic connections are described here. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
472
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
7.5.1 Overview Overview of the purpose and procedure of cleaning optical fiber connectors, the items that may cause pollution to optical connectors are also described here. Cleaning optical components is to remove dust or other dirt to avoid performance degradation of optical transmission systems. Here describes how to inspect and clean fiber connectors used in fiber optic connections. Figure 7-10 shows the optical fiber connector. Figure 7-10 Optical fiber connector
The following items should be removed because they pollute optical connectors that are extensively adopted in optical transmission systems: l
Dust
l
Oils (frequently from human hands)
l
Film residues (condensed from vapors in the air)
l
Powdery coatings (left after water or other solvents evaporate)
Dust is the most common dirt in optical connectors. Even small dust that can be seen only under a microscope can affect the quality of optical signals, degrade the system performance and cause potential instability in network operation. A one-micrometer dust granule on an optical connector of a single mode fiber can block 1% light and cause 0.05 dB lost. A nine-micrometer dust granule that cannot be seen by human eyes can block an entire fiber core. Therefore, small dirt even that cannot be seen by human eyes should be removed. NOTE
Before you connect any optical component, make sure that you have inspected and cleaned the component.
General Procedure Table 7-9 below describes the general procedure of how to inspect and clean the optical fiber connectors. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
473
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Table 7-9 General procedure of inspecting and cleaning the optical fiber connectors Operation
Details
Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Cartridge Cleaners
See "7.5.5 Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Cartridge Cleaners"
Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Lens Tissue
See "7.5.6 Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Lens Tissue"
Cleaning Optical Adapters Using Optical Cleaning Sticks
See "7.5.7 Cleaning Optical Adapters Using Optical Cleaning Sticks"
7.5.2 Protection of Optical Connectors The requirements of optical connector protection are listed here. The requirements of optical connector protection are: l
All optical port boards must be transported and stored in reliable packing. This serves to avoid mechanical and electrostatic damages and to reduce vibrations.
l
Store the protective caps in an ESD bag.
l
Cover the optical ports of the replaced boards with protective caps in time. Store them in proper packages to keep the optical ports clean.
l
The protective caps recommended are shown in Figure 7-11, and the protective caps not recommended are shown in Figure 7-12.
Figure 7-11 Protective caps recommended
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
474
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Figure 7-12 Protective caps not recommended
NOTE
The air filter caps made of soft rubber are not recommended, which tends to collect dust and sundries. This type of caps provides poor dustproof function.
7.5.3 Tools, Equipment, and Materials The recommended tools, equipment and materials used in cleaning the optical connector are listed here. The recommended tools, equipment and materials are listed below: l
Optical power meter
l
Optical fiberscope with 400x magnification (a video fiberscope is recommended)
l
CLETOP cassette cleaner, see Figure 7-13
l
Clean solvent (Isoamylol is preferred, propyl can be used, alcohol or formalin is never used)
l
Non-woven lens tissue, lint-free wipes or fiber cleaning tissue (Non-woven lens tissue is recommended)
l
Compressed air
l
Optical cleaning sticks used for optical connectors or cotton swabs (medical cotton or long fiber cotton) See Figure 7-14 and Figure 7-15
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
475
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Figure 7-13 CLETOP cassette cleaner
Figure 7-14 Cleaning stick for the SC and FC optical ports (for reference only)
Figure 7-15 Cleaning stick for the LC optical port
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
476
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
7.5.4 Inspecting Optical Connectors The following describes how to inspect the optical connectors and check the status of the fiber surface.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials The tools, equipment and materials are listed below: l
Optical power meter
l
Optical fiberscope with 400x magnification (a video fiberscope is recommended)
Precautions
WARNING Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness. Use a fiberscope equipped with a safety device or a desktop video fiberscope when you inspect the optical connectors. If one is not available, turn off the lasers and disconnect both ends of the fiber before you inspect the optical connectors
CAUTION Electro static discharge (ESD) is hazardous to the electronic equipment. Use proper handlings to prevent damage to the electronic equipment. Failure to follow this caution can cause equipment damage and/or loss of traffic
Procedure Step 1 Turn off the lasers before the inspection. Disconnect both ends of the fiber to be inspected. Step 2 Test the optical power using a power meter. Ensure that the laser is turned off. Step 3 Use a fiberscope to inspect the fiber to check if there is any dirt or damage. See the examples shown below. l For an image of the intact fiber optic surface through a fiberscope that can be used successfully in the equipment, see Figure 7-16.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
477
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Figure 7-16 An intact fiber
l For images of fibers through a fiberscope with imperfections that can impair the function of the assembly, see Figure 7-17. The image on the left shows clearly a damaged fiber. Severely damaged fibers must not be used in the system equipment. Otherwise, permanent and severe damage to the assembly can occur. The image on the right shows a fiber that is suspect. If the output power is within an acceptable range, the fiber might not cause any damage to the assembly. If the output power is unstable or falls outside the acceptable range, however, the fiber can cause damage to the assembly and must not be used. Figure 7-17 Damaged or suspect fibers
NOTE
The views shown do not represent the entire surface of the fiber optic. Much of the surface is the metal connector and only the 800-micron core is the actual fiber.
l For details on acceptable and unacceptable fibers, see Figure 7-18, Figure 7-19 and Figure 7-20. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
478
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Figure 7-18 An intact fiber
Figure 7-19 Acceptable fibers with imperfections
Figure 7-20 Unacceptable fibers with imperfections
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
479
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Step 4 If any dirt is detected, clean the optical connector. For details, see "7.5.5 Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Cartridge Cleaners" and "7.5.6 Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Lens Tissue". Step 5 If any damage is detected, replace the fiber or board. ----End
7.5.5 Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Cartridge Cleaners Clean the fiber optic only in the case that there are flaws on it. The following describes how to clean the fiber optic with a type of CLETOP cassette cleaner.
Prerequisites Before cleaning, inspect the fiber optic surface with a fiberscope or a magnifier to determine the extent to which the fiber optic might be damaged or dirty. Clean the fiber optic only in the case that there are flaws on it. If there are not, do not clean it. That is because the cleaning itself might introduce dust, dirt, or cause potential damage to the fiber optic. The following procedure provides the steps to clean the fiber connectors using cartridge type cleaners. There are several types of cartridge cleaners. The following describes a type of CLETOP cassette cleaner.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials The tools, equipment and materials are listed below: l
CLETOP cassette cleaner
l
Optical power meter
l
Optical fiberscope with 400x magnification (a video fiberscope is recommended)
Precautions
WARNING Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
CAUTION ESD is hazardous to the electronic equipment. Use proper handlings to prevent damage to the electronic equipment. Failure to follow this caution can cause equipment damage and/or loss of traffic.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
480
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Procedure Step 1 Turn off the lasers before the inspection. Disconnect both ends of the fiber to be inspected. Step 2 Use a power meter to measure and ensure that there is no laser light on the optical connector. Step 3 Press down and hold the lever of the cassette cleaner, and the shutter slides back and exposes a new cleaning area. See Figure 7-21. Figure 7-21 Using the CLETOP cassette cleaner
Step 4 Place the fiber tip lightly against the cleaning area so that the end face is flat on the cleaning area Step 5 Drag the fiber tip lightly on one cleaning area in the direction of the arrow once. See Figure 7-22. Do it again on the other cleaning area in the same direction as the first time once. See Figure 7-23.
CAUTION Do not scrub the fiber against fabric or clean over the same cleaning area more than once. Otherwise, the connector can be dirtied or damaged.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
481
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Figure 7-22 Dragging the fiber tip lightly on one cleaning area
Figure 7-23 Dragging the fiber tip lightly on the other cleaning area
Step 6 Release the lever of the cassette cleaner to close the cleaning area. Step 7 Use a fiberscope to inspect the adapter to check if there is any dirt. For details see the examples shown in 7.5.4 Inspecting Optical Connectors. If the optical adapter is still dirty, repeat the Step 1 to Step 6. Step 8 Connect the fiber connector to the board. Step 9 Turn on the lasers after you connect the fiber to the board. ----End Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
482
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
7.5.6 Cleaning Optical Fiber Connectors Using Lens Tissue Clean the fiber optic only in the case that there are flaws on it. The following procedure provides the steps to clean the fiber connectors using lens tissue.
Prerequisites Before cleaning, inspect the fiber optic surface with a fiberscope or a magnifier to determine the extent to which the fiber optic might be damaged or dirty. Clean the fiber optic only in the case that there are flaws on it. If there are not, do not clean it. That is because the cleaning itself might introduce dust, dirt, or cause potential damage to the fiber optic. The following procedure provides the steps to clean the fiber connectors using lens tissue. Use only the special materials for cleaning the fiber connectors. See the local site practices.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials The tools, equipment and materials are listed below: l
Optical power meter
l
Optical fiberscope with 400x magnification (a video fiberscope is recommended)
l
Clean solvent. (Isoamylol is preferred, propyl can be used. Alcohol or formalin is never used)
l
Non-woven lens tissue, lint-free wipes or fiber cleaning tissue (Non-woven lens tissue is recommended)
l
Compressed air
Precautions
WARNING Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
CAUTION ESD is hazardous to the electronic equipment. Use proper handlings to prevent damage to the electronic equipment. Failure to follow this caution can cause equipment damage and/or loss of traffic.
Procedure Step 1 Turn off the lasers before the inspection. Disconnect both ends of the fiber to be inspected. Step 2 Use a power meter to measure and ensure that there is no laser light on the optical connector. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
483
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Step 3 Place a small amount of cleaning solvent on the lens tissue. Step 4 Clean the fiber tip on the lens tissue. See Figure 7-24 and Figure 7-25.
CAUTION Do not scrub the fiber against fabric or clean over the same cleaning area more than once. Failure to comply can result in connector dirt or damage.
CAUTION Move the fiber connector in the same direction when you wipe the fiber connector on the lens tissue. Figure 7-24 Cleaning the fiber tip with the lens tissue on the desk
Figure 7-25 Cleaning the fiber tip with the lens tissue on the hand
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
484
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Step 5 Repeat Step 4 several times on the areas of the lens tissue that have not been used. Step 6 Use the compressed air to blow off the fiber tip. NOTE
l When you use the compressed air, keep the injector nozzle as close as possible to the fiber connector surface without touching it. l When you use the compressed air, first spray it into the air as the initial spray of compressed air can contain some condensation or propellant. Such condensation leaves behind a filmy deposit. l If the compressed air is not available, a clean roll can be used.
Step 7 Use a fiberscope to inspect the adapter to check if there is any dirt. For details, see the examples shown in 7.5.4 Inspecting Optical Connectors. If the optical adapter is still dirty, repeat the Step 1 to Step 6. Step 8 Do not touch the fiber connector after you clean it. Connect it to the optical port board at once. If it is not used for the time being, put a protective cap on it. NOTE
A piece of lens tissue can be used for only one time.
Step 9 Turn on the lasers after you connect the fiber to the board. ----End
7.5.7 Cleaning Optical Adapters Using Optical Cleaning Sticks Optical adapters must be cleaned with special cleaning tools and materials. The following procedure provides the steps to clean optical adapters using optical cleaning sticks.
Prerequisites There are several types of optical cleaning sticks and cotton swabs that can be used. See the local site practices. You can obtain these tools and materials from a fiber cable and connector manufacturer.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials The tools, equipment and materials are listed below: l
Optical power meter
l
Optical fiberscope with 400x magnification (a video fiberscope is recommended)
l
Clean solvent. (Isoamylol is preferred, propyl can be used. Alcohol or formalin is never used)
l
Compressed air
l
Optical cleaning sticks used for optical connectors or cotton swabs (medical cotton or long fiber cotton)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
485
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Precautions
WARNING Laser is dangerous. The light is not visible to the eyes with or without laser protective glasses. Do not look into optical connectors or ports. Failure to follow this warning can cause damage to the eyes, or even blindness.
CAUTION ESD is hazardous to the electronic equipment. Use proper handlings to prevent damage to the electronic equipment. Failure to follow this caution can cause equipment damage and/or loss of traffic.
Procedure Step 1 Turn off the lasers before the inspection. Disconnect both ends of the fiber to be inspected. Step 2 Test the optical power using a power meter. Ensure that the laser is turned off. Step 3 Select the cleaning stick with a proper diameter for a certain type of the adapter. NOTE
For the SC and FC optical port, use the cleaning stick with a diameter of 2.5 mm( 0.1 in.); for the LC optical port, use the cleaning stick with a diameter of 1.25 mm( 0.05 in.). See Figure 7-14 and Figure 7-15.
Step 4 Place a small amount of cleaning solvent on the optical cleaning stick. Step 5 Place the optical cleaning stick lightly on the optical adapters so that cleaning solvent is against the fiber tip. Hold the stick straight out from the adapter and turn the stick clockwise one circuit. Make sure that there is direct contact between the stick tip and fiber tip. Step 6 Use the compressed air to blow off the fiber tip. NOTE
l When you use the compressed air, keep the injector nozzle close to the connector surface without touching it. l When you use the compressed air, first spray it into the air as the initial spray of compressed air can contain some condensation or propellant. Such condensation leaves behind a filmy deposit.
Step 7 Use a fiberscope to inspect the adapter to check if there is any dirt. For details, see the examples shown in "7.5.4 Inspecting Optical Connectors". If the optical adapter is still dirty, repeat the Step 1 to Step 6. Step 8 Connect the fiber to the board, or put a protective cap on the port. Step 9 Turn on the lasers after you connect the fiber to the board. ----End Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
486
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
7.6 Performing Hardware Loopback Manually perform loopback to a physical port (optical port) with a fiber.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials Optical power meter, fixed attenuator, fiber jumper
Background Information Figure 7-26 shows the difference between software loopback and hardware loopback. Based on the loopback position, hardware loopbacks on the SDH ports are classified into the self-loop at the same board and the cross-connect self-loop at the same site, as shown in Table 7-11. Figure 7-26 Differences between hardware loopback and software loopback Transmitting module
Hardware loopback
Software loopback
Receiving module
Table 7-10 Hardware loopback on the WDM port Category Description Diagram
Category Description Diagram
Hardware loopback on OTU boards
Client-side loopback
Category Description Diagram
Rx Optical attenuator
IN OTU
Tx
OUT
Client side
WDM-side loopback
Rx
IN OTU
Tx Client side
Hardware loopback on tributary boards
Client-side loopback
WDM side
Optical attenuator
OUT
Optical attenuator
WDM side
Rx Tributary unit Tx Client side
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
487
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Category Description Diagram
Category Description Diagram
Hardware loopback on line boards
WDM-side loopback
7 Routine Operation On-site
Category Description Diagram
IN Optical attenuator
Line unit OUT WDM side
Table 7-11 Hardware loopback on the SDH port Category Description Diagram
Category Description Diagram
Self-loop at the same board
Using one fiber jumper or cable to connect the transmit port to the receive port of the same port board.
Cross-connect self-loop at the same site
Using the fiber jumpers or cables to connect the transmit port of the west port board to the receive port of the east interface board, and to connect the transmit port of the east interface board to the receive port of the west interface board.
Category Description Diagram
IN
IN
OUT OUT Optical Optical Interface Interface Board Board
IN
IN
OUT
OUT
West optical interface board
Eest optical interface board
Precautions
CAUTION When you perform hardware loopback, add an optical attenuator according to the range of the optical power received by different boards.
Procedure Step 1 Before a hardware loopback, use an optical power meter to measure the optical power of the output optical port (OUT).
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
488
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
Step 2 Based on the received optical power range of boards, select a proper fixed attenuator. For details about the range of each board, see the Hardware Description. Step 3 Use fiber jumper to connect the output optical port to the input port on the board, to perform a loopback. ----End
7.7 Reset a Board 7.7.1 Performing a Warm Reset on the Board When a board works abnormally, you might need to perform a warm reset of the board.
Prerequisites You must be an NM user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher.
Impact on System In the case of the SCC board, the impacts of resetting the board are as follows: l
The communication between the U2000 and the SCC board and between the SCC board and other boards stops.
A warm reset of boards does not affect the running services.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials U2000
Background Information Warm reset of the SCC board: l
After a warm reset of the SCC board, FPGA of the board is not updated, and the configuration data in the memory of the board remains the same. When a fault is detected, a warm reset is preferred.
l
A warm reset can be performed in any of the following methods: – By using the U2000: It is applicable to remote maintenance. In this method, the communication between the U2000 and the SCC board must be normal. – By pressing the RESET button on the SCC board: It is applicable to field maintenance or the situation where the communication between the U2000 and the SCC board stops.
Warm reset of the other boards: l
After a warm reset of other boards, FPGA of the boards is not updated, and the configuration data in the memory of the board remains the same.
l
A warm reset can be performed in the following method:
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
489
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
– By using the U2000: It is applicable to remote maintenance. In this method, the communication between the U2000 and the SCC board and between the SCC board and other boards must be normal.
Performing a Warm Reset of a Board 1.
Right-click the desired board in the NE panel window.
2.
Select Warm Reset from the shortcut menu. The warm reset maybe service-affecting. Then, the Warning dialog box is displayed. Click OK. NOTE
If Cold Reset is not present in the shortcut menu, then board does not support the cold reset function.
3.
Click Close on the Result dialog box displayed.
7.7.2 Performing a Cold Reset on the Board When a board works abnormally, you might need to perform a cold reset of the board.
Prerequisites You must be an NM user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher.
Impact on System If you perform a cold reset of the SCC board, the U2000 stops communicating with the SCC board, and the SCC board stops communicating with the other boards. If you perform a cold reset of the TN16XCH board, the U2000 stops communicating with the TN16XCH board, and the TN16XCH board stops communicating with the other boards. A cold reset of other boards affects the running services. If a reset of such a board is failing, it affects the communication between the board and the system control board, or even interrupts services. A cold reset on boards other than the SCC board affects the running services. A reset failure on these boards affects the communication between the board and the system control board, or even interrupts services.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials U2000
Background Information Cold reset of the SCC board: l
When the SCC board is faulty, perform a warm reset of the SCC board. If the fault persists after a warm reset, perform a cold reset.
l
The methods of performing a cold reset of the SCC board are as follows: – Perform a cold reset by removing and then inserting the SCC board. This method applies to field maintenance or scenarios where the SCC board fails to communicate with the U2000.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
490
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
7 Routine Operation On-site
– Perform a cold reset on the U2000. This method applies to remote maintenance where the communication between the SCC board and the U2000 is normal. Cold reset of the TN16XCH board: l
When the TN16XCH board is faulty, perform a warm reset of the TN16XCH board. If the fault persists after a warm reset, perform a cold reset.
l
The methods of performing a cold reset of the TN16XCH board are as follows: – Perform a cold reset by removing and then inserting the TN16XCH board. This method applies to field maintenance or scenarios where the TN16XCH board fails to communicate with the U2000. – Perform a cold reset on the U2000. This method applies to remote maintenance where the communication between the TN16XCH board and the U2000 is normal.
Cold reset of the other boards: l
After a cold reset of other boards, FPGA of the boards is updated, which is service-affecting. Perform a warm reset of the board, if the fault persists after a warm reset, perform a cold reset.
l
A cold reset can be performed in any of the following methods: – By using the U2000: It is applicable to remote maintenance. In this method, the communication between the U2000 and the system control board must be normal, and the communication between the board and the system control board must be normal. – By removing and then inserting the board: It is applicable to field maintenance or the situation where the communication between the board and the system control board stops. If you perform a cold reset of the board by reseating the board, see the procedure in Replacing a Board.
Performing a Cold Reset of a Board on the U2000 1.
Right-click the desired board in the NE panel window.
2.
Choose Cold Reset from the shortcut menu. The cold reset may be service-affecting. Then, the Warning dialog box is displayed. Click OK. NOTE
If Cold Reset is not present in the shortcut menu, then board does not support the cold reset function.
3.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click Close on the Result dialog box displayed.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
491
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8
Parts Replacement
About This Chapter
8.1 General Guide for Replacing a Board Most boards are replaced in similar fashion, and this section provides guidance for replacing a common board. 8.2 Replacing an SCC Board with One of the Same TNxx Version This section describes the procedure for replacing an SCC board with one of the same TNxx version. 8.3 Replacing the SCC Board with One of a Different TNxx Version This section describes how to replace an SCC board with an SCC board of a later TNxx version. The replacement mainly involves the SCC boards for the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 and OptiX OSN 6800. 8.4 Replacing the TN16XCH Board This section describes how to replace TN16XCH board. 8.5 Replacing the Cross-Connect Board This section describes how to replace the Cross-Connect boards. 8.6 Replacing the Raman Amplifier Board This section describes how to replace the Raman amplifier board. 8.7 Replacing the PID Board This section describes how to replace the PID board. 8.8 Replacing the AUX Board This section describes how to replace the AUX board. 8.9 Replacing the DCM This section describes how to replace the DCM. 8.10 Replacing the Pluggable Optical Module This section describes how to replace the pluggable optical module (eSFP/XFP). 8.11 Replacing the EFI Frame This section describes how to replace the EFI frame in the OptiX OSN 6800. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
492
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8.12 Replacing the EFI Board This section describes how to replace the EFI board in the OptiX OSN 8800. 8.13 Replacing the PIU Board This section describes how to replace the PIU board. 8.14 Replacing the Power Switch on the DC Power Distribution Box This section describes how to replace a faulty power switch on the DC power distribution box. 8.15 Replacing the Fan Tray Assembly This section describes how to replace the fan tray assembly. 8.16 Replacing the Air Filter Replace the air filter periodically to ensure efficient heat dissipation from the equipment. 8.17 Replacing SDI Components This section describes how to replace a component (such as fan module, power supply module, and control board) on the digital video O/E conversion chassis and how to replace the SDIspecific SFP module on the TOM board. 8.18 Replacing the Subrack If the backplane of a subrack has bent pins or other defects, the subrack must be replaced. This section describes how to replace the subrack.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
493
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8.1 General Guide for Replacing a Board Most boards are replaced in similar fashion, and this section provides guidance for replacing a common board. It applies to the following boards: l
optical transponder boards
l
tributary and line boards
l
optical multiplexer and demultiplexer boards
l
optical add and drop multiplexing boards
l
reconfigurable optical add and drop multiplexing boards
l
optical amplifier boards
l
optical supervisory channel boards
l
optical protection boards
l
spectrum analyzer boards
l
variable optical attenuator boards
l
optical power and dispersion equalizing boards
l
clock boards
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
494
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
l If the software version of the spare board is V100R004C01 or earlier, perform the following operations before replacing the board: l If the board is installed in the OptiX OSN 3800 subrack, no operation is required. l If the OptiX OSN 8800 T64 functions as the master subrack, you need to take the following actions on the replacement board before replacing any original board on the NE. Otherwise, the services of the active boards in other slots may be interrupted. l a. Install the spare board to any available slot of the OptiX OSN 6800 subrack of version V100R004C02 or later. Note that the master subrack of the NE where the OptiX OSN 6800 subrack is located cannot be OptiX OSN 8800 T64. l b. When the replacement board is in service, review the indicators on the board. If any indicator flashes abnormally, reset or replace the replacement board. For description of the indicators, see "Indicator". l c. Double-click the icon of the optical NE in the Physical View, and the NE Panel is displayed. Click the NE where the replacement board resides. l d. Right-click the slot where the replacement board resides. Choose Add Physical Board from the shortcut menu. l e. Right-click the slot where the replacement board resides. Choose Version from the shortcut menu to query the board software version information, and record the displayed version information. l f. Right click the slot where the replacement board resides. Choose Delete from the shortcut menu. l g. Right-click the slot where the board to be replaced or the board with the same type as the board to be replaced resides. Choose Version from the shortcut menu. If the version is the same as that recorded in Step e, it indicates that the process of the replacement board is successful. Otherwise, reset or replace the replacement board, and repeat Steps a to g. l h. Remove the replacement board, and the process of the replacement board is complete. l i. Replace the fault board. For more information, refer to "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. l If the OptiX OSN 8800 T64 does not function as the master subrack, and the board to be replaced is in any slot of the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 or OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack on the NE, you need to perform the following operations on the replacement board before replacing the original board. Otherwise, the services of the active boards in other slots may be interrupted. If the board is installed in the OptiX OSN 6800 subrack, no operation is required. l a. Install the spare board in any available slot of the OptiX OSN 6800 subrack of version V100R004C02 or later. l b. For other operations, see the previous steps b to i.
8.1.1 Prerequisite For the operations on the NMS, you must be an NMS user with "NE operator and network " authority or higher.
8.1.2 Impact on the System This section describes the impact of board replacement on services. Board Type
Impact on System when Replacing a Board
Optical Transponder Board Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Protection is configured
No protection is configured
Client 1+1 protection
Replacing a board causes all
Replacing a board has no impact on services.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
495
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Type
Impact on System when Replacing a Board
Tributary Board
Line Board
8 Parts Replacement
Protection is configured
No protection is configured
SNCP protection
When SNCP protection is configured, replacing the OTU where the sink node is located brings a service interruption. Replacing an OTU on other nodes generally brings no impact on services.
services carried by the board interruption
ERPS protection
Replacing a board causes service interruption at the site where the board is configured but has no impact on the services on the whole ring.
Client 1+1 protection
Replacing a board has no impact on services.
Tributary SNCP protection
Replacing a board has no impact on services.
Client 1+1 protection
Before replacing a line board, check if the service from the line to a tributary board is provided with the client 1+1 protection on the tributary board. If the protection is provided, replacing the line board brings no service interruption upon a normal switching. If the protection is not provided, replacing the line board brings a service interruption.
ODUk SNCP protection
Replacing a board has no impact on services.
ODUk SPRing protection
In the case of four-fiber ring, replacing a line board brings no service interruption in case of a normal switching.
When other protection is configured, replacing a board will cause service interruption.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
496
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Board Type
8 Parts Replacement
Impact on System when Replacing a Board Protection is configured
Optical Multiplexer and Demultiplexer Board
No protection is configured
Optical Power and Dispersion Equalizing Board
Replacing a board causes an interruption on all traditional services carried by the board. If ASON services traverse the board to be replaced, optimize the ASON services traversing the board to other paths (the preset restoration paths of the services are preferred if they do not traverse the board to be replaced) before board replacement. For optical-layer ASON services, the new paths must be commissioned; otherwise, the services may be interrupted. After board replacement, preset the insertion loss of the new board and re-commission the original paths. Then, switch the ASON services back to the original paths. If no other paths are available during board replacement, the ASON services will be interrupted.
Optical Supervisory Channel Board
Replacing a board causes interruption of the optical supervisory channel services, but has no impact on services.
Optical Protection Board
Replacing a board causes an interruption on all services carried by the board.
Spectrum Analyzer Board
Replacing a board has no impact on services.
Clock Board
For OptiX OSN 8800, 1+1 protection is configured for clock boards. Replacing a clock board will trigger switching on the active and standby clock boards, therefore, services are not affected.
Optical Add and Drop Multiplexing Board Optical Amplifier Board Variable Optical Attenuator Board
During board replacement, the board software takes several minutes to be synchronized. At this point, the PROG indicator on the board is blinking green quickly. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
8.1.3 Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, ESD wrist strap, Phillips screwdriver, flashlight, optical power meter, and U2000
8.1.4 Precautions This section describes the precautions to be taken before you replace optical transponder boards, line boards, tributary boards, and clock boards.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
497
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Optical Transponder Board
CAUTION Before connecting a fiber to the input optical port of a board, measure the optical power. You can directly connect a fiber to the input optical power of the board only when the measured optical power is within the permitted range of the receive optical power for the optical module on the board. If the measured optical power is beyond the permitted range, you must add a VOA before connecting the fiber to prevent the receiver optical module from being burned or damaged. The overload optical power point of an APD receiver laser is only -9 dBm, which must be considered with caution to prevent the optical module from being burned or damaged. l
Before replacing the board, ensure that the wavelength of the new board is consistent with that of the original board. NOTE
The wavelength of the board is printed on the PCB board.
l
Before replacing the board, test the input optical power. Prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module will be burned or damaged.
l
Before replacing the board, query and record the 15-minute BER before FEC at the receive end of the link.
l
If the client 1+1 protection is configured, perform the following steps: 1.
Before replacing the board, query the working status of the board to be replaced.
2.
If the board to be replaced is the current working board, perform an active/standby switchover on the U2000. NOTE
The channel status of the protection board must be normal. Otherwise, replacing the faulty board causes a service interruption. At the opposite end of the link, perform a manual switchover on the U2000 at the same time.
3. l
After replacing the board, query the state of the new board and ensure that it is the working board.
If the SNCP protection is configured, perform the following steps: 1.
Before replacing the board, query the working status of the board to be replaced.
2.
If the board to be replaced is the working board and the service sink does no reside on the board, perform an active/standby switchover on the U2000. NOTE
The channel status of the protection board must be normal. Otherwise, replacing the faulty board causes a service interruption. At the opposite end of the link, perform a manual switchover on the U2000 at the same time.
3. l
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
After replacing the board, query the state of the new board and ensure that it is the working board.
After replacing the board, query the wavelength of the new board on the U2000. Make sure the wavelength is the same as that of the original board. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
498
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
If the replaced board is a tunable OTU, after the board is replaced, the SCC automatically delivers the wavelength configuration of the original board.
l
After replacing the board, query the 15-minute BER before FEC at the receive end of the link. Make sure that the BER before FEC does not deteriorate greatly from the value before board replacement.
Line Board
CAUTION Before connecting a fiber to the input optical port of a board, measure the optical power. You can directly connect a fiber to the input optical power of the board only when the measured optical power is within the permitted range of the received optical power for the optical module on the board. If the measured optical power is beyond the permitted range, you must add a VOA before connecting the fiber to prevent the receiver optical module from being burned or damaged. The overload optical power point of an APD receiver laser is only -9 dBm, which must be considered with caution to prevent the optical module from being burned or damaged. l
Before replacing the board, ensure that the wavelength of the new board is consistent with that of the original board. NOTE
The wavelength of the board is printed on the PCB board.
l
Before replacing the board, query and record the 15-minute BER before FEC at the receive end of the link.
l
Before replacing the board, test the input optical power. Prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module will be burned or damaged.
l
If the ODUk SNCP protection or ODUk SPRing protection (four-fiber ring) is configured, perform the following steps: 1.
Before replacing the board, query the working status of the board to be replaced.
2.
If the board to be replaced is the current working board, perform an active/standby switchover on the U2000. NOTE
The channel status of the protection board must be normal. Otherwise, replacing the faulty board causes a service interruption. At the opposite end of the link, perform a manual switchover on the U2000 at the same time.
3.
After replacing the board, query the state of the new board and ensure that it is the working board.
l
After replacing the board, query the wavelength of the new board on the U2000. Ensure the wavelength is the same as that of the original board.
l
After replacing the board, query the 15-minute BER before FEC at the receive end of the link. Ensure that the BER before FEC does not deteriorate greatly from the value before board replacement.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
499
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Tributary Board
CAUTION Before connecting a fiber to the input optical port of a board, measure the optical power. You can directly connect a fiber to the input optical power of the board only when the measured optical power is within the permitted range of the received optical power for the optical module on the board. If the measured optical power is beyond the permitted range, you must add a VOA before connecting the fiber to prevent the receiver optical module from being burned or damaged. The overload optical power point of an APD receiver laser is only -9 dBm, which must be considered with caution to prevent the optical module from being burned or damaged. l
Before replacing the board, test the input optical power. Prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module will be burned or damaged.
l
If the client 1+1 protection or tributary SNCP protection is configured, perform the following steps: 1.
Before replacing the board, query the working status of the board to be replaced.
2.
If the board to be replaced is the current working board, perform an active/standby switchover on the U2000. NOTE
The channel status of the protection board must be normal. Otherwise, replacing the faulty board causes a service interruption. At the opposite end of the link, perform a manual switchover on the U2000 at the same time.
3.
After replacing the board, query the state of the new board and ensure that it is the working board.
Clock Board Before replacing the board, perform an active/standby switchover on the U2000. NOTE
For OptiX OSN 8800 T32, assume that the clock board to be replaced is located in slot 42, it is the main clock board, the clock board in slot 44 works normally and the subrack where it is located has no BUS_ERR alarm. For OptiX OSN 8800 T64, assume that the clock board to be replaced is located in slot 75, it is the main cross-connect board, the clock board in slot 86 works normally and the subrack where it is located has no BUS_ERR alarm.
8.1.5 Procedure for Replacing a Board This section provides the common procedure for replacing a board. When replacing a board, strictly comply with the procedure provided in this section.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, TNxx version, and type of the new board are the same as those of the original board. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
500
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
If the TNxx versions of the new board and the original board are not the same, you need to determine whether the new board can be substituted for the original board. For more information regarding the substitution relationships between boards of different versions, refer to "Substitution Relationship".
Step 2 Review and record current NE alarms. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE.
Step 3 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 4 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and remove the fibers and cables on the board to be replaced. 1.
Wear a well-grounded ESD wrist strap. Make sure that the wrist strap fully touches your skin. Insert the connector of the ESD strap into the ESD socket in the subrack.
2.
Record the mapping relationships of the board ports and the fibers.
3.
Remove the fiber jumpers connecting to the optical interfaces on the board. Keep the optical connector and end face clean. Cover the fiber immediately after the fiber is removed. The cable connector must be sealed to avoid short circuit.
Step 5 Remove the board to be replaced. 1.
Optional: If there are screws on the front panel, loosen the captive screws on the front panel of the board.
2.
Grip the ejector levers and apply an outward force until the ejector levers become horizontal and the connector of the board leave the backplane.
3.
Apply force gently outward to pull out the board completely.
4.
Put the replaced board in an ESD bag and attach a maintenance label on the bag. The label should contain the NE name and fault description.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
501
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-1 Removing a board of OptiX OSN 8800/6800 subrack 2
Figure 8-2 Removing a cross-connect board of OptiX OSN 8800 subrack
1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
2
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
502
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-3 Removing a board in the interface area of the OptiX OSN 8800 subrack 1
2
3
1 2
3
4
Figure 8-4 Removing a board of OptiX OSN 3800 chassis
Step 6 Insert the new board. 1. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Check the pins on the backplane using a flashlight. Ensure that no pin is bent. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
503
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2.
8 Parts Replacement
Check that the connectors on the board are in good condition. Figure 8-5 Position of connectors on a board
Figure 8-6 Example of a damaged connector
3.
Raise the ejector levers of the board using two hands and align the board with the guide rail of the slot.
4.
Slowly slide the board along the guide rail into the slot until it can no longer move forward.
5.
Lower the ejector levers to hold the beam of the subrack.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
504
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-7 Installing a board of the OptiX OSN 8800/6800 subrack
Figure 8-8 Installing a cross-connect board of the OptiX OSN 8800 subrack
1
2
Figure 8-9 Installing a board in the interface area of the OptiX OSN 8800 Subrack 1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
2
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
3
505
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-10 Installing a board of the OptiX OSN 3800 chassis
6.
Optional: If there are screws on the front panel, tighten the two captive screws on the panel of the board.
7.
Insert the fibers into the connectors on the board according to the mapping relationship. NOTE
After the board is replaced, the NE software delivers the configuration of the original board automatically.
Step 7 Review the indicators of the new board. It takes ten minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator gives an abnormal indication, reinsert the board or replace the board again. Step 8 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances issues are cleared. ----End
8.1.6 Substitution Relationships This section describes the substitution relationships of the boards.
8.1.6.1 Optical Transponder Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the optical transponder unit boards. The following board has substitution relationships.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
506
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
LOG Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11LOG
TN12LOG
The TN12LOG can be created as TN11LOG on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN12LOG functions as the TN11LOG. NOTE l When both the receive board and transmit board adopt the FEC code pattern, the substitution applies; when both the receive board and transmit board adopt the AFEC code pattern, the substitution does not apply. l A board with PIN as the receiver type cannot substitute for a board with APD as the receiver type, because their ranges of receive optical power are different.
TN12LOG
None
-
Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11LOM
TN12LOM
The TN12LOM can be created as TN11LOM on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN12LOM functions as the TN11LOM.
LOM
NOTE l When both the receive board and transmit board adopt the FEC code pattern, the substitution applies; when both the receive board and transmit board adopt the AFEC code pattern, the substitution does not apply. l A board with PIN as the receiver type cannot substitute for a board with APD as the receiver type, because their ranges of receive optical power are different.
TN12LOM
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
None
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
507
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
LSX Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11LSX
TN12LSX
The TN12LSX can be created as TN11LSX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN12LSX functions as the TN11LSX. NOTE A board with PIN as the receiver type cannot substitute for a board with APD as the receiver type, because their ranges of received optical power are different.
TN13LSX
The TN13LSX can be created as TN11LSX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN13LSX functions as the TN11LSX. NOTE l When both the receive board and transmit board adopt the FEC code pattern, the substitution applies; when both the receive board and transmit board adopt the AFEC code pattern, the substitution does not apply. l A board with PIN as the receiver type cannot substitute for a board with APD as the receiver type, because their ranges of receive optical power are different.
TN12LSX
TN13LSX
The TN13LSX can be created as TN12LSX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN13LSX functions as the TN12LSX. NOTE l When both the receive board and transmit board adopt the FEC code pattern, the substitution applies; when both the receive board and transmit board adopt the AFEC code pattern, the substitution does not apply. l A board with PIN as the receiver type cannot substitute for a board with APD as the receiver type, because their ranges of receive optical power are different.
TN13LSX
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
None
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
508
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
TMX Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11TMX
TN12TMX
The TN12TMX can be created as TN11TMX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN12TMX functions as the TN11TMX. NOTE l When both the receive board and transmit board adopt the FEC code pattern, the substitution applies; when both the receive board and transmit board adopt the AFEC code pattern, the substitution does not apply. l A board with PIN as the receiver type cannot substitute for a board with APD as the receiver type, because their ranges of receive optical power are different.
TN12TMX
None
-
8.1.6.2 Tributary and Line Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the tributary and line boards. The following board has substitution relationships.
ND2 Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11ND2
TN12ND2
The TN12ND2 can be created as TN11ND2 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN12ND2 functions as the TN11ND2. NOTE When both the receive board and transmit board adopt the FEC code pattern, the substitution applies; when both the receive board and transmit board adopt the AFEC code pattern, the substitution does not apply.
TN12ND2
TN53ND2
The TN53ND2 can be created as TN12ND2 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN53ND2 functions as the TN12ND2. NOTE The TN53ND2 does not support OTU2e services at rate 11.3 Gbit/s on the WDM side and it cannot substitute for the TN12ND2 in relay mode at rate 11.3 Gbit/s.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
509
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN52ND2
TN53ND2
The TN53ND2 can be created as TN52ND2 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN53ND2 functions as the TN52ND2. NOTE The TN53ND2 does not support OTU2e services at rate 11.3 Gbit/s on the WDM side and it cannot substitute for the TN52ND2 in relay mode at rate 11.3 Gbit/s.
TN53ND2
None
-
Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN51NQ2
TN52NQ2/ TN53NQ2
The TN52NQ2 /TN53NQ2 board can be created as TN51NQ2 on the NMS to function as a TN51NQ2 board. In this scenario, the TN52NQ2 /TN53NQ2 only provides the functions of the TN51NQ2 board, and the board software does not need to be upgraded.
NQ2
NOTE When both the receive board and transmit board adopt the FEC code pattern, the substitution applies; when both the receive board and transmit board adopt the AFEC code pattern, the substitution does not apply.
TN52NQ2
TN53NQ2/ TN54NQ2
The TN53NQ2/TN54NQ2 can be created as TN52NQ2 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN53NQ2/TN54NQ2 functions as the TN52NQ2. NOTE Only OptiX OSN 8800 supports the TN54NQ2.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
TN54NQ2
TN53NQ2
The TN53NQ2 board can be created as TN54NQ2 on the NMS to function as a TN54NQ2 board. In this scenario, the TN53NQ2 board only provides the functions of the TN54NQ2 board, and the board software does not need to be upgraded.
TN53NQ2
None
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
510
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NS2 Table 8-1 Substitution rules of the NS2 board Origin al Board
Substi tute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11N S2
None
-
TN12N S2
TN53 NS2
The TN53NS2 can be created as TN12NS2 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN53NS2 functions as the TN12NS2. NOTE When both the receive board and transmit board adopt the FEC code pattern, the substitution applies; when both the receive board and transmit board adopt the AFEC code pattern, the substitution does not apply.
TN52N S2
TN53 NS2
The TN53NS2 can be created as TN52NS2 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN53NS2 functions as the TN52NS2.
TN53N S2
None
-
NS3 Table 8-2 Substitution rules of the NS3 board
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11NS3
TN52NS3
The TN52NS3 can be created as TN11NS3 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN52NS3 functions as the TN11NS3.
TN52NS3
None
-
TN54NS3
None
-
TN55NS3
None
-
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
511
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
TDX Table 8-3 Substitution rules of the TDX board Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11TDX
None
-
TN12TDX
TN53TDX
The TN53TDX can be created as TN12TDX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN53TDX functions as the TN12TDX.
TN52TDX
TN53TDX
The TN53TDX can be created as TN52TDX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN53TDX functions as the TN52TDX.
TN53TDX
None
-
TQX Table 8-4 Substitution rules of the TQX board Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11TQX
TN55TQX
The TN55TQX can be created as TN11TQX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN55TQX functions as the TN11TQX.
TN52TQX
TN55TQX
The TN55TQX can be created as TN52TQX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN55TQX functions as the TN52TQX.
TN53TQX
TN55TQX
The TN55TQX can be created as TN53TQX on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN55TQX functions as the TN53TQX.
TN55TQX
None
-
8.1.6.3 Optical Multiplexer and Demultiplexer Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the optical multiplexer and demultiplexer boards. The following board has substitution relationships. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
512
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
M40 Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11M40
TN12M40
The TN12M40 board can be created as TN11M40 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter without any software upgrade. After the substitution, the TN12M40 board functions as the TN11M40 board. The TN12M40 board occupies two physical slots and three logical slots while the TN11M40 board occupies three physical slots. After the substitution, the remaining one physical slot cannot be used to house any other board.
TN12M40
None
-
Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11M40V
TN12M40 V
The TN12M40V can be created as TN11M40V on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After the substitution, the TN12M40V board functions as the TN11M40V board. The TN12M40V board occupies two physical slots and three logical slots while the TN11M40V board occupies three physical slots. After the substitution, the remaining one physical slot cannot be used to house any other board.
TN12M40V
None
-
Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11D40
TN12D40
The TN12D40 can be created as TN11D40 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After the substitution, the TN12D40 board functions as the TN11D40 board. The TN12D40 board occupies two physical slots and three logical slots while the TN11D40 board occupies three physical slots. After the substitution, the remaining one physical slot cannot be used to house any other board.
TN12D40
None
-
M40V
D40
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
513
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8.1.6.4 Optical Add and Drop Multiplexing Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the optical add and drop multiplexing boards. This type of boards does not have substitution relationships.
8.1.6.5 Reconfigurable Optical Add and Drop Multiplexing Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the reconfigurable optical add and drop multiplexing boards. This type of boards does not have substitution relationships.
8.1.6.6 Optical Amplifier Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the optical amplifier boards. The following board has substitution relationships.
OAU1 Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11OAU1
TN12OAU 1, TN13OAU 1
The TN12OAU1 and TN13OAU1 can be created as TN11OAU1 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN12OAU1 and TN13OAU1 function as the TN11OAU1.
TN12OAU1
TN13OAU 1
The TN13OAU1 can be created as TN12OAU1 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter at type 01,03,05, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN13OAU1 functions as the TN12OAU1.
TN13OAU1
None
-
Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11OBU1
TN12OBU 1
The TN12OBU1 can be created as TN11OBU1 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN12OBU1 functions as the TN11OBU1.
TN12OBU1
None
-
OBU1
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
514
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
OBU2 Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11OBU2
TN12OBU 2
The TN12OBU2 can be created as TN11OBU2 on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TN12OBU2 functions as the TN11OBU2.
TN12OBU2
None
-
8.1.6.7 Optical Supervisory Channel Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the optical supervisory channel boards. This type of boards does not have substitution relationships.
8.1.6.8 Optical Protection Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the optical protection boards. This type of boards does not have substitution relationships.
8.1.6.9 Spectrum Analyzer Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the spectrum analyzer boards. This type of boards does not have substitution relationships.
8.1.6.10 Variable Optical Attenuator Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the variable optical attenuator boards. This type of boards does not have substitution relationships.
8.1.6.11 Optical Power and Dispersion Equalizing Boards This section describes the substitution relationships of the optical power and dispersion equalizing board. This type of boards does not have substitution relationships.
8.1.6.12 Clock Board This section describes the substitution relationship of the STG board. This type of boards does not have substitution relationships.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
515
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8.2 Replacing an SCC Board with One of the Same TNxx Version This section describes the procedure for replacing an SCC board with one of the same TNxx version. NOTE
TNxx indicates the board hardware version that is displayed on the PCB board.
l
In the OptiX OSN 8800 T16, the SCC board fills one slot in the subrack. The valid slots for the SCC board are IU9 and IU10. IU9 is the first choice. If there is 1+1 protection for the SCC board, IU10 is the default slot for the standby SCC.
l
In the OptiX OSN 8800 T32, the SCC board fills one slot in the subrack. The valid slots for the SCC board are IU11 and IU28. IU28 is the first choice. If there is 1+1 protection for the SCC board, IU11 is the default slot for the standby SCC.
l
In the OptiX OSN 8800 T64, the SCC board fills one slot in the subrack. The valid slots for the SCC board are IU74 and IU85. IU74 is the first choice. If there is 1+1 protection for the SCC board, IU85 is the default slot for the standby SCC.
l
In the OptiX OSN 6800, the SCC board fills one slot in the subrack. The valid slots for the SCC board are IU17 and IU18. IU18 is the first choice. If there is 1+1 protection for the SCC board, IU17 is the default slot for the standby SCC.
l
In the OptiX OSN 3800, the SCC board fills one slot in the subrack. The valid slots for the SCC board are IU8 and IU9. IU9 is the first choice. If there is 1+1 protection for the SCC board, IU8 is the default slot for the standby SCC. NOTE
If there is SCC 1+1 protection, the data on the active SCC board is synchronized to the standby SCC board after the standby board is replaced. No manual setting of NE ID is required on the standby board. When the 1+1 protection is not provided, NE ID must be set. Consult Huawei technical support engineers before replacing an SCC board.
CAUTION To help prevent unsynchronized data, do not remove the SCC board during batch data backup. Do not directly insert a standby SCC board that is removed from an ASON NE in to the master subrack of another ASON NE so that the SCC board functions as the active SCC board of the latter NE. Before inserting the SCC board, ensure that the node ID and OSPF IP address that are saved on the SCC board are unique on the entire ASON network. You can replace the SCC board on the OptiX OSN 8800/6800 when: l
The SCC board of the master subrack is configured with SCC 1+1 protection.
l
There is no protection for the SCC board of the master subrack.
l
You are replacing the SCC board of the slave subrack.
You can replace the SCC board on the OptiX OSN 3800 when: l Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
The SCC board of the master subrack is configured with SCC 1+1 protection. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
516
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
8 Parts Replacement
There is no protection for the SCC board.
8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC This section describes how to set the battery jumpers and BIOS jumpers on the spare SCC board before replacing the SCC board. The battery on the SCC helps to ensure that the configuration is kept upon a power failure of the SCC. If the board is in use, place a jumper cap over the battery jumper to make a short circuit, which allows the battery to supply power normally. If the board is not in use, use a jumper cap to disconnect the battery jumper.Figure 8-11 shows the battery jumper. The BIOS jumper helps clear the system parameter area and database in the flash memory on the SCC board. Table 8-5 shows the function of the BIOS jumper. Figure 8-11 battery jumper
Not used
Used
3
2
1
Table 8-5 Function of the BIOS jumper Jumper Settings
Description
1010
Clear the system parameter area.
1011
Clear the database in the flash memory.
1111
Clear all the data in the flash memory except the board manufacturing information. The data includes the system data, system parameter areas, and extended BIOS files. The upper layer part of BIOS is not started.
1001
Restores the system parameter area, database, and NE software from the CF card.
Figure 8-12 shows the position of jumpers on the TN11SCC board. Figure 8-13 shows the position of jumpers on the TN16SCC board. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
517
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-14 shows the position of jumpers on the TN21SCC board. Figure 8-15 shows the position of jumpers on the TN22SCC board. Figure 8-16 shows the jumpers on the TN51SCC board. Figure 8-17 shows jumpers on the TN52SCC board. Figure 8-18 shows jumpers on the TNK2SCC board. Figure 8-12 Position of the jumpers on the TN11SCC board 01 02 03 04
1010 01 02 03 04
1001 01 02 03 04
1011 01 02 03 04
CPU
1111 BIOS running mode
1 2 CF card
01020304
3 Battery jumper
BIOS running mode
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Battery jumper
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
518
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-13 Position of the jumpers on the TN16SCC board SW1 ON
1010 1
2
3
4
OFF
SW1 ON
1001 BIOS Running Mode
SW1 ON 1 234
J1
OFF
Battery Jumper
1
2
3
4
SW1 ON
321
1011 1
CF Card
OFF
2
3
4
OFF
SW1 ON
1111 1
2
3
4
OFF
BIOS Running Mode
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
519
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-14 Position of the jumpers on the TN21SCC board
BIOS running mode
CPU
01 02
03 04 J13
01 02
1010
J13
2
1001 J14
03 04 J13
01 02
1 Battery jumper
1011 J14
03 04 J13
3
J14 03 04
01 02
Battery jumper
J13J14
1111 J14
BIOS running mode
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
520
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-15 Position of the jumpers on the TN22SCC board
BIOS running mode
J11 J13
CPU
01 02
01 02 J11
03 04
J11 03 04
J13
1010
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
01 02
Battery jumper
01 02 J11
03 04
3 J11
03 04
J13
J13
1001
1011
BIOS running mode
2 1
J13
Battery jumper
1111
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
521
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-16 Position of the jumpers on the TN51SCC board BIOS running mode
04 03 1010 02 01
04 03 02 01
U45
J42
J42
J1
J12 Battery jumper
04 03 1001 02 01
U42
J42
CPU
321 04 03 1011 02 01
CF card J42
04 03 1111 02 01 J42 BIOS running mode
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
522
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-17 Position of the jumpers on the TN52SCC board 01 02 03 1010 04
CPU
J1
Battery jumper
321
BIOS running mode
01 02 03 04
U18
U33
J11 01 02 03 1001 04
J11 J11
01 02 03 1011 04
CF card J11
01 02 03 1111 04 J11 BIOS running mode
Figure 8-18 Position of the jumpers on the TNK2SCC board Battery jumper
BIOS running mode 01020304
J9
CPU
3 2 1
J44
CF card
01 02 03 04
01 02 03 04 J9
1010
01 02 03 04 J9
1001
01 02 03 04 J9
1011
J9
1111
BIOS running mode
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
523
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8.2.2 Replacing the Protected SCC in a Master Subrack This section describes how to replace the SCC board of the master subrack when SCC 1+1 protection is configured.
Prerequisites l
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
l
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
l
The SCC replacement board must be the same type as the SCC board being replaced.
Impact on the System Replacing an SCC board configured with protection does not affect the existing services. For SCC 1+1 protection, replacing one of the SCC in the protection group does not interrupt communication between the NE where the SCC board resides and the U2000 after you switch services from one SCC board to the other SCC board.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials l
ESD bag
l
U2000
l
Multimeter
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement board. Ensure that the spare SCC board and the SCC board to be replaced have the same name and are of the same type.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
524
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
The 1X3 battery jumper on the replacement board enables or disables the power supply from the battery. Ensure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper are capped. Then, remove the cap of pin 1 and cap of pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The selected SCC board cannot be used as a replacement board.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Back up the NE database to the NMS server. This is to record the NE database for future reference when the SCC board is replaced. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the device(s) that you want to backup in the NE View table. NOTE
The Backup Information tab is unavailable when multiple devices are selected.
3.
Select Backup... to open the Backup dialog.
4.
Select the option NMS Server or NMS Client to backup the selected device information. NOTE
By default the NMS Server is selected. If the NMS Server is selected, the selected device information is stored on the NMS server.
5.
Optional: If the NMS Client is selected, click data are to be backed up.
6.
Click Start to start the backup operation for the selected device(s). On the NE View tab page, the backup progress is displayed.
7.
When the backup operation is successful, the NMS creates the dbf.pkg file in the NEName/ yyyymmddhhmmss directory. "NEName" indicates the name of the NE, "yyyymmdd" indicates the date when the backup is created, and "hhmmss" indicates the time when the backup is created.
to select the location where the device
Step 4 Follow the steps below to review the working state of the board to be replaced. 1.
In the NE Explorer, click the NE and choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Query.
Step 5 If the board to be replaced is the active board, go to Step 6. Otherwise, go to Step 7. Step 6 If the board to be replaced is the working board, complete the following the steps to perform an active/standby switching on the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click the desired SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Working/Protection Switching from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed.
4.
Click Query. If the Active Board is not the board to be replaced, the switching is successful.
5.
Query the alarms and performance events on the U2000. Check if services are normal. If services are normal, there must be no new abnormal alarms or performances. The switching is successful.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
525
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 7 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 8 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For details about how to remove a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 9 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board to set the BIOS running mode. Then insert the SCC board to the slot housing the original SCC board to format the file system of the new SCC board. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1111 to clear all the data in the flash memory except the board manufacturing information. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 15 minutes to allow the database to be cleared.
Step 10 After the file system of the SCC board is formatted completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which you set in Step 9. Reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 11 View the indicators on the front panel of the new board. It takes approximately 90 minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator is not steady green, you need to reinsert the board or select a new replacement board. For details about the indicators, see Board Indicators. Step 12 Optional: Follow the steps below to switch the active/standby state of the SCCs back to the original state. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Restore Working/Protection from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed. NOTE
After you start the new SCC board, the system automatically synchronizes the data between the existing SCC board and the new SCC board. After data backup completes, perform the preceding step to initiate active/standby switching.
Step 13 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
6.
Check whether the switching state is correct. Perform a switching test.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
526
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
For details about how to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 14 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.2.3 Replacing the Unprotected SCC in a Master Subrack This section describes how to replace an SCC board in the master subrack when no protection is configured for the SCC board. Table 8-6 Modes of replacing the SCC of the master subrack without protection Scenario
Mode
Remarks
The NE is reachable on the U2000.
Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data to the NMS
The database of the NE must be backed up. After replacing the SCC, restore the database to the NE. The first mode is recommended. If a slot is available for another SCC, configure the system to provide 1+1 SCC protection.
Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data to a CF Card Replacing the SCC Board After Configuring SCC 1+1 Protection Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
527
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Scenario The NE is not reachable on the U2000.
8 Parts Replacement
Mode
Remarks
A backup database is stored on the U2000.
Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data from the NMS
No backup database is stored on the U2000.
Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data from a CF Card
The current database of the NE cannot be backed up. After the SCC is replaced, the NE can only read the database on the U2000 or the database on the CF card saved during the last backup.
No backup database is stored on the U2000, and the CF board has failed.
Manually reconfigure NE parameters as required
8.2.3.1 Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data from the NMS (NE Is Unreachable) If the NE is unreachable because of SCC damage, you can restore the NE database from the NMS after replacing the SCC board.
Prerequisites l
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
l
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
l
The SCC replacement board must be the same type as the SCC board being replaced.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC board does not affect traditional services, but ASON services may be affected for a short time when configurations are restored by downloading the database.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter, Web LCT
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
528
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Precautions
CAUTION l
If the NE where the SCC to be replaced resides is an ASON NE, the Node ID of the NE must be set according to the original data after the SCC is replaced. Otherwise, the NE database and ASON service cannot be restored.
l
Operations on the U2000 must be performed in the network management center.
l
Operations on the Web LCT must be performed on site.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board. Ensure that the spare SCC board and the SCC board to be replaced have the same name and are of the same type. NOTE
The 1X3 jumper on the replacement board enables or disables the power supply from the battery. Ensure that pin 1 and pin 2 of each jumper are capped. Then, remove the cap of pin 1 and cap pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The selected SCC board cannot be used as a replacement.
Step 2 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 3 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and remove the board. For details about how to remove a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 4 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board so as to set the BIOS running mode of the board and then insert it to the slot housing the original SCC board. In this manner, the database on the new SCC board is cleared. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1011 to clear the database in the flash memory. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
529
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green. 3.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1010 to clear the system parameter area. For the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board, see 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC.
4.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
Step 5 After the database of the SCC board is cleared completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 4. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 6 After the new SCC board starts, connect the Web LCT to the NE. 1.
Disconnect the cables from the NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 ports (if connected). That is, disconnect the NE from the computer where the U2000 (hereinafter the computer is referred to as U2000) is installed.
2.
Connect the Web LCT to NM_ETH1.
3.
Set the IP address of the Web LCT to ensure that Web LCT is in the same IP subnet segment as the NE IP address. If the IP address of the Web LCT and the NE IP address are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. NOTE
The new board is initiated at the factory, and the default IP subnet segment of the board is 129.9.*.*.
4.
Log in to the Web LCT with the user name admin, and the initial password admin.
Step 7 Create the NE by using the Web LCT. 1.
Click NE Search > Advanced Search in the NE List. The Search NE dialog box is displayed.
2.
Click Manage Domain. The Manage Domain Search dialog box is displayed.
3.
Click Add. The New Domain dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Domain Type to GNE IP Domain or GNE IP Address. Enter an IP address in the Domain Address field.
5.
Click OK. NOTE
Repeat step 3 through 5 to add multiple search domains.
6.
Close the Manage Domain Search dialog box.
7.
Select the appropriate network segment IP addresses within the Domain and click Search. NOTE
l The NE search function searches for only the NEs in the specified network segment. l When the search is in progress, you can click End Search.
8.
After the search is complete, select an NE from the list and click Add NE. A prompt message is displayed, indicating that the NE is successfully added. Click OK.
9.
Select the NE that you want to log in and click NE Login in the lower right corner or rightclick the NE and choose NE Login. In the NE Login dialog box that is displayed, enter lct and password in the User Name and Password fields, and then click OK.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
530
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
TIP
You can select multiple NEs at a time by concurrently pressing Shift. If you select the Use same user name and password to login check box, you can log in to multiple NEs at a time by entering the user name and password only in the first line. If you select the Use the user name and password that was used last time check box, you do not need to enter the use name and password and the system automatically uses the user name and password for login last time.
Step 8 Modify the NE IP, gateway IP and subnet mask based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
2.
Enter the NE IP address, gateway IP address and subnet mask, and click Apply.
3.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box pops up.
4.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box about communication interruption between NEs pops up.
5.
Click Close after the Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
If the NE IP addresses before and after the modification are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. When this occurs, set the IP address of the Web LCT in the same network segment as the NE IP address.
Step 9 Modify the NE ID and extended ID based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, choose Configuration > NE Attribute from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Modify NE ID. In the Modify NE ID dialog box that is displayed, enter values in the New ID and New Extended ID fields, and then click OK.
3.
A Warning dialog box is displayed, click Yes. A dialog box indicating that the operation is successful is displayed, click Close to complete changing the NE ID. At this time, the NE is unreachable.
Step 10 Check the NE communication parameters using the Web LCT. 1.
Select the NE you just created and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
3.
Check that all NE communication parameters are the same as the original ones.
Step 11 Create a user for an NE using the Web LCT. NOTE
The created NE user must be included in the activated database and the password must match that recorded in the database. Otherwise, activating the database fails.
1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Create and the Add NE User dialog box is displayed.
3.
Enter the NE user name in the NE User field.
4.
Select the User Level as needed.
5.
Enter the password in the New Password field and enter it again in the Confirm Password field.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
531
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
You also need to set the Whether the password is allowed to be modified immediately parameter. The password is a string of 6-16 characters. It can consist of letters, symbols and numerals, and must contain at least one letter and one numeral.
6.
Click OK.
7.
Click Query, and the Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. All created users of the NE are displayed in NE User Management Table.
Step 12 If the NE is an ASON NE, modify the node ID of the NE by using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Click the Node ID Management tab.
2.
Click Query to view the current node ID of the NE.
3.
Double-click the Node ID field to enter a node ID for the NE.
4.
Click Apply. After you confirm the operation twice, a prompt appears telling you that the operation was successful. NOTE
You can also choose Configuration > WDM ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu and set the NE node ID.
Step 13 Recover the network connection of the NE. 1.
Remove the network cable which connected the NM_ETH1 port to the Web LCT.
2.
Connect the network cable removed in the Step 6. NOTE
After this procedure, you can use the original user name and password to access the NE by using the U2000.
Step 14 If the software version of the spare SCC board is different from the software version of the SCC board to be replaced, go to Step 15; otherwise, go to Step 16. Step 15 Upgrade or downgrade the software of the spare SCC board. For details, see the Upgrade Guide. Ensure that the software version of the spare SCC board is consistent with that of the SCC board to be replaced. Step 16 Restore the NE database from the NMS server. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the devices that you want to recover in the NE View table.
3.
Select Recover... to open the Recover dialog.
4.
In the File Name drop-down list, select the file to be recovered. If the backup file is listed in the File Name drop-down list, select the file to be recovered, and turn to 16.7. If the backup file is not listed in the File Name drop-down list, click Browse... to select the backup file in the Select File dialog box.
5.
Select NMS Server or NMS Client to recover the backup file for the selected devices. By default NMS Server is selected. l If NMS Server is selected, select the appropriate backup file from the NMS server. The selected backup file path is displayed in the Select File field. to select the backup file from the NMS Client. l If NMS Client is selected, click The selected backup file path is displayed in the Select File field.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
532
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6.
8 Parts Replacement
Click OK. NOTE
The selected backup file path from the NMS Server or NMS Client is displayed in the File Name dropdown list.
7.
Click Start, the Operation Confirmation dialog box is displayed.
8.
In the Operation Confirmation dialog, click Yes to start the recovery operation. The recovery operation status is displayed in the NE View table. NOTE
You must activate the NE database within five minutes after restoring it.
CAUTION During the process of backing up databases through restoring databases, do not modify the NE configurations to avoid database inconsistency. Step 17 Activate the NE database. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Select the NE where the SCC that has been replaced resides in the NE View table.
3.
Right-click the NE. A pop-up menu is displayed.
4.
Select Activate Database..., and the Activate Database dialog box is displayed.
5.
icon in Deliver To Board Activate. This icon is changed to . Optional: Click the Click Start to start the database activation process. The progress of the database activation is displayed on the NE View tab. NOTE
The operation on the U2000 may result in a service interruption.
Step 18 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
6.
Configure the OSPF IP address of the NE if the site complies with the models for separated optical and electrical NEs and the NE is on an optical-layer ASON network. NOTE
For details to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 19 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
533
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE.
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.2.3.2 Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data from a CF Card (NE Is Unreachable) When the NE is unreachable resulting from a damages SCC board, restore the NE database from the CF card after replacing the SCC board if there is no backup data on the NMS.
Prerequisites You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher. The SCC replacement board must be the same type as the SCC board being replaced.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC board does not affect traditional services, but ASON services may be affected for a short time when configurations are restored by downloading the database.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter, Web LCT
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
534
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Precautions
CAUTION l If the NE where the SCC to be replaced resides is an ASON NE, the Node ID of the NE must be set according to the original data after the SCC is replaced. Otherwise, the ASON service cannot be restored. l After the database of the NE is restored on the CF card, the restoration must be completed within two hours after you install the replacement SCC. If you wait more than two hours to restore the database of the NE on the CF card, the data automatically saved on the NE overwrites the original data stored on the CF card. If the original data is overwritten, the original database of the NE cannot be restored. l Operations on the U2000 must be performed in the network management center. l Operations on the Web LCT must be performed on site.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement board. Ensure that the spare SCC board and the SCC board to be replaced have the same name and are of the same type. NOTE
The 1X3 jumper (namely, the battery jumper) on the board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Make sure that pin 1 and pin 2 of each jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The board must be replaced.
Step 2 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 3 Remove the SCC board to be replaced. For details about how to remove a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 4 On the SCC board that has been removed, hold the CF card and pull the card out of the CF card slot. Put the SCC into an ESD bag. NOTE
Keep the CF card because it is required for NE data restoration.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
535
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 5 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board so as to set the BIOS running mode of the board and then insert it to the slot housing the original SCC board. In this manner, the database on the new SCC board is cleared. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1011 to clear the database in the flash memory. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
3.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1010 to clear the system parameter area. For the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board, see 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC.
4.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
Step 6 After the database of the SCC board is cleared completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 5. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 7 After the new SCC board is started, connect the Web LCT to the NE. 1.
Disconnect the cables from the NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 ports (if connected). That is, disconnect the NE from the computer where the U2000 (hereinafter the computer is referred to as U2000) is installed.
2.
Connect the Web LCT to NM_ETH1.
3.
Set the IP address of the Web LCT to ensure that Web LCT is in the same IP subnet segment as the NE IP address. If the IP address of the Web LCT and the NE IP address are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. NOTE
The new board is initiated at the factory, and the default IP subnet segment of the board is 129.9.*.*.
4.
Log in the Web LCT with the user name admin, and the initial password admin.
Step 8 Create the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
Click NE Search > Advanced Search in the NE List. The Search NE dialog box is displayed.
2.
Click Manage Domain. The Manage Domain Search dialog box is displayed.
3.
Click Add. The New Domain dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Domain Type to GNE IP Domain or GNE IP Address. Enter an IP address in the Domain Address field.
5.
Click OK. NOTE
Repeat step 3 through 5 to add multiple search domains.
6.
Close the Manage Domain Search dialog box.
7.
Select the appropriate network segment IP addresses within the Domain and click Search.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
536
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
l The NE search function searches for only the NEs in the specified network segment. l When the search is in progress, you can click End Search.
8.
After the search is complete, select an NE from the list and click Add NE. A prompt message is displayed, indicating that the NE is successfully added. Click OK.
9.
Select the NE that you want to log in and click NE Login in the lower right corner or rightclick the NE and choose NE Login. In the NE Login dialog box that is displayed, enter lct and password in the User Name and Password fields, and then click OK. TIP
You can select multiple NEs at a time by concurrently pressing Shift. If you select the Use same user name and password to login check box, you can log in to multiple NEs at a time by entering the user name and password only in the first line. If you select the Use the user name and password that was used last time check box, you do not need to enter the use name and password and the system automatically uses the user name and password for login last time.
Step 9 Modify the NE IP, gateway IP and subnet mask based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
2.
Enter the NE IP address, gateway IP address and subnet mask, and click Apply.
3.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box pops up.
4.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box about communication interruption between NEs pops up.
5.
Click Close after the Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
If the NE IP addresses before and after the modification are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. When this occurs, set the IP address of the Web LCT in the same network segment as the NE IP address.
Step 10 Modify the NE ID and extended ID based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, choose Configuration > NE Attribute from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Modify NE ID. In the Modify NE ID dialog box that is displayed, enter values in the New ID and New Extended ID fields, and then click OK.
3.
A Warning dialog box is displayed, click Yes. A dialog box indicating that the operation is successful is displayed, click Close to complete changing the NE ID. At this time, the NE is unreachable.
Step 11 Check the NE communication parameters using the Web LCT. 1.
Select the NE you just created and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
3.
Check that all NE communication parameters are the same as the original ones.
Step 12 Create a user for an NE using the Web LCT. NOTE
The created NE user must be included in the activated database and the password must match that recorded in the database. Otherwise, activating the database fails.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
537
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Create and the Add NE User dialog box is displayed.
3.
Enter the NE user name in the NE User field.
4.
Select the User Level as needed.
5.
Enter the password in the New Password field and enter it again in the Confirm Password field. NOTE
You also need to set the Whether the password is allowed to be modified immediately parameter. The password is a string of 6-16 characters. It can consist of letters, symbols and numerals, and must contain at least one letter and one numeral.
6.
Click OK.
7.
Click Query, and the Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. All created users of the NE are displayed in NE User Management Table.
Step 13 If the NE is an ASON NE, modify the node ID of the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Click the Node ID Management tab.
2.
Click Query to view the current node ID of the NE.
3.
Double-click the Node ID field to enter a node ID for the NE.
4.
Click Apply. After you confirm the operation twice, a prompt appears telling you that the operation was successful. NOTE
You can also choose Configuration > WDM ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu and set the NE node ID.
Step 14 Restore the network connection of the NE. 1.
Remove the network cable which connected the NM_ETH1 port to the Web LCT.
2.
Connect the network cable removed. NOTE
After this procedure, you can use the original user name and password to access the NE using the U2000.
Step 15 After the SCC board is started, remove the SCC board just inserted. Insert the CF card that has been removed in Step 4 into the CF card slot on the SCC board. Then insert the SCC. Step 16 If the software version of the spare SCC board is different from the software version of the SCC board to be replaced, go to Step 17;, otherwise, go to Step 18. Step 17 Upgrade or downgrade the software of the spare SCC board. For details, see the Upgrade Guide. Ensure that the software version of the spare SCC board is consistent with that of the SCC board to be replaced. Step 18 Restore the initial database of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Configuration > NE Configuration Data Management from the Main Menu, and the NE Configuration Data Management interface is displayed.
2.
In the Object Tree on the left, select an NE and click
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
. 538
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
3.
In NE Configuration, select an NE or multiple NEs.
4.
Click Restore NE Database from CF Card. The Confirm dialog box is displayed, indicating that the restoration of the NE database may lead to service interruption.
5.
Click OK to start to restore the NE database. NOTE
If the database is performing a scheduled backup task, a message will be displayed on the NMS, indicating that restoring data from the CF card will fail. In this scenario, you are advised to wait 5 minutes, and restore data again from the CF card after the database finishes the scheduled backup task.
6.
Click Closeafter an Operation Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
After the NE databases are restored, the NE software issues the data in the CF card to only the SCC board but not other boards. To ensure that the configurations in the SCC board and the configurations in other boards are consistent, you need to perform warm resets on other boards.
CAUTION During the process from backing up databases to restoring databases, do not modify the NE configurations to avoid database inconsistency. Step 19 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
6.
Configure the OSPF IP address of the NE if the site complies with the models for separated optical and electrical NEs and the NE is on an optical-layer ASON network. NOTE
For details to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 20 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
539
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.2.3.3 Replacing the SCC After Configuring SCC 1+1 Protection If the slot designated for the standby SCC board is vacant and will not house a service board, you can replace the SCC board by installing the new SCC board in the vacant slot and then performing an active/standby switchover on the SCC boards.
Prerequisites l
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
l
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
l
The type of the replacement SCC board is the same as the SCC board to be replaced.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC does not affect the existing services. The impact caused by replacing an SCC without protection is as follows: l
For the OptiX OSN 8800 T16, the SCC is housed in IU9 by default. When IU10 is not occupied by another board, it is available for another SCC to implement 1+1 protection with the SCC in IU9. In this case, replacing one of the SCC in the protection group does not interrupt the communication between the NE where the SCC resides and the U2000 after a switching from this SCC to the other SCC is performed.
l
For the OptiX OSN 8800 T32, the SCC is housed in IU28 by default. When IU11 is not occupied by another board, it is available for another SCC to implement 1+1 protection with the SCC in IU28. In this case, replacing one of the SCC in the protection group does not interrupt the communication between the NE where the SCC resides and the U2000 after a switching from this SCC to the other SCC is performed.
l
For the OptiX OSN 8800 T64, the SCC is housed in IU74 by default. When IU85 is vacant, it is available for another SCC to implement 1+1 protection with the SCC in IU74. In this case, replacing one of the SCC in the protection group does not interrupt the communication between the NE where the SCC resides and the U2000 after a switching from this SCC to the other SCC is performed.
l
For the OptiX OSN 6800, the SCC is housed in IU18 by default. When IU17 is not occupied by another board, it is available for another SCC to implement 1+1 protection with the SCC in IU18. In this case, replacing one of the SCC in the protection group does not interrupt the communication between the NE where the SCC resides and the U2000 after a switching from this SCC to the other SCC is performed.
l
For the OptiX OSN 3800, the SCC is housed in IU9 by default. When IU8 is not occupied by another board, it is available for another SCC to implement 1+1 protection with the SCC in IU9. In this case, replacing one of the SCC in the protection group does not interrupt the
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
540
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
communication between the NE where the SCC resides and the U2000 after a switching from this SCC to the other SCC is performed.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter, Web LCT
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Precautions
CAUTION l
If the NE where the SCC to be replaced resides is an ASON NE, the Node ID of the NE must be set according to the original data after the SCC is replaced. Otherwise, the NE database and ASON service cannot be restored.
l
Operations on the U2000 must be performed in the network management center.
l
Operations on the Web LCT must be performed on site.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement board. Ensure that the spare SCC board and the SCC board to be replaced have the same name and type. NOTE
The 1X3 battery jumper on the replacement board enables or disables the power supply from the battery. Ensure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper. Then, remove the cap of pin 1 and cap of pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The selected SCC board cannot be used as a replacement board.
Step 2 Back up the NE database to the NMS server. This records the NE database for future reference when the SCC board is replaced. 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
541
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2.
8 Parts Replacement
Right click the device(s) that you want to backup in the NE View table. NOTE
The Backup Information tab is unavailable when multiple devices are selected.
3.
Select Backup... to open the Backup dialog.
4.
Select the option NMS Server or NMS Client to backup the selected device information. NOTE
By default the NMS Server is selected. If the NMS Server is selected, the selected device information is stored on the NMS server.
5.
Optional: If the NMS Client is selected, click data are to be backed up.
6.
Click Start to start the backup operation for the selected device(s). On the NE View tab page, the backup progress is displayed.
7.
When the backup operation is successful, the NMS creates the dbf.pkg file in the NEName/ yyyymmddhhmmss directory. "NEName" indicates the name of the NE, "yyyymmdd" indicates the date when the backup is created, and "hhmmss" indicates the time when the backup is created.
to select the location where the device
Step 3 Set the jumpers on the spare SCC board using the following methods and insert it to the specified slot for a standby SCC board. In this manner, the file system of the new SCC board is formatted. NOTE
After inserting the spare SCC board to the specified slot for a standby SCC board, you need to add a corresponding logical board on the U2000. Then, the system automatically configures 1+1 protection for the SCC.
1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1111 so as to clear all the data in the flash memory except the board manufacturing information. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board to the slot housing the original SCC board, and wait for 15 minutes to allow the file system to be formated.
Step 4 After the file system of the SCC board is formated completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 3. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 5 View the indicators on the front panel of the new board. It takes approximately 90 minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator is not steady green, you need to reinsert the board or select a new replacement board. For details about the indicators, see Board Indicators. Step 6 Log in to the U2000 and complete the following steps to perform an active/standby switch between the SCC boards. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click the desired SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Working/Protection Switching from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed.
4.
Click Query. If the Active Board is not the board to be replaced, the switching is successful.
5.
Query the alarms and performance events on the U2000. Check if services are normal. If services are normal, there must be no new abnormal alarms or performances. The switching is successful.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
542
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
After the new SCC board is started, the system automatically backs up the data on the existing SCC board to the new SCC board. After the data is backed up, you can perform the preceding step to initiate an active/ standby switching.
Step 7 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring. NOTE
For details to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 8 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. Step 9 Remove the physical SCC board and put it in an ESD bag. Then, on the U2000, delete the logical board of the SCC board to be replaced. ----End
8.2.3.4 Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data to the NMS (NE Is Reachable) Before replacing an SCC board, you can back up the NE database to the NMS if the NE is reachable and the slot for housing the standby SCC board is occupied by a service board. In this manner, you can restore the NE database from the NMS after replacing the SCC board. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
543
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Prerequisites l
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
l
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
l
The SCC replacement board must be the same type as the SCC board being replaced.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC board does not affect traditional services, but ASON services may be affected for a short time when configurations are restored by downloading the database.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter, Web LCT
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Precautions
CAUTION l
If the NE where the SCC to be replaced resides is an ASON NE, the Node ID of the NE must be set according to the original data after the SCC is replaced. Otherwise, the NE database and ASON service cannot be restored.
l
Operations on the U2000 must be performed in the network management center.
l
Operations on the Web LCT must be performed on site.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement board. Ensure that the spare SCC board and the SCC board to be replaced have the same name and are of the same type. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
544
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
The 1X3 battery jumper on the replacement board enables or disables the power supply from the battery. Ensure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper. Remove the cap of pin 1 and cap of pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The selected SCC board cannot be used as a replacement board.
Step 2 Review and record the current NE alarms. Step 3 Back up the NE database to the NMS server. This records the NE database for future reference when the SCC board is faulty. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the device(s) that you want to backup in the NE View table. NOTE
The Backup Information tab is unavailable when multiple devices are selected.
3.
Select Backup... to open the Backup dialog.
4.
Select the option NMS Server or NMS Client to backup the selected device information. NOTE
By default the NMS Server is selected. If the NMS Server is selected, the selected device information is stored on the NMS server.
to select the location where the device
5.
Optional: If the NMS Client is selected, click data are to be backed up.
6.
Click Start to start the backup operation for the selected device(s). On the NE View tab page, the backup progress is displayed.
7.
When the backup operation is successful, the NMS creates the dbf.pkg file in the NEName/ yyyymmddhhmmss directory. "NEName" indicates the name of the NE, "yyyymmdd" indicates the date when the backup is created, and "hhmmss" indicates the time when the backup is created.
Step 4 Follow the steps below to query the system to obtain the user data of the NE. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Query.
3.
Record the NE user data returned by the system for future restoration of the NE user data. NOTE
Also record the password for each user account of the NE.
Step 5 Follow the steps below to query the NE communication parameters. 1.
Select the NE you just created, and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from Function Tree.
3.
Record NE communication parameters such as the IP address and the subnet mask in case you need them for parameter restoration.
Step 6 If the NE is an ASON NE, query and record the node ID of the NE. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click the Node ID Management tab.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
545
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3.
8 Parts Replacement
Click Query, and record the node ID.
Step 7 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 8 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and remove the board. For details about how to remove a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 9 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board so as to set the BIOS running mode of the board and then insert it to the slot housing the original SCC board. In this manner, the database on the new SCC board is cleared. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1011 to clear the database in the flash memory. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
3.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1010 to clear the system parameter area. For the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board, see 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC.
4.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
Step 10 After the database of the SCC board is cleared completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 9. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 11 After the new SCC board is started, connect the Web LCT to the NE. 1.
Disconnect the cables from the NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 ports (if connected). That is, disconnect the NE from the computer where the U2000 (hereinafter the computer is referred to as U2000) is installed.
2.
Connect the Web LCT to NM_ETH1.
3.
Set the IP address of the Web LCT to ensure that Web LCT is in the same IP subnet segment as the NE IP address. If the IP address of the Web LCT and the NE IP address are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. NOTE
The new board is initiated at factory, and the default IP subnet segment of the board is 129.9.*.*.
4.
Log in the Web LCT with the user name admin, and the initial password admin.
Step 12 Create the NE using the Web LCT. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
546
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
1.
Click NE Search > Advanced Search in the NE List. The Search NE dialog box is displayed.
2.
Click Manage Domain. The Manage Domain Search dialog box is displayed.
3.
Click Add. The New Domain dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Domain Type to GNE IP Domain or GNE IP Address. Enter an IP address in the Domain Address field.
5.
Click OK. NOTE
Repeat step 3 through 5 to add multiple search domains.
6.
Close the Manage Domain Search dialog box.
7.
Select the appropriate network segment IP addresses within the Domain and click Search. NOTE
l The NE search function searches for only the NEs in the specified network segment. l When the search is in progress, you can click End Search.
8.
After the search is complete, select an NE from the list and click Add NE. A prompt message is displayed, indicating that the NE is successfully added. Click OK.
9.
Select the NE that you want to log in and click NE Login in the lower right corner or rightclick the NE and choose NE Login. In the NE Login dialog box that is displayed, enter lct and password in the User Name and Password fields, and then click OK. TIP
You can select multiple NEs at a time by concurrently pressing Shift. If you select the Use same user name and password to login check box, you can log in to multiple NEs at a time by entering the user name and password only in the first line. If you select the Use the user name and password that was used last time check box, you do not need to enter the use name and password and the system automatically uses the user name and password for login last time.
Step 13 Modify the NE IP, gateway IP and subnet mask based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
2.
Enter the NE IP address, gateway IP address and subnet mask, and click Apply.
3.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box pops up.
4.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box about communication interruption between NEs pops up.
5.
Click Close after the Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
If the NE IP addresses before and after the modification are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. When this occurs, set the IP address of the Web LCT in the same network segment as the NE IP address.
Step 14 Modify the NE ID and extended ID based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, choose Configuration > NE Attribute from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Modify NE ID. In the Modify NE ID dialog box that is displayed, enter values in the New ID and New Extended ID fields, and then click OK.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
547
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
3.
8 Parts Replacement
A Warning dialog box is displayed, click Yes. A dialog box indicating that the operation is successful is displayed, click Close to complete changing the NE ID. At this time, the NE is unreachable.
Step 15 Check the NE communication parameters using the Web LCT. 1.
Select the NE you just created and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
3.
Check that all NE communication parameters are the same as the original ones.
Step 16 According to the NE user data queried in Step 4, create a user for an NE using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Create and the Add NE User dialog box is displayed.
3.
Enter the NE user name in the NE User field.
4.
Select the User Level as needed.
5.
Enter the password in the New Password field and enter it again in the Confirm Password field. NOTE
You also need to set the Whether the password is allowed to be modified immediately parameter. The password is a string of 6-16 characters. It can consist of letters, symbols and numerals, and must contain at least one letter and one numeral.
6.
Click OK.
7.
Click Query, and the Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. All created users of the NE are displayed in NE User Management Table.
Step 17 If the NE is an ASON NE, modify the node ID of the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Click the Node ID Management tab.
2.
Click Query to view the current node ID of the NE.
3.
Double-click the Node ID field to enter a node ID for the NE.
4.
Click Apply. After you confirm the operation twice, a prompt appears telling you that the operation was successful. NOTE
You can also choose Configuration > WDM ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu and set the NE node ID.
Step 18 Recover the network connection of the NE. 1.
Remove the network cable which connected the NM_ETH1 port to the Web LCT.
2.
Connect the network cable removed in Step 11. NOTE
After this procedure, you can use the original user name and password to access the NE using the U2000.
Step 19 If the software version of the spare SCC board is different from the software version of the SCC board to be replaced, go to Step 20; otherwise, go to Step 21. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
548
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 20 Upgrade or downgrade the software of the spare SCC board. For details, see the Upgrade Guide. Ensure that the software version of the spare SCC board is consistent with that of the SCC board to be replaced. Step 21 Restore the NE database from the NMS server. NOTE
You must activate the NE database within five minutes after restoring it.
1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the devices that you want to recover in the NE View table.
3.
Select Recover... to open the Recover dialog.
4.
In the File Name drop-down list, select the file to be recovered. If the backup file is listed in the File Name drop-down list, select the file to be recovered, and turn to 21.7. If the backup file is not listed in the File Name drop-down list, click Browse... to select the backup file in the Select File dialog box.
5.
Select NMS Server or NMS Client to recover the backup file for the selected devices. By default NMS Server is selected. l If NMS Server is selected, select the appropriate backup file from the NMS server. The selected backup file path is displayed in the Select File field. to select the backup file from the NMS Client. l If NMS Client is selected, click The selected backup file path is displayed in the Select File field.
6.
Click OK. NOTE
The selected backup file path from the NMS Server or NMS Client is displayed in the File Name dropdown list.
7.
Click Start, the Operation Confirmation dialog box is displayed.
8.
In the Operation Confirmation dialog, click Yes to start the recovery operation. The recovery operation status is displayed in the NE View table.
CAUTION During the process from backing up databases to restoring databases, do not modify the NE configurations to avoid database inconsistency. Step 22 Activate the NE database. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Select the NE where the SCC that has been replaced resides in the NE View table.
3.
Right-click the NE. A pop-up menu is displayed.
4.
Select Activate Database..., and the Activate Database dialog box is displayed.
5.
icon in Deliver To Board Activate. This icon is changed to . Optional: Click the Click Start to start the database activation process. The progress of the database activation is displayed on the NE View tab.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
549
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
The operation on the U2000 may result in a service interruption.
Step 23 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
6.
Configure the OSPF IP address of the NE if the site complies with the models for separated optical and electrical NEs and the NE is on an optical-layer ASON network. NOTE
For details to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 24 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.2.3.5 Replacing the SCC by Backing Up Database Data to a CF Card (NE Is Reachable) Before replacing an SCC board, back up the NE database to a CF card if the NE is reachable and the standby SCC slot is occupied by a service board. If you choose to back up the database, you can restore the NE database from the CF card after you replace the SCC board is replaced. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
550
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Prerequisites You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher. The SCC replacement board must be the same type as the SCC board being replaced.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC board does not affect traditional services, but ASON services may be affected for a short time when configurations are restored by downloading the database.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter, Web LCT
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Precautions
CAUTION l If the NE where the SCC to be replaced resides is an ASON NE, the Node ID of the NE must be set according to the original data after the SCC is replaced. Otherwise, the ASON service cannot be restored. l After the database of the NE is restored on the CF card, the restoration must be completed within two hours after you install the replacement SCC. If you wait more than two hours to restore the database of the NE on the CF card, the data automatically saved on the NE overwrites the original data stored on the CF card. If the original data is overwritten, the original database of the NE cannot be restored. l Operations on the U2000 must be performed in the network management center. l Operations on the Web LCT must be performed on site.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
551
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement board. The spare SCC board and the SCC board to be replaced must have the same name and type. NOTE
The 1X3 battery jumper on the replacement board enables or disables the power supply from the battery. Ensure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper. Then remove the cap of pin 1 and cap of pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The selected SCC board cannot be used as a replacement board.
Step 2 Review and record the current NE alarms. Step 3 Back up the database on the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Configuration > NE Configuration Data Management from the Main Menu, and the NE Configuration interface is displayed.
2.
In the Object Tree, select an NE and click
3.
Select one or more NEs in the NE Configuration.
4.
Click Back Up NE Data and then choose Manually Back Up Database to CF Card.
5.
Click OK in the Confirm dialog box.
6.
Click Close in the Result dialog box is displayed.
.
Step 4 Wait four minutes and query the system to obtain the user data of the NE by following the steps below. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Query.
3.
Record the NE user data returned by the system for future restoration of the NE user data. NOTE
Also record the password for each user account of the NE.
Step 5 Follow the steps below to query the NE communication parameters. 1.
Select the NE you just created, and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from Function Tree.
3.
Record NE communication parameters such as the IP address and the subnet mask in case you need them for parameter restoration.
Step 6 If the NE is an ASON NE, query and record the node ID of the NE. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click the Node ID Management tab.
3.
Click Query, and record the node ID.
Step 7 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
552
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 8 Remove the SCC board to be replaced. For details about how to remove a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 9 On the SCC board that has been removed, hold the CF card and pull the card out of the CF card slot. Put the SCC into an ESD bag. NOTE
Keep the CF card because it is required for NE data restoration.
Step 10 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board so as to set the BIOS running mode of the board and then insert it to the slot housing the original SCC board. In this manner, the database on the new SCC board is cleared. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1011 to clear the database in the flash memory. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
3.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1010 to clear the system parameter area. For the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board, see 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC.
4.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
Step 11 After the database of the SCC board is cleared completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 10. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 12 After the new SCC board is started, connect the Web LCT to the NE. 1.
Disconnect the cables from the NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 ports (if connected). That is, disconnect the NE from the computer where the U2000 (hereinafter the computer is referred to as U2000) is installed.
2.
Connect the Web LCT to NM_ETH1.
3.
Set the IP address of the Web LCT to ensure that Web LCT is in the same IP subnet segment as the NE IP address. If the IP address of the Web LCT and the NE IP address are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. NOTE
The new board is initiated at factory, and the default IP subnet segment of the board is 129.9.*.*.
4.
Log in the Web LCT with the user name admin, and the initial password admin.
Step 13 Create the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click NE Search > Advanced Search in the NE List. The Search NE dialog box is displayed. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
553
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
2.
Click Manage Domain. The Manage Domain Search dialog box is displayed.
3.
Click Add. The New Domain dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Domain Type to GNE IP Domain or GNE IP Address. Enter an IP address in the Domain Address field.
5.
Click OK. NOTE
Repeat step 3 through 5 to add multiple search domains.
6.
Close the Manage Domain Search dialog box.
7.
Select the appropriate network segment IP addresses within the Domain and click Search. NOTE
l The NE search function searches for only the NEs in the specified network segment. l When the search is in progress, you can click End Search.
8.
After the search is complete, select an NE from the list and click Add NE. A prompt message is displayed, indicating that the NE is successfully added. Click OK.
9.
Select the NE that you want to log in and click NE Login in the lower right corner or rightclick the NE and choose NE Login. In the NE Login dialog box that is displayed, enter lct and password in the User Name and Password fields, and then click OK. TIP
You can select multiple NEs at a time by concurrently pressing Shift. If you select the Use same user name and password to login check box, you can log in to multiple NEs at a time by entering the user name and password only in the first line. If you select the Use the user name and password that was used last time check box, you do not need to enter the use name and password and the system automatically uses the user name and password for login last time.
Step 14 Modify the NE IP, gateway IP and subnet mask based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
2.
Enter the NE IP address, gateway IP address and subnet mask, and click Apply.
3.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box pops up.
4.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box about communication interruption between NEs pops up.
5.
Click Close after the Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
If the NE IP addresses before and after the modification are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. When this occurs, set the IP address of the Web LCT in the same network segment as the NE IP address.
Step 15 Modify the NE ID and extended ID based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, choose Configuration > NE Attribute from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Modify NE ID. In the Modify NE ID dialog box that is displayed, enter values in the New ID and New Extended ID fields, and then click OK.
3.
A Warning dialog box is displayed, click Yes. A dialog box indicating that the operation is successful is displayed, click Close to complete changing the NE ID. At this time, the NE is unreachable.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
554
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 16 Check the NE communication parameters using the Web LCT. 1.
Select the NE you just created and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
3.
Check that all NE communication parameters are the same as the original ones.
Step 17 According to the NE user data queried in Step 4, create a user of the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Create and the Add NE User dialog box is displayed.
3.
Enter the NE user name in the NE User field.
4.
Select the User Level as needed.
5.
Enter the password in the New Password field and enter it again in the Confirm Password field. NOTE
You also need to set the Whether the password is allowed to be modified immediately parameter. The password is a string of 6-16 characters. It can consist of letters, symbols and numerals, and must contain at least one letter and one numeral.
6.
Click OK.
7.
Click Query, and the Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. All created users of the NE are displayed in NE User Management Table.
Step 18 If the NE is an ASON NE, modify the node ID of the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Click the Node ID Management tab.
2.
Click Query to view the current node ID of the NE.
3.
Double-click the Node ID field to enter a node ID for the NE.
4.
Click Apply. After you confirm the operation twice, a prompt appears telling you that the operation was successful. NOTE
You can also choose Configuration > WDM ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu and set the NE node ID.
Step 19 Recover the network connection of the NE. 1.
Remove the network cable which connected the NM_ETH1 port to the Web LCT.
2.
Connect the network cable removed. NOTE
After this procedure, you can use the original user name and password to access the NE using the U2000.
Step 20 After the SCC board is started, remove the SCC board just inserted. Insert the CF card that has been removed in Step 9 into the CF card slot on the SCC board. Then insert the SCC. Step 21 If the software version of the spare SCC board is different from the software version of the SCC board to be replaced, go to Step 22; otherwise, go to Step 23. Step 22 Upgrade or downgrade the software of the spare SCC board. For details, see the Upgrade Guide. Ensure that the software version of the spare SCC board is consistent with that of the SCC board to be replaced. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
555
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 23 Restore the initial database of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Configuration > NE Configuration Data Management from the Main Menu, and the NE Configuration Data Management interface is displayed.
2.
In the Object Tree on the left, select an NE and click
3.
In NE Configuration, select an NE or multiple NEs.
4.
Click Restore NE Database from CF Card. The Confirm dialog box is displayed, indicating that the restoration of the NE database may lead to service interruption.
5.
Click OK to start to restore the NE database.
.
NOTE
If the database is performing a scheduled backup task, a message will be displayed on the NMS, indicating that restoring data from the CF card will fail. In this scenario, you are advised to wait 5 minutes, and restore data again from the CF card after the database finishes the scheduled backup task.
6.
Click Closeafter an Operation Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
After the NE databases are restored, the NE software issues the data in the CF card to only the SCC board but not other boards. To ensure that the configurations in the SCC board and the configurations in other boards are consistent, you need to perform warm resets on other boards.
CAUTION During the process from backing up databases to restoring databases, do not modify the NE configurations to avoid database inconsistency. Step 24 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
6.
Configure the OSPF IP address of the NE if the site complies with the models for separated optical and electrical NEs and the NE is on an optical-layer ASON network. NOTE
For details to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 25 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
556
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.2.4 Replacing the SCC Board in a Slave Subrack This section describes how to replace an SCC board in a slave subrack.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher. The SCC replacement board must be the same type as the SCC board being replaced.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC does not affect the existing services. If the SCC is configured with 1+1 protection, replacing the SCC does not affect the system. If an SCC is not configured with 1+1 protection, replacing the SCC has the following effects: l
The fan is automatically changed to the "High Speed" mode.
l
The ESC and OSC communication of the subrack where the replacement SCC resides fails.
l
The POWER_FAIL alarm of the subrack where the replacement SCC resides cannot be reported.
l
The subrack whose ID conflicts with the ID of the subrack where the replacement SCC resides cannot be detected.
l
Certain optical boards in the slave subrack housing the SCC board to be replaced go offline and cannot be managed. However, the services on these boards are not affected.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
557
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, and the type of the spare board are the same as those of the original board. NOTE
The 1X3 jumper inside the board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Ensure that pin 1 and pin 2 on the battery jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and pin 3 on the battery jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. In this case, the SCC board needs to be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current NE alarms. Step 3 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 4 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For more information regarding how to replace a board, refer to "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 5 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board to set the BIOS running mode, and then insert the SCC board to the slot housing the original SCC board. In this manner, the file system on the new SCC board is formated. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1111 to clear all the data in the flash memory except the board manufacturing information. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. NOTE
After you set the jumpers and install the new SCC board in the slot, wait 15 minutes to allow the file system to be formated.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
558
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 6 After the file system of the SCC board is formatted completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which you set in Step 5. Reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 7 Review the indicators of the new board. It takes ten minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator gives an abnormal indication, reinsert the board, or replace the board again. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators". Step 8 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.3 Replacing the SCC Board with One of a Different TNxx Version This section describes how to replace an SCC board with an SCC board of a later TNxx version. The replacement mainly involves the SCC boards for the OptiX OSN 8800 T32 and OptiX OSN 6800. NOTE
TNxx indicates a board hardware version displayed on the PCB board.
8.3.1 Substitution Relationships This section describes the substitution relationships of the SCC boards.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
559
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TN11SCC
TN51SCC
When the TN51SCC board is installed in a master subrack with ASON disabled, it can replace the TN11SCC board. But after the replacement, the board software must be upgraded. When it is installed in a master subrack with ASON disabled, it cannot replace the TN11SCC board. When it is installed in a slave subrack, it can directly replace the TN11SCC board.
TN52SCC
Software upgrade is required for the replacement.
TN16SCC
None
-
TN51SCC
TN52SCC
Software upgrade is required for the replacement.
TN52SCC
None
-
TNK2SCC
None
-
TN21SCC
TN22SCC
Software upgrade is required for the replacement.
TN22SCC
None
-
NOTE If a subrack/chassis uses two SCC boards (one is active and the other is standby), the versions of the two SCC boards must be the same.
8.3.2 Replacing the Protected SCC Board in a Master Subrack This section describes how to replace the SCC board in a master subrack when SCC 1+1 protection is configured.
Prerequisites l
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
l
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
l
If the replacement board and the SCC board to be replaced are of different types, the two SCC boards in the subrack must be replaced to ensure that the active and standby SCC boards are of the same type.
Impact on the System The replacement does not affect the existing services. For SCC 1+1 protection, replacing one SCC in the protection group does not interrupt the communication between the NE where the SCC resides and the U2000 after a switching from this SCC to the other SCC is performed.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
560
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement SCC board by referring to "Substitution Relationships". NOTE
The 1X3 jumper (namely, the battery jumper) on the SCC board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Make sure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out of work. The SCC board needs to be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current NE alarms. Step 3 Back up the NE database to the NMS server. This is to record the NE database for future reference when the SCC board is replaced. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the device(s) that you want to backup in the NE View table. NOTE
The Backup Information tab is unavailable when multiple devices are selected.
3.
Select Backup... to open the Backup dialog.
4.
Select the option NMS Server or NMS Client to backup the selected device information. NOTE
By default the NMS Server is selected. If the NMS Server is selected, the selected device information is stored on the NMS server.
5.
Optional: If the NMS Client is selected, click data are to be backed up.
6.
Click Start to start the backup operation for the selected device(s). On the NE View tab page, the backup progress is displayed.
7.
When the backup operation is successful, the NMS creates the dbf.pkg file in the NEName/ yyyymmddhhmmss directory. "NEName" indicates the name of the NE, "yyyymmdd"
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
to select the location where the device
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
561
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
indicates the date when the backup is created, and "hhmmss" indicates the time when the backup is created. Step 4 Follow the steps below to query the working state of the board to be replaced. 1.
In the NE Explorer, click the NE and choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Query.
Step 5 If the board to be replaced is the active board, go to Step 6. Otherwise, go to Step 7. Step 6 If the board to be replaced is the working board, follow the steps below to perform an active/ standby switching on the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click the desired SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Working/Protection Switching from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed.
4.
Click Query. If the Active Board is not the board to be replaced, the switching is successful.
5.
Query the alarms and performance events on the U2000. Check if services are normal. If services are normal, there must be no new abnormal alarms or performances. The switching is successful.
Step 7 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 8 Set Replace Board Type on the U2000. 1.
Double-click the optical NE icon in the Main Topology. Then, the running status of the optical NE is displayed.
2.
Select the desired NE. In the NE Panel tab, right-click the desired SCC board and click Replace Board Type from the shortcut menu.
3.
The dialog box of Replacement Board Type is displayed, select the name of the target board to be replaced within the Usable Board Type. Click OK.
4.
After the replacement, a prompt appears asking you whether to immediately upload the NE data. Click OK. NOTE
If you click Cancel, the board is successfully upgraded, but you need to manually upload the NE data later.
5.
Click OK to confirm the uploading of the NE data again. NOTE
If you click Cancel, the board is successfully upgraded, but you need to manually upload the NE data later.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
562
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6.
8 Parts Replacement
Click Close in the displayed Result dialog box. NOTE
After changing the board type by setting Replace Board Type on the U2000, the WRG_BD_TYPE alarm will be reported.
Step 9 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For more information regarding how to replace a board, refer to "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 10 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board to set the BIOS running mode. Then insert the SCC board to the slot housing the original SCC board to format the file system of the new SCC board. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1111 to clear all the data in the flash memory except the board manufacturing information. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 15 minutes to allow the database to be cleared.
Step 11 After the file system of the SCC board is formatted completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which you set in Step 9. Reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 12 Wait ten minutes. If the U2000 reports a SWDL_PKG_NOBDSOFT alarm, a software upgrade is required for the replacement. For details, see Upgrade Guide. Step 13 View the indicators on the front panel of the new board. It takes approximately 90 minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator is not steady green, you need to reinsert the board or select a new replacement board. For details about the indicators, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the new board works normally, the WRG_BD_TYPE alarm will be cleared on the U2000.
Step 14 Follow the steps below to switch the active/standby state of the SCC boards back to the original state. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Restore Working/Protection from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed. NOTE
After you start the new SCC board, the system automatically synchronizes the data between the existing SCC board and the new SCC board. After the data backup is complete, you can perform the preceding step to initiate active/standby switching.
Step 15 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
563
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
6.
8 Parts Replacement
Check whether the switching state is correct. Perform a switching test. NOTE
For details about how to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 16 Check the indicators of the new board. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady on green. If the indicator gives an abnormal indication, reinsert the board, or replace the board again. For the indicator definitions, see Board Indicators. Step 17 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. Step 18 Repeat the preceding steps to replace the other SCC board in the protection group and ensure that the two SCC boards are of the same type after the replacement. ----End
8.3.3 Replacing the Unprotected SCC Board in a Master Subrack This section describes how to replace an SCC board in a master subrack when no protection is configured for the SCC board.
8.3.3.1 Replacing the SCC with the Database Backed Up to the NMS Before replacing an SCC board, you can back up the NE database to the NMS. In this manner, you can restore the NE database from the NMS after replacing the SCC board.
Prerequisites l Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
564
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
l
8 Parts Replacement
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC board does not affect traditional services, but ASON services may be affected for a short time when configurations are restored by downloading the database. The impact caused by replacing an SCC without protection is as follows: l
For the OptiX OSN 8800 T32, the SCC is housed in IU28 by default. If another board is installed in IU11, SCC 1+1 protection cannot be configured. In this case, replacing the SCC in an NE interrupts the communication between the NE and the U2000.
l
For the OptiX OSN 6800, the SCC is housed in IU18 by default. When IU17 is occupied by another board, SCC 1+1 protection cannot be configured. In this case, replacing the SCC in an NE interrupts the communication between the NE and the U2000.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter, Web LCT
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Precautions
CAUTION l
If the NE where the SCC to be replaced resides is an ASON NE, the Node ID of the NE must be set according to the original data after the SCC is replaced. Otherwise, the NE database and ASON service cannot be restored.
l
Operations on the U2000 must be performed in the network management center.
l
Operations on the Web LCT must be performed on site.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
565
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement SCC board by referring to "Substitution Relationships". NOTE
The 1X3 jumper (namely, the battery jumper) on the SCC board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Make sure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and of pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out of work. The SCC board needs to be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current NE alarms. Step 3 Back up the NE database to the NMS server. This is to record the NE database for future reference when the SCC board is faulty. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the device(s) that you want to backup in the NE View table. NOTE
The Backup Information tab is unavailable when multiple devices are selected.
3.
Select Backup... to open the Backup dialog.
4.
Select the option NMS Server or NMS Client to backup the selected device information. NOTE
By default the NMS Server is selected. If the NMS Server is selected, the selected device information is stored on the NMS server.
5.
Optional: If the NMS Client is selected, click data are to be backed up.
to select the location where the device
6.
Click Start to start the backup operation for the selected device(s). On the NE View tab page, the backup progress is displayed.
7.
When the backup operation is successful, the NMS creates the dbf.pkg file in the NEName/ yyyymmddhhmmss directory. "NEName" indicates the name of the NE, "yyyymmdd" indicates the date when the backup is created, and "hhmmss" indicates the time when the backup is created.
Step 4 Follow the steps below to query the system to obtain the user data of the NE. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Query.
3.
Record the NE user data returned by the system for future restoration of the NE user data. NOTE
Also record the password for each user account of the NE.
Step 5 Follow the steps below to query the NE communication parameters. 1.
Select the NE you just created, and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from Function Tree.
3.
Record NE communication parameters such as the IP address and the subnet mask in case you need them for parameter restoration.
Step 6 If the NE is an ASON NE, query and record the node ID of the NE. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
566
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click the Node ID Management tab.
3.
Click Query, and record the node ID.
Step 7 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 8 Set Replace Board Type on the U2000. 1.
Double-click the optical NE icon in the Main Topology. Then, the running status of the optical NE is displayed.
2.
Select the desired NE. In the NE Panel tab, right-click the desired SCC board and click Replace Board Type from the shortcut menu.
3.
The dialog box of Replacement Board Type is displayed, select the name of the target board to be replaced within the Usable Board Type. Click OK.
4.
After the replacement, a prompt appears asking you whether to immediately upload the NE data. Click OK. NOTE
If you click Cancel, the board is successfully upgraded, but you need to manually upload the NE data later.
5.
Click OK to confirm the uploading of the NE data again. NOTE
If you click Cancel, the board is successfully upgraded, but you need to manually upload the NE data later.
6.
Click Close in the displayed Result dialog box. NOTE
After changing the board type by setting Replace Board Type on the U2000, the WRG_BD_TYPE alarm will be reported.
Step 9 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and remove the board. For details about how to remove a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 10 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board so as to set the BIOS running mode of the board and then insert it to the slot housing the original SCC board. In this manner, the database on the new SCC board is cleared. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1011 to clear the database in the flash memory. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
567
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
3.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1010 to clear the system parameter area. For the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board, see 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC.
4.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
Step 11 After the database of the SCC board is cleared completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 10. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 12 After the new SCC board is started, connect the Web LCT to the NE. 1.
Disconnect the cables from the NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 ports (if connected). That is, disconnect the NE from the computer where the U2000 (hereinafter the computer is referred to as U2000) is installed.
2.
Connect the Web LCT to NM_ETH1.
3.
Set the IP address of the Web LCT to ensure that Web LCT is in the same IP subnet segment as the NE IP address. If the IP address of the Web LCT and the NE IP address are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. NOTE
The new board is initiated at factory, and the default IP subnet segment of the board is 129.9.*.*.
4.
Log in the Web LCT with the user name admin, and the initial password admin.
Step 13 Create the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
Click NE Search > Advanced Search in the NE List. The Search NE dialog box is displayed.
2.
Click Manage Domain. The Manage Domain Search dialog box is displayed.
3.
Click Add. The New Domain dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Domain Type to GNE IP Domain or GNE IP Address. Enter an IP address in the Domain Address field.
5.
Click OK. NOTE
Repeat step 3 through 5 to add multiple search domains.
6.
Close the Manage Domain Search dialog box.
7.
Select the appropriate network segment IP addresses within the Domain and click Search. NOTE
l The NE search function searches for only the NEs in the specified network segment. l When the search is in progress, you can click End Search.
8.
After the search is complete, select an NE from the list and click Add NE. A prompt message is displayed, indicating that the NE is successfully added. Click OK.
9.
Select the NE that you want to log in and click NE Login in the lower right corner or rightclick the NE and choose NE Login. In the NE Login dialog box that is displayed, enter lct and password in the User Name and Password fields, and then click OK.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
568
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
TIP
You can select multiple NEs at a time by concurrently pressing Shift. If you select the Use same user name and password to login check box, you can log in to multiple NEs at a time by entering the user name and password only in the first line. If you select the Use the user name and password that was used last time check box, you do not need to enter the use name and password and the system automatically uses the user name and password for login last time.
Step 14 Modify the NE IP, gateway IP and subnet mask based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
2.
Enter the NE IP address, gateway IP address and subnet mask, and click Apply.
3.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box pops up.
4.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box about communication interruption between NEs pops up.
5.
Click Close after the Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
If the NE IP addresses before and after the modification are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. When this occurs, set the IP address of the Web LCT in the same network segment as the NE IP address.
Step 15 Modify the NE ID and extended ID based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, choose Configuration > NE Attribute from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Modify NE ID. In the Modify NE ID dialog box that is displayed, enter values in the New ID and New Extended ID fields, and then click OK.
3.
A Warning dialog box is displayed, click Yes. A dialog box indicating that the operation is successful is displayed, click Close to complete changing the NE ID. At this time, the NE is unreachable.
Step 16 Check the NE communication parameters using the Web LCT. 1.
Select the NE you just created and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
3.
Check that all NE communication parameters are the same as the original ones.
Step 17 According to the NE user data queried in Step 4,create an NE's user using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Create and the Add NE User dialog box is displayed.
3.
Enter the NE user name in the NE User field.
4.
Select the User Level as needed.
5.
Enter the password in the New Password field and enter it again in the Confirm Password field. NOTE
You also need to set the Whether the password is allowed to be modified immediately parameter. The password is a string of 6-16 characters. It can consist of letters, symbols and numerals, and must contain at least one letter and one numeral.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
569
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
6.
Click OK.
7.
Click Query, and the Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. All created users of the NE are displayed in NE User Management Table.
Step 18 If the NE is an ASON NE, modify the node ID of the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Click the Node ID Management tab.
2.
Click Query to view the current node ID of the NE.
3.
Double-click the Node ID field to enter a node ID for the NE.
4.
Click Apply. After you confirm the operation twice, a prompt appears telling you that the operation was successful. NOTE
You can also choose Configuration > WDM ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu and set the NE node ID.
Step 19 Recover the network connection of the NE. 1.
Remove the network cable which connected the NM_ETH1 port to the Web LCT.
2.
Connect the network cable removed in Step 12. NOTE
After this procedure, you can use the original user name and password to access the NE using the U2000. NOTE
After recovering the network connection of the NE, the WRG_BD_TYPE alarm is cleared on the U2000.
Step 20 If the software version of the spare SCC board is different from the software version of the SCC board to be replaced, go to Step 21; otherwise, go to Step 22. Step 21 Upgrade or downgrade the software of the spare SCC board. For details, see the Upgrade Guide. Ensure that the software version of the spare SCC board is consistent with that of the SCC board to be replaced. Step 22 Restore the NE database from the NMS server. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the devices that you want to recover in the NE View table.
3.
Select Recover... to open the Recover dialog.
4.
In the File Name drop-down list, select the file to be recovered. If the backup file is listed in the File Name drop-down list, select the file to be recovered, and turn to 22.7. If the backup file is not listed in the File Name drop-down list, click Browse... to select the backup file in the Select File dialog box.
5.
Select NMS Server or NMS Client to recover the backup file for the selected devices. By default NMS Server is selected. l If NMS Server is selected, select the appropriate backup file from the NMS server. The selected backup file path is displayed in the Select File field. to select the backup file from the NMS Client. l If NMS Client is selected, click The selected backup file path is displayed in the Select File field.
6. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click OK. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
570
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
The selected backup file path from the NMS Server or NMS Client is displayed in the File Name dropdown list.
7.
Click Start, the Operation Confirmation dialog box is displayed.
8.
In the Operation Confirmation dialog, click Yes to start the recovery operation. The recovery operation status is displayed in the NE View table. NOTE
You must activate the NE database within five minutes after restoring it.
CAUTION During the process from backing up databases to restoring databases, do not modify the NE configurations to avoid database inconsistency. Step 23 Activate the NE database. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Select the NE where the SCC that has been replaced resides in the NE View table.
3.
Right-click the NE. A pop-up menu is displayed.
4.
Select Activate Database..., and the Activate Database dialog box is displayed.
5.
icon in Deliver To Board Activate. This icon is changed to . Optional: Click the Click Start to start the database activation process. The progress of the database activation is displayed on the NE View tab. NOTE
The operation on the U2000 may result in a service interruption.
Step 24 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
6.
Configure the OSPF IP address of the NE if the site complies with the models for separated optical and electrical NEs and the NE is on an optical-layer ASON network. NOTE
For details to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 25 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
571
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4.
8 Parts Replacement
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.3.3.2 Replacing the SCC with the Database Backed Up to a CF Card When replacing an SCC board, you can back up the NE database to a CF card. In this manner, you can restore the NE database from the CF card after replacing the SCC board.
Prerequisites l
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC board does not affect traditional services, but ASON services may be affected for a short time when configurations are restored by downloading the database. The impact caused by replacing an SCC without protection is as follows: l
For the OptiX OSN 8800 T32, the SCC is housed in IU28 by default. If another board is installed in IU11, SCC 1+1 protection cannot be configured. In this case, replacing the SCC in an NE interrupts the communication between the NE and the U2000.
l
For the OptiX OSN 6800, the SCC is housed in IU18 by default. When IU17 is occupied by another board, SCC 1+1 protection cannot be configured. In this case, replacing the SCC in an NE interrupts the communication between the NE and the U2000.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter, Web LCT
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
572
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Precautions
CAUTION l If the NE where the SCC to be replaced resides is an ASON NE, the Node ID of the NE must be set according to the original data after the SCC is replaced. Otherwise, the ASON service cannot be restored. l After the database of the NE is restored on the CF card, the restoration must be completed within two hours after you install the replacement SCC is installed. If you wait more than two hours to restore the database of the NE on the CF card, the data automatically saved on the NE overwrites the original data stored on the CF card. If the original data is overwritten, the original database of the NE cannot be restored. l Operations on the U2000 must be performed in the network management center. l Operations on the Web LCT must be performed on site.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement SCC board by referring to "Substitution Relationships". NOTE
The 1X3 jumper (namely, the battery jumper) on the SCC board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Make sure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out of work. The SCC board needs to be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current NE alarms. Step 3 Backup the database on the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Configuration > NE Configuration Data Management from the Main Menu, and the NE Configuration interface is displayed.
2.
In the Object Tree, select an NE and click
3.
Select one or more NEs in the NE Configuration.
4.
Click Back Up NE Data and then choose Manually Back Up Database to CF Card.
5.
Click OK in the Confirm dialog box.
6.
Click Close in the Result dialog box is displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
573
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 4 Wait four minutes later, and query the system to obtain the user data of the NE by following the steps below. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Query.
3.
Record the NE user data returned by the system for future restoration of the NE user data. NOTE
Also record the password for each user account of the NE.
Step 5 Follow the steps below to query the NE communication parameters. 1.
Select the NE you just created, and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from Function Tree.
3.
Record NE communication parameters such as the IP address and the subnet mask in case you need them for parameter restoration.
Step 6 If the NE is an ASON NE, query and record the node ID of the NE. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click the Node ID Management tab.
3.
Click Query, and record the node ID.
Step 7 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 8 Set Replace Board Type on the U2000. 1.
Double-click the optical NE icon in the Main Topology. Then, the running status of the optical NE is displayed.
2.
Select the desired NE. In the NE Panel tab, right-click the desired SCC board and click Replace Board Type from the shortcut menu.
3.
The dialog box of Replacement Board Type is displayed, select the name of the target board to be replaced within the Usable Board Type. Click OK.
4.
After the replacement, a prompt appears asking you whether to immediately upload the NE data. Click OK. NOTE
If you click Cancel, the board is successfully upgraded, but you need to manually upload the NE data later.
5.
Click OK to confirm the uploading of the NE data again. NOTE
If you click Cancel, the board is successfully upgraded, but you need to manually upload the NE data later.
6. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click Close in the displayed Result dialog box. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
574
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
After changing the board type by setting Replace Board Type on the U2000, the WRG_BD_TYPE alarm will be reported.
Step 9 Remove the SCC board to be replaced. For details about how to remove a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 10 On the SCC board that has been removed, hold the CF card and pull the card out of the CF card slot. Put the SCC into an ESD bag. NOTE
Keep the CF card because it is required for NE data restoration.
Step 11 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board so as to set the BIOS running mode of the board and then insert it to the slot housing the original SCC board. In this manner, the database on the new SCC board is cleared. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1011 to clear the database in the flash memory. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
3.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1010 to clear the system parameter area. For the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board, see 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC.
4.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 2 minutes until the database on the spare SCC board is cleared. If the spare SCC board is of V100R006C03 or a later version, the database is being cleared when the STAT indicator on the SCC board is quickly blinking and the database clearing is complete when the STAT indicator is steady green.
Step 12 After the database of the SCC board is cleared completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 11. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 13 After the new SCC board is started, connect the Web LCT to the NE. 1.
Disconnect the cables from the NM_ETH1 and NM_ETH2 ports (if connected). That is, disconnect the NE from the computer where the U2000 (hereinafter the computer is referred to as U2000) is installed.
2.
Connect the Web LCT to NM_ETH1.
3.
Set the IP address of the Web LCT to ensure that Web LCT is in the same IP subnet segment as the NE IP address. If the IP address of the Web LCT and the NE IP address are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. NOTE
The new board is initiated at factory, and the default IP subnet segment of the board is 129.9.*.*.
4.
Log in the Web LCT with the user name admin, and the initial password admin.
Step 14 Create the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Click NE Search > Advanced Search in the NE List. The Search NE dialog box is displayed. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
575
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
2.
Click Manage Domain. The Manage Domain Search dialog box is displayed.
3.
Click Add. The New Domain dialog box is displayed.
4.
Set Domain Type to GNE IP Domain or GNE IP Address. Enter an IP address in the Domain Address field.
5.
Click OK. NOTE
Repeat step 3 through 5 to add multiple search domains.
6.
Close the Manage Domain Search dialog box.
7.
Select the appropriate network segment IP addresses within the Domain and click Search. NOTE
l The NE search function searches for only the NEs in the specified network segment. l When the search is in progress, you can click End Search.
8.
After the search is complete, select an NE from the list and click Add NE. A prompt message is displayed, indicating that the NE is successfully added. Click OK.
9.
Select the NE that you want to log in and click NE Login in the lower right corner or rightclick the NE and choose NE Login. In the NE Login dialog box that is displayed, enter lct and password in the User Name and Password fields, and then click OK. TIP
You can select multiple NEs at a time by concurrently pressing Shift. If you select the Use same user name and password to login check box, you can log in to multiple NEs at a time by entering the user name and password only in the first line. If you select the Use the user name and password that was used last time check box, you do not need to enter the use name and password and the system automatically uses the user name and password for login last time.
Step 15 Modify the NE IP, gateway IP and subnet mask based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
2.
Enter the NE IP address, gateway IP address and subnet mask, and click Apply.
3.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box pops up.
4.
Click OK after the Warning dialog box about communication interruption between NEs pops up.
5.
Click Close after the Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
If the NE IP addresses before and after the modification are in different network segments, the Web LCT cannot be connected to the NE. When this occurs, set the IP address of the Web LCT in the same network segment as the NE IP address.
Step 16 Modify the NE ID and extended ID based on the original information using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, choose Configuration > NE Attribute from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Modify NE ID. In the Modify NE ID dialog box that is displayed, enter values in the New ID and New Extended ID fields, and then click OK.
3.
A Warning dialog box is displayed, click Yes. A dialog box indicating that the operation is successful is displayed, click Close to complete changing the NE ID. At this time, the NE is unreachable.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
576
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 17 Check the NE communication parameters using the Web LCT. 1.
Select the NE you just created and click the NE Explorer.
2.
Select Communication > Communication Parameters from the Function Tree.
3.
Check that all NE communication parameters are the same as the original ones.
Step 18 According to the NE user data queried in Step 4,create an NE's user using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the NE and choose Security > NE User Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Create and the Add NE User dialog box is displayed.
3.
Enter the NE user name in the NE User field.
4.
Select the User Level as needed.
5.
Enter the password in the New Password field and enter it again in the Confirm Password field. NOTE
You also need to set the Whether the password is allowed to be modified immediately parameter. The password is a string of 6-16 characters. It can consist of letters, symbols and numerals, and must contain at least one letter and one numeral.
6.
Click OK.
7.
Click Query, and the Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. All created users of the NE are displayed in NE User Management Table.
Step 19 If the NE is an ASON NE, modify the node ID of the NE using the Web LCT. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Click the Node ID Management tab.
2.
Click Query to view the current node ID of the NE.
3.
Double-click the Node ID field to enter a node ID for the NE.
4.
Click Apply. After you confirm the operation twice, a prompt appears telling you that the operation was successful. NOTE
You can also choose Configuration > WDM ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu and set the NE node ID.
Step 20 Recover the network connection of the NE. 1.
Pull out the network cable which connected the NM_ETH1 port to the Web LCT.
2.
Connect the network cable removed. NOTE
After this procedure, you can use the original user name and password to access the NE using the U2000. NOTE
After recovering the network connection of the NE, the WRG_BD_TYPE alarm is cleared on the U2000.
Step 21 After the SCC board is started, remove the SCC board inserted just now. Insert the CF card that has been removed in Step 10 into the CF card slot on the SCC board. Then, insert the SCC. Step 22 If the software version of the spare SCC board is different from the software version of the SCC board to be replaced, go to Step 23, otherwise go to Step 24. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
577
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 23 Upgrade or downgrade the software of the spare SCC board. For details, see the Upgrade Guide. Ensure that the software version of the spare SCC board is consistent with that of the SCC board to be replaced. Step 24 Restore the initial database of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Configuration > NE Configuration Data Management from the Main Menu, and the NE Configuration Data Management interface is displayed.
2.
In the Object Tree on the left, select an NE and click
3.
In NE Configuration, select an NE or multiple NEs.
4.
Click Restore NE Database from CF Card. The Confirm dialog box is displayed, indicating that the restoration of the NE database may lead to service interruption.
5.
Click OK to start to restore the NE database.
.
NOTE
If the database is performing a scheduled backup task, a message will be displayed on the NMS, indicating that restoring data from the CF card will fail. In this scenario, you are advised to wait 5 minutes, and restore data again from the CF card after the database finishes the scheduled backup task.
6.
Click Closeafter an Operation Result dialog box is displayed. NOTE
After the NE databases are restored, the NE software issues the data in the CF card to only the SCC board but not other boards. To ensure that the configurations in the SCC board and the configurations in other boards are consistent, you need to perform warm resets on other boards.
CAUTION During the process from backing up databases to restoring databases, do not modify the NE configurations to avoid database inconsistency. Step 25 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
6.
Configure the OSPF IP address of the NE if the site complies with the models for separated optical and electrical NEs and the NE is on an optical-layer ASON network. NOTE
For details to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 26 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
578
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4.
8 Parts Replacement
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.3.3.3 Replacing the Board After Configuring SCC 1+1 Protection If the slot designated for the standby SCC board is vacant and will not house a service board, you can replace the properly-functioning SCC board by installing the new SCC board in the vacant slot and then performing an active/standby switchover on the SCC boards.
Prerequisites l
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
l
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
Impact on the System The replacement does not affect the existing services. The impact caused by replacing an SCC without protection is as follows: l
For the OptiX OSN 8800 T32, the SCC is housed in IU28 by default. When IU11 is not occupied by another board, it is available for another SCC to implement 1+1 protection with the SCC in IU28. In this case, replacing one of the SCC in the protection group does not interrupt the communication between the NE where the SCC resides and the U2000 after a switching from this SCC to the other SCC is performed.
l
For the OptiX OSN 6800, the SCC is housed in IU18 by default. When IU17 is not occupied by another board, it is available for another SCC to implement 1+1 protection with the SCC in IU18. In this case, replacing one of the SCC in the protection group does not interrupt the communication between the NE where the SCC resides and the U2000 after a switching from this SCC to the other SCC is performed.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter, Web LCT Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
579
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Precautions
CAUTION l
If the NE where the SCC to be replaced resides is an ASON NE, the Node ID of the NE must be set according to the original data after the SCC is replaced. Otherwise, the NE database and ASON service cannot be restored.
l
Operations on the U2000 must be performed in the network management center.
l
Operations on the Web LCT must be performed on site.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement SCC board by referring to "Substitution Relationships". NOTE
The 1X3 jumper (namely, the battery jumper) on the SCC board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Make sure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and of pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out of work. The SCC board needs to be replaced.
Step 2 Back up the NE database to the NMS server. This is to record the NE database for future reference when the SCC board is replaced. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the device(s) that you want to backup in the NE View table. NOTE
The Backup Information tab is unavailable when multiple devices are selected.
3.
Select Backup... to open the Backup dialog.
4.
Select the option NMS Server or NMS Client to backup the selected device information.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
580
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
By default the NMS Server is selected. If the NMS Server is selected, the selected device information is stored on the NMS server.
5.
Optional: If the NMS Client is selected, click data are to be backed up.
6.
Click Start to start the backup operation for the selected device(s). On the NE View tab page, the backup progress is displayed.
7.
When the backup operation is successful, the NMS creates the dbf.pkg file in the NEName/ yyyymmddhhmmss directory. "NEName" indicates the name of the NE, "yyyymmdd" indicates the date when the backup is created, and "hhmmss" indicates the time when the backup is created.
to select the location where the device
Step 3 Set the jumpers on the spare SCC board using the following methods and insert it to the specified slot for a standby SCC board. In this manner, the file system of the new SCC board is formatted. NOTE
After inserting the spare SCC board to the specified slot for a standby SCC board, you need to add a corresponding logical board on the U2000. Then, the system automatically configures 1+1 protection for the SCC.
1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1111 so as to clear all the data in the flash memory except the board manufacturing information. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board to the slot housing the original SCC board, and wait for 15 minutes to allow the file system to be formated.
Step 4 After the file system of the SCC board is formated completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 3. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 5 View the indicators on the front panel of the new board. It takes approximately 90 minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator is not steady green, you need to reinsert the board or select a new replacement board. For details about the indicators, see Board Indicators. Step 6 Follow the steps below to perform an active/standby switching on the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click the desired SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Working/Protection Switching from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed.
4.
Click Query. If the Active Board is not the board to be replaced, the switching is successful.
5.
Query the alarms and performance events on the U2000. Check if services are normal. If services are normal, there must be no new abnormal alarms or performances. The switching is successful. NOTE
After you start the new SCC board, the system automatically synchronizes the data between the existing SCC board and the new SCC board. After data backup completes, you can perform the preceding step to initiate active/standby switching.
Step 7 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
581
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring. NOTE
For details to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 8 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. Step 9 Remove the physical SCC board and put it in an ESD bag. Then, on the U2000, delete the logical board of the SCC board to be replaced. ----End
8.3.4 Replacing the SCC in a Slave Subrack This section describes how to replace an SCC board in a slave subrack.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on the System Replacing the SCC does not affect the existing services. If the SCC is configured with 1+1 protection, replacing the SCC does not affect the system. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
582
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
If an SCC is not configured with 1+1 protection, replacing the SCC has the following effects: l
The fan is automatically changed to the "High Speed" mode.
l
The ESC and OSC communication of the subrack where the replacement SCC resides fails. NOTE
For an NE where only one SCC is configured, change the SCC board type on the U2000 before replacing the SCC.
l
The POWER_FAIL alarm of the subrack where the replacement SCC resides cannot be reported.
l
The subrack whose ID conflicts with the ID of the subrack where the replacement SCC resides cannot be detected.
l
Certain optical boards in the slave subrack housing the SCC board to be replaced go offline and cannot be managed; however, the services on these boards are not affected.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter
Background Information Before replacing an SCC board with a spare SCC board, set the battery jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. Clear the database on the spare SCC board before starting the replacement. Use setting jumpers on the spare board to configure the BIOS running mode and clear the database. Set the BIOS jumper on the spare board according to the procedure described in 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC. The four jumpers used for setting the BIOS running mode are arranged in order from high to low values and are identified as 04, 03, 02, and 01. The setting for each jumper corresponds to a binary value of either 0 or 1. When a jumper is not capped, the setting corresponds to binary 0. When the jumper is capped, the setting corresponds to binary 1. The settings of the four jumpers can be arranged in 16 different combinations, representing the values 0 to 15 in the decimal system. The default setting of the four jumpers is 0000. Ignore the alarms that are reported during SCC board replacement.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare SCC board as the replacement SCC board by referring to "Substitution Relationships". NOTE
The 1X3 jumper (namely, the battery jumper) on the SCC board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Make sure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and of pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out of work. The SCC board needs to be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current NE alarms. Step 3 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
583
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 4 Set Replace Board Type on the U2000. 1.
Double-click the optical NE icon in the Main Topology. Then, the running status of the optical NE is displayed.
2.
Select the desired NE. In the NE Panel tab, right-click the desired SCC board and click Replace Board Type from the shortcut menu.
3.
The dialog box of Replacement Board Type is displayed, select the name of the target board to be replaced within the Usable Board Type. Click OK.
4.
After the replacement, a prompt appears asking you whether to immediately upload the NE data. Click OK. NOTE
If you click Cancel, the board is successfully upgraded, but you need to manually upload the NE data later.
5.
Click OK to confirm the uploading of the NE data again. NOTE
If you click Cancel, the board is successfully upgraded, but you need to manually upload the NE data later.
6.
Click Close in the displayed Result dialog box. NOTE
After changing the board type by setting Replace Board Type on the U2000, the WRG_BD_TYPE alarm will be reported.
Step 5 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For more information regarding how to replace a board, refer to "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 6 Set the four jumpers on the spare SCC board to set the BIOS running mode. Then insert the SCC board to the slot housing the original SCC board to format the file system of the new SCC board. 1.
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare SCC board to 1111 to clear all the data in the flash memory except the board manufacturing information. 8.2.1 Setting the Jumper on the SCC shows the settings of the four jumpers on the SCC board.
2.
Insert the spare SCC board in the slot housing the original SCC board. Wait for 15 minutes to allow the database to be cleared.
Step 7 After the file system of the SCC board is formated completely, remove the board. Remove the jumper caps which are shown in Step 6. After that, reinsert this SCC board to the slot. Step 8 Wait ten minutes. If the U2000 reports a SWDL_PKG_NOBDSOFT alarm, a software upgrade is required for the replacement. For details, see Upgrade Guide. Step 9 View the indicators on the front panel of the new board. It takes approximately 90 minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator is not steady green, you need to reinsert the board or select a new replacement board. For details about the indicators, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the new board works normally, the WRG_BD_TYPE alarm will be cleared on the U2000.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
584
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 10 Query the current alarms of the NE using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After replacing the SCC, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the SCC board is abnormal, check whether the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is out. The board must be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.4 Replacing the TN16XCH Board This section describes how to replace TN16XCH board.
8.4.1 Setting the Battery Jumper on the TN16XCH Board This section describes how to set the battery jumper on the spare TN16XCH board before replacing the TN16XCH board. The battery on the TN16XCH helps to ensure that the configuration is kept upon a power failure of the TN16XCH. If the board is in use, place a jumper cap over the battery jumper to make a short circuit, which allows the battery to supply power normally. If the board is not in use, use a jumper cap to disconnect the battery jumper. Figure 8-19 shows the position of battery jumper on the TN16XCH board.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
585
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-19 Position of the battery jumper on the TN16XCH board
J1 CPU
Battery Jumper
321
CF Card
Figure 8-20 shows the power jumper. Figure 8-20 battery jumper
Not used
Used
3
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
2
1
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
586
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8.4.2 Replacing the TN16XCH Board in a Master Subrack This section describes how to replace the TN16XCH board of the master subrack when TN16XCH 1+1 protection is configured.
Prerequisites l
You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
l
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
Impact on the System Replacing an TN16XCH board configured with protection does not affect the existing services. For TN16XCH 1+1 protection, replacing one of the TN16XCH in the protection group does not interrupt the communication between the NE where the TN16XCH resides and the U2000 after a switching from this TN16XCH to the other TN16XCH is performed.
Tools, Equipment and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter
Background Information Before an TN16XCH board is replaced with a spare board, the battery jumper on the spare TN16XCH board must be set with reference to Setting the Jumper on the TN16XCH Board. In addition, the file system on the spare TN16XCH board must be formated before the replacement. This can be achieved by setting the BIOS running mode to 1111 through DIP switch on the spare TN16XCH board reference to Setting the Jumper on the TN16XCH Board.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare TN16XCH board as the replacement board. Ensure that the spare TN16XCH board and the TN16XCH board to be replaced have the same name and type. NOTE
The 1 x 3 jumper (namely, the battery jumper) on the TN16XCH board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Ensure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The TN16XCH board needs to be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Back up the NE database to the NMS server. This is to record the NE database for future reference when the TN16XCH board is replaced. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the device(s) that you want to backup in the NE View table. NOTE
The Backup Information tab is unavailable when multiple devices are selected.
3. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Select Backup... to open the Backup dialog. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
587
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
4.
8 Parts Replacement
Select the option NMS Server or NMS Client to backup the selected device information. NOTE
By default the NMS Server is selected. If the NMS Server is selected, the selected device information is stored on the NMS server.
5.
Optional: If the NMS Client is selected, click data are to be backed up.
6.
Click Start to start the backup operation for the selected device(s). On the NE View tab page, the backup progress is displayed.
7.
When the backup operation is successful, the NMS creates the dbf.pkg file in the NEName/ yyyymmddhhmmss directory. "NEName" indicates the name of the NE, "yyyymmdd" indicates the date when the backup is created, and "hhmmss" indicates the time when the backup is created.
to select the location where the device
Step 4 Follow the steps below to review the working state of the board to be replaced. 1.
In the NE Explorer, click the NE and choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Query.
Step 5 If the board to be replaced is the active board, go to Step 6. Otherwise, go to Step 8. Step 6 If the board to be replaced is the working board, follow the steps below to perform an active/ standby switching on the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click the desired SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Working/Protection Switching from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed.
4.
Click Query. If the Active Board is not the board to be replaced, the switching is successful.
5.
Query the alarms and performance events on the U2000. Check if services are normal. If services are normal, there must be no new abnormal alarms or performances. The switching is successful.
Step 7 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 8 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For more information regarding how to remove a board, refer to "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 9 Set the DIP switch on the spare TN16XCH board to set the BIOS running mode and then insert the TN16XCH board to the slot housing the original TN16XCH board. In this manner, the database on the new TN16XCH board is cleared. 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Set the BIOS running mode of the spare TN16XCH board to 1111 to format the file system in the flash memory. Setting the Jumper on the TN16XCH Board shows the settings of the DIP switch on the TN16XCH board. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
588
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2.
8 Parts Replacement
Insert the spare TN16XCH board to the slot housing the original TN16XCH board. Wait for 15 minutes to allow the database to be cleared.
Step 10 After the database on the new TN16XCH board is cleared, remove it. In addition, reset the DIP switch to the 0000 state which is shown in Step 9. Then reinsert this TN16XCH board to the slot. Step 11 Review the indicators of the new board. It takes 90 minutes for a board to work normally after the board is inserted. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator gives an abnormal indication, reinsert the board or replace the board again. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Indicators". Step 12 Optional: Follow the steps below to switch the active/standby state of the SCCs back to the original state. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Restore Working/Protection from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed. NOTE
After the new TN16XCH board is started, the system automatically backs up the data on the existing TN16XCH board to the new TN16XCH board. After the data is backed up, you can perform the preceding step to initiate an active/standby switching.
Step 13 Check and set the other parameters on the U2000 to ensure that the parameter values of the new board are the same as the original data. 1.
Check the software information of the new SCC against the original data.
2.
Synchronize the NE time with the NMS server time.
3.
Check the NE alarm attribute data against the original data. The data include saving mode, reversion mode and delayed report.
4.
Check the alarm suppression setting data against the original data.
5.
Enable the NE performance monitoring.
6.
Check whether the switching state is correct. Perform a switching test. NOTE
For details about how to set these parameters, see iManager U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management.
Step 14 Query the current alarms of the NE by using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
589
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
After the TN16XCH is replaced, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the TN16XCH board is abnormal, determine if the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The board needs to be replaced.
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.4.3 Replacing the TN16XCH Board in a Slave Subrack This section describes how to replace TN16XCH board in a slave subrack.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on the System Replacing the TN16XCH does not affect the existing services and system.
Tools, Equipment and Materials ESD bag, U2000, multimeter
Background Information Before TN16XCH board is replaced with a spare board, the battery jumper on the spare TN16XCH board must be set. Reference to Setting the Jumper on the TN16XCH Board for more information.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare TN16XCH board as the replacement board. Ensure that the spare TN16XCH board and the TN16XCH board to be replaced have the same name and type. NOTE
The 1 x 3 jumper (namely, the battery jumper) on the TN16XCH board is used to enable or disable the power supply from the battery. Ensure that pin 1 and pin 2 of this jumper are capped. Then, cap pin 2 and pin 3 on the jumper and use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The TN16XCH board needs to be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Follow the steps below to review the working state of the board to be replaced. 1.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
In the NE Explorer, click the NE and choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
590
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
2.
8 Parts Replacement
Click Query.
Step 4 If the board to be replaced is the active board, go to Step 5. Otherwise, go to Step 7. Step 5 If the board to be replaced is the working board, follow the steps below to perform an active/ standby switching on the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click the desired SCC Board 1+1 Protection. Select Working/Protection Switching from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed.
4.
Click Query. If the Active Board is not the board to be replaced, the switching is successful.
5.
Query the alarms and performance events on the U2000. Check if services are normal. If services are normal, there must be no new abnormal alarms or performances. The switching is successful.
Step 6 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 7 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For more information regarding how to remove a board, refer to "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. Step 8 Review the indicators of the new board. It takes ten minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator gives an abnormal indication, reinsert the board, or replace the board again. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators". Step 9 Query the current alarms of the NE by using the U2000. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the Main Menu.
2.
Click the Basic Setting and Alarm Source tabs in turn on the Filter dialog box to set the filter conditions for the current alarms.
3.
Click OK.
4.
Record the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
You can select the desired alarms and right-click to choose Save > Save Selected Records, or rightclick to choose Save > Save All Records from the shortcut menu to save the current alarms of the NE. NOTE
After the TN16XCH is replaced, ensure that the monitoring of the POWER_FAIL alarm is enabled. If the POWER_FAIL alarm occurs, and the alarm parameter is 0x5 0xff 0xff 0xff 0xff, the battery of the TN16XCH board is abnormal, determine if the jumper cap is correctly placed over the battery jumper. If yes, use a multimeter to measure the battery voltage. If the voltage is lower than 3 V, the battery is not working. The board needs to be replaced.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
591
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
CAUTION The standard voltage of the battery is 3.6 V. The battery is fixed on the board and cannot be replaced. ----End
8.5 Replacing the Cross-Connect Board This section describes how to replace the Cross-Connect boards. You can replace the Cross-Connect board if: l
The Cross-Connect board 1+1 protection is configured.
l
There is no protection for the Cross-Connect board.
8.5.1 Substitution Relationships This section describes the substitution relationships of the cross-connect board. The following board has substitution relationships.
SXM Table 8-7 Substitution rules of the SXM board Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TNK2SXM
TNK4SXM
The TNK4SXM can be created as TNK2SXM on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TNK4SXM functions as the TNK2SXM.
TNK4SXM
None
None
XCH TN52XCH and TN16XCH are the versions of this boards. The description of replacing the TN16XCH board will be described separately because its functions are different from those of a common cross-connect board.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
592
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
XCT Original Board
Substitute Board
Substitution Rules
TNK2XCT
TNK4XCT
The TNK4XCT can be created as TNK2XCT on the NMS. The former can substitute for the latter, without any software upgrade. After substitution, the TNK4XCT functions as the TNK2XCT.
TNK4XCT
None
None
8.5.2 Under Board 1+1 Protection This section describes how to replace the cross-connect board when cross-connect board 1+1 protection is configured.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on System When cross-connect 1+1 board protection is configured, replacing the cross-connect board brings no impact on the services in case of a normal switching. During board replacement, the board software takes several minutes to be synchronized. At this point, the PROG indicator on the board is blinking green quickly. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version and model number of the new board are the same as those of the original. NOTE
If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
Step 2 Query and record the current alarms on the NE. Check whether the BUS_ERR alarm has occurred to the subrack where the cross-connect board is located. If it has occurred, clear the alarm before the replacement. Otherwise, replacing the board causes a service interruption. Step 3 Perform an active/standby switching on the U2000.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
593
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
For OptiX OSN 8800 T32, assume that the cross-connect board to be replaced in slot 9 is the active crossconnect board, and that the cross-connect board in slot 10 works normally and no BUS_ERR alarm is generated on the subrack. For OptiX OSN 8800 T64, assume that the cross-connect board to be replaced in slot 9 (slot 10) is the active cross-connect board, and that the cross-connect board in slot 43 (slot 44) works normally and no BUS_ERR alarm is generated on the subrack. NOTE
For OptiX OSN 6800, assume that the XCS board to be replaced is located in slot 9 and it is the main XCS board, and that the XCS board in slot 10 works normally and the subrack where it is located has no BUS_ERR alarm.
1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click the desired Cross-Connect Board 1+1 Protection . Select Working/Protection Switching from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed.
4.
Click Query. If the Active Board is not the board to be replaced, the switching is successful.
5.
Query the alarms and performance events on the U2000. Check if services are normal. If services are normal, there must be no new abnormal alarms or performances. The switching is successful.
Step 4 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators . NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 5 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For details about how to replace a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. NOTE
After the board is replaced, the NE software delivers the configuration of the original board automatically.
Step 6 Check the indicators of the new board. It takes four or five minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady on green. If the indicator is not steady on green, you need to reinsert the board or select a new replacement board. For details about the indicators, see "Indicators". Step 7 Follow the steps below to cancel the switching. 1.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
2.
Choose Configuration > Board 1+1 Protection from the Function Tree.
3.
In Board 1+1 Protection, right-click the desired Cross-Connect Board 1+1 Protection. Select Working/Protection Switching from the shortcut menu. Click OK in the window displayed.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
594
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 8 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. ----End
8.5.3 Under No Protection This section describes how to replace the cross-connect board when no protection is configured.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on System When you replace the cross-connect board without protection, that is, the only cross-connect board (suppose it is in IU9) on an NE. l
For OptiX OSN 6800, – When IU10 is occupied by other boards, cross-connect board protection cannot be configured. Replacement of the cross-connect board causes interruption of traditional services. − If the NE whose cross-connect board needs to be replaced is an intermediate NE of electrical-layer ASON services, optimize the electrical-layer ASON services traversing the NE to other paths (the preset restoration paths are preferred if the preset restoration paths of the services do not traverse the NE) before board replacement. Then, switch the services back to the original paths after board replacement and verify that the services are running correctly. − If the NE whose cross-connect board needs to be replaced is an NE where electricallayer ASON services are added or dropped, the services will be interrupted during board replacement. – When IU10 is not occupied by other boards, it is available for another cross-connect board to realize 1+1 protection with the cross-connect board in IU10. When the crossconnect board has 1+1 protection and when the switching is normal, replacement of the cross-connect board does not cause service interruption
During board replacement, the board software takes several minutes to be synchronized. At this point, the PROG indicator on the board is blinking green quickly. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version and model number of the new board are the same as those of the original. NOTE
If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
595
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 3 For OptiX OSN 6800, if IU10 is not occupied by other boards, insert another cross-connect board in IU10 and add a corresponding logical board on the U2000. Then the system automatically configures the cross-connect board 1+1 protection. For steps to replace an crossconnect board that is configured with board 1+1 protection, see 8.5.2 Under Board 1+1 Protection. Step 4 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators . NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 5 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For details about how to remove a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. NOTE
After the board is replaced, the NE software delivers the configuration of the original board automatically.
Step 6 Check the indicators of the new board. It takes four or five minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady on green. If the indicator is not steady on green, you need to reinsert the board or select a new replacement board. For details about the indicators, see "Indicators" . Step 7 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. ----End
8.6 Replacing the Raman Amplifier Board This section describes how to replace the Raman amplifier board.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher. Be aware of the laser security level, potential injuries and protective precautions. Confirm the amount of the adopted Raman amplifier board. Be familiar with the fiber connection between the local Raman amplifier board and the remote board. Be familiar with the location of the connector. Take the drawings into the room.
Impact on the System Replacement of boards that process services causes interruption of traditional services. If ASON services traverse the board to be replaced, optimize the ASON services traversing the board to other paths (the preset restoration paths of the services are preferred if they do not traverse the board to be replaced) before board replacement. For optical-layer ASON services, the new paths must be commissioned; otherwise, the services may be interrupted. After board replacement, switch the ASON services back to the original paths. If no other paths are available during board replacement, the ASON services will be interrupted. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
596
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000
Precautions
WARNING When replacing the Raman amplifier board or before removing or inserting the Raman amplifier board shut down the pump laser on the CRPC/RAU1. Otherwise, the laser may bring damage to human body.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version and model number of the new board are the same as those of the original. NOTE
If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Disabling the IPA. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose Configuration > IPA Management from the Function Tree.
2.
Click Query to query the created IPA information. The Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close.
3.
Select the IPA that you want to enable or disable, double-click the field of IPA Status, and set the value to Enabled or Disabled.
4.
Click Apply. The Warning dialog box is displayed and click Yes. The Result dialog box is displayed telling you that the operation was successful. Click Close.
5.
In the NE Explorer of the opposite NE, repeat the steps above.
Step 4 Shutting down the Raman laser. 1.
Double-click the Optical NE icon on the Main Topology. The NE Panel tab is displayed. Right-click the NE icon and select NE Explorer.
2.
In the NE Explorer, select the desired board and choose Configuration > WDM interface from the Function Tree.
3.
Click By Board/Port(Channel). Select Channel from the drop-down list.
4.
In the Basic Attributes tab, double-click the Laser Status field of the port. Then choose On or Off from the drop-down list to change the laser state.
5.
Click Apply. l After you open the laser, the You are starting up to a high power Optical Fiber Communications System. You must ensure that the fiber is continuous. Do you wish to continue and enable this system? dialog box is displayed. Click OK. Then, click Close on the Operation Result dialog box.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
597
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
l After you close the laser, the You can turn on a laser again only when the board belongs to an IPA pair. Continue? dialog box is displayed. Click OK. Then, click Close on the displayed Operation Result dialog box. Step 5 Replacing the Raman amplifier board. 1.
Disconnect the fibers at the LINE port and the SYS port.
2.
Remove the Raman amplifier board and put it into the ESD bag.
3.
Insert the new Raman amplifier board.
4.
Connect the fibers at the LINE port and the SYS port.
Step 6 View the indicators on the front panel of the new board. It takes approximately three or four minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the RUN indicator is green. If the indicator is not green, reinsert the board or select a new replacement board. For details about the indicators, see "Indicators". Step 7 Enable the IPA function and turn on the Raman laser. Check whether the on-off gain of the Raman amplifier board complies with the specification requirement for the on-off gain of the board. If not, adjust the on-off gain of the board. NOTE
On-off gain = Optical power on the SYS interface when the laser is enabled - Optical power on the SYS interface when the Raman laser is disabled
Step 8 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. Step 9 Check and ensure that the traffic is correct. NOTE
If there are any other problems, contact Huawei.
----End
8.7 Replacing the PID Board This section describes how to replace the PID board. Methods of replacing the PID board are described under the following scenarios: l
Replacing the ENQ2/NPO2/NPO2E board.
l
Replacing the PQ2 Sub-board
8.7.1 Replacing the ENQ2/NPO2/NPO2E Board This section describes how to replace the ENQ2/NPO2/NPO2E Board. Methods of replacing the ENQ2/NPO2/NPO2E board are described under the following scenarios: l
ODUk SNCP is configured.
l
There is no protection for the PID board.
8.7.1.1 Under ODUk SNCP Protection This section describes how to replace a PID board when ODUk SNCP protection is configured. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
598
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Prerequisites For the operations on the NMS, you must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on System When ODUk SNCP protection is configured, replacing a PID board generally brings no service interruption. During board replacement, the board software takes several minutes to be synchronized. At this point, the PROG indicator on the board is blinking green quickly. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD wrist strap, ESD bag, U2000, optical power meter
Background In the following scenarios, when a PID board works with an OBU1P1 board on an NE, check the optical power of the PID board before you replace the PID board to avoid optical power overload during board replacement: l
When a TN55NPO2L06 or TN55NPO2L08 board needs to be replaced on a 200 Gbit/s NE configured with a PID board, ensure received optical power of each channel is lower than 0 dBm.
l
When an ENQ2 board needs to be replaced on a 120 Gbit/s NE configured with a PID board, ensure received optical power of each channel is lower than 1 dBm.
When substituting the TN55NPO2 board for the TN54NPO2 board, you must configure the PQ2 sub-board to support four wavelengths. For details on board substitution relationships, see the following table. New Board
Original
TN54NPO201
TN55NPO2S01+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO202
TN55NPO2S02/TN55NPO2L02+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO203
TN55NPO2S03+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO204
TN55NPO2S04/TN55NPO2L04+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO205
TN55NPO2S05+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO206
TN55NPO2S06/TN55NPO2L06+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO207
TN55NPO2S07+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO208
TN55NPO2S08/TN55NPO2L08+TN54PQ2
NOTE
When you replace the NPO2/NPO2E board and the ENQ2 board at the same time, it is recommended to replace the NPO2/NPO2E board first.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
599
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Precautions
CAUTION When you connect a fiber to the input optical port of an NPO2 or NPO2E board, loosely connect the fiber to prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module will be burned and damaged.
Procedure 1.
Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version, and software version of the new board are the same as those of the original board. If the version is inconsistent, you need to determine if the board with a different versions can be replaced.
2.
Review and record the current alarms on the NE. NOTE
To replace a board in an upgrade, perform this operation to determine if abnormal alarms are generated on the NE where the board to be replaced resides and the downstream NE. If there are abnormal alarms, handle these alarms before replacing the board.
3.
Test the input optical power. Prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module will be burned and damaged. For this procedure, refer to the Testing Optical Power by Using an Optical Power Meter.
4.
Query the working status of each channel on the board to be replaced. a.
In the NE Explorer, click the NE and choose Configuration > WDM Service Management from the Function Tree. Click the SNCP Service Control tab.
b.
Click Query to obtain the SNCP protection state of each NE. Then, you can determine whether the service is working on the active path or working on the standby path.
5.
If the board is the current working board, go to 6. If the board is the current protection board, go to 9.
6.
If the board to be replaced is the current working board, follow the steps below to perform active/standby switching on the U2000. NOTE
The channel status of the protection board must be normal. Otherwise, replacing the faulty board causes a service interruption. NOTE
If an NPO2/NPO2E board needs to be replaced, switch services on the working channels of the PID boards to protection channels. If an ENQ2 board needs to be replaced, switch services on the working channel only over the ENQ2 board to the protection channel.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
a.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
b.
Choose Configuration > WDM Service Management from the Function Tree.
c.
Click SNCP Service Control tab.
d.
Click Function on the right-hand interface and select Manual to Protection from the menu displayed. Click OK on the interface displayed. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
600
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
e.
Click Function on the right-hand interface and select Query Switching Status from the menu displayed. If Manual(from working to protection) switching state is displayed in the Status field, the switching succeeds.
f.
Query the U2000 for the alarms and performance events. Make sure that there are no new alarms or performance events and services are normal but only protection switching alarm.
7.
At the opposite end perform manual switching on the U2000 to ensure that the working channel is at the opposite end and is consistent with that at the local end. For information about how to perform manual switching, see 6.
8.
On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
9.
Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. a.
Remove the pigtail connected to the optical port and remove the board to be replaced. If the PQ2 sub-board also needs to be replaced, go to 9.3. If the PQ2 sub-board does not need to be replaced, go to 9.2.
b.
Loosen the screws on the PQ2 sub-board and remove the board. Install the PQ2 subboard on the new board and tighten the screws on the PQ2 sub-board.
c.
Insert the new board to the original slot. For details on how to remove and insert a new board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board.
d.
After the board replacement is complete, clean the fiber connector using a fiber cleaning tissue and reconnect the pigtail to the optical port based on the fiber labels. NOTE
After the board is replaced, the NE software delivers the configuration of the original board automatically.
10. Review the indicators of the new board. It takes ten minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator of the PID board and the PQ2 subboard is green. If the indicator gives an abnormal indication, reinsert the board, or replace the board again. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators". 11. Release the switching on the local and opposite NEs. a.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
b.
Choose Configuration > WDM Service Management in the Function Tree.
c.
Click SNCP Service Control tab.
d.
Select the switched service, and click Function on the right-hand interface. Select Clear from the menu displayed.
e.
Click Query, and review Status. If the value is Normal State, the switching succeeds.
12. Query the 15-minute BER before FEC at the receive end of the link. Ensure that the BER before FEC does not deteriorate greatly from the value before board replacement. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
601
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
a.
Choose Performance > Browse WDM Performance from the Main Menu of the U2000, and then click the Current Performance Data tab.
b.
Choose the desired boards in the left pane, and click the double-right-arrow button (red).
c.
Choose the option from the drop-down list next to Monitored Object Filter Condition.
d.
In Monitor Period, select 15-Minute.
e.
Click Count option button. Select options under Performance Event Type, and select Display Zero Data for the Display Options.
f.
Click Query to query the performance value for bit error on the NE side.
g.
In the Operation Result dialog box, click Close to finish the operation.
h.
In the Monitored Object, FEC_BEF_COR_ER represents the BER before FEC.
13. Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. NOTE
The ENQ2 board does not support the PQ2 sub-board. To replace an ENQ2 board, perform steps 1, 2, 4– 10, and 12. For OptiX OSN 8800, when the Restart Mode of PID IPA is set to Manual, a manual restart at two stations is required after the board is replaced. For more information about the restarting the PID IPA, refer to Restarting of PID IPA.
8.7.1.2 Under No Protection This section describes how to replace a PID board when no protection is configured.
Prerequisites For the operations on the NMS, you must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on System Replacing a PID board without protection will interrupt services. Replacing only a PQ2 subboard will interrupt channels 5 to 8 on the NPO2 or NPO2E board. During board replacement, the board software takes several minutes to be synchronized. At this point, the PROG indicator on the board is blinking green quickly. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD wrist strap, ESD bag, U2000, optical power meter
Background In the following scenarios, when a PID board works with an OBU1P1 board on an NE, check the optical power of the PID board before you replace the PID board to avoid optical power overload during board replacement: Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
602
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
l
When a TN55NPO2L06 or TN55NPO2L08 board needs to be replaced on a 200 Gbit/s NE configured with a PID board, ensure received optical power of each channel is lower than 0 dBm.
l
When an ENQ2 board needs to be replaced on a 120 Gbit/s NE configured with a PID board, ensure received optical power of each channel is lower than 1 dBm.
When substituting the TN55NPO2 board for the TN54NPO2 board, you must configure the PQ2 sub-board to support four wavelengths. For details on board substitution relationships, see the following table. New Board
Original
TN54NPO201
TN55NPO2S01+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO202
TN55NPO2S02/TN55NPO2L02+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO203
TN55NPO2S03+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO204
TN55NPO2S04/TN55NPO2L04+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO205
TN55NPO2S05+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO206
TN55NPO2S06/TN55NPO2L06+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO207
TN55NPO2S07+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO208
TN55NPO2S08/TN55NPO2L08+TN54PQ2
NOTE
When you replace the NPO2/NPO2E board and the ENQ2 board at the same time, it is recommended to replace the NPO2/NPO2E board first.
Precautions
CAUTION When you connect a fiber to the input optical port of an NPO2 or NPO2E board, loosely connect the fiber to prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module will be burned and damaged.
Procedure 1.
Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version, and software version of the new board are the same as those of the original board. If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
2.
Review and record the current alarms on the NE.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
603
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
To replace a board in an upgrade, perform this operation to determine if abnormal alarms are generated on the NE where the board to be replaced resides and the downstream NE. If there are abnormal alarms, handle these alarms before replacing the board.
3.
Test the input optical power. Prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module will be burned and damaged. For the procedure, refer to the Testing Optical Power by Using an Optical Power Meter.
4.
On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators. NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
5.
Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. a.
Remove the pigtail connected to the optical port and remove the board to be replaced. If the PQ2 sub-board also needs to be replaced, go to 5.3. If the PQ2 sub-board does not need to be replaced, go to 5.2.
b.
Loosen the screws on the PQ2 sub-board and remove the board. Install the PQ2 subboard on the new board and tighten the screws on the PQ2 sub-board.
c.
Insert the new board to the original slot. For details on how to remove and insert a new board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board.
d.
After board replacement is complete, clean the fiber connector using a fiber cleaning tissue and reconnect the pigtail to the optical port based on the fiber labels. NOTE
After the board is replaced, the NE software delivers the configuration of the original board automatically.
6.
Review the indicators of the new board. It takes ten minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator of the PID board and the PQ2 subboard is green. If the indicator gives an abnormal indication, reinsert the board, or replace the board again. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
7.
Query the 15-minute BER before FEC at the receive end of the link. Ensure that the BER before FEC does not deteriorate greatly from the value before board replacement.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
a.
Choose Performance > Browse WDM Performance from the Main Menu of the U2000, and then click the Current Performance Data tab.
b.
Choose the desired boards in the left pane, and click the double-right-arrow button (red).
c.
Choose the option from the drop-down list next to Monitored Object Filter Condition.
d.
In Monitor Period, select 15-Minute.
e.
Click Count option button. Select options under Performance Event Type, and select Display Zero Data for the Display Options.
f.
Click Query to query the performance value for bit error on the NE side.
g.
In the Operation Result dialog box, click Close to finish the operation. Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
604
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
h. 8.
8 Parts Replacement
In the Monitored Object, FEC_BEF_COR_ER represents the BER before FEC.
Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. NOTE
For OptiX OSN 8800, when the Restart Mode of PID IPA is set to Manual, a manual restart at two stations is required after the board is replaced. For more information about restarting the PID IPA, refer to Restarting of PID IPA.
8.7.2 Replacing the PQ2 Sub-board This section describes how to replace the ENQ2/NPO2/NPO2E Board. Methods of replacing the PQ2 sub-board are described under the following scenarios: l
ODUk SNCP is configured.
l
There is no protection for the PID board.
8.7.2.1 Under ODUk SNCP Protection This section describes how to replace a PID board when ODUk SNCP protection is configured.
Prerequisites For the operations on the NMS, you must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on System When ODUk SNCP protection is configured, replacing a PID board generally brings no service interruption. During board replacement, the board software takes several minutes to be synchronized. At this point, the PROG indicator on the board is blinking green quickly. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD wrist strap, ESD bag, U2000, optical power meter
Background In the following scenarios, when a PID board works with an OBU1P1 board on an NE, check the optical power of the PID board before you replace the PID board to avoid optical power overload during board replacement: l
When a TN55NPO2L06 or TN55NPO2L08 board needs to be replaced on a 200 Gbit/s NE configured with a PID board, ensure received optical power of each channel is lower than 0 dBm.
l
When an ENQ2 board needs to be replaced on a 120 Gbit/s NE configured with a PID board, ensure received optical power of each channel is lower than 1 dBm.
When substituting the TN55NPO2 board for the TN54NPO2 board, you must configure the PQ2 sub-board to support four wavelengths. For details on board substitution relationships, see the following table. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
605
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
New Board
Original
TN54NPO201
TN55NPO2S01+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO202
TN55NPO2S02/TN55NPO2L02+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO203
TN55NPO2S03+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO204
TN55NPO2S04/TN55NPO2L04+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO205
TN55NPO2S05+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO206
TN55NPO2S06/TN55NPO2L06+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO207
TN55NPO2S07+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO208
TN55NPO2S08/TN55NPO2L08+TN54PQ2
NOTE
When you replace the NPO2/NPO2E board and the ENQ2 board at the same time, it is recommended to replace the NPO2/NPO2E board first.
Precautions
CAUTION When you connect a fiber to the input optical port of an NPO2 or NPO2E board, loosely connect the fiber to prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module is burnt and damaged.
Procedure 1.
Review and record the current alarms on the NE. NOTE
To replace a board in an upgrade, perform this operation to determine if abnormal alarms are generated on the NE where the board to be replaced resides and the downstream NE. If there are abnormal alarms, you need to handle these alarms before replacing the board.
2.
Query the working status of the NPO2/NPO2E board where the PQ2 sub-board resides. a.
In the NE Explorer, click the NE and choose Configuration > WDM Service Management from the Function Tree. Click the SNCP Service Control tab.
b.
Click Query to obtain the SNCP protection state of each NE. Then, you can learn the service is working on active path or working on standby path.
3.
If the board is the working NPO2 or NPO2E board, go to 4. If the board is the protection NPO2 or NPO2E board, go to 6.
4.
If the NPO2/NPO2E board where the PQ2 sub-board to be replaced resides is the working board, perform manual switching on the NPO2/NPO2E board in U2000. NOTE
In this step, you need to switch services on all working channels of PID boards to protection channels.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
606
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
The channel status of the protection board must be normal. Otherwise, replacing the faulty board causes a service interruption.
a.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
b.
Choose Configuration > WDM Service Management from the Function Tree.
c.
Click SNCP Service Control tab.
d.
Click Function on the right-hand interface and select Manual to Protection from the menu displayed. Click OK on the interface displayed.
e.
Click Function on the right-hand interface and select Query Switching Status from the menu displayed. If Manual(from working to protection) switching state is displayed in the Status field, the switching succeeds.
f.
Query the U2000 for the alarms and performance events. Make sure that there are no new alarms or performance events and services are normal but only protection switching alarm.
5.
At the opposite end perform manual switching on the U2000 to ensure that the working channel at the opposite end is consistent with that at the local end. For how to perform manual switching, see 4.
6.
Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the PQ2 sub-board. a.
Loosen the screws on the PQ2 sub-board and remove the board.
b.
Install the new PQ2 sub-board on the original board and tighten the screws on the PQ2 sub-board.
7.
Review the indicators of the new board. It takes three minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator of the PQ2 sub-board is green. If the indicator gives abnormal indication, reinsert the board, or replace the board again. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
8.
Release the switching on the local and opposite NEs.
9.
a.
In the Main Topology, right-click the desire NE and click NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. The NE Explorer window is displayed.
b.
Choose Configuration > WDM Service Management in the Function Tree.
c.
Click SNCP Service Control tab.
d.
Select the switched service, and click Function on the right-hand interface. Select Clear from the menu displayed.
e.
Click Query, and review Status. If the value is Normal State, the switching succeeds.
Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. NOTE
For OptiX OSN 8800, when the Restart Mode of PID IPA is set to Manual, a manual restart at two stations is required after the board is replaced. For more information about restarting the PID IPA, refer to Restarting of PID IPA.
8.7.2.2 Under No Protection This section describes how to replace a PID board when no protection is configured. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
607
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Prerequisites For the operations on the NMS, you must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on System Replacing a PID board without protection will interrupt services. Replacing only a PQ2 subboard will interrupt channels 5 to 8 on the NPO2 or NPO2E board. During board replacement, the board software takes several minutes to be synchronized. At this point, the PROG indicator on the board is blinking green quickly. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD wrist strap, ESD bag, U2000, optical power meter
Background In the following scenarios, when a PID board works with an OBU1P1 board on an NE, check the optical power of the PID board before you replace the PID board to avoid optical power overload during board replacement: l
When a TN55NPO2L06 or TN55NPO2L08 board needs to be replaced on a 200 Gbit/s NE configured with a PID board, ensure received optical power of each channel is lower than 0 dBm.
l
When an ENQ2 board needs to be replaced on a 120 Gbit/s NE configured with a PID board, ensure received optical power of each channel is lower than 1 dBm.
When substituting the TN55NPO2 board for the TN54NPO2 board, you must configure the PQ2 sub-board to support four wavelengths. For details on board substitution relationships, see the following table. New Board
Original
TN54NPO201
TN55NPO2S01+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO202
TN55NPO2S02/TN55NPO2L02+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO203
TN55NPO2S03+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO204
TN55NPO2S04/TN55NPO2L04+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO205
TN55NPO2S05+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO206
TN55NPO2S06/TN55NPO2L06+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO207
TN55NPO2S07+TN54PQ2
TN54NPO208
TN55NPO2S08/TN55NPO2L08+TN54PQ2
NOTE
When you replace the NPO2/NPO2E board and the ENQ2 board at the same time, it is recommended to replace the NPO2/NPO2E board first.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
608
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Precautions
CAUTION When you connect a fiber to the input optical port of an NPO2 or NPO2E board, loosely connect the fiber to prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module is burnt and damaged.
Procedure 1.
Review and record the current alarms on the NE. NOTE
To replace a board in an upgrade, perform this operation to determine if abnormal alarms are generated on the NE where the board to be replaced resides and the downstream NE. If there are abnormal alarms, handle these alarms before replacing the board.
2.
Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the PQ2 sub-board. a.
Loosen the screws on the PQ2 sub-board and remove the board.
b.
Install the new PQ2 sub-board on the original board and tighten the screws on the PQ2 sub-board.
3.
Review the indicators of the new board. It takes three minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator of the PQ2 sub-board is green. If the indicator gives abnormal indication, reinsert the board, or replace the board again. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators".
4.
Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE and confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. NOTE
For OptiX OSN 8800, when the Restart Mode of PID IPA is set to Manual, a manual restart at two stations is required after the board is replaced. For more information about restarting the PID IPA, refer to Restarting of PID IPA.
8.8 Replacing the AUX Board This section describes how to replace the AUX board.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on System Replacing the AUX board does not affect services. When 1+1 protection is provided, replacing the AUX board does not interrupt the communication between the NE and the U2000. When 1+1 protection is not provided, replacing the AUX board interrupts the communication between the NE and the U2000, or the communication between the subrack where the AUX board is located and the U2000. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
609
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000
Background Information (OptiX OSN 8800) There is no jumper inside the TN51AUX board.
Background Information (OptiX OSN 6800) The AUX board can be used to set the subrack ID. The setting is realized by jumpers. The TN11AUX01 board is available in two types. For one type there are three jumpers and for the other type there are eight jumpers inside the board. l
For the TN11AUX01 board that has three jumpers inside, the jumpers can be set in eight combinations, representing decimal values 0-7. The default setting of the three jumpers is 000. The value 0 indicates the master subrack, and the other values indicate slave subracks. Figure 8-21 shows the position of the three jumpers. When the two pins on the right of each jumper are capped, the setting is 1; when the two pins on the left of each jumper are capped, the setting is 0. As shown in Figure 8-21, the jumper setting represents the decimal value of 1, which means that the subrack ID is 1.
l
For the TN11AUX01 board that has eight jumpers inside, the J14, J17, and J18 jumpers are reserved and the two pins on the left of each reserved jumper must be capped. The J16, J15, J4, J3, and J2 jumpers can be set in 32 combinations, representing decimal values 0-31. The default setting of the five jumpers is 00000. The value 0 indicates the master subrack and the other values indicate slave subracks. Figure 8-22 shows the position of the jumpers. When the two pins on the right of each of the five jumpers are capped, the setting is 1; when the two pins on the left of each of the five jumpers are capped, the setting is 0. As shown in Figure 8-22, the jumper setting represents the decimal value of 1, which means that the subrack ID is 1.
The TN11AUX02 board has eight jumpers, which can be used to implement 32 states that represent decimal values 0-31. Each jumper represents a binary value: 0 or 1. In the TN11AUX02 board, the J14, J17, and J18 jumpers are reserved. The default value of the five jumpers is 00000. "0" indicates the master subrack. The other values indicate slave subracks. Figure 8-23 shows the jumpers on the board. For the master/slave subrack, the ID of the master subrack is set to 0. Others are slave subracks. The master/slave subrack cannot be configured by using the U2000.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
610
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-21 Position of the three jumpers on the TN11AUX01 board representing representing
0
representing
0
1
2
1
3
Junper cap
jumpers
1
3
2
CPU
Figure 8-22 Position of the eight jumpers on the TN11AUX01 board representing 0
representing 0
J3
J4
J2
representing 0
representing 0
J17
representing 1
representing 0
J15
J16 representing 0
representing 0
Junper cap J14
J18
J4
J3
J2
J17
J16
J15
J18
J14
jumpers
CPU
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
611
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-23 Position of the jumper on the TN11AUX02 board representing 0
representing 0
J3
J4
J2
representing 0
representing 0
J17
representing 1
representing 0
J15
J16 representing 0
representing 0
Junper cap J14
J18
J4
J3
J2
J17
J16
J15
J18
J14
jumpers
CPU
CAUTION The J14, J17, and J18 jumpers must be set as specified in Figure 8-22 and Figure 8-23. Exercise caution when modifying the subrack ID, because the modification may cause service interruption.
Precaution(OptiX OSN 3800) The TN21AUX has threejumpers. Figure 8-24 shows the jumpers.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
612
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-24 Position of the jumper on the TN21AUX
CPU
Jumper
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version and model number of the new board are the same as those of the original. NOTE
If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 On the NMS, enable the removal indication function for the board to be replaced. For details, see Enabling the Function of Board Removal Indication. NOTE
For the boards supporting the removal indication function, see Board Indicators . NOTE
After the removal indication function is enabled for the board to be replaced, the STAT indicator on the board and Minor alarm indicator in the subrack slowly blink green so that the onsite maintenance engineer can easily locate the board to be replaced.
Step 4 Inform the on-site maintenance engineer and replace the board. For details about how to replace a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board. NOTE
Before inserting a new AUX board to the original slot, make sure that jumper settings on the new AUX board are the same as those of the AUX board to be replaced. NOTE
After the board is replaced, the NE software delivers the configuration of the original board automatically.
Step 5 Review the indicators of the new board. It takes ten minutes for a new board to work normally after insertion. Ensure that the STAT indicator is steady green. If the indicator gives an abnormal indication, reinsert the board, or replace the board again. For more information regarding indicator definitions, refer to "Board Indicators". Step 6 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. ----End Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
613
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8.9 Replacing the DCM This section describes how to replace the DCM.
Prerequisites None
Impact on the System Replacement of DCMs causes interruption of traditional services. If ASON services traverse the DCM to be replaced, optimize the ASON services traversing the DCM to other paths (the preset restoration paths of the services are preferred if they do not traverse the DCM to be replaced) before replacement. For optical-layer ASON services, the new paths must be commissioned; otherwise, the services may be interrupted. After replacement, switch the ASON services back to the original paths. If no other paths are available during replacement, the ASON services will be interrupted.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials Phillips screwdriver and screw
Procedure Step 1 Loosen the screws from below on the DCM frame for fixing the DCM with the cross screwdriver. Remove the DCM from the DCM frame. NOTE
Each DCM frame can hold up to two DCMs. Each DCM requires four screws.
Step 2 Put a new DCM on the DCM frame. Tighten the screws to fix the DCM, as shown in Figure 8-25.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
614
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-25 Replacing the DCM on the DCM frame
1
2 3 4
1. DCM
2. DCM frame
3. Mounting ear
4. Screw
----End
8.10 Replacing the Pluggable Optical Module This section describes how to replace the pluggable optical module (eSFP/XFP).
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on the System When you replace an eSFP or XFP, query whether the port of the optical module to be replaced is configured with protection. If it is not, replacement of the optical module causes interruption of traditional services. If electrical-layer ASON services traverse the port of the optical module to be replaced and the port is not configured with protection, optimize the electrical-layer ASON services traversing the port to other ports or other boards (the preset restoration paths of the services are preferred if they do not traverse the port of the optical module to be replaced) before module replacement. Then, switch the services back to the original paths after module replacement. If the port of the optical module to be replaced is configured with protection, module replacement does not affect services when the protection switching functions properly.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, optical power meter Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
615
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Precautions
CAUTION Before you connect a fiber to a pluggable optical module, test the input optical power of the module and confirm that the tested input optical power is within the normal range. Otherwise, the input optical power might cross the overload point and the receiver optical module will be burned and damaged. The overload optical power point of an APD receiver laser is only -9 dBm, which must be considered with special caution to prevent the optical module from being burned or damaged.
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare pluggable optical module. The part number of the new pluggable optical module must be the same as the part number of the original. For details, see "Querying Optical Module Information". NOTE
For boards supporting TXFP modules, you can use a TXFP module when replacing the XFP module on these boards.
Step 2 Review and record the current NE alarms. Step 3 Query whether the ports of the optical module to be replaced are configured with protection. For details, see Replacing the Optical Transponder Board and Replacing the Tributary and Line Board. l
If the port of the optical module to be replaced is not configured with protection, go to Step 4.
l
If the port of the optical module to be replaced is configured with protection: – When you replace the optical module of the protection channel, go to Step 4. – When you replace the optical module of the working channel, perform a protection switching. For details, see Replacing the Optical Transponder Board and Replacing the Tributary and Line Board.
Step 4 Remove the fiber on the port of the optical module.
WARNING Cover the fiber with a protection cap immediately after you remove it. Step 5 Test the input optical power. Prevent the input optical power from crossing the overload point; otherwise, the receiver optical module will be burned and damaged.For the procedure, see the "Testing Optical Power by Using an Optical Power Meter" in Supporting Tasks. Step 6 Replace the fault optical module. For details, see Figure 8-26.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
616
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
NOTE
l Before removing an optical module, ensure that the fiber jumpers connected to the ports of the optical module are removed. l Before inserting an optical module, ensure that there are no fiber jumpers on the ports of the optical module.
Figure 8-26 Inserting and removing the eSFP/SFP/XFP
port
2 1 latch
Removing eSFP/SFP+/XFP 1.Pull out fibre connectors first before removing eSFP/SFP+/XFP. 2.Pull the safty latch to pull out eSFP/SFP+/XFP from the port. 3.Cover the optical port with cover.
eSFP/SFP+ XFP
Inserting eSFP/SFP+/XFP 1.Insert the eSFP/SFP+/XFP into the port.
Step 7 Check the wavelength of the new optical module on the U2000. Make sure the wavelength is the same as that of the original. 1.
In the NE Explorer, select the desired board and choose Configuration > WDM Interface from the Function Tree.
2.
Select By Function, and select Band Type/Wavelength No./Wavelength(nm)/ Frequency(THz) from the drop-down list.
3.
Click Query to view Band Type/Wavelength No./Wavelength(nm)/Frequency(THz) of each optical port. NOTE
If the replaced optical module is a tunable optical module, after the optical module is replaced, the SCC delivers the wavelength configuration of the original optical module automatically.
Step 8 Insert the fiber removed in Step 4. Step 9 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. ----End
8.11 Replacing the EFI Frame This section describes how to replace the EFI frame in the OptiX OSN 6800. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
617
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Impact on System If the ETH3 interface is in use, the communication between the ETH3 interface and the slave subrack or the CRPC/ROP board connected to the interface is interrupted during replacement of the EFI frame in the OptiX OSN 6800. If the LAMP1 or LAMP2 interface is in use, the corresponding alarm indicator on the cabinet does not light up in case of an alarm during the replacement. If the ALMO or ALMI interface is in use, the alarms generated during the replacement fail to be output by using the external equipment. The existing services, however, are not affected.
Tools, Equipment and Materials ESD bag, Philips screwdriver
Procedure Step 1 Select a new board. The model number of the new board must be the same as that of the original board. Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Replace the EFI frame on site. For details, see Figure 8-27. Figure 8-27 Replacing the EFI frame
1.
Unfasten the screws on the plastic panel of the subrack to remove the panel.
2.
Record the matching relationship between each interface on the EFI frame and the cable connected to the interface, and then remove the cables.
3.
Unfasten the screws on the EFI frame to remove it gently, and then put it into an ESD bag.
4.
Insert the new EFI frame gently, and fasten the screws on it.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
618
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
5.
Connect the removed cables back to the corresponding interfaces according to the recorded matching relationship.
6.
Place the removed plastic panel back to the subrack, and use screws to fasten the plastic panel.
Step 4 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. ----End
8.12 Replacing the EFI Board This section describes how to replace the EFI board in the OptiX OSN 8800.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on the System Replacement of the EFI interrupts alarm signal input and output, communication among subracks, and communication between NE and U2000. In addition, services may be interrupted.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag and U2000
Background Information Subrack ID can be set by DIP switch on EFI board. l
For OptiX OSN 8800 T64 and OptiX OSN 8800 T32: The TN51EFI2 board is connected to the master subrack through the ETH1, ETH2, or ETH3 interface. The ID of each subrack is set by using two DIP switches on the TN51EFI1 board.
l
For OptiX OSN 8800 T16: The TN16EFI board is connected to the master subrack through the ETH1, ETH2, or ETH3 interface. The ID of each subrack is set by using two DIP switches on the TN16EFI board.
The value that can be set by using each of the two DIP switches on the TN51EFI1/TN16EFI board is a binary value 0 or 1. ID1-ID4 correspond to bits 1-4 of SW2, and ID5-ID8 corresponding to bits 1-4 of SW1. Among these ID values, only ID1-ID5 are valid. ID6 -ID8 are reserved. The bits from high to low are ID5-ID1, by which a maximum of 32 states can be set. The value is 00000 by default. "0" indicates the master subrack. The other values indicate slave subracks Figure 8-28 shows the position of the DIP switches on the TN51EFI1 board, Figure 8-29shows the position of the DIP switches on the TN16EFI board. The value represented by the ID5-ID1 is 00001, which is 1 in decimal system. That is, the subrack ID is 1. When the DIP switch is toggle to ON, the value of the corresponding bit is set to 0. NOTE
For details about the principle for configuring the master and slave subracks, see "Master-Slave Subrack" in the Product Description.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
619
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-28 Position of the DIP switches on the TN51EFI1 board
EFI1 CPLD
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON ON
SW1
ON ON ON ON
SW2
Figure 8-29 Position of the DIP switches on the TN16EFI board
U8 SERIAL
SW1
NM_ETH2
SW2
T1
(ID4)
(ID3)
(ID2)
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
(ID5)
(ID1)
(ID6)
ON
ON
(ID7) (ID8)
SW2
SW1 NOTE
The values of ID6 to ID8 are the same as those specified in Figure 8-29.
Figure 8-30 The ID of the subrack: 1-15 SW2
Subrack ID
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
1
ON
6
ON
ON
11
SW2
Subrack ID
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
ON
ON
ON
2
7
12
SW2
Subrack ID
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
3
ON
ON
ON
8
13
SW2
Subrack ID
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
4
ON
9
ON
ON
14
SW2
Subrack ID
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
5
ON
ON
ON
10
15
NOTE
When the ID of the subrack is from 1 to 15, ID5-ID8 of the SW1 must be toggle to ON.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
620
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-31 The ID of the subrack: 16-31 SW1
SW2
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Subrack ID
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
16
ON
19
ON
22
ON
25
ON
28
ON
SW1
SW2
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Subrack ID
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
17
ON
20
ON
23
ON
26
ON
29
ON
SW1
SW2
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
(ID5) (ID6) (ID7) (ID8)
ON ON ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Subrack ID
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
(ID1) (ID2) (ID3) (ID4)
ON ON ON
18
ON
21
ON
24
ON
27
ON
30
ON
31
ON
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version and model number of the new board are the same as those of the original. NOTE
If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Follow the steps below to replace the EFI on site. 1.
Record the mapping relationships of the board interfaces and the cables and wires.
2.
Remove the cables and wires on the connectors.
3.
TN51EFI board: Loosen the screw at the top right corner of the board. TN16EFI board: Loosen two screws at the top corner of the board.
4.
Gently pull out the board and put it into the ESD bag.
5.
Before inserting a new EFI board to the original slot, ensure that the DIP switch on the new EFI board is the same as that of the EFI board to be replaced.
6.
Gently insert the new board.
7.
View the subrack ID displayed in the LCD screen on the front panel of the board to ensure that the subrack ID is correct. For OptiX OSN 8800 T64 and OptiX OSN 8800 T32, the subrack ID is displayed on the SCC board; For OptiX OSN 8800 T16, the subrack ID is displayed on the AUX board.
8.
TN51EFI board: Tighten the captive screw at the top right corner of the board. TN16EFI board: Tighten two captive screws at the top corner of the board.
9.
Connect the cables and wires on the connectors as recorded.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
621
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 4 Verify that there are no faults on the board. Query the U2000 for alarms on the NE and ensure that the alarm detected in Step 2 is cleared. ----End
8.13 Replacing the PIU Board This section describes how to replace the PIU board.
Prerequisite You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on the System When 1+1 backup is provided, replacing the standby PIU brings no impact on services.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag, U2000, Phillips screwdriver, power meter
Precautions
WARNING Before replacing a PIU board, you must switch off the input power supply on the PIU board.
Procedure (OptiX OSN 6800/3800) Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version and model number of the new board are the same as those of the original. NOTE
If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Switch off the corresponding power output switch on the DC power distribution unit on the top of the cabinet.
CAUTION l For OptiX OSN 6800, there are 6 power output switches on each of the right and left sides of the DC power distribution unit. Do shut down the corresponding switch. For details, refer to Quick Installation Guide. Step 4 Remove the power cables on the PIU board to be replaced. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
622
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 5 Inform the onsite maintenance engineer and replace the board. For details about how to replace a board, see "step 4, step 5, and step 6" of Procedure of Replacing a Board Step 6 After the replacement, attach the power cables back to the new PIU board. Switch on the corresponding power switch on the DC power distribution unit. Step 7 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. ----End
Procedure (OptiX OSN 8800) Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version and model number of the new board are the same as those of the original. NOTE
If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Switch off the corresponding power output switch on the DC power distribution unit on the top of the cabinet.
CAUTION l For OptiX OSN 8800, there are 4 power output switches on each of the right and left sides of the DC power distribution unit. Do shut down the corresponding switch. For details, refer to Quick Installation Guide. You can use a power meter to verify there is no power on the line. Step 4 Remove the plastic cover on the power input terminal block on the PIU board by using the cross screwdrivers. Step 5 Unfasten the nuts on the power input terminals by using the cross screwdrivers and remove the power cables. Step 6 Follow the steps below to replace the PIU: 1.
Loosen the screw at the top right corner of the unit.
2.
Gently remove the unit, and put it into the ESD bag.
3.
Gently, insert the new PIU.
4.
Tighten the screw at the top right corner of the unit.
Step 7 After the replacement, attach the power cables back to the new PIU board. Switch on the corresponding power switch on the DC power distribution unit. Step 8 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. ----End Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
623
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
8.14 Replacing the Power Switch on the DC Power Distribution Box This section describes how to replace a faulty power switch on the DC power distribution box.
Prerequisites None
Impact on System None
Tools, Equipment and Materials Cross screwdriver, screw
Background Information l
OptiX OSN 8800 uses the standard -48V/-60V DC power supply. The -48V/-60 DC power supply is distributed to the working subracks through the power box shown in Figure 8-32 and Figure 8-33 .
l
OptiX OSN 6800 uses the standard -48V/-60V DC power supply. The -48V/-60 DC power supply is distributed to the working subracks through the power box shown in Figure 8-34.
Figure 8-32 Front panel of the DC power distribution box in the OptiX OSN 8800 T64&8800 T32 Power supply output area
Power supply switch area
Power supply input area
A
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
Power supply switch area
Power supply output area
B
624
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-33 Front panel of the DC power distribution box in the OptiX OSN 8800 T16 Power supply output area
+ 1
+ 2
+ 3
Power supply input area
Power supply switch area
Power supply switch area
Power supply output area
+
+
1
4
+ 2
+ 3
+ 4
Figure 8-34 Front panel of the DC power distribution box in OptiX OSN 6800 1
2
3
3
2
4
1
4
1. Output cable terminal
2. Grounding cable
3. Input cable terminal
4. Power switch
Procedure (Replacing a DC Power Distribution Box Other Than DPD63-8-8) 1.
Set the faulty switch on the DC power distribution box to the OFF position. The power distribution box can be seen in Figure 8-32. There are 4 power switches in each side.
2.
Loosen the captive screw on the front panel of the faulty power switch with the cross screwdriver as shown in Figure 8-35. Remove the faulty power switch from the DC power distribution box.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
625
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-35 Loosen the captive screw
3.
Loosen the two screws between the faulty power switch and the plastic protective shell to separate the power switch from the protective shell. See Figure 8-36. Figure 8-36 Loosen the two screws between the faulty power switch and the plastic protective shell
4.
Get a new power switch, and ensure the state is OFF.
5.
Install the new power switch and the plastic protective shell.
6.
Insert the new power switch into the DC power distribution box. Tighten the captive screw on the front panel of the new power switch with the cross screwdriver.
7.
Set the new power switch to the state of ON. Check RUN indicator of the PIU board which connects to the power distribution box through the new power switch. l If the RUN indicator is on, it indicates the new power distribution unit works normally.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
626
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
l If the RUN indicator is off, check if the connection of the input power cables is correct: – if the connection is wrong, reconnect the cables. – if the connection is correct, replace the power switch again.
8.15 Replacing the Fan Tray Assembly This section describes how to replace the fan tray assembly.
Prerequisites You must be an NMS user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
Impact on the System The equipment can work normally for three minutes when no fans are provided. When there is a fault in the fan tray assembly, replace it immediately to avoid any damage to the equipment due to power heat dissipation. Replacing the fan tray assembly does not interrupt service.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD bag and U2000
Procedure Step 1 Select a spare board. Ensure the name, version and model number of the new board are the same as those of the original. NOTE
If the version is inconsistent, determine if the board with different versions can be replaced.
Step 2 Review and record the current alarms on the NE. Step 3 Follow the steps below to replace the fan tray assembly on site. 1.
Remove the faulty fan tray assembly.
2.
Insert a spare fan tray assembly immediately.
3.
Put the fan tray assembly replaced into an ESD bag. NOTE
When the subrack is powered on for the first time, the fans rotate at a low or medium speed for the first 20 minutes. After 20 minutes, the fans rotate at the specified speed.
Step 4 Query alarms and performances of the local NE and of the opposite NE. Confirm that the original alarms or performances are cleared. ----End
8.16 Replacing the Air Filter Replace the air filter periodically to ensure efficient heat dissipation from the equipment. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
627
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Prerequisite None
Impact on System None
Tools, Equipment, and Materials None
Precaution
CAUTION When pulling out the air filter during its replacement, do not pull out the fans. Gently pull out the air filter to prevent dust disturbance. NOTE
Air filter replacement It is recommended every six months.
Procedure (OptiX OSN 8800/6800) Step 1 Hold the grooves on the two sides of the air filter panel with two fingers and pull out the air filter. Figure 8-37 and Figure 8-38 shows the position of the air filter. Figure 8-37 Pulling out the air filter (OptiX OSN 8800)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
628
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-38 Pulling out the air filter (OptiX OSN 6800)
Step 2 Gently slide the new air filter into the original position along the guide rails below the fan tray assembly. ----End
Procedure (OptiX OSN 3800) Step 1 Pull out the air filter by the handle. Figure 8-39 shows the position of the air filter. Figure 8-39 Pulling out the air filter(OptiX OSN 3800)
Fan Air filter
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
629
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 2 Gently slide the new air filter into the original position along the guide rails on the left part of the fan tray assembly. ----End
8.17 Replacing SDI Components This section describes how to replace a component (such as fan module, power supply module, and control board) on the digital video O/E conversion chassis and how to replace the SDIspecific SFP module on the TOM board.
Prerequisite None
Impact on System l
Replacing a fan module has no impact on the existing services. NOTE
A fan module must be replaced in time after it is damaged. This prevents the SDI from being damaged due to excessively high working temperature.
l
Replacing a power supply module has no impact on the existing services if there are active and standby power supply modules. Otherwise, the digital video O/E conversion chassis is powered off during the replacement and thus the existing services are interrupted.
l
Replacing a control board has no impact on the existing services if there are active and standby control boards. NOTE
The preceding components in the digital video O/E conversion chassis are hot-swappable.
l
Replacing an SFP module interrupts the existing services. NOTE
This SFP module is dedicated for the SDI.
Tools, Equipment and Materials ESD bag, flathead screwdriver
Background Information The SDI consists of an O/E conversion chassis and the SFP module on the TOM board. The SFP module on the TOM board is specific for connecting to the SDI.
Procedure Replace a fan module, power supply module, or control board according to the following steps. For the steps of replacing an SFP module, see 8.10 Replacing the Pluggable Optical Module. Step 1 Select a spare board. The name and model number of the new board must be the same as those of the original board. Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
630
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 2 Use a flathead screwdriver to unfasten the fastening screws on the front panel of the module to be replaced. Then, remove the module from the SDI O/E conversion chassis and put it into an ESD bag. 1
Control Card Power Supply Module
Fan Module
2
Step 3 Insert a new module into the slot that houses the original module. Step 4 After the new module is positioned properly in the slot, use the flathead screwdriver to tighten the fastening screws on the front panel. ----End
8.18 Replacing the Subrack If the backplane of a subrack has bent pins or other defects, the subrack must be replaced. This section describes how to replace the subrack.
Prerequisites l
You must be an NM user with "NE and network operator" authority or higher.
l
The FTP/TFTP/SFTP server is configured and the FTP/TFTP/SFTP service is started. For more information, see U2000 User Guide for NE Software Management.
Impact on the System l
Impact on services: – When a subrack is replaced, all services carried by the subrack are interrupted. NOTE
You are advised to migrate important services or optimize ASON services to other subracks before you replace a subrack, minimizing impact on services.
l
Impact on communication: – When a subrack on a gateway NE (GNE) is replaced, the GNE will be unreachable and any non-GNEs connected to the GNE may be unreachable. Before replacing a subrack on a GNE, removing the gateway from this NE and switching it to a different NE is
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
631
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
recommended. For details on how to switch GNEs, see the U2000 Operator Guide for NG WDM NE Management. – If you replace the master subrack on a non-GNE, the master subrack and all slave subracks will be unreachable. If you replace a slave subrack on a non-GNE, the slave subrack will be unreachable, and other slave subracks that communicate with the master subrack through the slave subrack will be unavailable. l
Other impact: – All features, such as automatic level control (ALC) and automatic power equilibrium (APE), that involve multiple NEs will be affected.
Tools, Equipment, and Materials ESD wrist strap, ESD gloves, dustproof cap, fiber cleaning tissue, Phillips screwdriver, ESD bag, U2000
Precautions l
To ensure a safe subrack installation process, two engineers must work together. One holds the subrack while the other tightens screws that attach it to the rack.
l
Before replacing a subrack, prepare backup boards for any boards that are unprotected. If boards are damaged during subrack replacement, the backup boards can be used to restore services quickly.
l
Before replacing a subrack, ensure that labels with complete and accurate information are attached to all cables and fibers connected to the subrack.
l
During the subrack replacement process, do not power off or perform warm or cold reset on master or slave subracks related to the subrack being replaced.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
632
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Subrack Appearance Figure 8-40 OptiX OSN 8800 T64 subrack structure diagram
3
1
6
2
5 3 4
1. Board area
2. Fiber cabling area
3. Fan tray assembly
4. Air filter
5. Fiber spool
6. Mounting ear
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
633
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-41 OptiX OSN 8800 T32 subrack structure diagram
3
6
1 5
2
3 4
1. Board area
2. Fiber cabling area
3. Fan tray assembly
4. Air filter
5. Fiber spool
6. Mounting ear
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
634
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-42 OptiX OSN 8800 T16 subrack structure diagram
1
6
5 2 3 4
1. Board area
2. Fiber cabling area
3. Fan tray assembly
4. Air filter
5. Fiber spool
6. Mounting ear
Figure 8-43 OptiX OSN 6800 subrack structure diagram 1
2
7
3 6
4 5
1. Indicator
2. Board area
3. Air filter
4. Fiber cabling area
5. Fan tray
6. Fiber spool
7. Mounting ear
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
635
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-44 Appearance of an OptiX OSN 3800 chassis
5 1 4 2
3
1. Grounding connector 2. Fiber frame 3. Board area 4. Antistatic jack 5. Fan indicator
Procedure Step 1 Put on an ESD wrist strap or a pair of ESD gloves. Step 2 Have a new subrack available to replace the target subrack. This new subrack must have the same name and be the same model as the target subrack. NOTE
Before replacing the target suback with a new subrack, ensure that there are no bent pins on the backplane connector of the new subrack.
Figure 8-45 Bent pins on the backplane connector
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
636
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Step 3 Query and record information on current alarms for the target subrack. Step 4 Back up the NE database to the NMS server. 1.
In the Main Topology view, choose Administration > NE Software Management > NE Data Backup/Restoration from the Main Menu.
2.
Right click the device(s) that you want to backup in the NE View table. NOTE
The Backup Information tab is unavailable when multiple devices are selected.
3.
Select Backup... to open the Backup dialog.
4.
Select the option NMS Server or NMS Client to backup the selected device information. NOTE
By default the NMS Server is selected. If the NMS Server is selected, the selected device information is stored on the NMS server.
to select the location where the device
5.
Optional: If the NMS Client is selected, click data are to be backed up.
6.
Click Start to start the backup operation for the selected device(s). On the NE View tab page, the backup progress is displayed.
7.
When the backup operation is successful, the NMS creates the dbf.pkg file in the NEName/ yyyymmddhhmmss directory. "NEName" indicates the name of the NE, "yyyymmdd" indicates the date when the backup is created, and "hhmmss" indicates the time when the backup is created.
Step 5 Use the switch on the power distribution unit (PDU) at the top of the rack to power off the target subrack. Step 6 Remove all cables and fibers connected to the target subrack. NOTE
Keep fiber connectors clear by capping them immediately after fibers are disconnected from the subrack. Also keep disconnected cables clean for later use.
Step 7 Loosen the screws for securing the target subrack using a Phillips screwdriver and remove the subrack. Place the subrack on an ESD pad. Step 8 Install the new subrack into the rack and secure it with screws. Step 9 Take the boards from the subrack that has been removed and install them on the new subrack. NOTE
Before installing a board on the new subrack, check that the connectors on the board are in good condition.
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
637
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
8 Parts Replacement
Figure 8-46 Position of connectors on a board
Figure 8-47 Example of a damaged connector
Step 10 Use the labels to reconnect the cables and fibers to the new subrack. Restore the original network cable connections between subracks. NOTE
Clean the fiber connectors with fiber cleaning tissues before reconnecting fibers.
Step 11 Use the switch on the PDU at the top of the rack to power on the new subrack. Step 12 Wait 20 minutes. Check that there are no new alarms reporting abnormalities in the new subrack. Step 13 Operate the subrack for 24 consecutive hours. If no alarm reporting abnormalities are generated during that period, the replacement process is a success and the new subrack is working properly. ----End
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
638
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
9
9 Nominal Central Wavelength and Frequency of the DWDM System
Nominal Central Wavelength and Frequency of the DWDM System NOTE
C-band 80-wavelength systems consist of even and odd wavelengths. The information about odd and even wavelengths is provided below: l
C_EVEN: indicates even-numbered wavelengths. In total there are 40 even wavelengths. The center frequency of the even wavelengths is within the range of 192.100 THz to 196.000 THz (center wavelength is within the range of 1529.55 nm to 1560.61 nm) and the frequency spacing is 100 GHz.
l
C_ODD: indicates odd-numbered wavelengths. In total there are 40 odd wavelengths. The center frequency of the odd wavelengths is within the range of 192.150 THz to 196.050 THz (center wavelength is within the range of 1529.16 nm to 1560.20 nm) and the frequency spacing is 100 GHz.
Table 9-1 Wavelengths and frequencies of a C-band 80-channel (spacing of 50 GHz) system
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Wavele ngth No.
Central Frequency (THz)
Central Wavelength (nm)
Wavele ngth No.
Central Frequency (THz)
Central Wavelength (nm)
1
196.05
1529.16
41
194.05
1544.92
2
196.00
1529.55
42
194.00
1545.32
3
195.95
1529.94
43
193.95
1545.72
4
195.90
1530.33
44
193.90
1546.12
5
195.85
1530.72
45
193.85
1546.52
6
195.80
1531.12
46
193.80
1546.92
7
195.75
1531.51
47
193.75
1547.32
8
195.70
1531.90
48
193.70
1547.72
9
195.65
1532.29
49
193.65
1548.11
10
195.60
1532.68
50
193.60
1548.51
11
195.55
1533.07
51
193.55
1548.91
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
639
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
9 Nominal Central Wavelength and Frequency of the DWDM System
Wavele ngth No.
Central Frequency (THz)
Central Wavelength (nm)
Wavele ngth No.
Central Frequency (THz)
Central Wavelength (nm)
12
195.50
1533.47
52
193.50
1549.32
13
195.45
1533.86
53
193.45
1549.72
14
195.40
1534.25
54
193.40
1550.12
15
195.35
1534.64
55
193.35
1550.52
16
195.30
1535.04
56
193.30
1550.92
17
195.25
1535.43
57
193.25
1551.32
18
195.20
1535.82
58
193.20
1551.72
19
195.15
1536.22
59
193.15
1552.12
20
195.10
1536.61
60
193.10
1552.52
21
195.05
1537.00
61
193.05
1552.93
22
195.00
1537.40
62
193.00
1553.33
23
194.95
1537.79
63
192.95
1553.73
24
194.90
1538.19
64
192.90
1554.13
25
194.85
1538.58
65
192.85
1554.54
26
194.80
1538.98
66
192.80
1554.94
27
194.75
1539.37
67
192.75
1555.34
28
194.70
1539.77
68
192.70
1555.75
29
194.65
1540.16
69
192.65
1556.15
30
194.60
1540.56
70
192.60
1556.55
31
194.55
1540.95
71
192.55
1556.96
32
194.50
1541.35
72
192.50
1557.36
33
194.45
1541.75
73
192.45
1557.77
34
194.40
1542.14
74
192.40
1558.17
35
194.35
1542.54
75
192.35
1558.58
36
194.30
1542.94
76
192.30
1558.98
37
194.25
1543.33
77
192.25
1559.39
38
194.20
1543.73
78
192.20
1559.79
39
194.15
1544.13
79
192.15
1560.20
40
194.10
1544.53
80
192.10
1560.61
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
640
OptiX OSN 8800/6800/3800 Installing, Operating and Maintaining Your Network(For Field Engineer)
10
10 Nominal Central Wavelengths of the CWDM System
Nominal Central Wavelengths of the CWDM System
Table 10-1 Nominal central wavelengths of the CWDM system
Issue 01 (2012-09-30)
Wavelengt h No.
Wavelength (nm)
Wavelength No.
Wavelength (nm)
11
1471
15
1551
12
1491
16
1571
13
1511
17
1591
14
1531
18
1611
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright © Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.
641